7SK80xx Manual A5 V041001 Us
7SK80xx Manual A5 V041001 Us
7SK80xx Manual A5 V041001 Us
1 2 3 4 A
Manual
E50417-G1140-C344-A5
Note For safety purposes, please note instructions and warnings in the Preface.
Disclaimer of Liability We have checked the contents of this manual against the hardware and software described. However, deviations from the description cannot be completely ruled out, so that no liability can be accepted for any errors or omissions contained in the information given. The information given in this document is reviewed regularly and any necessary corrections will be included in subsequent editions. We appreciate any suggested improvements. We reserve the right to make technical improvements without notice. Document version V04.10.01 Release date 11.2012
Copyright Copyright Siemens AG 2012. All rights reserved. Dissemination or reproduction of this document, or evaluation and communication of its contents, is not authorized except where expressly permitted. Violations are liable for damages. All rights reserved, particularly for the purposes of patent application or trademark registration. Registered Trademarks SIPROTEC, SINAUT, SICAM and DIGSI are registered trademarks of Siemens AG. Other designations in this manual might be trademarks whose use by third parties for their own purposes would infringe the rights of the owner.
Siemens Aktiengesellschaft
Preface
Purpose of this Manual This manual describes the functions, operation, installation, and commissioning of 7SK80 devices. In particular, one will find: Information regarding the configuration of the scope of the device and a description of the device functions and settings Chapter 2; Instructions for Installation and Commissioning Chapter 3; Compilation of the Technical Data Chapter 4; As well as a compilation of the most significant data for advanced users Appendix A. General information with regard to design, configuration, and operation of SIPROTEC 4 devices are set out in the SIPROTEC 4 System Description /1/. Target Audience Protection engineers, commissioning engineers, personnel concerned with adjustment, checking, and service of selective protective equipment, automatic and control facilities, and personnel of electrical facilities and power plants. Applicability of this Manual This manual is valid for: SIPROTEC 4 Multifunctional Protection Device with Motor Protection 7SK80; Firmware Version V4.7 Indication of Conformity This product complies with the directive of the Council of the European Communities on the approximation of the laws of the Member States relating to electromagnetic compatibility (EMC Council Directive 2004/108/EC) and concerning electrical equipment for use within specified voltage limits (Low-voltage Directive 2006/95 EC). This conformity is proved by tests conducted by Siemens AG in accordance with the Council Directive in agreement with the generic standards EN 61000-6-2 and EN 61000-6-4 for EMC directive, and with the standard EN 60255-27 for the low-voltage directive. The device has been designed and produced for industrial use. The product conforms with the international standards of the series IEC 60255 and the German standard VDE 0435.
Preface
Additional Standards
IEEE C37.90 (see Chapter 4 "Technical Data") This product is UL-certified according to the Technical Data. file E194016
Additional Support Should further information on the System SIPROTEC 4 be desired or should particular problems arise which are not covered sufficiently for the purchaser's purpose, the matter should be referred to the local Siemens representative. Our Customer Support Center provides a 24-hour service. Phone: +49 (180) 524-8437 Fax: +49 (180) 524-2471 e-mail: [email protected] Training Courses Enquiries regarding individual training courses should be addressed to our Training Center: Siemens AG Siemens Power Academy Humboldt Street 59 90459 Nuremberg Telephone: +49 (911) 433-7415 Fax: +49 (911) 433-5482 Internet: www.siemens.com/energy/power-academy e-mail: [email protected] Safety Information This manual does not constitute a complete index of all required safety measures for operation of the equipment (module, device), as special operational conditions may require additional measures. However, it comprises important information that should be noted for purposes of personal safety as well as avoiding material damage. Information that is highlighted by means of a warning triangle and according to the degree of danger, is illustrated as follows.
DANGER!
Danger indicates that death, severe personal injury or substantial material damage will result if proper precautions are not taken.
Preface
WARNING!
indicates that death, severe personal injury or substantial property damage may result if proper precautions are not taken.
Caution!
indicates that minor personal injury or property damage may result if proper precautions are not taken. This particularly applies to damage to or within the device itself and consequential damage thereof.
Note indicates information on the device, handling of the device, or the respective part of the instruction manual which is important to be noted.
WARNING!
Qualified Personnel Commissioning and operation of the equipment (module, device) as set out in this manual may only be carried out by qualified personnel. Qualified personnel in terms of the technical safety information as set out in this manual are persons who are authorized to commission, activate, to ground and to designate devices, systems and electrical circuits in accordance with the safety standards. Use as prescribed The operational equipment (device, module) may only be used for such applications as set out in the catalog and the technical description, and only in combination with third-party equipment recommended or approved by Siemens. The successful and safe operation of the device is dependent on proper handling, storage, installation, operation, and maintenance. When operating an electrical equipment, certain parts of the device are inevitably subject to dangerous voltage. Severe personal injury or property damage may result if the device is not handled properly. Before any connections are made, the device must be grounded to the ground terminal. All circuit components connected to the voltage supply may be subject to dangerous voltage. Dangerous voltage may be present in the device even after the power supply voltage has been removed (capacitors can still be charged). Operational equipment with exposed current transformer circuits may not be operated. The limit values as specified in this manual or in the operating instructions may not be exceeded. This aspect must also be observed during testing and commissioning.
Preface
Typographic and Symbol Conventions The following text formats are used when literal information from the device or to the device appear in the text flow: Parameter Names Designators of configuration or function parameters which may appear word-for-word in the display of the device or on the screen of a personal computer (with operation software DIGSI), are marked in bold letters in monospace type style. The same goes for the titles of menus. 1234A Parameter addresses have the same character style as parameter names. Parameter addresses contain the suffix A in the overview tables if the parameter can only be set in DIGSI via the option Display additional settings. Parameter Options Possible settings of text parameters, which may appear word-for-word in the display of the device or on the screen of a personal computer (with operation software DIGSI), are additionally written in italics. This also applies to header bars for selection menus. Messages Designators for information, which may be output by the relay or required from other devices or from the switch gear, are marked in a monospace type style in quotation marks. Deviations may be permitted in drawings and tables when the type of designator can be obviously derived from the illustration. The following symbols are used in drawings: Device-internal logical input signal Device-internal logical output signal Internal input signal of an analog quantity External binary input signal with number (binary input, input indication) External binary input signal with number (example of a value indication) External binary output signal with number (device indication) used as input signal Example of a parameter switch designated FUNCTION with address 1234 and the possible settings ON and OFF
Preface
Besides these, graphical symbols are used according to IEC 60617-12 and IEC 60617-13 or symbols derived from these standards. Some of the most frequently used are listed below:
OR operation of input variables Exclusive OR (antivalence): output is active if only one of the inputs is active Coincidence: output is active if both inputs are active or inactive at the same time Dynamic input signals (edge-triggered) above with positive, below with negative edge Formation of one analog output signal from a number of analog input signals
Timer (pickup delay T adjustable) with setting address and parameter names
Edge-triggered time element with action time T Static memory (SR flipflop) with setting input (S), resetting input (R), output (Q) and inverted output (Q), setting input dominant Static memory (RS-flipflop) with resetting input (R) setting input (S), output (Q) and inverted output (Q), resetting input dominant
Preface
Contents
1 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17 1.1 1.2 1.3 2 Overall Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18 Application Scope . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21 Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23
Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29 2.1 2.1.1 2.1.1.1 2.1.1.2 2.1.1.3 2.1.2 2.1.2.1 2.1.2.2 2.1.2.3 2.1.2.4 2.1.3 2.1.3.1 2.1.3.2 2.1.3.3 2.1.3.4 2.1.4 2.1.4.1 2.1.4.2 2.1.4.3 2.1.4.4 2.1.5 2.1.5.1 2.1.5.2 2.1.5.3 2.1.5.4 2.1.6 2.1.6.1 2.1.6.2 2.1.6.3 2.1.6.4 2.1.7 2.1.7.1 2.1.7.2 2.1.7.3 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30 Functional Scope . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32 Device, General Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37 Power System Data 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52 Oscillographic Fault Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54 Settings Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55 Power System Data 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57 EN100-Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58
Contents
2.2 2.2.1 2.2.2 2.2.3 2.2.4 2.2.5 2.2.6 2.2.7 2.2.8 2.2.9 2.2.10 2.2.11 2.2.12 2.2.13 2.3 2.3.1 2.3.2 2.3.3 2.3.4 2.3.5 2.3.6 2.3.7 2.3.8 2.3.9 2.3.10 2.3.11 2.4 2.4.1 2.4.2 2.4.3 2.4.4 2.5 2.5.1 2.5.2 2.5.3 2.5.4 2.5.5 2.5.6 2.6 2.6.1 2.6.2 2.6.3 2.6.4 2.6.5
Overcurrent Protection 50, 51, 50N, 51N . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 Definite Time High-set Elements 50-3, 50-2, 50N-3, 50N-2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Definite Time Overcurrent Elements 50-1, 50N-1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 Inverse Time Overcurrent Elements 51, 51N . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 Inverse Time Overcurrent Protection 51V (Voltage-controlled / Voltage-restraint) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Dynamic Cold Load Pickup Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 Inrush Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 Pickup Logic and Tripping Logic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 Two-phase Overcurrent Protection (Only Non-Directional) Fast Busbar Protection Using Reverse Interlocking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 Directional Overcurrent Protection Ground 67, 67N . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87 Directional Definite Time High-Current Elements 67N-2, 67N-3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 Definite Time, Directional Overcurrent Element 67N-1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Inverse Time, Directional Overcurrent Element 67N-TOC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92 Interaction with Fuse Failure Monitor (FFM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93 Dynamic Cold Load Pickup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 Inrush Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 Determination of Direction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 Dynamic Cold Load Pickup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 Voltage Protection 27, 59 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 Measurement Principle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 Overvoltage Protection 59 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Undervoltage Protection 27 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Negative Sequence Protection 46. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Definite Time Characteristic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Inverse Time Characteristic 46-TOC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
10
Contents
2.7 2.7.1 2.7.1.1 2.7.1.2 2.7.2 2.7.2.1 2.7.2.2 2.7.3 2.7.3.1 2.7.3.2 2.7.4 2.7.4.1 2.7.4.2 2.8 2.8.1 2.8.2 2.8.3 2.8.4 2.9 2.9.1 2.9.2 2.9.3 2.9.4 2.10 2.10.1 2.10.1.1 2.10.1.2 2.10.1.3 2.10.1.4 2.10.1.5 2.10.1.6 2.10.1.7 2.10.1.8 2.10.1.9 2.10.2 2.10.2.1 2.10.2.2 2.10.2.3 2.10.2.4 2.10.3 2.10.3.1 2.11 2.11.1 2.11.2 2.11.3 2.11.4 2.11.5 2.11.6
Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection) . . . .128 Motor Starting Protection 48. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131 Motor Restart Inhibit 66 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139 Load Jam Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143 Mode of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145 Motor (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection) . . . . . . . . . .148 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149 Frequency Protection 81 O/U . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152 Information List. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153 Thermal Overload Protection 49 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162 Information List. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163 Monitoring Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164 Measurement Supervision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164 General. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164 Hardware Monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164 Software Monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167 Monitoring of the Transformer Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167 Measuring Voltage Failure Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169 Broken Wire Monitoring of Voltage Transformer Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177 Trip Circuit Supervision 74TC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182 Malfunction Responses of the Monitoring Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182 Ground Fault Protection 64, 67N(s), 50N(s), 51N(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185 Ground Fault Detection for cos- / sin- Measurement (Standard Method) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185 Ground Fault Detection for V0/I0- Measurement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .192 Ground Fault Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .197 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204 Information List. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
11
Contents
2.12 2.12.1 2.12.2 2.12.3 2.12.4 2.13 2.13.1 2.13.2 2.13.3 2.13.4 2.14 2.14.1 2.14.2 2.14.3 2.14.4 2.15 2.15.1 2.15.2 2.15.3 2.15.4 2.16 2.16.1 2.16.2 2.16.3 2.17 2.17.1 2.17.2 2.17.3 2.17.4 2.18 2.18.1 2.18.2 2.19 2.19.1 2.19.2 2.19.3
Intermittent Ground Fault Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212 Dir. Intermittent earth fault protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217 Breaker Failure Protection 50BF. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 Flexible Protection Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236 Reverse-Power Protection Application with Flexible Protection Function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 Implementation of the Reverse Power Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 Configuring the Reverse Power Protection in DIGSI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 Temperature Detection via RTD Box. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255 Phase Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257 Function Logic. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258 Pickup Logic of the Entire Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258 Tripping Logic of the Entire Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
12
Contents
2.20 2.20.1 2.20.1.1 2.20.1.2 2.20.1.3 2.20.2 2.20.2.1 2.20.2.2 2.20.2.3 2.20.2.4 2.20.2.5 2.20.3 2.20.3.1 2.20.3.2 2.20.3.3 2.20.4 2.20.4.1 2.20.4.2 2.20.4.3 2.20.4.4 2.20.5 2.20.5.1 2.20.5.2 2.20.5.3 2.20.5.4 2.20.6 2.20.6.1 2.20.7 2.20.7.1 2.20.7.2 2.20.7.3 2.20.8 2.20.8.1 2.20.8.2 2.20.8.3 2.20.8.4 2.20.9 2.20.9.1 2.21 2.21.1 2.21.1.1 2.21.1.2 2.21.2 2.21.2.1 2.21.3 2.21.3.1 2.21.4 2.21.4.1 2.21.5 2.21.5.1
Auxiliary Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260 Message Processing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260 LEDs and Binary Outputs (Output Relays). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260 Information via Display Field or PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .261 Information to a Control Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262 Statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263 Circuit Breaker Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263 Motor Statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272 Measurement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273 Display of Measured Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273 Transmitting Measured Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .276 Average Measurements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .277 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .277 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .277 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278 Min/Max Measurement Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .279 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .279 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .279 Set Points for Measured Values. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281 Set Points for Statistic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .282 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .282 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .282 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .282 Energy Metering. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283 Setting Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283 Commissioning Aids. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .284 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .284 Command Processing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286 Control Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .287 Command Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .288 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .288 Command Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289 Interlocking. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .290 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .290 Command Logging. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
13
Contents
2.22 2.22.1 3
Mounting and Commissioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301 3.1 3.1.1 3.1.2 3.1.2.1 3.1.2.2 3.1.2.3 3.1.2.4 3.1.2.5 3.1.2.6 3.1.3 3.1.3.1 3.1.3.2 3.1.3.3 3.1.3.4 3.2 3.2.1 3.2.2 3.3 3.3.1 3.3.2 3.3.3 3.3.4 3.3.5 3.3.6 3.3.7 3.3.8 3.3.9 3.3.10 3.3.11 3.3.12 3.3.13 3.3.14 3.3.15 3.4 Mounting and Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302 Configuration Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302 Hardware Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306 Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306 Connections of the Current Terminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309 Connections of the Voltage Terminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310 Connection of the temperature sensors to the extension module I/O 2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311 Interface Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313 Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316 Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317 Panel Flush Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318 Cubicle Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319 Panel Surface Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320 Checking Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321 Checking the Data Connections of the Interfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321 Checking the System Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325 Commissioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327 Test Mode and Transmission Block. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328 Testing the System Interface (at Port B) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328 Configuring Communication Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330 Checking the Status of Binary Inputs and Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 333 Tests for Breaker Failure Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 335 Testing User-Defined Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337 Current, Voltage, and Phase Rotation Testing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337 Testing the Reverse Interlocking Scheme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339 Direction Check with Load Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340 Polarity Check for Voltage Input V3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341 Ground Fault Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341 Polarity Check for Current Input IN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342 Checking the Temperature Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344 Trip/Close Tests for the Configured Operating Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 346 Creating Oscillographic Recordings for Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 346 Final Preparation of the Device. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 348
14
Contents
Technical Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349 4.1 4.1.1 4.1.2 4.1.3 4.1.4 4.1.5 4.1.6 4.1.7 4.1.8 4.1.9 4.1.10 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 4.6 4.7 4.8 4.9 4.10 4.11 4.12 4.13 4.14 4.15 4.16 4.17 4.18 4.19 4.20 4.21 4.22 4.23 4.24 4.24.1 4.24.3 4.24.4 General Device Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .350 Analog Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .350 Auxiliary voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .351 Binary Inputs and Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .351 Communication Interfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .352 Electrical Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .355 Mechanical Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .356 Climatic Stress Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .357 Service conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .358 Constructive Design . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .358 UL certification conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .359 Definite-time Overcurrent Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .360 Inverse-time Overcurrent Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .362 Directional overcurrent protection ground . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373 Inrush Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .374 Dynamic Cold Load Pickup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .375 Voltage Protection 27, 59 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
Negative Sequence Protection (definite-time characteristic) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .378 Negative Sequence Protection (inverse-time characteristics) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .379 Motor Starting Time Supervision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .385 Motor Restart Inhibit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .386 Load Jam Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .387 Frequency Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .388 Thermal Overload Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .389 Ground Fault Detection (Sensitive/Insensitive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .391 Intermittent Ground Fault Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .395 Directional intermittent ground fault protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .396 Breaker Failure Protection 50BF Flexible Protection Functions Temperature Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .397 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .398 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .401
User-defined Functions (CFC). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .403 Additional Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .408 Switching Device Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .413 Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .414 Panel Flush and Cubicle Mounting (Housing Size 1/6) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .414 Panel Surface Mounting (Housing Size 1/6) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .415 Bottom view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .416
Appendix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .417 A.1 A.1.1 A.1.1.1 A.1.2 Ordering Information and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .418 Ordering Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .418 7SK80 V4.7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .418 Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .421
15
Contents
Terminal Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 423 7SK80 Housing for panel flush mounting and cubicle installation and for panel surface mounting 423 Connection Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 429 Connection Example for RTD Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440 Connection Examples for SICAM I/O Units and RTD Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440 Current Transformer Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 442 Accuracy limiting factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 442 Effective and Rated Accuracy Limiting Factor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 442 Calculation example according to IEC 600441 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 442 Class conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 443 Cable core balance current transformer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 443 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 443 Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 443 Class accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 444 Default Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 445 LEDs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 445 Binary Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 446 Binary Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 447 Function Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 447 Default Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 448 Protocol-dependent Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 451 Functional Scope . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 452 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 454 Information List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471 Group Alarms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 490 Measured Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 491
A.4.2 A.4.3
A.5 A.5.1 A.5.2 A.5.3 A.5.4 A.5.5 A.6 A.7 A.8 A.9 A.10 A.11
16
Introduction
This chapter introduces the SIPROTEC 4 7SK80 and gives an overview of the device's application, properties and functions.
18 21 23
17
1.1
Overall Operation
The digital SIPROTEC 7SK80 motor protection is equipped with a powerful microprocessor. It allows all tasks to be processed digitally, from the acquisition of measured quantities to sending commands to circuit breakers. Figure 1-1 shows the basic structure of the 7SK80.
Analog Inputs The measuring inputs (MI) convert the currents and voltages coming from the measuring transformers and adapt them to the level appropriate for the internal processing of the device. The device provides 4 current transformers and - depending on the model - additionally 3 voltage transformers. Three current inputs serve for the input of the phase currents, another current input (IN) may be used for measuring the ground fault current IN (current transformer neutral point) or for a separate ground current transformer (for sensitive ground fault detection INs and directional determination of ground faults ) - depending on the model.
Figure 1-1
The optional voltage transformers can either be used to input 3 phase-to-Ground voltages or 2 phase-to-phase voltages and the displacement voltage (open delta voltage) or any other voltages. It is also possible to connect two phase-to-phase voltages in open delta connection.
18
The analog input quantities are passed on to the input amplifiers (IA). The input amplifier IA element provides a high-resistance termination for the input quantities. It consists of filters that are optimized for measured-value processing with regard to bandwidth and processing speed. The analog-to-digital (AD) transformer group consists of an analog-to-digital converter and memory components for the transmission of data to the microcomputer. Microcomputer System Apart from processing the measured values, the microcomputer system (C) also executes the actual protection and control functions. They especially include: Filtering and preparation of the measured quantities Continuous monitoring of the measured quantities Monitoring of the pickup conditions for the individual protective functions Interrogation of limit values and sequences in time Control of signals for the logic functions Output of control commands for switching devices Recording of messages, fault data and fault values for analysis Management of the operating system and the associated functions such as data recording, real-time clock, communication, interfaces, etc. The information is distributed via output amplifiers (OA). Binary Inputs and Outputs The computer system obtains external information through the binary input/output boards (inputs and outputs). The computer system obtains information from the system (e.g remote resetting) or from external equipment (e.g. blocking commands). These outputs include, in particular, trip commands to circuit breakers and signals for the remote indication of important events and conditions. Front Elements Information such as messages related to events, states, measured values and the functional status of the device are visualized by light-emitting diodes (LEDs) and a display screen (LCD) on the front panel. Integrated control and numeric keys in conjunction with the LCD enable interaction with the remote device. These elements can be used to access the device for information such as configuration and setting parameters. Similarly, setting parameters can be accessed and changed if needed. In addition, control of circuit breakers and other equipment is possible from the front panel of the device. Interfaces Communication with a PC can be implemented via the USB DIGSI interface using the DIGSI software, allowing all device functions to be easily executed. Communication with a PC is also possible via port A (Ethernet interface) and port B (System/Service interface) using DIGSI. Port A or port B can be used for connecting a thermobox - via Ethernet - to enter external temperatures (e.g. overload protection). Optionally, up to 5 temperature sensors can be connected directly to the device via the I/O 2 extension module. In addition to the device communication via DIGSI, port B can also be used to transmit all device data to a central evaluator or a control center. This interface may be provided with various protocols and physical transmission schemes to suit the particular application.
19
Power Supply A power supply unit (Vaux or PS) delivers power to the functional units using the different voltage levels. Voltage dips may occur if the voltage supply system (substation battery) becomes short-circuited. Usually, they are bridged by a capacitor (see also Technical Data).
A buffer battery is located under the flap at the lower end of the front cover.
20
1.2
Application Scope
The digital motor protection SIPROTEC 4 7SK80 is suitable as protection and monitoring unit for asynchronous machines of any size. It can nevertheless also be used in busbar feeders or as line protection in networks with grounded, low-resistance grounded, isolated or compensated star point structure. It is suited for networks that are radial and supplied from a single source, open or closed looped networks and for lines with sources at both ends. The device includes the functions that are usually necessary for protection, monitoring of circuit breaker positions and control of circuit breakers; therefore, the device can be employed universally. The device provides excellent backup facilities of differential protective schemes of any kind for lines, transformers, generators, motors, and busbars of all electromotive series.
Protection Functions The basic function is the motor protection with start-up time monitoring, restart inhibit and load step function. Additionally, there is a non-directional overcurrent protection with three definite time elements each and one inverse time Element for the phase currents and the ground current. For the inverse time Elements, several characteristics of different standards are provided. Alternatively, a user-defined Curve can be used for the sensitive ground fault detection. Further protection functions included are the negative sequence protection, overload protection, circuit breaker failure protection and ground fault protection. Depending on the ordered variant, further protection functions are included, such as frequency protection, overvoltage and undervoltage protection, and ground fault protection for high-resistance ground faults (directional or non-directional). External detectors can measure ambient temperatures or coolant temperatures (also possible by means of an external RTD box). Control Functions The device provides a control function which can be accomplished for activating and deactivating the switchgear via operator buttons, port B, binary inputs and - using a PC and the DIGSI software - via the front interface. The status of the primary equipment can be transmitted to the device via auxiliary contacts connected to binary inputs. The present status (or position) of the primary equipment can be displayed on the device, and used for interlocking or alarm condition monitoring. The number of operating equipments to be switched is limited by the binary inputs and outputs available in the device or the binary inputs and outputs allocated for the switch position indications. Depending on the primary equipment being controlled, one binary input (single point indication) or two binary inputs (double point indication) may be used for this process. The capability of switching primary equipment can be restricted by a setting associated with switching authority (Remote or Local), and by the operating mode (interlocked/non-interlocked, with or without password request). Processing of interlocking conditions for switching (e.g. switchgear interlocking) can be established with the aid of integrated, user-configurable logic functions.
21
Messages and Measured Values; Recording of Event and Fault Data The operational indications provide information about conditions in the power system and the device. Measurement quantities and values that are calculated can be displayed locally and communicated via the serial interfaces. Device messages can be assigned to a number of LEDs on the front cover (allocatable), can be externally processed via output contacts (allocatable), linked with user-definable logic functions and/or issued via serial interfaces. During a fault (system fault) important events and changes in conditions are saved in fault protocols (Event Log or Trip Log). Instantaneous fault values are also saved in the device and may be analyzed subsequently. Communication The following interfaces are available for communication with external operating, control and memory systems. The USB DIGSI interface on the front cover serves for local communication with a PC. By means of the SIPROTEC 4 operating software DIGSI, all operational and evaluation tasks can be executed via this operator interface, such as specifying and modifying configuration parameters and settings, configuring user-specific logic functions, retrieving operational messages and measured values, inquiring device conditions and measured values, issuing control commands. Depending on the ordered variant, additional interfaces are located at the bottom of the device. They serve for establishing extensive communication with other digital operating, control and memory components: Port A serves for DIGSI communication directly on the device or via network. Furthermore, 2 SICAM I/O units 7XV5673 can be connected to this port. Port A can also be used for time synchronization using the NTP protocol. Furthermore, the connection of one or two RTD box for entering external temperatures can be provided via port A (via Ethernet) or port B, for example via RS485. Port B serves for central communication between the device and a control center. It can be operated via data lines or fiber optic cables. For the data transfer, there are standard protocols in accordance with IEC 60870-5103 available. The integration of the devices into the SINAUT LSA and SICAM automation systems can also be implemented with this profile. Alternatively, additional connection options are available with PROFIBUS DP and the DNP3.0 and MODBUS protocols. If an EN100 module is available, you can use the protocols IEC61850, PROFINET or DNP3 TCP. Furthermore, connecting a SICAM I/O unit is possible via IEC651850 GOOSE.
22
1.3
Characteristics
General Characteristics Powerful 32-bit microprocessor system Complete digital processing and control of measured values, from the sampling of the analog input quantities to the initiation of outputs, for example, tripping or closing circuit breakers or other switchgear devices Total electrical separation between the internal processing stages of the device and the external transformer, control, and DC supply circuits of the system because of the design of the binary inputs, outputs, and the DC or AC converters Complete set of functions necessary for the proper protection of lines, feeders, motors, and busbars Easy device operation through an integrated operator panel or by means of a connected personal computer running DIGSI Continuous calculation and display of measured and metered values on the front of the device Storage of min./max. measured values (slave pointer function) and storage of long-term mean values Storing fault indications for the last 8 power system faults (faults in the power system) with real-time assignment and instantaneous values for fault recording for a maximum time period of approx. 18 s Constant monitoring of the measured quantities, as well as continuous self-diagnostics covering the hardware and software Communication with SCADA or substation controller equipment via serial interfaces through the choice of data cable, modem, or optical fibers Battery-buffered clock which can be synchronized via a synchronization signal at the binary input or via a protocol Switching statistics: Counting the number of trip commands initiated by the device, logging the currents of the last switch-off operation initiated by the device, and accumulating the eliminated short-circuit currents of each breaker pole Motor statistics: Recording of the operational information and startup information such as the total number of motor starts, motor operating hours, percentage of motor operating time, total megawatt hours, and the startup information duration and currents for each motor startup Operating hours counter: Counting the operating hours of the protected object under load Commissioning aids such as connection and direction check, status indication of all binary inputs and outputs, easy testing of port B, and influencing of information at port B during test operation. Time Overcurrent Protection 50, 51, 50N, 51N Three definite time overcurrent protective Elements and one inverse time overcurrent protective element for phase current and ground current IN or summation current 3I0 Two-phase operation of the overcurrent protection (IA, IC) is possible For inverse-time overcurrent protection, selection from various characteristics of different standards possible Blocking is possible, e.g. for reverse interlocking with any Element Instantaneous tripping by any Element is possible when switching onto a fault In-rush restraint with second harmonic current quantities.
23
Ground Fault Protection 50N, 51N Three definite time overcurrent protective elements and one inverse time overcurrent protective element applicable for grounded or high-resistance grounded systems For inverse-time overcurrent protection, selection from various characteristics of different standards In-rush restraint with second harmonic current quantities. Instantaneous tripping by any overcurrent Element upon switch onto fault is possible. Directional overcurrent protection ground Three definite time elements and one inverse time element operate parallel to the non-directional overcurrent elements. Their pickup value and delay can be set independently Direction determination with quadrature voltages and voltage memory, therefore dynamically unlimited directional sensitivity Direction determination is phase-selective and separate ground and summation current faults. Dynamic Cold Load Pick-up Function 50C, 50NC, 51C, 51NC, 67C, 67NC Dynamic changeover of time overcurrent protection settings, e.g. when cold load conditions are recognized Detection of cold load condition via circuit breaker position or current threshold. Activation also possible via binary input. Voltage Protection 27, 59 Two element undervoltage detection via the positive-sequence system of the voltages, phase-to-phase or phase-to-ground voltages Choice of current supervision for 27-1 and 27-2 Separate two-element overvoltage detection of the largest voltages applied or detection of the positive or negative sequence component of the voltages Settable dropout ratio for all elements of the undervoltage and overvoltage protection. Negative Sequence Protection 46 Evaluation of the negative sequence component of the currents Two definite-time elements 46-1 and 46-2 and one inverse-time element 46-TOC; curves of common standards are available for 46-TOC. Motor Starting Protection 48 Inverse time tripping characteristic based on an evaluation of the motor starting current Definite time delay for blocked rotor. Motor Restart Inhibit 66, 86 Approximate computation of the rotor overtemperature Startup is permitted only if the rotor has sufficient thermal reserves for a complete startup Disabling of the start inhibit is possible if an emergency startup is required.
24
Load Step Function Detection of mechanical or thermal overload of the rotor. Frequency Protection 81 O/U Monitoring of falling below (f<) and/or exceeding (f>) with 4 frequency limits and time delays that are independently adjustable Insensitive to harmonics and abrupt phase angle changes Adjustable undervoltage threshold. Thermal Overload Protection 49 Thermal profile of energy losses (overload protection has full memory capability) True r.m.s. calculation Adjustable thermal warning element Adjustable alarm level based on current magnitude Additional time constant setting for motors to accommodate the motor at standstill Integration of the ambient temperature or coolant temperature is possible via internal temperature detection or an external thermobox. Monitoring Functions Increased reliability due to monitoring of the internal measurement circuits as well as the hardware and software Fuse failure monitor with protection function blocking Monitoring of the current transformer and voltage transformer secondary circuits using sum and symmetry supervision with optional protection function blocking Trip circuit monitoring possible Phase rotation check. Ground Fault Detection 50N(s), 51N(s), 67N(s), 59N/64 Displacement voltage is measured or calculated from the three phase voltages. Determination of a faulty phase on ungrounded or grounded systems. Two-element ground fault detection: High-current element 50Ns-2 and overcurrent element 50Ns-1. High sensitivity (as low as 1 mA) Overcurrent element with definite time or inverse time delay. For inverse-time overcurrent protection, a user-defined characteristic is available. Direction determination with zero sequence quantities(I0, V0), wattmetric ground fault direction determination. A sector characteristic can be set as directional characteristic Any Element can be set as directional or non-directional forward sensing directional, or reverse sensing directional Optionally applicable as additional ground fault protection.
25
Intermittent Ground Fault Protection Detects and accumulates intermittent ground faults Tripping after configurable total time. Directional intermittent ground fault protection Detects intermittent ground faults Direction determination Tripping after settable number of intermittent restrikes Breaker Failure Protection 50 BF By checking the current and/or evaluating the circuit breaker auxiliary contacts Started by any integrated protection function that trips Initiation possible via a binary input from an external protective device. Flexible Protective Functions Up to 20 customizable protection functions with three-phase or single-phase operation Any calculated or directly measured quantity can be evaluated on principle. Standard protection logic with a constant (i.e. definite-time) characteristic curve Internal and configurable pickup and dropout delay Modifiable message texts. RTD box/temperature detection Detection of any ambient temperatures or coolant temperatures using external RTD boxes or internal temperature detection via the extension module I/O 2. Phase Rotation Selectable ABC or ACB by setting (static) or binary input (dynamic). Circuit-Breaker Maintenance Statistical methods to help adjust maintenance intervals for CB contacts according to their actual wear Several independent subfunctions have been implemented (I procedure, Ix procedure, 2P procedure and I2t procedure) Acquisition and conditioning of measured values for all subfunctions operates phase-selective using one procedure-specific threshold per subfunction.
26
User Defined Functions Freely programmable linking of internal and external signals in order to implement user-defined logic functions. All standard logic functions (AND, OR, NOT, EXCLUSIVE-OR, etc.) Time delays and limit value interrogations Processing of measured values, including zero suppression, adding a knee curve for a transducer input, and live-zero monitoring. Breaker Control Switching devices can be opened and closed manually using control keys, programmable function keys, via port B (e.g. of SICAM or LSA), or via the user interface (using a personal computer and the DIGSI operating software) Feedback of switching states via the switch auxiliary contacts Plausibility monitoring of the circuit breaker position and check of interlocking conditions.
27
28
Functions
This chapter describes the numerous functions available on the SIPROTEC 4 device 7SK80. It shows the setting possibilities for each function in maximum configuration. Information with regard to the determination of setting values as well as formulas, if required, are also provided. Based on the following information, it can also be determined which of the provided functions should be used.
2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 2.6 2.7 2.8 2.9 2.10 2.11 2.12 2.13 2.14 2.15 2.16 2.17 2.18 2.19 2.20 2.21 2.22
General Overcurrent Protection 50, 51, 50N, 51N Directional Overcurrent Protection Ground 67, 67N Dynamic Cold Load Pickup Voltage Protection 27, 59 Negative Sequence Protection 46
Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection) 128 Frequency Protection 81 O/U Thermal Overload Protection 49 Monitoring Functions Ground Fault Protection 64, 67N(s), 50N(s), 51N(s) Intermittent Ground Fault Protection Dir. Intermittent earth fault protection Breaker Failure Protection 50BF Flexible Protection Functions Reverse-Power Protection Application with Flexible Protection Function Temperature Detection via RTD Box Phase Rotation Function Logic Auxiliary Functions Command Processing Notes on Device Operation 150 154 164 185 207 213 218 224 237 245 256 258 260 286 298
29
2.1
General
The settings associated with the various device functions can be modified using the operating or service interface in DIGSI in conjunction with a personal computer. Some parameters can also be changed using the controls on the front panel of the device. The procedure is described in detail in the SIPROTEC System Description ./1/
2.1.1
Functional Scope
The 7SK80 relay comprises protection functions and additional functions. The hardware and firmware are designed for this scope of functions. Additionally, the control functions can be matched to the system requirements. Individual functions can be activated or deactivated during the configuration procedure or the interaction of functions be modified.
2.1.1.1 Description
Setting the Functional Scope The available protection and additional functions must be configured as Enabled or Disabled. Some functions allow the user to select among several alternatives which are described further below. Functions configured as Disabled are not processed by the 7SK80. There are no indications, and the corresponding settings (functions, limit values) are not relevant during configuration. Note Available functions and default settings are depending on the ordering code of the relay (see A.1 for details).
30
For the elements associated with non-directional overcurrent protection 50(N), 51(N) (phase and ground), various tripping characteristics can be selected at addresses 112 Charac. Phase and 113 Charac. Ground. If only the definite time Curve is desired, select Definite Time. Alternatively, you can select between inverse-time curves according to IEC standard (TOC IEC) or ANSI standard (TOC ANSI). The dropout behavior of the IEC and ANSI curves is specified at address 1210 or 1310 when configuring the time overcurrent protection. Set to Disabled to disable the entire time overcurrent protection. The direction overcurrent protection Ground is set at 11667N/67N-TOC. Here, the same options are available as for non-directional overcurrent protection (except the 50N-3 element). For (sensitive) ground fault detection address 130 S.Gnd.F.Dir.Ch lets you specify the directional characteristic of the sensitive ground fault detection. You can select between cos / sin and V0/I0 mea. as the measurement procedure. The cos / sin procedure (via residual wattmetric current detection) is set by default. If the measuring method cos / sin is set, select between a definite time characteristic (Definite Time) and an inverse time characteristic User Defined PU at address 131 Sens. Gnd Fault. V0/I0 mea. provides the definite time characteristic Definite Time, inverse time characteristics TOC IEC or TOC ANSI. When selecting the setting Disabled, the entire function is disabled. For the intermittent ground fault protection, you can specify the measured quantity (with Ignd, with 3I0 or with Ignd,sens.) to be used by this protection function at address 133 INTERM.EF. At address 134 Dir. Interm. EF you can set the directional intermittent ground fault protection to Enabled or Disabled. For unbalanced load protection, address 140 46 allows you to specify which tripping characteristics to use. You can select between Definite Time, TOC ANSI or TOC IEC. If this function is not required, select Disabled. For overload protection, you can determine at address 142 49 whether the function operates with or without ambient temperature (With amb. temp. or No ambient temp) or whether the entire function is Disabled. In address 170 you can set the breaker failure protection to Enabled or Disabled. The setting option enabled w/ 3I0> subjects the ground current and the negative sequence current to a plausibility check. For the CB maintenance functions, several options are available under address 172 52 B.WEAR MONIT. Irrespective of this, the basic functionality of the summation current formation (I procedure) is always active. It requires no further configurations and adds up the tripping currents of the trips initiated by the protection functions. When selecting the Ix-Procedure, the sum of all tripping current powers is formed and output as reference value. The 2P Procedure continuously calculates the remaining lifespan of the circuit breaker. With the I2t Procedure the square fault current integrals are formed via arc time and output as a reference value. Further information concerning the individual procedures of the CB maintenance are given in Section 2.20.2. You can also disable this function by setting it to Disabled. Under address 182 74 Trip Ct Supv it can be selected whether the trip-circuit supervision works with two (2 Binary Inputs) or only one binary input (1 Binary Input), or whether the function is configured Disabled. If you have set the function to Enabled at address 190 RTD INPUT, you can specify the number and the transmission type of the measuring points (RTD = Resistance Temperature Detector) at address 191 RTD CONNECTION. When connecting an RTD box to the serial port B, set 12 RTD HDX. When connecting an RTD box to port A, select 12 RTD Eth. If the connection is made via the I/O-2 module, select the setting Int.Temp.Meas.. The Appendix provides some implementation examples in the section Connection Examples). The settings in address have to comply with those at the RTD box (see Section 2.17.2, side title RTD box Settings).
31
In address 192 Cap. Volt.Meas. you can specify whether you want to employ capacitive voltage measurement. When selecting YES, you have to specify the bushing capacitance, the line and stray capacitance for the capacitive voltage dividers at the voltage inputs in addresses 241 to 246 (see 2.1.3.2). With capacitive voltage measurement several functions are not available or only partly. See table 2-1 in section 2.1.3.2 for more information regarding this topic. In address 617 ServiProt (CM) you can specify for which purpose port B is used. T103 means that the device is connected to a control and protection facility via serial port, DIGSI means that you are using the port to connect DIGSI and RTD-RS485 means that you are using the port to connect an RTD box. Disabled indicates that you can not use port B. The flexible protection functions can be configured via parameter FLEXIBLE FUNC.. You can create up to 20 flexible functions by setting a checkmark in front of the desired function (an example is given in the section 2.16). If the checkmark of a function is removed, all settings and configurations made previously will be lost. After re-selecting the function, all settings and configurations are in default setting. Setting of the flexible function is done in DIGSI under Settings, Additional Functions and Settings. The configuration is done, as usual, under Settings and Masking I/O (Configuration Matrix).
2.1.1.3 Settings
Addr. 103 104 112 Parameter Grp Chge OPTION OSC. FAULT REC. Charac. Phase Setting Options Disabled Enabled Disabled Enabled Disabled Definite Time TOC IEC TOC ANSI Disabled Definite Time TOC IEC TOC ANSI Disabled Definite Time TOC IEC TOC ANSI Disabled Enabled Disabled Enabled cos / sin V0/I0 mea. Disabled Definite Time User Defined PU Disabled with Ignd with 3I0 with Ignd,sens. Disabled Enabled Default Setting Disabled Enabled Definite Time Comments Setting Group Change Option Oscillographic Fault Records 50/51
113
Charac. Ground
Definite Time
50N/51N
116
67N/67N-TOC
Definite Time
67N, 67N-TOC
Cold Load Pickup 2nd Harmonic Inrush Restraint (sens.) Ground fault dir. characteristic (sensitive) Ground fault
133
INTERM.EF
Disabled
134
Dir. Interm. EF
Disabled
32
Addr. 140 46
Parameter
Setting Options Disabled TOC ANSI TOC IEC Definite Time Disabled Enabled Disabled No ambient temp With amb. temp. Disabled Enabled Disabled Enabled Disabled Enabled Disabled Enabled Disabled Enabled enabled w/ 3I0> Disabled Ix-Method 2P-Method I2t-Method Disabled 2 Binary Inputs 1 Binary Input Disabled Enabled 6 RTD simplex 6 RTD HDX 12 RTD HDX 6 RTD Eth 12 RTD Eth Int.Temp.Meas. NO YES
141 142
48 49
66 Startup Counter for Motors Load Jam Protection 27, 59 Under/Overvoltage Protection 81 Over/Underfrequency Protection 50BF Breaker Failure Protection
172
52 B.WEAR MONIT
Disabled
182
74 Trip Ct Supv
Disabled
190 191
192
Cap. Volt.Meas.
NO
33
Addr. 617
Setting Options Disabled T103 DIGSI RTD-RS485 Flex. Function 01 Flex. Function 02 Flex. Function 03 Flex. Function 04 Flex. Function 05 Flex. Function 06 Flex. Function 07 Flex. Function 08 Flex. Function 09 Flex. Function 10 Flex. Function 11 Flex. Function 12 Flex. Function 13 Flex. Function 14 Flex. Function 15 Flex. Function 16 Flex. Function 17 Flex. Function 18 Flex. Function 19 Flex. Function 20
Please select
Flexible Functions
2.1.2
2.1.2.1 Description
Command-Dependent Messages "No Trip No Flag" The storage of indications assigned to local LEDs and the availability of spontaneous indications can be made dependent on whether the device has issued a trip command. This information is then not issued if during a system disturbance one or more protection functions have picked up but the 7SK80 did not trip because the fault was cleared by another device (e.g. on another line). These messages are then limited to faults in the line to be protected. The following figure illustrates the generation of the reset command for stored indications. The instant the device drops out, the presetting of parameter 610 FltDisp.LED/LCD decides whether the new fault remains stored or is reset.
34
Figure 2-1
Creation of the reset command for the latched LED and LCD messages
Spontaneous Messages on the Display You can determine whether or not the most important data of a fault event is displayed automatically after the fault has occurred (see also Subsection "Fault Messages" in Section "Auxiliary Functions").
client for primary and secondary addresses switched on or off. daylight saving time switched on or off. offset for the time zone in minutes
Address 671 Offset DayT/min offset for daylight saving time in minutes Address 672 W2S month through 675 W2S hour address 676 S2W month through 679 S2W hour month, week (of the month), day of the week, hour of switching to daylight saving time month, week (of the month), day of the week, hour of switching to winter time
35
Access authorization for port A At address 651 ParEN100(LC)blk you can parameterize a read access option via the EN100 module at port A. If the parameter is set to ON, you can read out the device parameters using DIGSI or fetch fault records. IEC 61850 GOOSE Function At address 700 GOOSE-Stop you can set the GOOSE function of the IEC 61850 protocol to active or not. If GOOSE-Stop is set to YES, you can release the GOOSE function again via a binary input during operation.
2.1.2.3 Settings
Addr. 132 610 611 640 Parameter GND CT Scaling FltDisp.LED/LCD Spont. FltDisp. Start image DD Setting Options Sensitive Normal Target on PU Target on TRIP YES NO image 1 image 2 image 3 image 4 image 5 image 6 OFF ON 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 OFF ON OFF ON -1440 .. 1440 min -1440 .. 1440 min 1 .. 12 1 .. 5 Default Setting Normal Target on PU NO image 1 Comments Ground CT Scaling Fault Display on LED / LCD Spontaneous display of flt.annunciations Start image Default Display
651 660 661 662 663 664 665 666 667 668 669 670 671 672 673
ParEN100(LC)blk IP adr[0](Prim) IP adr[1](Prim) IP adr[2](Prim) IP adr[3](Prim) IP adr[0] (Sec) IP adr[1] (Sec) IP adr[2] (Sec) IP adr[3] (Sec) Client activ Daylight Set Offset TZ/min Offset DayT/min W2S month W2S week
DIGSI-config. over EN100 (LC) blocked IP address [0] (NTP-Primary) IP address [1] (NTP-Primary) IP address [2] (NTP-Primary) IP address [3] (NTP-Primary) IP address [0] (NTP-Sekundary) IP address [1] (NTP-Sekundary) IP address [2] (NTP-Sekundary) IP address [3] (NTP-Sekundary) Client activ Daylight Set Offset for time zone in minutes Offset for daylight in minutes month of time set winter to summer week of time set winter to summer
36
Addr. 674
Setting Options Monday Tuesday Wednesday Thursday Friday Saturday Sunday 1 .. 24 1 .. 12 1 .. 5 Monday Tuesday Wednesday Thursday Friday Saturday Sunday 1 .. 24 YES NO
2 10 5 Sunday
hour of time set winter to summer month of time set summer to winter week of time set summer to winter day of time set summer to winter
679 700
3 NO
37
No. 69 70 71 72 73 110 113 125 140 160 177 178 181 191 193 194 232 233 301 302 303 320 321 322 323 335 502 510 545 546 10080 10081 10082 10083
Information DayLightSavTime Settings Calc. Settings Check Level-2 change Local change Event Lost Flag Lost Chatter ON Error Sum Alarm Alarm Sum Event Fail Battery I/O-Board error Error A/D-conv. Error Offset Alarm NO calibr Error neutralCT CT ph mismatch CT gnd mismatch Pow.Sys.Flt. Fault Event sens Gnd flt Warn Mem. Data Warn Mem. Para. Warn Mem. Oper. Warn Mem. New >GOOSE-Stop Relay Drop Out Relay CLOSE PU Time TRIP Time Error Ext I/O Error Ethernet Error Terminal Error Basic I/O
Type of Information OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT_Ev OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT SP SP SP VI VI OUT OUT OUT OUT Daylight Saving Time
Comments
Setting calculation is running Settings Check Level-2 change Local setting change Event lost Flag Lost Chatter ON Error with a summary alarm Alarm Summary Event Failure: Battery empty I/O-Board Error Error: A/D converter Error: Offset Alarm: NO calibration data available Error: Neutral CT different from MLFB LPCT phase Current Transf. mismatching LPCT ground Current Transf. mismatching Power System fault Fault Event sensitive Ground fault Warn: Limit of Memory Data exceeded Warn: Limit of Memory Parameter exceeded Warn: Limit of Memory Operation exceeded Warn: Limit of Memory New exceeded >GOOSE-Stop Relay Drop Out General CLOSE of relay Time from Pickup to drop out Time from Pickup to TRIP Error Extension I/O Error Ethernet Error Current Terminal Error Basic I/O
38
2.1.3
2.1.3.1 Description
The device requires certain data regarding the network and substation so that it can adapt its functions to this data depending on the application. This may be, for instance, nominal data of the substation and measuring transformers, polarity and connection of the measured quantities, breaker properties (where applicable), etc. There are also certain parameters that are common to all functions, i.e. not associated with a specific protection, control or monitoring function. The following section discusses this data.
39
Figure 2-2
Current Connection I4 (Power System) Here, it is communicated to the device whether the ground current of the current transformer neutral point is connected to the fourth current input (I4). This corresponds to the Holmgreen connection, (see connection example in Appendix A.3,A-7). In this case, parameter 280 Holmgr. for i is set to YES. In all other cases, even if the ground current of the own line is measured via a separate ground current transformer, enter the setting NO. This setting exclusively affects the function Current Sum Monitoring (see Section 2.10.1). Current Connection (Power System Data) Via parameter 251 CT Connect. a special connection of the current transformers can be determined. The standard connection is A, B, C, (Gnd). It may only be changed if the device is set to measure one or more ground currents via two current inputs. The standard connection has to be used in all other cases. The following picture illustrates such a special connection.
40
Figure 2-3
The phase currents IA and IC must be connected to the first current input (terminals F1, F2) and to the third (terminals F5, F6) The ground current IN or INS is connected to the fourth input (terminals F7, F8) as usual, in this case the ground current of the line. A second ground current, in this case the transformer starpoint current, is connected to the second current input IN2 (terminals F3, F4). The settings A,G2,C,G; G->B or A,G2,C,G; G2->B are used here. They both define the connection of a ground current IN2 to the second current input (terminals F3, F4). The settings only differ in the calculation of IB. In the case of A,G2,C,G; G->B, the phase current IB is determined from the phase currents IA and IC and from the measured ground current IN or INS at the fourth current input. In the case of A,G2,C,G; G2->B, the phase current IB is determined from the phase currents IA and IC and from the measured ground current IN2 at the second current input. This setting is only possible for devices with sensitive ground current transformer. Therefore, the current IN2 at the second current input is referred to IN in the flexible protection functions and in the operational measured values. The sensitive ground current at the fourth current input is referred to INS. The setting must be selected according to the system requirements. The following table gives an overview of how the protection functions are assigned to the ground current inputs for the special connection.
41
Function
Time overcurrent protection ground 50N/51N (Section 2.2) Directional time overcurrent protection ground 67N 1) (Section 2.3). Ground fault detection 64, 67N(s), 50N(s), 51N(s) (Section 2.11) Display of operational measured values Track in the fault record
1)
x x x
IN IN
INs INs
Notice! The function Directional Time Overcurrent Protection Ground 67N may only be enabled if the ground current of the protected line is measured via IN2. This is not the case in the example shown in Figure 2-3. Here, the ground current of the protected line is measured via IN. The function must be deactivated. A connection in which the function can be enabled is illustrated in the Appendix A.3 Figure A-10.
The settings for address 251 are only possible with DIGSI at Display Additional Settings. The Appendix provides some connection examples at A.3. Note The settings in address 251 CT Connect. for evaluating the phase currents are only effective if address 250 50/51 2-ph prot was set to OFF.
Voltage Transformer Connection (Power System Data) Address 213 specifies how the voltage transformers are connected. VT Connect. 3ph = Van, Vbn, Vcn means that the three phase voltages are wye connected, i.e. the three phase-to-ground voltages are measured. VT Connect. 3ph = Vab, Vbc, VGnd means that two phase-to-phase voltages (open-delta-connection) and the displacement voltage Vgnd are connected. VT Connect. 3ph = Vab, Vbc means that two phase-to-phase voltages (open-delta-connection) are connected. The third voltage transformer of the device is not used. VT Connect. 3ph = Vab, Vbc, Vx means that two phase-to-phase voltages (open-delta-connection) are connected. Furthermore, any third voltage Vx is connected that is used exclusively for the flexible protection functions. The transformer nominal voltages for Vx are set at address 232 and 233. The selection of the voltage transformer connection affects the operation of all device functions that require voltage input. The settings Vab, Vbc or Vab, Vbc, Vx do not allow determining the zero voltage. The associated protection functions are inactive in this case.
42
The table gives an overview of the functions that can be activated for the corresponding connection type (depends also on the ordering number). The functions which are not shown are available for all connection types. Connection type Functions Directional definite-time/inverse-time Sensitive ground fault detection overcurrent protection ground Van, Vbn, Vcn Vab, Vbc, VGnd Vab, Vbc Vab, Vbc, Vx
1)
yes yes no no
Determination of the direction is only possible by evaluating the negative sequence system (otherwise select zero sequence system or negative sequence system).
Measured values, which due to the chosen voltage connection cannot be calculated, will be displayed as dots. With capacitive voltage connection, some functions are not available. Table 2-1 gives information on this topic. The Appendix provides some connection examples for all connection types at A.3. Capacitive Voltage Measurement When selecting capacitive voltage measurement in the Device Configuration at address 192 Cap. Volt.Meas., the voltage will be measured via so-called bushing capacitances. The usual primary voltage transformers are not relevant in this case. Capacitive voltage measurement always measures the phase-toGround voltages from the protection device. The following figure shows this type of connection.
Figure 2-4
In addition to the bushing capacitances, the line and stray capacitances too affect the measured voltage fed to the protection device. These capacitances are primarily determined by the type and length of the connection line. The voltage inputs of the device feature an input capacitance of 2.2nF and an ohmic component of 2.0 M.
43
Two capacitance values must be configured for each of the three voltage inputs when using capacitive voltage measurement. The first value to be configured is the bushing capacitance (CD,Lx). The second value to be configured is the sum of the line and stray capacitance (CS,Lx) and input capacitance (2200 pF). Since the input capacitances can have a tolerance of 20%, they are not considered as a fixed value internally but they have to be configured (see also side heading Optimizing the Configured Capacitance Values). The capacitances are configured as follows: Phase A Phase B Phase C 241 Volt.trans.A:C1 242 Volt.trans.A:C2 243 Volt.trans.B:C1 244 Volt.trans.B:C2 245 Volt.trans.C:C1 246 Volt.trans.C:C2 = CD,A = CS,A + 2200 pF = CD,B = CS,B + 2200 pF = CD,C = CS,C + 2200 pF
Boundary Conditions for the Capacitive Voltage Measurement The voltages at the inputs of the protection devices are the result of the primary nominal voltage, the capacitances in the power system and the impedances of the voltage inputs which are taken into account. These voltages can assume different values for three voltage inputs. The voltage Vsecondary, x for phase x can be determined using the following formula:
with Vprim, x Vsec, x CD,Lx CS,Lx exec. Primary voltage of phase x Voltage at the voltage input of the protection device Value of the bushing capacitance for phase x Value of the line and stray capacitance for phase x System frequency (50 Hz or 60 Hz)
The following figure represents the above equation graphically. The frequency is 50 Hz. With a frequency of 60 Hz, the ratio of secondary voltage to primary voltage is about 20 % higher than the values in this example. The x-axis shows the value of the bushing capacitance. The y-axis shows the resulting ratio o f secondary voltage to primary voltage. As an additional parameter the value C S,LX + 2200 pF, which is the sum of line capacitance, stray capacitance and input capacitance, is varied in a range from 2000 pF to 10,000 pF in increments of 500 pF. Since the input capacitance of 2200 pF can have a tolerance of 20 %, values higher than 1800 pF are recommended here.
44
Figure 2-5
The device can fully function only if the secondary voltage that results from the nominal voltage on the primary side lies within a certain range. If the primary nominal voltage at the voltage inputs causes a too small or too high voltage, the function of the device will be blocked. This plausibility check is run each time the device starts up based on the configured parameter values for the primary nominal voltage and the configured capacitance values. Note The settings for the primary nominal voltage and the settings of the capacitance values must lead to a voltage between 34 V and 140 V on the secondary side (voltage inputs of the device) with nominal voltage on the primary side. Since the input voltages are phase-to-Ground voltages, the operational range for the input voltages is hence 34 V / 3 to 140 V / 3 .
If this condition is not satisfied for at least one of the three voltage inputs, the device will generate the messages Device Failure and 10036 Capac.Par.Fail. after startup. Note Used bushing capacities have to be available exclusively to the connected 7Sx80. Connecting a parallel port, e.g. on a capacitive voltage measuring device, at the same bushing capacities is not allowed.
Internal Normalization of the Measured Voltages The capacitance values for the three voltage inputs will usually not be absolutely identical. From this we can conclude that voltages identical on the primary side are mapped differently at the voltage inputs. The measured voltages are normalized by the device so that the three phase-to-Ground voltages can still be linked by calculation (e.g. to calculate the phase-to-phase voltages of the positive sequence system and of the negative sequence system etc.). This normalization has the effect that the primary nominal voltage in the device leads to voltage values that correspond to the configured secondary nominal voltage (parameter 203 Vnom SECONDARY) even though the real voltages at the input terminals are different. The setting of parameter 203 Vnom SECONDARY should be roughly equivalent to the voltage at the terminals of the protection device at primary nominal voltage. If capacitive voltage measurement is selected, a setting range of 34 V to 140 V is sufficient for this parameter.
45
Optimizing the Configured Capacitance Values In many cases the exact values for the bushing capacitance and for the line and stray capacitance will be unknown. Besides that the capacitance of the voltage inputs has a tolerance of 20 %. These uncertainties can cause amplitude and phase errors of the measured voltage. If the primary voltage is known, the value for the bushing capacitance (CD, x) to be configured can still be optimized later. This is based on the fact that an incorrect configuration of the bushing capacitance usually affects the secondary voltage value and not so much the phase angle. We can gain insight into the amplitude error by comparing the primary phase-to-Ground voltages in the operational measured values with their setpoint values. The value of the configured bushing capacitance should be increased by the percentage that the displayed phase-to-Ground voltage is too large or it should be reduced by the percentage that the displayed phase-toGround voltage is too small. If the phase angle of the primary voltage to the primary current is known, the setting value for the sum of line capacitance and stray capacitance (CS,x) and input capacitance can still be optimized later. This is based on the fact that these capacitances usually affect the phase angle of the secondary voltage and not so much the amplitude. We can gain insight into the phase errors by comparing the phase angles ( A, B and C) in the operational measured values with their setpoint values. The configured value must be corrected by 4 % per degree angle error (actual angle less desired angle). If the angle error is positive, the configured value has to be reduced accordingly; if the angle error is negative it has to be increased accordingly. The prerequisite for the phase angle between phase-to-Ground voltage and phase current to be displayed is that the current amounts to at least 10 % of the nominal value. The optimization steps for the capacitances to be configured for each voltage channel may have to be repeated until the desired accuracy has been achieved. Influence of the Capacitive Voltage Measurement The following table shows how the capacitive voltage measurement affects the voltage-dependent device functions. Table 2-1 Influence of the capacitive voltage measurement Function Directional time overcurrent protection Ground 67, 67N Voltage protection 27, 59 Ground fault detection 64, 50Ns, 67Ns Frequency protection 81 O/U Flexible protection functions Fuse failure monitor Operational measured values operational operational Please observe the increased tolerances of the measured voltage. The voltage elements are not available. The current elements always operate non-directional. operational Operating modes that use the power are not available. not operational Power and energy not available Effect
ATEX100 (Power System) Parameter 235 ATEX100 enables meeting the requirements for protecting explosion-protected motors for thermal replicas. Set this parameter to YES to save all thermal replicas of the 7SK80 devices in the event of a power supply failure. After the supply voltage is restored, the thermal replicas will resume operation using the stored values. Set the parameter to NO, to reset the calculated overtemperature values of all thermal replicas to zero if the power supply fails.
46
Nominal Values of Current Transformers (CTs) At addresses 204 CT PRIMARY and 205 CT SECONDARY information is entered regarding the primary and secondary ampere ratings of the current transformers. It is important to ensure that the rated secondary current of the current transformer matches the rated current of the device, otherwise the device will calculate incorrect primary data. At addresses 217 Ignd-CT PRIM and 218 Ignd-CT SEC, information is entered regarding the primary and secondary ampere rating of the current transformers. In case of a normal connection (starpoint current connected to IN transformer), 217 Ignd-CT PRIM and 204 CT PRIMARY must be set to the same value. If the device features a sensitive ground current input, parameter 218 Ignd-CT SEC is set to 1 A. For US device models (order item 10= C) parameters 205 and 218 are set by default to 5 A. If address 251 CT Connect. has been set so that ground currents are measured by two inputs (setting options A,G2,C,G; G->B or A,G2,C,G; G2->B), you have to enter the primary rated current at address 238 Ignd2-CT PRIM. and at address 239 Ignd2-CT SEC. the secondary rated current of the second ground current transformer connected to IN2. For proper calculation of phase current IB, the primary rated current of the ground current transformer, which is used for the calculation of IB (address 217 or address 238), must be lower than the primary rated current of the phase current transformer (address 204). Nominal Values of Voltage Transformers (VTs) At addresses 202 Vnom PRIMARY and 203 Vnom SECONDARY, information is entered regarding the primary nominal voltage and secondary nominal voltage (phase-to-phase) of the connected voltage transformers. Transformation Ratio of Voltage Transformers (VTs) Address 206 Vph / Vdelta informs the device of the adjustment factor between the phase voltage and the displacement voltage. This information is relevant for the processing of ground faults (in grounded systems and ungrounded systems), for the operational measured value VN and measured-variable monitoring. If the voltage transformer set provides open delta windings and if these windings are connected to the device, this must be specified accordingly in address 213 (see above margin heading "Voltage Connection"). Since the voltage transformer ratio is normally as follows:
the factor Vph/VN (secondary voltage, address 206 Vph / Vdelta) must be set to 3/ 3 = 3 = 1.73 which must be used if the VN voltage is connected. For other transformation ratios, i.e. the formation of the displacement voltage via an interconnected transformer set, the factor must be corrected accordingly. Please take into consideration that also the calculated secondary V0-voltage is divided by the value set in address 206. Thus, even if the V0-voltage is not connected, address 206 has an impact on the secondary operational measured value VN. If Vab, Vbc, VGnd is selected as voltage connection type, parameter Vph / Vdelta is used to calculate the phase-to-ground voltages and is therefore important for the protection function. With voltage connection type Van, Vbn, Vcn, this parameter is used only to calculate the operational measured value of the secondary voltage VN.
47
Trip and close command duration (Breaker) In address 210 the minimum trip command duration TMin TRIP CMD can be set. This setting applies to all protection functions that can initiate tripping. Current Flow Monitoring (Breaker) In address 212 BkrClosed I MIN the pickup threshold of the integrated current flow monitoring function can be set. This parameter is used by several protection functions (e.g. voltage protection with current criterion, overload protection, load jam protection, restart inhibit for motors and circuit breaker maintenance). If the set current value is exceeded, the circuit breaker is considered closed. The threshold value setting applies to all three phases, and must take into consideration all used protection functions. The pickup threshold for the breaker failure protection is set separately (see 2.14.2). When using the device as motor protection and using the overload protection, load jam protection and restart inhibit, the protective relay can distinguish between a running motor and a stopped motor, as well as take into account the different motor cooldown behavior. For this application, the set value must be lower than the minimum no-load current of the motor. Circuit-breaker Maintenance (Breaker) Parameters 260 to 267 are assigned to CB maintenance. The parameters and the different procedures are explained in the setting notes of this function (see Section 2.20.2). Pickup Thresholds of the Binary Inputs (Thresholds BI) At address 220 Threshold BI 1 to 226 Threshold BI 7 you can set the pickup thresholds of the binary inputs of the device. The settings Thresh. BI 176V, Thresh. BI 88V or Thresh. BI 19V are possible. Two-phase Time Overcurrent Protection (Protection Operating Quantities) The two-phase time overcurrent protection functionality is used in isolated or resonant-grounded systems where interaction of three-phase devices with existing two-phase protection equipment is required. Via parameter 250 50/51 2-ph prot the time overcurrent protection can be configured to two or three-phase operation. If the parameter is set to ON, the value 0 A instead of the measured value for IB is used permanently for the threshold comparison so that no pickup is possible in phase B. All other functions, however, operate in three-phase mode. Ground Fault (Protection Operating Quantities) Parameter 613 Gnd O/Cprot. w. lets you specify whether the directional and the non-directional ground fault protection, the breaker failure protection or the fuse failure monitor will use the measured values Ignd (measured) or the values 3I0 (calcul.) calculated from the three phase currents. In the first case, the measured quantity at the fourth current input is evaluated. In the latter case, the summation current is calculated from the three phase current inputs. If the device features a sensitive ground current input (measuring range starts at 1 mA), the ground fault protection always uses the calculated variable 3I0. In this case, parameter 613 Gnd O/Cprot. w. is not available.
48
Voltage Protection (Protection Operating Quantities) In a three-phase connection, the fundamental harmonic of the largest of the three phase-to-phase voltages (Vphph) or phase-Ground voltages (Vph-n) or the positive sequence voltage (V1) or the negative sequence voltage (V2) is supplied to the overvoltage protection elements. In three-phase connection, undervoltage protection relies either on the positive sequence voltage (V1) or the smallest of the phase-to-phase voltages (Vphph) or the phase-to-Ground voltages (Vph-n). This is configured by setting the parameter value in address 614 OP. QUANTITY 59 and 615 OP. QUANTITY 27.
2.1.3.3 Settings
Addresses which have an appended "A" can only be changed with DIGSI, under "Display Additional Settings". The table indicates region-specific default settings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corresponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer. Addr. 201 202 203 204 205 206A 209 210A 212 Parameter CT Starpoint Vnom PRIMARY Vnom SECONDARY CT PRIMARY CT SECONDARY Vph / Vdelta PHASE SEQ. TMin TRIP CMD BkrClosed I MIN 1A 5A 213 VT Connect. 3ph C Setting Options towards Line towards Busbar 0.10 .. 800.00 kV 34 .. 225 V 10 .. 50000 A 1A 5A 1.00 .. 3.00 ABC ACB 0.01 .. 32.00 sec 0.04 .. 1.00 A 0.20 .. 5.00 A Van, Vbn, Vcn Vab, Vbc, VGnd Vab, Vbc Vab, Vbc, Vx 50 Hz 60 Hz 1 .. 50000 A 1A 5A Thresh. BI 176V Thresh. BI 88V Thresh. BI 19V Thresh. BI 176V Thresh. BI 88V Thresh. BI 19V Default Setting towards Line 20.00 kV 100 V 400 A 1A 1.73 ABC 0.15 sec 0.04 A 0.20 A Van, Vbn, Vcn Comments CT Starpoint Rated Primary Voltage Rated Secondary Voltage (L-L) CT Rated Primary Current CT Rated Secondary Current Matching ratio Phase-VT To Open-Delta-VT Phase Sequence Minimum TRIP Command Duration Closed Breaker Min. Current Threshold VT Connection, threephase
50 Hz 60 A 1A Thresh. BI 176V
Rated Frequency Ignd-CT rated primary current Ignd-CT rated secondary current Threshold for Binary Input 1 Threshold for Binary Input 2
221
Threshold BI 2
Thresh. BI 176V
49
Addr. 222
Parameter Threshold BI 3
Setting Options Thresh. BI 176V Thresh. BI 88V Thresh. BI 19V Thresh. BI 176V Thresh. BI 88V Thresh. BI 19V Thresh. BI 176V Thresh. BI 88V Thresh. BI 19V Thresh. BI 176V Thresh. BI 88V Thresh. BI 19V Thresh. BI 176V Thresh. BI 88V Thresh. BI 19V 0.10 .. 800.00 kV 100 .. 225 V NO YES 1 .. 50000 A 1A 5A 1.0 .. 100.0 pF 250 .. 10000 pF 1.0 .. 100.0 pF 250 .. 10000 pF 1.0 .. 100.0 pF 250 .. 10000 pF OFF ON A, B, C, (Gnd) A,G2,C,G; G->B A,G2,C,G; G2->B not reversed reversed 10 .. 50000 A 100 .. 1000000
Comments Threshold for Binary Input 3 Threshold for Binary Input 4 Threshold for Binary Input 5 Threshold for Binary Input 6 Threshold for Binary Input 7 Rated Primary Voltage X Rated Secondary Voltage X Storage of th. Replicas w/o Power Supply Ignd2-CT rated primary c. (conn. to I2) Ignd2-CT rated secondary current (I2) Voltage transducer A: Capacity C1 Voltage transducer A: Capacity C2 Voltage transducer B: Capacity C1 Voltage transducer B: Capacity C2 Voltage transducer C: Capacity C1 Voltage transducer C: Capacity C2 50, 51 Time Overcurrent with 2ph. prot. CT Connection
223
Threshold BI 4
Thresh. BI 176V
224
Threshold BI 5
Thresh. BI 176V
225
Threshold BI 6
Thresh. BI 176V
226
Threshold BI 7
Thresh. BI 176V
232 233 235A 238 239 241 242 243 244 245 246 250A 251A
VXnom PRIMARY VXnom SECONDARY ATEX100 Ignd2-CT PRIM. Ignd2-CT SEC. Volt.trans.A:C1 Volt.trans.A:C2 Volt.trans.B:C1 Volt.trans.B:C2 Volt.trans.C:C1 Volt.trans.C:C2 50/51 2-ph prot CT Connect.
20.00 kV 100 V YES 400 A 1A 10.0 pF 2200 pF 10.0 pF 2200 pF 10.0 pF 2200 pF OFF A, B, C, (Gnd)
Phase LPCT orientation / polarity Rated Normal Current (52 Breaker) Switching Cycles at Rated Normal Current
50
Addr. 262 263 264 265 266 267 276 280 310 311 312 313 314 315 320A 321A 322A 323A 324A 330 332A 613A
Parameter Isc-52 OP.CYCLES Isc Ix EXPONENT Cmd.via control T 52 BREAKTIME T 52 OPENING TEMP. UNIT Holmgr. for i Iph-PRIM ref. Iph-LPCT PRIM Ignd-PRIM ref. Ignd-LPCT PRIM Vph-LPCT SEC Vgnd-LPCT SEC Corr.factor IL1 Corr.factor IL2 Corr.factor IL3 Corr.factor IE Corr.factor IEE V-LPVT SEC V-LPVT PHA Gnd O/Cprot. w.
Setting Options 10 .. 100000 A 1 .. 1000 1.0 .. 3.0 (Setting options depend on configuration) 1 .. 600 ms 1 .. 500 ms Celsius Fahrenheit NO YES 10 .. 50000 A 1 .. 5000 A 1 .. 50000 A 0.01 .. 5000.00 A 10.0 .. 1000.0 mV 10.0 .. 1000.0 mV 0.9000 .. 1.1000 0.9000 .. 1.1000 0.9000 .. 1.1000 0.9000 .. 1.1000 0.9000 .. 1.1000 3.00 .. 17.00 V -10.00 .. 10.00 Ignd (measured) 3I0 (calcul.)
Default Setting 25000 A 50 2.0 None 80 ms 65 ms Celsius NO 400 A 400 A 60 A 2.00 A 225.0 mV 225.0 mV 1.0000 1.0000 1.0000 1.0000 1.0000 3.25 V 0.00 Ignd (measured)
Comments Rated Short-Circuit Breaking Current Switch. Cycles at Rated Short-Cir. Curr. Exponent for the IxMethod 52 B.Wear: Open Cmd. via Control Device Breaktime (52 Breaker) Opening Time (52 Breaker) Unit of temperature measurement Holmgreen-conn. (for fast sum-i-monit.) Primary refer. phase current for prot. Rated primary phase current LPCT Primary refer. ground current for prot. Rated primary ground current LPCT Rated secondary phase voltage LPCT Rated secondary ground voltage LPCT Correction factor for magnitude IL1 Correction factor for magnitude IL2 Correction factor for magnitude IL3 Correction factor for magnitude IE Correction factor for magnitude IEE rated secondary voltage LPVT phase angle LPVT Ground Overcurrent protection with
51
Addr. 614A
615A
OP. QUANTITY 27
V1
2.1.4
2.1.4.1 Description
The data of a fault event can be read out via the device interface and evaluated with the help of the SIGRA 4 graphic analysis software. SIGRA 4 graphically represents the data recorded during the fault event and also calculates additional information from the measured values. Currents and voltages can be presented either as primary or as secondary values. Signals are additionally recorded as binary tracks (marks), e.g. "pickup", "trip". If port B of the device has been configured correspondingly, the fault record data can be imported by a central controller via this interface and evaluated. Currents and voltages are prepared for a graphic representation. Signals are additionally recorded as binary tracks (marks), e.g. "pickup", "trip". The retrieval of the fault data by the central controller takes place automatically either after each protection pickup or after a tipping. If device parameter 651 ParEN100(LC)blk is set to ON, you can also read out fault records via port A (see Section 2.1.2.2).
52
Depending on the selected type of connection of the voltage transformers (address 213 VT Connect. 3ph), the following measured values are recorded in the fault record: Voltage Connection Van, Vbn, Vcn vAB vBC vCA vA vB vC vN vx Note The signals used for the binary tracks can be allocated in DIGSI. yes yes yes yes yes yes yes Vab, Vbc, VGnd yes yes yes yes yes yes yes yes Vab, Vbc yes yes yes Vab, Vbc, Vx yes yes yes
Note If one of the current transformer connection types A,G2,C,G; G->B or A,G2,C,G; G2->B has been selected via parameter 251 CT Connect., the ground current IN2 measured with the second current transformer is indicated under track IN. The ground current detected by the fourth current transformer is indicated under track INs.
53
2.1.4.3 Settings
Addr. 401 Parameter WAVEFORMTRIGGE R MAX. LENGTH PRE. TRIG. TIME POST REC. TIME BinIn CAPT.TIME Setting Options Save w. Pickup Save w. TRIP Start w. TRIP 0.30 .. 5.00 sec 0.05 .. 0.50 sec 0.05 .. 0.50 sec 0.10 .. 5.00 sec; Default Setting Save w. Pickup Comments Waveform Capture
Max. length of a Waveform Capture Record Captured Waveform Prior to Trigger Captured Waveform after Event Capture Time via Binary Input
2.1.5
Settings Groups
Up to four different setting groups can be created for establishing the device's function settings.
2.1.5.1 Description
Changing Setting Groups During operation the user can switch back and forth setting groups locally, via the operator panel, binary inputs (if so configured), the service interface using a personal computer, or via the system interface. For reasons of safety it is not possible to change between setting groups during a power system fault. A setting group includes the setting values for all functions that have been selected as Enabled during configuration (see Section 2.1.1.2). In 7SK80 relays, four independent setting groups (A to D) are available. While setting values may vary, the selected functions of each setting group remain the same.
54
2.1.5.3 Settings
Addr. 302 Parameter CHANGE Setting Options Group A Group B Group C Group D Binary Input Protocol Default Setting Group A Comments Change to Another Setting Group
55
2.1.6
Applications If the primary reference voltage and the primary reference current of the protected object are set, the device is able to calculate and output the percentaged operational measured values. For utilization in motors, detection of a motor start represents an important feature. Exceeding a configured current value serves as a criterion.
2.1.6.1 Description
The general protection data (P.System Data 2) includes parameters common to all functions, i.e. not associated with a specific protection or monitoring function. In contrast to the P.System Data 1 as discussed before, they can be changed with the parameter group.
56
2.1.6.3 Settings
The table indicates region-specific default settings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corresponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer. Addr. 1101 1102 1107 Parameter FullScaleVolt. FullScaleCurr. I MOTOR START 1A 5A 1108 P,Q sign C Setting Options 0.10 .. 800.00 kV 10 .. 50000 A 0.40 .. 10.00 A 2.00 .. 50.00 A not reversed reversed Default Setting 20.00 kV 400 A 2.50 A 12.50 A not reversed Comments Measurem:FullScaleVoltage(Equipm.rating) Measurem:FullScaleCurrent(Equipm.rating) Motor Start Current (Block 49, Start 48) P,Q operational measured values sign
57
2.1.7
EN100-Module
2.1.7.1 Description
The EN100-Module enables integration of the 7SK80 in 100-Mbit communication networks in control and automation systems with the protocols according to IEC 61850 standard. This standard permits uniform communication of the devices without gateways and protocol converters. Even when installed in heterogeneous environments, SIPROTEC 4 relays therefore provide for open and interoperable operation. Parallel to the process control integration of the device, this interface can also be used for communication with DIGSI and for interrelay communication via GOOSE.
58
2.2
Applications The non-directional overcurrent protection is suited for radial systems with single-side infeed or open ring systems, for backup protection of all kinds of comparison protection equipment for lines, transformers, generators, motors, and busbars.
2.2.1
General
The overcurrent protection for the ground current can either operate with measured values IN or with the quantities 3I0 calculated from the three phase currents. Which values are used depends on the setting of parameter 613 Gnd O/Cprot. w. and the selected type of connection of the current transformers. Information on this can be found in Chapter 2.1.3.2, connection examples in the Appendix A.3. Devices featuring a sensitive ground current input, however, generally use the calculated quantity 3I0. The timer for each Element can be blocked via binary input thus suppressing the trip command. If the blocking is cancelled during pickup, the timer will be restarted. The Manual Close signal is an exception in this case. If a circuit breaker is manually closed onto a fault, it can be re-opened immediately. For the overcurrent or high current Element the delay can be bypassed via a Manual Close pulse which results in instantaneous tripping. This pulse is extended up to at least 300 ms. Pickup of the definite-time elements can be stabilized by setting the dropout times. This protection is used in systems where intermittent faults occur. Combined with electromechanical relays, it allows different dropout responses to be adjusted and a time grading of digital and electromechanical relays to be implemented. Pickup and delay settings may be quickly adapted to system requirements via dynamic setting changeover (see Section 2.4). Tripping by the 50-1 and 51 elements (in phases), 50N-1 and 51N elements (in ground path) may be blocked for inrush conditions by utilizing the inrush restraint feature. The following table gives an overview of the interconnections to other functions of the devices 7SK80. Table 2-2 Interconnection to other functions Manual CLOSE Dynamic cold load pickup function Inrush restraint
Overcurrent protection elements 50-1 50-2 50-3 51 50N-1 50N-2 50N-3 51N
59
2.2.2
60
Figure 2-6
If parameter 1213 MANUAL CLOSE is set to 50-2 instant. or 50-3 instant. and manual close detection is used, a pickup causes instantaneous tripping even if the Element is blocked via a binary input.
61
Figure 2-7
If parameter 1313 MANUAL CLOSE is set to 50N-2 instant. or 50N-3 instant. and manual close detection is used, a pickup causes instantaneous tripping even if the Element is blocked via a binary input.
62
2.2.3
63
Figure 2-8
If parameter 1213 MANUAL CLOSE is set to 50 -1 instant. and manual close detection is used, a pickup causes instantaneous tripping even if theElement is blocked via a binary input. The dropout delay only operates if no inrush was detected. An incoming inrush will reset a running dropout delay time.
Figure 2-9
64
Figure 2-10
If parameter 1313 MANUAL CLOSE is set to 50N-1 instant. and manual close detection is used, a pickup causes instantaneous tripping even if the Element is blocked via a binary input. The pickup values of each 50-1, 50-2 Element for the phase currents and 50N-1, 50N-2 Element for the ground current and the valid delay times for each element can be set individually. The dropout delay only functions if no inrush was detected. An incoming inrush will reset a running dropout time delay.
Figure 2-11
65
2.2.4
Pickup Behavior For each Element, an individual pickup value 51 PICKUP or 51N PICKUP is set. Apart from Fundamental, the True RMS can also be measured. Each phase and ground current is separately compared with the setting value 51 or 51N per Element. If a current exceeds 1.1 times the setting value, the corresponding Element picks up and is signaled individually. If the inrush restraint function is used, either the normal pickup signals or the corresponding inrush signals are issued as long as inrush current is detected. If the 51 Element picks up, the tripping time is calculated from the actual fault current flowing, using an integrating method of measurement. The calculated tripping time depends on the selected tripping curve. Once this time has elapsed, a trip signal is issued provided that no inrush current is detected or inrush restraint is disabled. If the inrush restraint function is enabled and an inrush condition exists, no tripping takes place but a message is issued indicating when the overcurrent element time delay elapses. For ground current element 51N, the Curve may be selected independently of the Curve used for phase currents. Pickup values of elements 51 (phase currents) and 51N (ground current) and the relevant time multiplicators may be set individually. The following two figures show the logic diagrams for the inverse time overcurrent protection.
66
Figure 2-12
If an ANSI Curve is configured, parameter 1209 51 TIME DIAL is used instead of parameter 1208 51 TIME DIAL. If parameter 1213 MANUAL CLOSE is set to 51 instant. and manual close detection is used, a pickup causes instantaneous tripping even if the Element is blocked via a binary input.
67
Figure 2-13
If an ANSI Curve is configured, parameter 1309 51N TIME DIAL is used instead of parameter 1308 51N TIME DIAL. If parameter 1313 MANUAL CLOSE is set to 51N instant. and manual close detection is used, a pickup causes instantaneous tripping even if theElement is blocked via a binary input. Dropout Behavior For the ANSI or IEC characteristics, you can select whether an Element drops out instantaneously after a threshold has been undershot or whether dropout is performed by means of disk emulation. "Instantaneous" means that the picked-up element drops out when 95 % of the pickup value is undershot. For a new pickup, the time delay starts at zero. The disk emulation evokes a dropout process (timer counter is decrementing) which begins after de-energization. This process corresponds to the reset of a Ferraris disk (explaining its denomination "disk emulation"). In case several faults occur in succession, the "history" is taken into consideration due to the inertia of the Ferraris disk and the time response is adapted. Reset begins as soon as 90 % of the setting value is undershot, in accordance to the dropout curve of the selected characteristic. In the range between the dropout value (95 % of the pickup value) and 90 % of the setting value, the incrementing and the decrementing processes are in idle state. Disk emulation offers advantages when the overcurrent relay elements must be coordinated with conventional electromechanical overcurrent relays located towards the source.
68
2.2.5
Undervoltage Consideration The inverse time overcurrent protection is provided with an undervoltage detection that can be disabled (address 1223 VOLT. INFLUENCE). This function can influence overcurrent detection by means of two different methods: Voltage-controlled: If a set voltage threshold is undershot, the overcurrent element is released. Voltage-restraint: The pickup threshold of the overcurrent element depends on the voltage magnitude. A lower voltage decreases the current pickup value (see Figure 2-14). In the range between V/VNom = 1.00 to 0.25 a linear, directly proportional dependence is realized, and therefore the following applies:
Figure 2-14
The 51 PICKUP value is decreased proportional to the voltage decrease. Consequently, for constant current I the I/ 51 PICKUP ratio is increased and the tripping time is reduced. Compared with the standard curves represented in Section Technical Data the tripping curve shifts to the left side as the voltage decreases. Switching to the lower pickup value or decreasing the pickup threshold is carried out phase-selectively. The assignment of voltages to current-carrying phases is shown in the following table. Table 2-3 Current IA IB IC VA VB VB VC VC VA Controlling voltages in relation to the fault currents Voltage
In order to avoid an unwanted operation in case of a voltage transformer fault, a function blocking is implemented via a binary input controlled by the voltage transformer protection breaker as well as via the device-internal measuring voltage failure detection ("Fuse Failure Monitor"). The following two figures show the logic diagrams for the inverse time overcurrent protection with undervoltage consideration.
69
Figure 2-15
70
Figure 2-16
71
2.2.6
2.2.7
Inrush Restraint
When the multi-functional protective relay with local control 7SK80 is installed, for instance, to protect a power transformer, large magnetizing inrush currents will flow when the transformer is energized. These inrush currents may be several times the nominal transformer current, and, depending on the transformer size and design, may last from several tens of milliseconds to several seconds. Although pickup of the relay elements is based only on the fundamental harmonic component of the measured currents, false device pickup due to inrush is still a potential problem since, depending on the transformer size and design, the inrush current also comprises a large component of the fundamental. The 7SK80 features an integrated inrush restraint function. It prevents the normal pickup of 50-1 or 51 relay elements (not 50-2 and 50-3) in the phases and the ground path of all directional and non-directional overcurrent relay elements. The same is true for the alternative pickup thresholds of the dynamic cold load pickup function. After detection of inrush currents above a pickup value, special inrush signals are generated. These signals also initiate fault annunciations and start the associated trip delay time. If inrush conditions are still present after the tripping time delay has elapsed, a corresponding message (....Timeout.) is output, but the overcurrent tripping is blocked (see also logic diagrams of time overcurrent elements, Figures 2-8 to 2-13). Inrush current contains a relatively large second harmonic component (twice the nominal frequency) which is nearly absent during a fault current. The inrush restraint is based on the evaluation of the 2nd harmonic present in the inrush current. For frequency analysis, digital filters are used to conduct a Fourier analysis of all three phase currents and the ground current. Inrush current is recognized if the following conditions are fulfilled at the same time: The harmonic content is larger than the setting value 2202 2nd HARMONIC (minimum 0.125 * INom,sec); the currents do not exceed an upper limit value 2205 I Max; an exceeding of a threshold value via an inrush restraint of the blocked Element takes place. In this case an inrush in the affected phase is recognized (annunciations 1840 to 1842 and 7558 InRush Gnd Det, see Figure 2-17) and its blocking being carried out. Since quantitative analysis of the harmonic components cannot be completed until a full line period has been measured, pickup will generally be blocked by then. Therefore, assuming the inrush restraint feature is enabled, a pickup message will be delayed by a full line period if no closing process is present. On the other hand, trip delay times of the time overcurrent protection feature are started immediately even with the inrush restraint being enabled. Time delays continue running with inrush currents present. If inrush blocking drops out after the time delay has elapsed, tripping will occur immediately. Therefore, utilization of the inrush restraint feature will not result in any additional tripping delays. If a relay element drops out during inrush blocking, the associated time delay will reset.
72
Cross Blocking Since inrush restraint operates individually for each phase, protection is ideal where a power transformer is energized into a single-phase fault and inrush currents are detected on a different healthy phase. However, the protection feature can be configured to allow that not only this phase element but also the remaining elements (including ground) are blocked (the so-called CROSS BLOCK function, address 2203) if the permissible harmonic component of the current is exceeded for only one phase. Please take into consideration that inrush currents flowing in the ground path will not cross-block tripping by the phase elements. Cross blocking is reset if there is no more inrush in any phase. Furthermore, the cross blocking function may also be limited to a particular time interval (address 2204 CROSS BLK TIMER). After expiry of this time interval, the cross blocking function will be disabled, even if inrush current is still present. The inrush restraint has an upper limit: Above this (via adjustable parameter 2205 I Max) current blocking is suppressed since a high-current fault is assumed in this case. The following figure shows the inrush restraint influence on the time overcurrent elements including crossblocking.
73
Figure 2-17
74
2.2.8
Internal indication 50-3 A PU 50-2 A PU 50-1 A PU 51 A PU 50-3 B PU 50-2 BPU 50-1B PU 51 B PU 50-3 C PU 50-2 C PU 50-1 C PU 51 C PU 50N-3 PU 50N-2 PU 50N-1 PU 51N PU 50-3 A PU 50-3 B PU 50-3 C PU 50N-3 PU 50-2 A PU 50-2 B PU 50-2 C PU 50N-2 PU 50-1 A PU 50-1 B PU 50-1 C PU 50N-1 PU 51 A PU 51 B PU 51 C PU 51N PU (All pickups) 2-6 2-6 2-6 2-7 2-8 2-8 2-8 2-7 2-12 2-12 2-12 2-13
50/51 Ph B PU
1763
50/51 Ph C PU
1764
1765 1767
50N-3 picked up 50-2 picked up 50N-2 picked up 50-1 picked up 50N-1 picked up 51 picked up 51N picked up 50(N)/51(N) PU
In the trip signals, the Element which initiated the tripping is also indicated.
75
2.2.9
2.2.10
Application Example Each of the current elements can be blocked via binary inputs. A setting parameter determines whether the binary input operates in the normally open (i.e. actuated when energized) or the normally closed (i.e. actuated when de-energized) mode. This allows fast busbar protection to be applied in star systems or open ring systems by applying "reverse interlocking". This principle is often used, for example, in distribution systems, auxiliary systems of power plants and similar systems, where a station supply transformer supplied from the transmission grid serves internal loads of the generation station via a medium voltage bus with multiple feeders (Figure 2-18). The reverse interlocking principle is based on the following: Time overcurrent protection of the busbar feeder trips with a short time delay T 50-2 independent of the grading times of the feeders, unless the pickup of the next load-side overcurrent protection element blocks the busbar protection (Figure 2-18). Always the protection element nearest to the fault will trip with the short time delay since this element cannot be blocked by a protection element located behind the fault. Time elements T 50-1 or T51 are still effective as backup element. Pickup signals output by the load-side protective relay are used as input message>BLOCK 50-2 via a binary input at the feeder-side protective relay.
76
Figure 2-18
2.2.11
General
Setting Notes
When selecting the time overcurrent protection in DIGSI, a dialog box appears with several tabs for setting the individual parameters. Depending on the functional scope specified during configuration of the protection functions under addresses 112 Charac. Phase and 113 Charac. Ground, the number of tabs can vary. If address FCT 50/51 was set to Definite Time, or Charac. Ground was set to Definite Time, then only the settings for the definite time elements are available. The selection of TOC IEC or TOC ANSI makes available additional inverse time characteristics. The superimposed high-set elements 50-2, 50-3 or 50N-2, 50N-3 are available in all these cases. Parameter 250 50/51 2-ph prot can also be set to activate two-phase overcurrent protection. Under address 1201 FCT 50/51, overcurrent protection for phases and under address 1301 FCT 50N/51N, the ground overcurrent protection can be switched ON or OFF. Pickup values, time delays, and Curves for ground protection are set separately from the pickup values, time delays and characteristic curves associated with phase protection. Because of this, relay coordination for ground faults is independent of relay coordination for phase faults, and more sensitive settings can often be applied to directional ground protection. Depending on the setting of parameter 251 CT Connect., the device can also be used in specific system configuration with regard to current connections. Further information can be found under Section 2.1.3.2, Current Connections.
77
Measurement Methods The comparison values to be used for the respective element can be set in the setting sheets for the elements. Measurement of the fundamental harmonic (standard method): This measurement method processes the sampled values of the current and filters in numerical order the fundamental harmonic so that the higher harmonics or transient peak currents remain largely unconsidered. Measurement of the true RMS value The current amplitude is derived from the sampled values in accordance with the definition equation of the true RMS value. This measurement method should be selected when higher harmonics are to be considered by the function (e.g. in capacitor banks). Measurement with instantaneous values This procedure compares the instantaneous values to the set threshold. The element picks up at 2 2 setting value (rms). It does not perform a mean-value calculation and is thus sensitive with regard to disturbances. This measurement method should only be selected if an especially short pickup time of the element is required. In this measurement procedure, the operating time of the element is reduced compared to the measurement of effective values or fundamental harmonics (see Technical Data). The type of the comparison values can be set under the following addresses: 50-3 Element 50-2 Element 50-1 Element 51 Element 50N-3 Element 50N-2 Element 50N-1 Element 51N Element Address 1219 50-3 measurem. Address 1220 50-2 measurem. Address 1221 50-1 measurem. Address 1222 51 measurem. Address 1319 50N-3 measurem. Address 1320 50N-2 measurem. Address 1321 50N-1 measurem. Address 1322 51N measurem.
High current elements 50-2, 50-3 (phases) The pickup current of the high-set element 50-2 PICKUP or 50-3 PICKUP can be set at address 1202 or 1217. The corresponding delay time 50-2 DELAY or 50-3 DELAY can be configured under address 1203 or 1218. It is usually used for purposes of current grading intended for large impedances that are prevalent in transformers or generators. It is specified in such manner that it picks up faults up to this impedance. Example of the high-set current element 50-2 PICKUP: Transformer used for busbar supply with the following data: Rated apparent power Transformer impedance Primary nominal voltage Secondary nominal voltage Vector groups Neutral point Fault power on 110 kV-side SNomT = 16 MVA ZT = 10 % VNom1 = 110 kV VNom2 = 20 kV Dy 5 Grounded 1 GVA
Based on the data above, the following fault currents are calculated: Three-Phase High Voltage Side Fault Current Three-Phase Low Voltage Side Fault Current On the High Voltage Side Flowing at 110 kV = 5250 A at 20 kV = 3928 A at 110 kV = 714 A
78
The nominal current of the transformer is: INomT, 110 = 84 A (High Voltage Side) Current Transformer (High Voltage Side) Current Transformer (Low Voltage Side) Due to the following definition INomT, 20 = 462 A (Low Voltage Side) 100 A/1 A 500 A/1 A
the following setting applies to the protection device: The 50-2 high-set current element must be set higher than the maximum fault current which is detected during a low side fault on the high side. To reduce fault probability as much as possible even when fault power varies, the following setting is selected in primary values: 50-2 /INom = 10, i.e. 50-2 = 1000 A. The same applies analogously when using the high-set element 50-3. Increased inrush currents, if their fundamental component exceeds the setting value, are rendered harmless by delay times (address 1203 50-2 DELAY or 1218 50-3 DELAY). For motor protection, the 50-2 relay element must be set smaller than the smallest phase-to-phase fault current and larger than the largest motor starting current. Since the maximum occurring startup current is usually below 1.6 x the rated startup current (even with unfavourable conditions), the following setting is adequate for the fault current element 50-2: 1.6 x IStartup < 50-2 Pickup< Ifault,2pole,min The potential increase in starting current caused by overvoltage conditions is already accounted for by the 1.6 factor. The 50-2 Element can be tripped without delay (50-2 DELAY = 0.00 s), since saturation of the shunt reactance occurs in a motor, unlike in a transformer, for example. The principle of the "reverse interlocking" utilizes the multi-element function of the time overcurrent protection: Element 50-2 PICKUP is applied as a fast busbar protection with a shorter safety delay time 50-2 DELAY (e.g. 100 ms). For faults at the outgoing feeders, element 50-2 is blocked. The Elements 50-1 or 51 serve as backup protection. The pickup values of both elements (50-1 PICKUP or 51 PICKUP and 50-2 PICKUP) are set equal. The delay time 50-1 DELAY or 51 TIME DIAL is set in such manner that it overgrades the delay for the outgoing feeders. The selected time is an additional delay time and does not include the operating time (measuring time, dropout time). The delay can also be set to . In this case, the Element will not trip after pickup. However, pickup, will be signaled. If the 50-2 Element or the 50-3 Element is not required at all, the pickup threshold 50-2 or 50-3 is set to . This setting prevents tripping and the generation of a pickup message. High current elements 50N-2, 50N-3 (Ground) The pickup current of the high-set element 50N-2 PICKUP or 50N-3 PICKUP can be set at address 1302 or 1317. The corresponding delay time 50N-2 DELAY or 50N-3 DELAY can be configured under address 1303 or 1318. The same considerations apply to these settings as they did for phase currents discussed earlier. The selected time is an additional delay time and does not include the operating time (measuring time, dropout time). The delay can also be set to . In this case, the Element will not trip after pickup. However, pickup, will be signaled. If the 50N-2 Element or 50N-3 Element is not required at all, the pickup threshold 50N-2 or 50N3 should be set to . This setting prevents tripping and the generation of a pickup message.
79
50-1 Element (phases) For setting the 50-1 element, it is the maximum anticipated load current that must be considered above all. Pickup due to overload should never occur since in this mode the device operates as fault protection with correspondingly short tripping times and not as overload protection. For this reason, a setting equal to 20% of the expected peak load is recommended for line protection, and a setting equal to 40% is recommended for transformers and motors. The settable time delay (address 1205 50-1 DELAY) results from the grading coordination chart defined for the system. The selected time is an additional delay time and does not include the operating time (measuring time, dropout time). The delay can also be set to . In this case, the Element will not trip after pickup. However, pickup, will be signaled. If the 50-1 Element is not required at all, then the pickup threshold 50-1 should be set to . This setting prevents tripping and the generation of a pickup message. 50N-1 Element (Ground) The 50N-1 element is normally set based on minimum ground fault current. If the relay is used to protect transformers or motors with large inrush currents, the inrush restraint feature of 7SK80 may be used for the 50N1 relay element. It can be enabled or disabled for both the phase current and the ground current in address 2201 INRUSH REST.. The characteristic values of the inrush restraint are listed in Subsection "Inrush Restraint". The settable delay time (address 1305 50N-1 DELAY) results from the time coordination chart defined for the system. For ground currents in a grounded system a separate coordination timer with short time delays can be applied. The selected time is an additional delay time and does not include the operating time (measuring time, dropout time). The delay can also be set to . In this case, the Element will not trip after pickup. However, pickup, will be signaled. If the 50N-1 Element is not required at all, the pickup threshold 50N-1 PICKUP should be set to . This setting prevents tripping and the generation of a pickup message. Pickup Stabilization (Definite Time) The configurable dropout times 1215 50 T DROP-OUT or 1315 50N T DROP-OUT can be set to implement a uniform dropout behavior when using electromechanical relays. This is necessary for a time grading. The dropout time of the electromechanical relay must be known to this end. Subtract the dropout time of the device (see Technical Data) from this value and enter the result in the parameters. 51 Element (phases) with IEC or ANSI characteristics Having set address 112 Charac. Phase = TOC IEC or TOC ANSI when configuring the protection functions (Section 2.1.1.2), the parameters for the inverse time characteristics will also be available. If address 112 Charac. Phase was set to TOC IEC, you can select the desired IEC Curve (Normal Inverse, Very Inverse, Extremely Inv. or Long Inverse) at address 1211 51 IEC CURVE. If address 112 Charac. Phase was set to TOC ANSI, you can select the desired ANSI Curve (Very Inverse, Inverse, Short Inverse, Long Inverse, Moderately Inv., Extremely Inv. or Definite Inv.) at address 1212 51 ANSI CURVE. If the inverse time trip characteristic is selected, it must be noted that a safety factor of about 1.1 has already been included between the pickup value and the setting value. This means that a pickup will only occur if a current of about 1.1 times the setting value is present. If Disk Emulation was selected at address 1210 51 Drop-out, reset will occur in accordance with the reset curve as described before. The current value is set in address 1207 51 PICKUP. The setting is mainly determined by the maximum anticipated operating current. Pickup due to overload should never occur since in this mode, the device operates as fault protection with correspondingly short tripping times and not as overload protection.
80
The corresponding time multiplier for an IEC Curve is set at address 1208 51 TIME DIAL and in address 1209 51 TIME DIAL for an ANSI Curve. It must be coordinated with the time coordination chart of the system. The time multiplier can also be set to . In this case, the Element will not trip after pickup. However, pickup will be signaled. If the 51 Element is not required at all, address 112 Charac. Phase should be set to Definite Time during protection function configuration (see Section 2.1.1.2). If highly sensitive settings close to the load current are required in weak power systems or transformers, the element can be stabilized via the undervoltage as an additional criterion for the power system fault. The operating modes can be set in address 1223 VOLT. INFLUENCE. In a voltage-controlled operation, the voltage threshold is defined via parameter 1224 51V V< below which the current element is released. 51N Element (Ground) with IEC or ANSI Characteristics Having set address 113 Charac. Ground = TOC IEC when configuring the protection functions (Section 2.1.1), the parameters for the inverse time characteristics will also be available. Specify in address 1311 51N IEC CURVE the desired IEC Curve (Normal Inverse, Very Inverse, Extremely Inv. or Long Inverse). If address 113 Charac. Ground was set to TOC ANSI, you can select the desired ANSI Curve (Very Inverse, Inverse, Short Inverse, Long Inverse, Moderately Inv., Extremely Inv. or Definite Inv.) in address 1312 51N ANSI CURVE. If the inverse time trip characteristic is selected, it must be noted that a safety factor of about 1.1 has already been included between the pickup value and the setting value. This means that a pickup will only occur if a current of about 1.1 times the setting value is present. If Disk Emulation was selected at address 1310 51 Drop-out, reset will occur in accordance with the reset curve as described before. The current value is set in address 1307 51N PICKUP. The setting is mainly determined by the minimum anticipated ground fault current. The corresponding time multiplier for an IEC Curve is set at address 1308 51N TIME DIAL and at address 1309 51N TIME DIAL for an ANSI Curve. This has to be coordinated with the grading coordination chart of the network. For ground currents with grounded network, you can often set up a separate grading coordination chart with shorter delay times. The time multiplier can also be set to . In this case, the Element will not trip after pickup. However, pickup will be signaled. If the 51N-TOC Element is not required at all, address 113 Charac. Ground should be set to Definite Time during configuration of the protection functions (see Section 2.1.1). Inrush Restraint When applying the protection device to transformers where high inrush currents are to be expected, the 7SK80 can make use of an inrush restraint function for the overcurrent elements 50-1, 51, 50N-1 and 51N. Inrush restraint is only effective and accessible if address 122 InrushRestraint was set to Enabled. If this function is not required, then Disabled is set. In address 2201 INRUSH REST., the function is switched ON or OFF jointly for the overcurrent elements 50-1 PICKUP, 51 PICKUP, 50N-1 PICKUP, and 51N PICKUP The inrush restraint is based on the evaluation of the 2nd harmonic present in the inrush current. Upon delivery from the factory, a ratio I2f/If of 15 % is set. Under normal circumstances, this setting will not need to be changed. The setting value is identical for all phases and Ground. However, the component required for restraint may be adjusted to system conditions in address 2202 2nd HARMONIC. To provide more restraint in exceptional cases, where energizing conditions are particularly unfavorable, a smaller value can be set in the aforementioned address, e.g. 12 %. Irrespective of parameter 2202 2nd HARMONIC, rush blocking will only occur if the absolute value of the 2nd harmonic is at least 0.125 * INom,sec. The effective duration of the cross-blocking 2203 CROSS BLK TIMER can be set to a value between 0 s (harmonic restraint active for each phase individually) and a maximum of 180 s (harmonic restraint of a phase blocks also the other phases for the specified duration). If the current exceeds the value set in address 2205 I Max, no further restraint will take place for the 2nd harmonic.
81
Manual Close Mode (phases,Ground) When a circuit breaker is closed onto a faulted line, a high-speed trip by the circuit breaker is usually desired. For overcurrent or high-set Element the delay may be bypassed via a Manual Close pulse, thus resulting in instantaneous tripping. This pulse is prolonged by at least 300 ms. To enable the device to react properly on occurrence of a fault in the phase element, address 1213 MANUAL CLOSE has to be set accordingly. Correspondingly, address 1313 MANUAL CLOSE is considered for the ground path address. Thus, the user determines for both elements, the phase and the Ground element, what pickup value is active with what delay when the circuit breaker is closed manually. External Control Command If the manual close signal is not sent from 7SK80 device, i.e. neither via the built-in operator interface nor via a serial interface, but directly from a control acknowledgment switch, this signal must be passed to a 7SK80 binary input, and configured accordingly (>Manual Close), so that the Element selected for MANUAL CLOSE can become effective. The alternative Inactive means that all elements operate as per configuration even with manual close and do not get special treatment. Internal Control Function If the manual close signal is sent via the internal control function of the device, an internal connection of information has to be established via CFC (interlocking task level) using the CMD_Information block (see Figure 219).
Figure 2-19
Example for the generation of a manual close signal using the internal control function
2.2.12
Settings
Addresses which have an appended "A" can only be changed with DIGSI, under "Display Additional Settings". The table indicates region-specific default settings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corresponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer.
C ON OFF 1A 5A
Setting Options
Default Setting ON 4.00 A 20.00 A 0.00 sec 1.00 A 5.00 A 0.50 sec 1.00 A 5.00 A 0.50 sec
1203 1204
1205 1207
1208
51 TIME DIAL
51 Time Dial
82
Setting Options 0.50 .. 15.00 ; Instantaneous Disk Emulation Normal Inverse Very Inverse Extremely Inv. Long Inverse Very Inverse Inverse Short Inverse Long Inverse Moderately Inv. Extremely Inv. Definite Inv. 50-3 instant. 50-2 instant. 50 -1 instant. 51 instant. Inactive Always 0.00 .. 60.00 sec Always
1212
51 ANSI CURVE
Very Inverse
ANSI Curve
1213A
MANUAL CLOSE
50-2 instant.
1.00 .. 35.00 A; 5.00 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; Fundamental True RMS Instantaneous Fundamental True RMS Fundamental True RMS Fundamental True RMS NO Volt. controll. Volt. restraint 10.0 .. 125.0 V ON OFF
1218 1219A
51V V< Threshold for Release Ip 50N, 51N Ground Time Overcurrent 50N-2 Pickup
1303 1304
83
Default Setting 0.50 sec 0.20 A 1.00 A 0.20 sec 5.00 Disk Emulation Normal Inverse
1A 5A
0.05 .. 4.00 A 0.25 .. 20.00 A 0.05 .. 3.20 sec; 0.50 .. 15.00 ; Instantaneous Disk Emulation Normal Inverse Very Inverse Extremely Inv. Long Inverse Very Inverse Inverse Short Inverse Long Inverse Moderately Inv. Extremely Inv. Definite Inv. 50N-3 instant. 50N-2 instant. 50N-1 instant. 51N instant. Inactive Always 0.00 .. 60.00 sec Always 0.25 .. 35.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; Fundamental True RMS Instantaneous Fundamental True RMS Fundamental True RMS Fundamental True RMS OFF ON 10 .. 45 % NO YES 0.00 .. 180.00 sec
51N TIME DIAL 51N TIME DIAL 51N Drop-out 51N IEC CURVE
51N Time Dial 51N Time Dial Drop-Out Characteristic IEC Curve
1312
Very Inverse
ANSI Curve
1313A
MANUAL CLOSE
50N-2 instant.
50N-2 active 50N T DROP-OUT 50N-3 active 50N-3 PICKUP 50N-3 DELAY 50N-3 measurem.
50N-2 active 50N Drop-Out Time Delay 50N-3 active 50N-3 Pickup 50N-3 Time Delay 50N-3 measurement of
50N-2 measurem. 50N-1 measurem. 51N measurem. INRUSH REST. 2nd HARMONIC CROSS BLOCK CROSS BLK TIMER I Max 1A 5A
50N-2 measurement of 50N-1 measurement of 51N measurement of Inrush Restraint 2nd. harmonic in % of fundamental Cross Block Cross Block Time Maximum Current for Inrush Restraint
84
2.2.13
No. 1704 1714 1718 1719 1721 1722 1723 1724 1725 1726 1751 1752 1753 1756 1757 1758 1761 1762 1763 1764 1765 1767 1768 1769 1770 1787 1788 1791 1800 1804 1805 1810 1814 1815 1820 1824 1825 1831 1832 1833 1834 1835 1836 1837
Information List
Information >BLK 50/51 >BLK 50N/51N >BLOCK 50-3 >BLOCK 50N-3 >BLOCK 50-2 >BLOCK 50-1 >BLOCK 51 >BLOCK 50N-2 >BLOCK 50N-1 >BLOCK 51N 50/51 PH OFF 50/51 PH BLK 50/51 PH ACT 50N/51N OFF 50N/51N BLK 50N/51N ACT 50(N)/51(N) PU 50/51 Ph A PU 50/51 Ph B PU 50/51 Ph C PU 50N/51NPickedup 50-3 picked up 50N-3 picked up 50-3 TRIP 50N-3 TRIP 50-3 TimeOut 50N-3 TimeOut 50(N)/51(N)TRIP 50-2 picked up 50-2 TimeOut 50-2 TRIP 50-1 picked up 50-1 TimeOut 50-1 TRIP 51 picked up 51 Time Out 51 TRIP 50N-2 picked up 50N-2 TimeOut 50N-2 TRIP 50N-1 picked up 50N-1 TimeOut 50N-1 TRIP 51N picked up Type of Information SP SP SP SP SP SP SP SP SP SP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT >BLOCK 50/51 >BLOCK 50N/51N >BLOCK 50-3 >BLOCK 50N-3 >BLOCK 50-2 >BLOCK 50-1 >BLOCK 51 >BLOCK 50N-2 >BLOCK 50N-1 >BLOCK 51N 50/51 O/C switched OFF 50/51 O/C is BLOCKED 50/51 O/C is ACTIVE 50N/51N is OFF 50N/51N is BLOCKED 50N/51N is ACTIVE 50(N)/51(N) O/C PICKUP 50/51 Phase A picked up 50/51 Phase B picked up 50/51 Phase C picked up 50N/51N picked up 50-3 picked up 50N-3 picked up 50-3 TRIP 50N-3 TRIP 50-3 TimeOut 50N-3 TimeOut 50(N)/51(N) TRIP 50-2 picked up 50-2 Time Out 50-2 TRIP 50-1 picked up 50-1 Time Out 50-1 TRIP 51 picked up 51 Time Out 51 TRIP 50N-2 picked up 50N-2 Time Out 50N-2 TRIP 50N-1 picked up 50N-1 Time Out 50N-1 TRIP 51N picked up Comments
85
No. 1838 1839 1840 1841 1842 1843 1851 1852 1853 1854 1855 1856 1866 1867 7551 7552 7553 7554 7556 7557 7558 7559 7560 7561 7562 7563 7564 7565 7566 7567 10034 10035
Information 51N TimeOut 51N TRIP PhA InrushDet PhB InrushDet PhC InrushDet INRUSH X-BLK 50-1 BLOCKED 50-2 BLOCKED 50N-1 BLOCKED 50N-2 BLOCKED 51 BLOCKED 51N BLOCKED 51 Disk Pickup 51N Disk Pickup 50-1 InRushPU 50N-1 InRushPU 51 InRushPU 51N InRushPU InRush OFF InRush BLK InRush Gnd Det 67-1 InRushPU 67N-1 InRushPU 67-TOC InRushPU 67N-TOCInRushPU >BLOCK InRush Gnd InRush PU Ia InRush PU Ib InRush PU Ic InRush PU 50-3 BLOCKED 50N-3 BLOCKED
Type of Information OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT SP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT 51N Time Out 51N TRIP
Comments
Phase A inrush detection Phase B inrush detection Phase C inrush detection Cross blk: PhX blocked PhY 50-1 BLOCKED 50-2 BLOCKED 50N-1 BLOCKED 50N-2 BLOCKED 51 BLOCKED 51N BLOCKED 51 Disk emulation Pickup 51N Disk emulation picked up 50-1 InRush picked up 50N-1 InRush picked up 51 InRush picked up 51N InRush picked up InRush OFF InRush BLOCKED InRush Ground detected 67-1 InRush picked up 67N-1 InRush picked up 67-TOC InRush picked up 67N-TOC InRush picked up >BLOCK InRush Ground InRush picked up Phase A InRush picked up Phase B InRush picked up Phase C InRush picked up 50-3 BLOCKED 50N-3 BLOCKED
86
2.3
Applications The directional ground overcurrent protection also allows the 7SK80 multifunctional protection devices to be used in systems where selectivity depends on both the magnitude of the fault current and the direction of power flow to the fault location. The (non-directional) time overcurrent protection described in Section 2.2 can operate as backup protection or it can be disabled. Additionally, individual elements (e.g. 67N-2) can be interconnected with the directional ground overcurrent protection.
2.3.1
General
Depending on the setting of parameter 613 Gnd O/Cprot. w., the ground current element can operate either with measured values IN or with the values 3I0 calculated from the three phase currents. Devices with sensitive ground current measurement, however, generally use the calculated quantity 3I0. The directional orientation Forward, Reverse or Non-Directional can be set individually for each element (Non-Directional from V4.7 on). For each element the time can be blocked via binary input thus suppressing the trip command. If the blocking is cancelled during pickup, the timer will be restarted. The Manual Close signal is an exception. If a circuit breaker is manually closed onto a fault, it can be re-opened immediately. For the overcurrent elements the delay can be bypassed via the Manual Close pulse which results in instantaneous tripping upon pickup. Pickup stabilization for the 67/67N elements of the directional overcurrent protection can be accomplished by means of settable dropout times. This protection comes into use in systems where intermittent faults occur. Combined with electromechanical relays, it allows different dropout responses to be adjusted and a time grading of digital and electromechanical relays to be implemented. Pickup and delay settings can be quickly adjusted to system requirements using the dynamic cold load pickup function (see Section 2.4). By activating the inrush restraint feature, tripping by the directional 67N-1 or 67N-TOC elements can be blocked when inrush current is detected. The following table gives an overview of the interconnection to other functions of the 7SK80. Table 2-5 Interconnection to other functions Manual CLOSE Dynamic cold load pickup Inrush restraint
87
2.3.2
88
Figure 2-20
If parameter 1613 is set to 67N-2 instant. or 67N-3 instant. and manual close detection is present, a pickup causes instantaneous tripping even if the element is blocked via binary input.
89
2.3.3
90
Figure 2-21
If parameter 1613 is set to 67N-1 instant. and manual close detection applies, the trip is initiated as soon as the pickup conditions arrive, even if the element is blocked via a binary input. The dropout delay only functions if no inrush was detected. An incoming inrush will reset an already running dropout time delay.
91
Figure 2-22
2.3.4
Pickup Behavior The ground current is compared with the setting value 67N-TOC PICKUP. When a current value exceeds the corresponding setting value by a factor of 1.1, the function will pick up and a message is sent provided that the fault direction is identical to the direction configured. If the inrush restraint feature is used, either the normal pickup signal or the corresponding inrush signal is issued as long as inrush current is detected. When the element picks up, the trip time is calculated from the actually flowing fault current using an integrating measurement method. The calculated tripping time depends on the selected tripping curve. Once this time has elapsed, a trip signal is issued provided that no inrush current is detected or inrush restraint is disabled. If an inrush condition is detected while the inrush restraint function is enabled, there will be no trip but a message will be generated indicating that the timer has elapsed. The pickup value of the 67N-TOC element, the delay time and the Curve can be selected individually. The element can work directionally or non-directionally. Dropout Behaviour With an ANSI oe IEC curve it can be selected whether an element will drop out instantaneously after the threshold has been undershot or whether dropout is to be performed by means of disk emulation mechanism. "Instantaneous" means that the pickup will drop out when the value falls below 95% of the pickup value. For a new pickup the timer is restarted. The disk emulation evokes a dropout process (timer counter is decrementing) which begins after de-energization. This process corresponds to the reset of a Ferraris-disk (explaining its denomination "disk emulation"). If several faults occur in succession, the "history" is thus taken into consideration due to the inertia of the Ferrarisdisk and the time response is adapted. Reset begins as soon as the value falls below 90 % of the setting value in accordance with the dropout curve of the selected characteristic. In the range between the dropout value (95 % of the pickup value) and 90 % of the setting value, the incrementing and decrementing process will pause. Disk emulation offers advantages when the overcurrent relay elements must be coordinated with conventional electromechanical overcurrent relays located towards the source. The following figure shows the logic diagram of the 67N-TOC overcurrent element of the directional inversetime overcurrent protection.
92
Figure 2-23
2.3.5
93
2.3.6
2.3.7
Inrush Restraint
7SK80 features an integrated inrush restraint function. It prevents the "normal" pickup of the 67N-1 or 67N-TOC elements (not 67N-2 and 67N-3) in the ground path of the non-directional and directional overcurrent protection. The same is true for the alternative pickup thresholds of the dynamic cold load pickup function. If inrush currents are detected, special inrush pickup signals are generated. These signals also initiate fault recording and start the associated trip delay time. If inrush conditions are still present after the tripping time delay has elapsed, a corresponding message ("....TimeOut ") is output, but tripping is blocked (for further information see "Inrush Restraint" in Section 2.2).
2.3.8
Determination of Direction
Basically, the direction determination is performed by determining the phase angle between the fault current and a reference voltage.
Method of Directional Measurement For the directional ground fault element there are two ways of direction determination: Direction determination with zero-sequence or ground quantities Direction determination with negative-sequence quantities Direction Determination with Zero-sequence or Ground Quantities For the directional ground fault elements, the direction can be determined from the zero-sequence system quantities. In the current path, the IN current is valid when the transformer neutral current is connected to the device. Otherwise, the device calculates the ground current from the sum of the three phase currents. In the voltage path, the displacement voltage VN is used as reference voltage if connected. Otherwise, the device calculates as reference voltage the zero-sequence voltage 3 V0 from the sum of the three phase voltages. If the magnitude of V0 or 3 V0 is not sufficient to determine direction, the direction is undefined. Then the directional ground element will not initiate a trip signal. If measurement from the zero-sequence system is not possible, e.g. because only two current transformers are connected, the directional ground element will work neither. Direction Determination with Negative-sequence Quantities Here, the negative sequence current and the negative sequence voltage as reference voltage are used to determine the direction. This is advantageous if the zero sequence is influenced via a parallel line or if the zero voltage becomes very small due to unfavorable zero sequence impedances. The negative sequence system is calculated from the individual voltages and currents. As with using the zero sequence quantities, the direction is only determined once the values required for direction determination have exceeded a certain minimum threshold. Otherwise, the direction will remain undetermined.
94
When voltage transformers are open-delta-connected, direction determination is always based on the negative-sequence quantities. Reference Voltages for Direction Determination A single-phase fault (ground fault) is detected by the directional ground fault element. For the directional ground fault elements, the connection requirements described previously must be met. The following table shows the allocation of measured values for the determination of the fault direction for various pickup conditions. Table 2-6 Measured values for determining the fault direction Pickup Current N A, N B, N C, N A. B, N B, C, N A, C, N A, B, C, N
1)
Direction Determination via Ground Element using Ground Values Figure 2-24 shows the treatment of the reference voltage for the directional ground element, also based on a single-phase ground fault in phase A. The fault voltage serves as reference voltage. Depending on the connection of the voltage transformer, this is the voltage 3V0 (as shown in Figure 2-24) or VN. The fault current -3I0 is phase offset by 180 to the fault current IscA and follows the fault voltage 3V0 by fault angle sc. The reference voltage is rotated by the setting value 1619 ROTATION ANGLE. In this case, a rotation by -45.
Figure 2-24
Rotation of the reference voltage, directional ground element with zero sequence values
The forward area is equally a range of 86 around the rotated reference voltage Vref,rot If the vector of the fault current -3I0 (or IN) is in this area, the device detects forward direction.
95
Direction Determination via Ground Element using Negative Sequence Values Figure 2-25 shows how the reference voltage for the directional ground element is processed using the negative sequence values based on a single-phase ground fault in phase A. The negative sequence voltage is used as reference voltage; the negative sequence current is used as current for direction determination in which the fault current is represented. The fault current -3I2 is phase opposite to the fault current IscA and follows the voltage 3V2 by fault angle sc. The reference voltage is rotated by the setting value 1619 ROTATION ANGLE. In this case, a rotation by -45.
Figure 2-25
Rotation of the reference voltage, directional ground element with negative sequence values
The forward area is a range of 86 around the rotated reference voltage Vref,rot If the vector of the negative sequence current -3I2 is in this area, the device detects forward direction.
2.3.9
General
Setting Notes
When selecting the directional ground overcurrent protection in DIGSI, a dialog box opens with several tabs for setting the associated parameters. Depending on the functional scope specified during configuration of the protective functions in address 116 67N/67N-TOC, the number of tabs can vary. When selecting 67N/67N-TOC = Definite Time, only the settings for the definite time elements are available. Selecting TOC IEC or TOC ANSI the inverse time characteristics will be available too. The superimposed directional elements 67N-2 and 67N-1 apply in all these cases. The directional ground current element can be turned ON or OFF at address 1601 FCT 67N/67N-TOC. Depending on the parameter 613 Gnd O/Cprot. w., the device can operate using either measured values IN or the quantities 3I0 calculated from the three phase currents. Devices featuring a sensitive ground current input generally use the calculated quantity 3I0. The directional orientation of the function is influenced by parameter 201 CT Starpoint (see Chapter 2.1.3).
96
Measurement methods In the tabs for each element you can specify the references values used by the corresponding element. Measurement of the fundamental harmonic (standard method): This measurement method processes the sampled values of the current and filters in numerical order the fundamental harmonic so that the higher harmonics or transient peak currents are rejected. Measurement of the r.m.s value The current amplitude is derived from the sampled values in accordance with the definition equation of the r.m.s value. This measurement method should be selected when higher harmonics are to be considered by the function (e.g. in capacitor banks). The type of the reference values can be set in the following addresses: 67N-3 Element 67N-2 Element 67N-1 Element address 1627 67N-3 MEASUREM. Address 1620 50N-2 measurem. Address 1621 50N-1 measurem.
67N-TOC Element Address 1622 51N measurem. Directional characteristic The directional characteristic, i.e. the position of the ranges forward and reverse, is set in address 1619 ROTATION ANGLE. The short-circuit angle is generally inductive in a range of 30 to 60. This means that the default setting of -45 for adjusting the reference voltage can usually be retained because it guarantees a safe direction result. With the ground directional element, the reference voltage is the short-circuit voltage itself. The resulting setting of the angle of rotation is then: Angle of rotation ref.voltage = -k directional ground element, phase-to-ground fault Please note that for an angle of rotation of 30 the setting must be -30. Directional orientation The directional orientation Forward or Reverse can be set separately for each element. Moreover, each element can also be operated Non-Directional. Address 1626 67N-3 Direction Address 1623 67N-2 Direction Address 1624 67N-1 Direction Address 1625 67N-TOC Direct. The directional overcurrent protection usually works in direction towards the protected object (line, transformer). Note If the 67N-1 Element picks up, the phase-specific directional indications forward or reverse are issued (message 2635 or 2636). Pickup of the 67N-2 Element or 67N-3Element lies within the parameterized directional range without directional indication.
97
Setting the parameters for direction determination Parameter 1617 67N POLARIZAT. can be set to specify whether direction determination is accomplished from the zero sequence quantities, the ground quantities (with VN and IN) or the negative sequence quantities (with V2 and I2) in the ground directional element. The first option is the preferential setting; the latter is selected if there is a risk of the zero voltage becoming too small due to unfavorable zero impedance or a parallel line influencing the zero sequence system. Note If parameter 213 VT Connect. 3ph is set to Vab, Vbc or Vab, Vbc, Vx, the direction is always determined using the negative sequence values V2/I2. For these voltage connection types the zero sequence voltage VN or 3V0) is not available.
High-current elements 67N-2, 67N-3 directional The high-current elements 67N-2 PICKUP or 67N-3 PICKUP are set at address 1602 or 1628 and the associated delays 67N-2 DELAY or 67N-3 DELAY at 1603 or 1629. The same considerations apply for these settings as for the phase currents. The selected time is an additional delay time and does not include the operating time (measuring time, dropout time). The delay can also be set to . In this case, the Element will not trip after pickup. However, pickup, will be signaled. If the directional 67N-2 Element or 67N-3 Element is not required, set the pickup threshold 67N2 PICKUP or 67N-3 PICKUP to . This setting prevents tripping and the generation of a pickup indication. 67N-1 Directional overcurrent element The setting of the overcurrent element 1604 67N-1 PICKUP is mainly determined by the minimum anticipated ground fault current. If the relay is used to protect transformers or motors with large inrush currents, the inrush restraint feature of 7SK80 may be used for the 67N-1 PICKUP element (for more information see margin heading "Inrush Restraint"). The delay is set at address 1605 67N-1 DELAY and should be based on system coordination requirements for directional tripping. For ground currents in a grounded system a separate coordination chart with short time delays is often used. The selected time is an additional time delay and does not include the operating time (measuring time, dropout time). The delay can also be set to . In this case, the Element will not trip after pickup. However, pickup, will be signaled. If the 67N-1 Element is not required at all, the pickup value 67N-1 PICKUP should be set to . This setting prevents tripping and the generation of a pickup message. Pickup stabilization (67N Ground) Pickup of the directional overcurrent elements can also be stabilized using configurable dropout times under address 1618 67N T DROP-OUT. 67N-TOC Directional overcurrent element with IEC and ANSI curves (inverse-time, Ground) Having set address 116 67N/67N-TOC = TOC IEC when configuring the protection functions (Section 2.1.1), the parameters for the inverse time characteristics will also be available. Specify in address 1611 67N-TOC IEC the desired IEC Curve (Normal Inverse, Very Inverse, Extremely Inv. or Long Inverse). If address 116 67N/67N-TOC = TOC ANSI, you can select the desired ANSICurve (Very Inverse, Inverse, Short Inverse, Long Inverse, Moderately Inv., Extremely Inv. or Definite Inv.) in address 1612 67N-TOC ANSI.
98
If the relay is used to protect transformers or motors with large inrush currents, the inrush restraint feature of 7SK80 may be used for the 67N-TOC PICKUP element (for more information see margin heading "Inrush Restraint"). If the inverse time trip characteristic is selected, it must be noted that a safety factor of about 1.1 has already been included between the pickup value and setting value 67N-TOC PICKUP. This means that a pickup will only occur if a current of about 1.1 times the setting value is present. If Disk Emulation was selected at address 1610 67N-TOC DropOut, reset will occur in accordance with the reset curve as for the existing nondirectional time overcurrent protection described in Section 2.2. The current value is set at address 1607 67N-TOC PICKUP. The most relevant for this setting is the minimum appearing ground fault current. The corresponding element time multiplication factor for an IEC Curve is set at address 1608 67N-TOC TDIAL and in address 1609 67N-TOC T-DIAL for an ANSI Curve. This has to be coordinated with the system grading coordination chart for directional tripping. For ground currents with grounded network, you can mostly set up a separate grading coordination chart with shorter delay times. The time multiplier can also be set to . In this case, the Element will not trip after pickup. However, pickup, will be signaled. If the 67N-TOC Element is not required at all, address 116 67N/67N-TOC should be set to Definite Time when configuring the protection functions (see Section 2.1.1). Inrush restraint When used at transformers where high inrush currents are expected, the 7SK80 can activate an inrush restraint function for the directional overcurrent elements 67N-1 PICKUP, 67N-TOC PICKUP as well as for the nondirectional overcurrent elements. The inrush restraint option is enabled or disabled in 2201 INRUSH REST. (in the settings option non-directional time overcurrent protection). The characteristic values of the inrush restraint are already listed in the section discussing the non-directional time overcurrent (Section 2.2.11). Manual closing When a circuit breaker is closed onto a faulted line, a high speed trip by the circuit breaker is often desired. For overcurrent or high-set Element the delay may be bypassed via a Manual Close pulse, thus resulting in instantaneous tripping. This pulse is prolonged by at least 300 ms. To enable the device to react properly on occurrence of a fault in the phase elements after manual close, address 1613 MANUAL CLOSE has to be set accordingly. This determines the delay after which the pickup value becomes effective when closing the circuit breaker manually. External control command If the manual closing signal is not generated by the 7SK80, that is, it is sent neither via the built-in operator interface nor via the serial port but directly from a control acknowledgment switch, this signal must be passed to a 7SK80 binary input, and configured accordingly (>Manual Close) so that the Element selected for MANUAL CLOSE will be effective. Inactive means that the Element operates as configured even with manual close. Internal control command If the manual closing signal is generated by the device's integrated control function, the information items have to be linked via CFC (interlocking task-level) using the CMD_Information function block.
99
Figure 2-26
Example for the generation of a manual close signal using the internal control function
2.3.10
Settings
Addresses which have an appended "A" can only be changed with DIGSI, under "Display Additional Settings". The table indicates region-specific default settings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corresponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer.
Addr. 1523
Setting Options Forward Reverse Non-Directional Forward Reverse Non-Directional Forward Reverse Non-Directional Forward Reverse Non-Directional OFF ON
1524
67-1 Direction
Forward
67-1 Direction
1525
67-TOC Direct.
Forward
67-TOC Direction
1526
67-3 Direction
Forward
67-3 Direction
1601 1602
OFF 0.50 A 2.50 A 0.10 sec 0.20 A 1.00 A 0.50 sec 0.20 A 1.00 A 0.20 sec 5.00 Disk Emulation Normal Inverse
1603 1604
1605 1607
0.05 .. 4.00 A 0.25 .. 20.00 A 0.05 .. 3.20 sec; 0.50 .. 15.00 ; Instantaneous Disk Emulation Normal Inverse Very Inverse Extremely Inv. Long Inverse
67N-TOC Time Dial 67N-TOC Time Dial Drop-Out Characteristic IEC Curve
100
Addr. 1612
Setting Options Very Inverse Inverse Short Inverse Long Inverse Moderately Inv. Extremely Inv. Definite Inv. 67N-3 instant. 67N-2 instant. 67N-1 instant. 67N-TOC instant Inactive always with VN and IN with V2 and I2 0.00 .. 60.00 sec -180 .. 180 Fundamental True RMS Fundamental True RMS Fundamental True RMS Forward Reverse Non-Directional Forward Reverse Non-Directional Forward Reverse Non-Directional Forward Reverse Non-Directional Fundamental True RMS 0.50 .. 35.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; always with 79 active
1613A
MANUAL CLOSE
67N-2 instant.
67N-2 active 67N POLARIZAT. 67N T DROP-OUT ROTATION ANGLE 67N-2 MEASUREM. 67N-1 MEASUREM. 67N-TOC MEASUR. 67N-2 Direction
always with VN and IN 0.00 sec -45 Fundamental Fundamental Fundamental Forward
67N-2 active Ground Polarization 67N Drop-Out Time Delay Rotation Angle of Reference Voltage 67N-2 measurement of 67N-1 measurement of 67N-TOC measurement of 67N-2 Direction
1624
67N-1 Direction
Forward
67N-1 Direction
1625
67N-TOC Direct.
Forward
67N-TOC Direction
1626
67N-3 Direction
Forward
67N-3 Direction
101
2.3.11
No. 2603 2605 2606 2614 2616 2617 2618 2623 2624 2635 2636 2646 2648 2656 2657 2658 2659 2668 2677 2678 2679 2681 2682 2683 2684 2685 2686 2687 2691 2695 2696 2697 2698 2699 2700
Information List
Information 67N-3 TRIP 67N-3 BLOCKED 67-3 BLOCKED >BLK 67N/67NTOC >BLOCK 67N-2 >BLOCK 67-3 >BLOCK 67N-3 >BLOCK 67N-1 >BLOCK 67N-TOC Ground forward Ground reverse 67N-2 picked up 67N-2 Time Out 67N OFF 67N BLOCKED 67N ACTIVE 67N-1 BLOCKED 67N-2 BLOCKED 67N-TOC BLOCKED 67-3 TRIP 67N-2 TRIP 67N-1 picked up 67N-1 Time Out 67N-1 TRIP 67N-TOCPickedup 67N-TOC TimeOut 67N-TOC TRIP 67N-TOC Disk PU 67/67N pickedup 67N picked up 67/67N TRIP 67-3 picked up 67N-3 picked up 67-3 Time Out 67N-3 Time Out Type of Information OUT OUT OUT SP SP SP SP SP SP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT 67N-3 TRIP 67N-3 is BLOCKED 67-3 is BLOCKED >BLOCK 67N/67N-TOC >BLOCK 67N-2 >BLOCK 67-3 >BLOCK 67N-3 >BLOCK 67N-1 >BLOCK 67N-TOC Ground forward Ground reverse 67N-2 picked up 67N-2 Time Out 67N/67N-TOC switched OFF 67N/67N-TOC is BLOCKED 67N/67N-TOC is ACTIVE 67N-1 is BLOCKED 67N-2 is BLOCKED 67N-TOC is BLOCKED 67-3 TRIP 67N-2 TRIP 67N-1 picked up 67N-1 Time Out 67N-1 TRIP 67N-TOC picked up 67N-TOC Time Out 67N-TOC TRIP 67N-TOC disk emulation is ACTIVE 67/67N picked up 67N/67N-TOC picked up 67/67N TRIP 67-3 picked up 67N-3 picked up 67-3 Time Out 67N-3 Time Out Comments
102
2.4
Applications It may be necessary to dynamically increase the pickup values if, during starting and for a short time thereafter, certain elements of the system have an increased power consumption after a long period of zero voltage (e.g. air-conditioning systems, heating installations, motors). Thus a raise of pickup thresholds can be avoided by taking into consideration such starting conditions. Prerequisites Note: Dynamic cold load pickup must not be confused with the changeover option of the 4 setting groups (A to D). It is an additional feature. It is possible to change pickup thresholds and delay times.
2.4.1
Effect
Description
There are two methods by which the device can determine if the protected equipment is de-energized: Via binary inputs, the device is informed of the position of the circuit breaker (address 1702 Start Condition = Breaker Contact). As a criterion a set current threshold is undershot (address 1702 Start Condition = No Current). If the device determines that the protected equipment is de-energized via one of the above methods, a time, CB Open Time, is started and after its expiration the increased thresholds take effect. Regardless of how parameter 1702 Start Condition is set, the release for cold load pickup can always be given via binary input >ACTIVATE CLP. Figure 2-28 shows the logic diagram of the dynamic cold load pickup function. If it is detected via the auxiliary contact or the current criterion that the system is de-energized, i.e. the circuit breaker is open, the CB Open Time is started. As soon as it has elapsed, the greater thresholds are enabled. When the protected equipment is re-energized (the device receives this information via the binary inputs or when threshold BkrClosed I MIN is exceeded), a second time delay referred to as the Active Time is initiated. Once it elapses, the pickup values of the relay elements return to their normal settings. This time may be reduced when current values fall below all normal pickup values for a set Stop Time after startup, i.e. after the circuit breaker has been closed. The starting condition of the fast reset time is made up of an OR-combination of the configured dropout conditions of all directional and non-directional overcurrent elements. When Stop Time is set to or when binary input >BLK CLP stpTim is active, no comparison is made with the "normal" thresholds. The function is inactive and the fast reset time, if applied, is reset. If overcurrent elements are picked up while time Active Time is running, the fault generally prevails until pickup drops out, using the dynamic settings. Only then the parameters are set back to "normal". When the dynamic setting values are activated via binary input >ACTIVATE CLP and this cause drops out, the "normal" settings are restored immediately even if a pickup is present.
103
If the binary input >BLOCK CLP is enabled, all triggered timers are reset and, as a consequence, all "normal" settings are immediately restored. If blocking occurs during an on-going fault with dynamic cold load pickup functions enabled, the timers of all overcurrent relay elements are stopped and may then be restarted based on their "normal" duration. During power up of the protective relay with an open circuit breaker, the time delay CB Open Time is started, and is processed using the "normal" settings. Therefore, when the circuit breaker is closed, the "normal" settings are effective.
Figure 2-27
104
Figure 2-28
Logic diagram of the dynamic cold load pickup function (50c, 50Nc, 51c, 51Nc, 67c, 67Nc)
105
2.4.2
General
Setting Notes
The dynamic cold load pickup function can only be enabled if address 117 Coldload Pickup was set to Enabled during configuration of the protection functions. If not required, this function is set to Disabled. The function can be turned ON or OFF under address 1701 Coldload Pickup. Depending on the condition that initiates the cold load pickup function, address 1702 Start Condition is set to either No Current or Breaker Contact. Breaker Contact can only be selected if the device receives information about the circuit breaker state via at least one binary input. Time Delays There are no specific procedures on how to set the time delays at addresses 1703 CB Open Time, 1704 Active Time and 1705 Stop Time. These time delays must be based on the specific loading characteristics of the equipment being protected, and should be set to allow for brief overloads associated with dynamic cold load conditions. Non-Directional Time Overcurrent Protection, Phases (50/51) The dynamic pickup values and time delays associated with non-directional time overcurrent protection are set at address block 18 (50C.../51C...) for phase currents: Address 1801 50c-2 PICKUP and 1802 50c-2 DELAY or 1808 50c-3 PICKUP and 1809 50c-3 DELAY define the dynamic parameters for the high current elements, 1803 50c-1 PICKUP and 1804 50c-1 DELAY for the 50 overcurrent element 1805 51c PICKUP together with 1806 51c TIME DIAL (for IEC curves) or 1807 51c TIME DIAL (or ANSI curves) for the 51 overcurrent element. Non-directional Time Overcurrent Protection (50N, 51N), Ground The dynamic pickup values and time delays associated with non-directional time overcurrent ground protection are set at address block 19 (50NC.../51NC...): Address 1901 50Nc-2 PICKUP and 1902 50Nc-2 DELAY or 1908 50Nc-3 PICKUP and 1909 50Nc-3 DELAY define the dynamic parameters for the high current elements, 1903 50Nc-1 PICKUP and 1904 50Nc1 DELAY for the 50N overcurrent element and 1905 51Nc PICKUP together with 1906 51Nc T-DIAL (for IEC curves) or 1907 51Nc T-DIAL (for ANSI curves) for the 51N overcurrent element. Directional Time Overcurrent Protection, Ground (67N, 67N-TOC) The dynamic pickup values and time delays associated with directional overcurrent ground protection are set at address block 21 (g67Nc.../67Nc-TOC...): Address 2101 67Nc-2 PICKUP and 2102 67Nc-2 DELAY define the dynamic parameters for the 67-2 element, 2103 67Nc-1 PICKUP and 2104 67Nc-1 DELAY for the 67-1 element and 2105 67Nc-TOC PICKUP together with 2106 67Nc-TOC T-DIAL (for IEC curves) or 2107 67Nc-TOC T-DIAL (for ANSI curves) for the 67-TOC element.
106
2.4.3
Settings
The table indicates region-specific default settings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corresponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer.
Parameter COLDLOAD PICKUP Start Condition CB Open Time Active Time Stop Time 50c-2 PICKUP
C OFF ON
Setting Options
Default Setting OFF No Current 3600 sec 3600 sec 600 sec 10.00 A 50.00 A 0.00 sec 2.00 A 10.00 A 0.30 sec 1.50 A 7.50 A 0.50 sec 5.00 A A 0.00 sec 7.00 A 35.00 A 0.00 sec 1.50 A 7.50 A 0.30 sec 1.00 A 5.00 A 0.50 sec 5.00 A 0.00 sec A A 0.00 sec
Comments Cold-Load-Pickup Function Start Condition Circuit Breaker OPEN Time Active Time Stop Time 50c-2 Pickup
No Current Breaker Contact 0 .. 21600 sec 0 .. 21600 sec 1 .. 600 sec; 1A 5A 0.10 .. 35.00 A; 0.50 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; 1A 5A 0.10 .. 35.00 A; 0.50 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; 1A 5A 0.10 .. 4.00 A 0.50 .. 20.00 A 0.05 .. 3.20 sec; 0.50 .. 15.00 ; 1A 5A 1.00 .. 35.00 A; 5.00 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; 1A 5A 0.05 .. 35.00 A; 0.25 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; 1A 5A 0.05 .. 35.00 A; 0.25 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; 1A 5A 0.05 .. 4.00 A 0.25 .. 20.00 A 0.05 .. 3.20 sec; 0.50 .. 15.00 ; 0.05 .. 35.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; 1A 5A 1.00 .. 35.00 A; 5.00 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec;
1802 1803
1804 1805
1809 1901
1902 1903
1904 1905
51Nc T-DIAL 51Nc T-DIAL 50Nc-3 PICKUP 50Nc-3 DELAY 67c-3 PICKUP
51Nc Time Dial 51Nc Time Dial 50Nc-3 Pickup 50Nc-3 Time Delay 67c-3 Pickup
2009
67c-3 DELAY
107
Addr. 2101
C 1A 5A
Default Setting 7.00 A 35.00 A 0.00 sec 1.50 A 7.50 A 0.30 sec 1.00 A 5.00 A 0.50 sec 5.00 A 0.00 sec
2102 2103
2104 2105
0.05 .. 4.00 A 0.25 .. 20.00 A 0.05 .. 3.20 sec; 0.50 .. 15.00 ; 0.25 .. 35.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec;
67Nc-TOC Time Dial 67Nc-TOC Time Dial 67Nc-3 Pickup 67Nc-3 Time Delay
2.4.4
No. 1730 1731 1732 1994 1995 1996 1997
Information List
Information >BLOCK CLP >BLK CLP stpTim >ACTIVATE CLP CLP OFF CLP BLOCKED CLP running Dyn set. ACTIVE Type of Information SP SP SP OUT OUT OUT OUT Comments >BLOCK Cold-Load-Pickup >BLOCK Cold-Load-Pickup stop timer >ACTIVATE Cold-Load-Pickup Cold-Load-Pickup switched OFF Cold-Load-Pickup is BLOCKED Cold-Load-Pickup is RUNNING Dynamic settings are ACTIVE
108
2.5
Applications Abnormally high voltages often occur e.g. in low loaded, long distance transmission lines, in islanded systems when generator voltage regulation fails, or after full load rejection of a generator from the system. The undervoltage protection function detects voltage collapses on transmission lines and electrical machines and prevents inadmissible operating states and a possible loss of stability.
2.5.1
Measurement Principle
Connection / Measured Values The voltages supplied to the device can be either the three phase-to-Ground voltages VA-N, VB-N, VC-N or two phase-to-phase voltages (VA-B, VB-C) and the displacement voltage (ground voltage VN). The connection mode has been specified during the configuration in address 213 VT Connect. 3ph, see 2.1.3.2. The following table indicates which voltages can be evaluated by the function. The settings for this are made in the P.System Data 1 (see Section 2.1.3.2). Furthermore, it is indicated to which value the threshold must be set. All voltages are fundamental frequency values. Table 2-7 Voltage protection, selectable voltages Connection, three-phase (parameter 213) Van, Vbn, Vcn Selectable voltage (parameter 614 / 615) Vphph (largest phase-to-phase voltage) V1 (positive sequence voltage) Threshold to be set as Phase-to-phase voltage Positive sequence voltage calculated from phase-toGround voltage or phaseto-phase voltage / 3 Negative sequence voltage Phase-to-phase voltage Positive sequence voltage Negative sequence voltage
Function Overvoltage
V2 (negative sequence voltage) Vab, Vbc, VGnd Vab, Vbc Vab, Vbc, Vx Vphph (largest phase-to-phase voltage) V1 (positive sequence voltage) V2 (negative sequence voltage) Undervoltage Van, Vbn, Vcn
Vphph (smallest phase-to-phase voltage) Phase-to-phase voltage Vph-n (smallest phase-to-Ground voltage) Phase-to-Ground voltage V1 (positive sequence voltage) Positive sequence voltage 3 Positive sequence voltage 3
109
The positive and negative sequence voltages stated in the table are calculated from the phase-to-Ground voltages. Note For capacitive voltage connections, the same values as with the connection type Van, Vbn, Vcn are used.
Current Criterion Depending on the system, the primary voltage transformers are arranged either on the supply side or the load side of the associated circuit breaker. These different arrangements lead to different behaviour of the voltage protection function when a fault occurs. When a tripping command is issued and a circuit breaker is opened, full voltage remains on the supply side while the load side voltage becomes zero. When voltage supply is suppressed, undervoltage protection, for instance, will remain picked up. If pickup is to drop out, the current can be used as an additional criterion for pickup of undervoltage protection (current supervision CS). Undervoltage pickup can only be maintained when the undervoltage criterion satisfied and a settable minimum current level (BkrClosed I MIN) are exceeded. Here, the largest of the three phase currents is used. When the current decreases below the minimum current setting after the circuit breaker has opened, undervoltage protection drops out. Note If parameter CURRENT SUPERV. is set to disabled in address 5120, the device picks up immediately without measurement voltage and the undervoltage protection function in pickup. Apply measuring voltage or block the voltage protection to continue with configuration. Moreover you have the option of setting a flag via device operation for blocking the voltage protection. This initiates the reset of the pickup and device configuration can be resumed.
110
2.5.2
Function
Overvoltage Protection 59
The overvoltage protection has two elements. In case of a high overvoltage, tripping switch off is performed with a short-time delay, whereas in case of less severe overvoltages, the tripping is performed with a longer time delay. When one of the adjustable settings is exceeded, the 59 element picks up and trips after an adjustable time delay has elapsed. The time delay is not dependent on the magnitude of the overvoltage. The dropout ratio for the two overvoltage elements (= Vdropout value/Vpickup value) can be set. The following figure shows the logic diagram of the overvoltage protection function.
Figure 2-29
111
2.5.3
Function
Undervoltage Protection 27
Undervoltage protection consists of two definite time elements (27-1 PICKUP and 27-2 PICKUP). Therefore, tripping can be time-coordinated depending on how severe voltage collapses are. Voltage thresholds and time delays can be set individually for both elements. The dropout ratio for the two undervoltage elements (= Vdropout value/Vpickup value) can be set. Like the other protection functions, the undervoltage protection operates in an extended frequency range. This ensures that the protection function is ensured even for the protection of decelerating motors, for instance. However, the r.m.s. value of the positive voltage component is considered too small when the frequency deviates considerably so that the device will tend to overfunction. Figure 2-30 shows a typical voltage profile during a fault for source side connection of the voltage transformers. Because full voltage is present after the circuit breaker has been opened, current supervision CS described above is not necessary in this case. After the voltage has dropped below the pickup setting, tripping is initiated after time delay 27-1 DELAY. After the fault has been cleared, i.e. when the voltage increases above the dropout threshold, the element will drop out and allow closing of the circuit breaker.
Figure 2-30
Typical fault profile for supply-side connection of the voltage transformers (without current supervision)
Figure 2-31 shows a fault profile for a load side connection of the voltage transformers. When the circuit breaker is open, the voltage disappears (the voltage remains below the pickup setting), and current supervision is used to ensure that pickup drops out after the circuit breaker has opened (BkrClosed I MIN). After the voltage has dropped below the pickup setting, tripping is initiated after time delay 27-1 DELAY. When the circuit breaker opens, voltage decreases to zero and undervoltage pickup is maintained. The current value also decreases to zero so that current criterion is reset as soon as the release threshold (BkrClosed I MIN) is exceeded. Pickup of the protection function is also reset by the action of the AND-combination of voltage and current. As a consequence, energization is admitted anew when the minimum command time elapsed.
112
Figure 2-31
Typical fault profile for load side connection of the voltage transformers (with current supervision)
Upon the closing of the circuit breaker, current criterion is delayed for a short period of time. If the voltage criterion drops out during this time period (about 60 ms), the protection function does not pick up. Therefore no fault record is created when voltage protection is activated in a healthy system. It is important to understand, however, that if a low voltage condition exists on the load after the circuit breaker is closed (unlike Figure 2-31), the desired pickup of the element will be delayed by 60 ms.
113
The following figure shows the logic diagram of the undervoltage protection function.
Figure 2-32
114
2.5.4
General
Setting Notes
Voltage protection is only effective and accessible if address 150 27/59 is set to Enabled during configuration of protection functions. If this function is not required, then Disabled is set. The voltage to be evaluated is selected in Power System Data 1 (see Chapter 2.5, Table 2-7). Overvoltage protection can be turned ON or OFF, or set to Alarm Only at address 5001 FCT 59. Undervoltage protection can be turned ON or OFF or set to Alarm Only at address 5101 FCT 27. With the protection function ON, tripping, the clearing of a fault and fault recording are initiated when the thresholds are exceeded and the set time delays have expired. With setting Alarm Only no trip command is given, no fault is recorded and no immediate fault annunciation is shown on the display. Overvoltage Protection with Phase-to-phase or Phase-to-Ground Voltages The largest of the applied voltages is evaluated for the phase-to-phase or phase-to-Ground overvoltage protection. The threshold values are set in the value to be evaluated (see Chapter 2.5, Table 2-7). The overvoltage protection has two elements. The pickup value of the lower threshold (address 5002 or 5003, 59-1 PICKUP, depending on the phase-to-Ground or the phase-to-phase voltages, can be assigned a longer time delay (address 5004, 59-1 DELAY) and the upper threshold Element (address 5005 or 5006, 59-2 PICKUP) a shorter (address 5007, 59-2 DELAY) time delay. There are no specific procedures on how the pickup values are set. However, as the function is mainly used to prevent high insulation damage to system components and users, the threshold value 5002 , 5003 59-1 PICKUP lies generally between 110 % and 115 % of the nominal voltage and setting value 5005 , 5006 59-2 PICKUP at approximately 130 %. The time delays of the overvoltage elements are entered at addresses 5004 59-1 DELAY and 5007 59-2 DELAY, and should be selected in such manner that they make allowance for brief voltage peaks that are generated during switching operations and also enable clearance of stationary overvoltages in due time. The choice between phase-to-Ground and phase-to-phase voltage allows voltage asymmetries (e.g. caused by a ground fault) to be taken into account (phase-to-Ground) or to remain unconsidered (phase-to-phase) during evaluation. Overvoltage Protection - Positive Sequence System V1 In a three-phase voltage transformer connection the positive sequence system can be evaluated for the overvoltage protection by means of configuring parameter 614 OP. QUANTITY 59 to V1. In this case, the threshold values of the overvoltage protection must be set in parameters 5019 59-1 PICKUP V1 or 5020 59-2 PICKUP V1. Overvoltage Protection - Negative Sequence System V2 In a three-phase transformer connection, parameter 614 OP. QUANTITY 59 can determine that the negative sequence system V2 can be evaluated as a measured value for the overvoltage protection. The negative sequence system detects voltage unbalance and can be used for the stabilization of the time overcurrent protection. In backup protection of transformers or generators, the fault currents lie, in some cases, only slightly above the load currents. In order to obtain a pickup threshold of the time overcurrent protection that is as sensitive as possible, its stabilization via the voltage protection is necessary to avoid false tripping.
115
Overvoltage protection comprises two elements. Thus, with configuration of the negative system, a longer time delay (address 5004, 59-1 DELAY) may be assigned to the lower Element (address 5015, 59-1 PICKUP V2 and a shorter time delay (address 5007, 59-2 DELAY) may be assigned to the upper Element (address 5016, 59-2 PICKUP V2). There are not clear cut procedures on how to set the pickup values 59-1 PICKUP V2 or 59-2 PICKUP V2 as they depend on the respective station configuration. The time delays of the overvoltage elements are entered at addresses 5004 59-1 DELAY and 5007 59-2 DELAY, and should be selected in such manner that they make allowance for brief voltage peaks that are generated during switching operations and also enable clearance of stationary overvoltages in due time. Dropout Threshold of the Overvoltage Protection The dropout thresholds of the 59-1 Element and the 59-2 Element can be configured via the dropout ratio r = VDropout/VPickup at addresses 5017 59-1 DOUT RATIO or 5018 59-2 DOUT RATIO. The following marginal condition applies to r: r (configured pickup threshold) 150 V with connection of phase-to-phase voltages and phase-to-Ground voltages or r (configured pickup threshold) 260 V with calculation of the measured values from the connected voltages (e.g. phase-to-phase voltages calculated from the connected phase-to-Ground voltages). The minimum hysteresis is 0.6 V. Undervoltage Protection - Positive Sequence System V1 The positive sequence component (V1) can be evaluated for the undervoltage protection. Especially in case of stability problems, their acquisition is advantageous because the positive sequence system is relevant for the limit of the stable energy transmission. Concerning the pickup values there are no specific notes on how to set them. However, because the undervoltage protection function is primarily intended to protect induction machines from voltage dips and to prevent stability problems, the pickup values will usually be between 60 % and 85 % of the nominal voltage. The threshold value is multiplied as positive sequence voltage and set to 3, thus realizing the reference to the nominal voltage. Undervoltage protection comprises two elements. The pickup value of the lower threshold is set at address 5110 or 5111, 27-2 PICKUP (depending on the voltage transformer connection, phase-to-Ground or phaseto-phase), while time delay is set at address 5112, 27-2 DELAY (short time delay). The pickup value of the upper Element is set at address 5102 or 5103, 27-1 PICKUP, while the time delay is set at address 5106, 27-1 DELAY (a somewhat longer time delay). Setting these elements in this way allows the undervoltage protection function to closely follow the stability behavior of the system. The time settings should be selected such that tripping occurs in response to voltage dips that lead to unstable operating conditions. On the other hand, the time delay should be long enough to avoid tripping on short-term voltage dips. Undervoltage Protection with Phase-to-phase or Phase-to-Ground Voltages In parameter 615 OP. QUANTITY 27 you can determine for undervoltage protection in a three-phase connection that instead of the positive-sequence system V1, the smallest of the phase-to-phase voltages Vphph or the smallest phase-to-Ground voltage Vph-n is configured as a measured quantity. The threshold values are set in the quantity to be evaluated (see Section 2.5, table 2-7). Undervoltage protection comprises two elements. The pickup value of the lower threshold is set at address 5110 or 5111, 27-2 PICKUP (depending on the voltage transformer connection, phase-to-Ground or phaseto-phase), while time delay is set at address 5112, 27-2 DELAY (short time delay). The pickup value of the upper Element is set at address 5102 or 5103, 27-1 PICKUP, while the time delay is set at address 5106, 27-1 DELAY (a somewhat longer time delay). Setting these elements in this way allows the undervoltage protection function to closely follow the stability behavior of the system.
116
The time settings should be selected such that tripping occurs in response to voltage dips that lead to unstable operating conditions. On the other hand, the time delay should be long enough to avoid tripping on short-term voltage dips. Dropout threshold of the undervoltage protection The dropout thresholds of the 27-1 Element and the 27-2 Element can be configured via the dropout ratio r = VDropout/VPickup at addresses 5113 27-1 DOUT RATIO or 5114 27-2 DOUT RATIO. The following marginal condition applies to r: r (parameterized pickup threshold) 130 V for evaluating directly measured voltages (phase-to-phase voltages or phase-to-Ground voltages) or r (configured pickup threshold 225 V for evaluation of values calculated from measured voltages (e.g. calculated phase-to-phase voltages from the connected phase-to-ground voltages). The minimum hysteresis is 0.6 V. Note If a setting is accidentally selected so that the dropout threshold (= pickup threshold dropout ratio) results in a value greater than 130 V/225 V, it will be reduced automatically. No error message occurs.
Current Criterion for Undervoltage Protection The 27-1 Element and the 27-2 Element can be supervised by the current flow monitoring setting. If the CURRENT SUPERV. is switched ON at address 5120 (factory setting), the release condition of the current criterion must be fulfilled in addition to the corresponding undervoltage condition, which means that a configured minimum current (BkrClosed I MIN, address 212) must be present to make sure that this protective function can pick up. Thus it can be achieved that pickup of the undervoltage protection drops out when the line is disconnected from voltage supply. Furthermore, this feature prevents an immediate general pickup of the device when the device is powered-up without measurement voltage being present. Note If parameter CURRENT SUPERV. is set to disabled at address 5120, the device picks up immediately if the measuring-circuit voltage fails and the undervoltage protection is enabled. Furthermore, configuration can be performed by pickup of measuring-circuit voltage or blocking of the voltage protection. The latter can be initiated via device operation in DIGSI and via communication from the control center by means of a tagging command for blocking the voltage protection. This causes the dropout of the pickup and parameterization can be resumed.
Please note that the pickup threshold BkrClosed I MIN (address 212) also affects the overload protection, the load jam protection, the cold load pickup function and the CB maintenance.
117
2.5.5
Settings
Addresses which have an appended "A" can only be changed with DIGSI, under "Display Additional Settings".
Addr. 5001
Parameter FCT 59
Setting Options OFF ON Alarm Only 20 .. 260 V 20 .. 150 V 0.00 .. 100.00 sec; 20 .. 260 V 20 .. 150 V 0.00 .. 100.00 sec; 2 .. 150 V 2 .. 150 V 0.90 .. 0.99 0.90 .. 0.99 20 .. 150 V 20 .. 150 V OFF ON Alarm Only 10 .. 210 V 10 .. 120 V 0.00 .. 100.00 sec; 10 .. 210 V 10 .. 120 V 0.00 .. 100.00 sec; 1.01 .. 3.00 1.01 .. 3.00 OFF ON
5002 5003 5004 5005 5006 5007 5015 5016 5017A 5018A 5019 5020 5101
59-1 PICKUP 59-1 PICKUP 59-1 DELAY 59-2 PICKUP 59-2 PICKUP 59-2 DELAY 59-1 PICKUP V2 59-2 PICKUP V2 59-1 DOUT RATIO 59-2 DOUT RATIO 59-1 PICKUP V1 59-2 PICKUP V1 FCT 27
110 V 110 V 0.50 sec 120 V 120 V 0.50 sec 30 V 50 V 0.95 0.95 110 V 120 V OFF
59-1 Pickup 59-1 Pickup 59-1 Time Delay 59-2 Pickup 59-2 Pickup 59-2 Time Delay 59-1 Pickup V2 59-2 Pickup V2 59-1 Dropout Ratio 59-2 Dropout Ratio 59-1 Pickup V1 59-2 Pickup V1 27 Undervoltage Protection
27-1 PICKUP 27-1 PICKUP 27-1 DELAY 27-2 PICKUP 27-2 PICKUP 27-2 DELAY 27-1 DOUT RATIO 27-2 DOUT RATIO CURRENT SUPERV.
27-1 Pickup 27-1 Pickup 27-1 Time Delay 27-2 Pickup 27-2 Pickup 27-2 Time Delay 27-1 Dropout Ratio 27-2 Dropout Ratio Current Supervision
118
2.5.6
No.
Information List
Information Type of Information IntSP SP SP SP SP SP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT Comments 27, 59 blocked via operation >BLOCK 27 undervoltage protection >27-Switch current supervision ON >BLOCK 27-1 Undervoltage protection >BLOCK 27-2 Undervoltage protection >BLOCK 59 overvoltage protection 27 Undervoltage protection switched OFF 27 Undervoltage protection is BLOCKED 27 Undervoltage protection is ACTIVE 27-1 Undervoltage picked up 27-1 Undervoltage PICKUP w/curr. superv 27-2 Undervoltage picked up 27-2 Undervoltage PICKUP w/curr. superv 27-1 Undervoltage TRIP 27-2 Undervoltage TRIP 59-Overvoltage protection switched OFF 59-Overvoltage protection is BLOCKED 59-Overvoltage protection is ACTIVE 59-1 Overvoltage V> picked up 59-1 Overvoltage V> TRIP 59-2 Overvoltage V>> picked up 59-2 Overvoltage V>> TRIP
234.2100 27, 59 blk 6503 6505 6506 6508 6513 6530 6531 6532 6533 6534 6537 6538 6539 6540 6565 6566 6567 6568 6570 6571 6573 >BLOCK 27 >27 I SUPRVSN >BLOCK 27-1 >BLOCK 27-2 >BLOCK 59 27 OFF 27 BLOCKED 27 ACTIVE 27-1 picked up 27-1 PU CS 27-2 picked up 27-2 PU CS 27-1 TRIP 27-2 TRIP 59 OFF 59 BLOCKED 59 ACTIVE 59-1 picked up 59-1 TRIP 59-2 picked up 59-2 TRIP
119
2.6
Applications The application of unbalanced load protection to motors has a special significance. Unbalanced loads create counter-rotating fields in three-phase induction motors, which act on the rotor at double frequency. Eddy currents are induced at the rotor surface, and local overheating in rotor end zones and the slot wedge begins to take place. This especially goes for motors which are tripped via vacuum contactors with fuses connected in series. With single-phasing by fuse pickup the motor only generates small and pulsing moments such that it soon gets strained thermally assuming, however, that the driven machine requires the same amount of moments. In addition, with unbalanced supply voltage it is endangered by thermal overload. Due to the small negative sequence reactance even small voltage asymmetries lead to negative sequence currents. In addition, this protection function may be used to detect interruptions, short circuits and polarity problems with current transformers. It is also useful in detecting single-phase and two-phase faults with fault currents lower than the maximum load currents. Prerequisites The unbalanced load protection becomes effective when: at least one phase current is greater than 0.05 x INom and all phase currents are smaller than 10 x INom.
2.6.1
Figure 2-33
120
Settable Dropout Times Pickup stabilization for the definite-time tripping characteristic 46-1, 46-2 can be accomplished by means of settable dropout times. This facility is used in power systems with possible intermittent faults. Used together with electromechanical relays, it allows different dropout responses to be adjusted and a time grading of numerical and electromechanical relays to be implemented.
2.6.2
Pickup and Tripping The negative sequence current I2 is compared to the setting value 46-TOC PICKUP. When the negative sequence current exceeds 1.1 times the setting value, a pickup annunciation is generated. The tripping time is calculated from the negative sequence current according to the Curve selected. When tripping time is reached, a tripping command is issued. The characteristic curve is illustrated in the following Figure.
Figure 2-34
Dropout for IEC Curves The Element drops out when the negative sequence current decreases to approx. 95% of the pickup setting. The time delay resets immediately to be ready for another pickup operation.
121
Dropout for ANSI Curves When using an ANSI curve it can be selected whether the dropout of the element is to occur instantaneously or whether dropout is to be performed by means of the disk emulation mechanism. Instantaneous means that the drop out will occur when a 95 % of the pickup value is reached. For a new pickup the time counter starts at zero. The disk emulation evokes a dropout process (timer counter is decrementing) which begins after de-energization. This process corresponds to the reset of a Ferraris-disk (explaining its denomination "disk emulation"). In case several faults occur in succession, the "history" is taken into consideration due to the inertia of the Ferraris-disk, and the time response is adapted. This ensures a proper simulation of the temperature rise of the protected object even for extremely fluctuating unbalanced load values. Reset begins as soon as 90 % of the setting value is reached, in accordance with the dropout curve of the selected characteristic. In the range between the dropout value (95 % of the pickup value) and 90 % of the setting value, the incrementing and decrementing process is in idle state. Disk emulation offers advantages when the behavior of the negative sequence protection must be coordinated with other relays in the system based on electromagnetic measuring principles. Logic The following figure shows the logic diagram for the negative sequence protection function. The protection may be blocked via a binary input. This resets pickup and time elements and clears measured values. When leaving the operating range of the unbalanced load protection (all phase currents below 0.05 x INom or at least one phase current is greater than 10 x INom), all unbalanced load elements that have picked up will drop out.
122
Figure 2-35
The pickup of the definite time overcurrent protection can be stabilized by the configured dropout time 4012 46 T DROP-OUT. This time is started and maintains the pickup condition if the current falls below the threshold. Therefore, the function does not drop out at high speed. The trip command delay time continues running. After the dropout delay time has elapsed, the pickup is reported OFF and the trip delay time is reset unless the threshold has been exceeded again. If the threshold is exceeded again during the dropout delay time, the time is canceled. The trip command delay time continues running. Should the threshold value be exceeded after its expiry, the trip command is issued immediately. If the threshold value is not exceeded at this time, there will be no reaction. If the threshold value is exceeded again after expiry of the trip-command delay time, while the dropout delay time is still running, tripping occurs immediately. The configured dropout times do not influence the tripping times of the inverse time elements as these depend dynamically on the measured current value. For purposes of dropout coordination, disc emulation is used with electro-mechanical relays.
123
2.6.3
General
Setting Notes
The function type has been specified during configuration of the protection functions (see Section 2.1.1.2, address 140, 46). If only the definite time elements are desired, the address 46 should be set to Definite Time. Selecting 46 = TOC IEC or TOC ANSI in address 140 will additionally make all parameters available that are relevant for the inverse time characteristics. If this function is not required, then Disabled is set. The function can be turned ON or OFF in address 4001 FCT 46. The default pickup settings and delay settings are generally sufficient for most applications. If data is available from the manufacturer regarding the allowable long-term load imbalance and the allowable load imbalance per unit of time, this data should be used preferentially. It is important to note that the manufacturer's data relate to the primary values of the machine, for example, the maximum permissible permanent inverse current is referred to the nominal machine current. For the setting values at the protection device, this information is converted to the secondary inverse current. The following applies
with I2 perm prim INom Motor ICT sec ICT prim Definite Time Elements The unbalanced load protection function comprises two elements. Therefore, the upper Element (address 4004 46-2 PICKUP) can be set to a short time delay4005 46-2 DELAY) and the lower Element (address 4002 46-1 PICKUP) can be set to a somewhat longer time delay (address 4003 46-1 DELAY). This allows the lower Element to act, e.g. as an alarm, while the upper Element will cut the inverse time Curve as soon as high inverse currents are present. If 46-2 PICKUP is set to about 60%, tripping is always performed with the thermal Curve. On the other hand, with more than 60% of unbalanced load, a two-phase fault can be assumed. The delay time 46-2 DELAY must be coordinated with the system grading of phase-to-phase faults. If power supply with current I is provided via just two phases, the following applies to the inverse current: permissible thermal inverse current of the motor Nominal Motor Current Secondary Nominal Current of the Current Transformer Primary nominal current of the current transformer
124
Examples: Motor with the following data: Nominal current Briefly permissible negative sequence current Current transformer Setting value Setting value INom Motor = 545 A I2 long-term prim /INom Motor= 0.55 for T max = 1 s INomprim/INomsec = 600 A/1 A 46-1 Pickup = 0.11 545 A (1/600 A) = 0.10 A 46-2 Pickup = 0.55 545 A (1/600 A) = 0.50 A
Continuously permissible negative sequence current I2 dd prim /INom Motor = 0.11 continuous
When protecting feeder or cable systems, unbalanced load protection may serve to identify low magnitude unsymmetrical faults below the pickup values of the directional and non-directional overcurrent elements. Here, the following must be observed:
A phase-to-ground fault with current I corresponds to the following negative sequence current:
On the other hand, with more than 60% of unbalanced load, a phase-to-phase fault can be assumed. The delay time 46-2 DELAY must be coordinated with the system grading of phase-to-phase faults. For a power transformer, unbalanced load protection may be used as sensitive protection for low magnitude phase-to-ground and phase-to-phase faults. In particular, this application is well suited for delta-wye transformers where low side phase-to-ground faults do not generate high side zero sequence currents (e.g. vector group Dy). Since transformers transform symmetrical currents according to the transformation ratio "CTR", the relationship between negative sequence currents and total fault current for phase-to-phase faults and phase-to-ground faults are valid for the transformer as long as the turns ratio "CTR" is taken into consideration. Consider a transformer with the following data: Base Transformer Rating Primary Nominal Voltage Secondary Nominal Voltage Vector Groups High Side CT SNomT = 16 MVA VNom = 110 kV VNom = 20 kV Dy5 100 A / 1 A (CTI = 100) (TRV = 110/20)
The following fault currents may be detected at the low side: If 46-1 PICKUP on the high side of the devices is set to = 0.1, then a fault current of I = 3 TRV TRI 46-1 PICKUP = 3 110/20 100 0.1 A = 165 A for single-phase faults and 3 TRV TRI 46-1 PICKUP = 95 A can be detected for two-phase faults at the low side. This corresponds to 36% and 20% of the transformer nominal current respectively. It is important to note that load current is not taken into account in this simplified example.
125
As it cannot be recognized reliably on which side the thus detected fault is located, the delay time 46-1 DELAY must be coordinated with other downstream relays in the system. Pickup Stabilization (definite-time overcurrent protection) Pickup of the definite time elements can be stabilized by means of a configurable dropout time. This dropout time is set in 4012 46 T DROP-OUT. IEC Curves (Inverse Time Tripping Curve) The thermal behavior of a machine can be closely replicated due to negative sequence by means of an inverse time tripping curve. In address 4006 46 IEC CURVE, select out of three IEC curves provided by the device the curve which is most similar to the thermal unbalanced load curve provided by the manufacturer. The tripping curves of the protective relay, and the formulas on which they are based, are given in the Technical Data. It must be noted that a safety factor of about 1.1 has already been included between the pickup value and the setting value when an inverse time Curve is selected. This means that a pickup will only occur if an unbalanced load of about 1.1 times the setting value 46-TOC PICKUP is present (address 4008). The dropout is performed as soon as the value falls below 95% of the pickup value. The associated time multiplier is entered at address 4010, 46-TOC TIMEDIAL. The time multiplier can also be set to . After pickup the Element will then not trip. Pickup, however, will be signaled. If the inverse time Element is not required at all, address 140 46 should be set to Definite Time during the configuration of protection functions (Section 2.1.1.2).
126
2.6.4
Settings
Addresses which have an appended "A" can only be changed with DIGSI, under "Display Additional Settings". The table indicates region-specific default settings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corresponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer.
C OFF ON 1A 5A
Setting Options
Default Setting OFF 0.10 A 0.50 A 1.50 sec 0.50 A 2.50 A 1.50 sec Extremely Inv.
4003 4004
0.05 .. 3.00 A 0.25 .. 15.00 A 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; Normal Inverse Very Inverse Extremely Inv. Extremely Inv. Inverse Moderately Inv. Very Inverse
4005 4006
4007
46 ANSI CURVE
Extremely Inv.
ANSI Curve
4008
46-TOC PICKUP
1A 5A
0.05 .. 2.00 A 0.25 .. 10.00 A 0.50 .. 15.00 ; 0.05 .. 3.20 sec; Instantaneous Disk Emulation 0.00 .. 60.00 sec
46-TOC Pickup
46-TOC Time Dial 46-TOC Time Dial 46-TOC Drop Out 46 Drop-Out Time Delay
2.6.5
No. 5143 5151 5152 5153 5159 5165 5166 5170 5171
Information List
Information >BLOCK 46 46 OFF 46 BLOCKED 46 ACTIVE 46-2 picked up 46-1 picked up 46-TOC pickedup 46 TRIP 46 Dsk pickedup Type of Information SP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT >BLOCK 46 46 switched OFF 46 is BLOCKED 46 is ACTIVE 46-2 picked up 46-1 picked up 46-TOC picked up 46 TRIP 46 Disk emulation picked up Comments
127
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
2.7
Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
For the protection of motors, the 7SK80 can be provided with a motor starting protection feature, a restart inhibit and a load jam protection function. The starting protection function protects the motor from prolonged startup procedures thus supplementing the overload protection (see Section 2.9). The motor restart inhibit prevents restarting of the motor when this restart may cause the permissible thermal limits of the rotor to be exceeded. The load jam protection serves to protect the motor during sudden rotor blocking.
2.7.1
2.7.1.1 Description
General In particular, rotor-critical high-voltage motors can quickly be heated above their thermal limits when multiple starting attempts occur in a short period of time. If the durations of these starting attempts are lengthened e.g. by excessive voltage surges during motor starting, by excessive load moments, or by blocked rotor conditions, a trip signal will be initiated by the protective relay. Motor starting is detected when a settable current threshold I MOTOR START is exceeded. Calculation of the tripping time is then initiated. It should be noted that this timer starts every time the motor is started. This is therefore a normal operating condition that is neither indicated in the fault log nor causes the creation of a fault record. Only when the locked rotor time has elapsed is the trip command issued. The protection function consists of one definite time and one inverse time tripping element. Inverse Time Overcurrent Element The inverse time overcurrent element is designed to operate only when the rotor is not blocked. With a decreased startup current resulting from voltage dips when starting the motor, prolonged startup times are evaluated correctly and tripping with an appropriate time is enabled. The characteristic (see formula below) can be ideally adjusted to the condition of the motor by using different startup times depending on the cold or warm condition of the motor (see Figure 2-36). The tripping time is calculated based on the following equation:
with tTRIP t max STARTUP I ISTARTUP IMOTOR START Actual tripping time for flowing current I Tripping time for nominal startup current ISTARTUP (address 4103, STARTUP TIME or 4105, STARTUP T WARM) Current actually flowing (measurement value) Nominal startup current of the motor (address 4102, STARTUP CURRENT) Pickup value for recognition of motor startup (address 1107, I MOTOR START),
128
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
Figure 2-36
Therefore, if the startup current I is smaller (larger) than the nominal current ISTARTUP (parameter STARTUP CURRENT) as configured under address 4102, then the actual tripping time tTrip is prolonged (or shortened) accordingly (see Figure 2-36). Definite Time Overcurrent Tripping Characteristic (Locked Rotor Time) Tripping must be executed when the actual motor starting time exceeds the maximum allowable locked rotor time if the rotor is locked. The device can be informed about the locked rotor condition via the binary input (>48 Rot. locked), e.g. from an external r.p.m. monitor. The motor startup condition is assumed when the current in any phase exceeds the current threshold I MOTOR START. At this instant, the timer LOCK ROTOR TIME is started. The locked rotor delay time (LOCK ROTOR TIME) is linked to a binary input >48 Rot. locked via an AND gate. If the binary input is picked up after the set locked rotor time has expired, immediate tripping will take place regardless of whether the locked rotor condition occurred before, during or after the timeout. Logic Motor starting protection may be switched on or off. In addition, motor starting protection may be blocked via a binary input which will reset timers and pickup annunciations. The following figure illustrates the logic of motor starting protection. A pickup does not create messages in the trip log buffer. Fault recording is not started until a trip command has been issued. When the function drops out, all timers are reset. The annunciations disappear and a trip log is terminated should it have been created.
129
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
Figure 2-37
Switching of Startup Times The motor manufacturer provides startup time curves for both cold and warm motor conditions (see Figure 236). The function Motor Starting Protection automatically performs a switching. The "warm motor" condition is derived from the thermal storage of the restart inhibit (see Section 2.7.2). Therefore, this function must be enabled. The condition for the switching is determined by the parameter 4106 TEMP.COLD MOTOR. If the motor temperature (actually the rotor temperature) exceeds the threshold value, then a switching from "cold motor" to "warm motor" takes place (see logic diagram 2-37). The threshold values can be derived from the permitted number of cold (ncold) and warm (nwarm) motor startups. By means of the following formula an approximate limit value can be determined. (Parameter 4106 TEMP.COLD MOTOR)
The setting value should always be lower than the limit value (see Setting Notes 2.7.1.2).
130
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
The setting for address STARTUP CURRENT (ISTARTUP) as a secondary value is calculated as follows:
For reduced voltage, the startup current is also reduced almost linearly. At 80 % nominal voltage, the startup current in this example is reduced to 0.8 ISTARTUP = 2.5. The setting for detection of a motor startup must lie above the maximum load current and below the minimum start-up current. If no other influencing factors are present (peak loads), the value for motor startup I MOTOR START set at address 1107 may be an average value: Based on the Long-Term Current Rating:
131
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
For ratios deviating from nominal conditions, the motor tripping time changes:
At 80% of nominal voltage (which corresponds to 80% of nominal starting current), the tripping time is:
After the time delay (4104 LOCK ROTOR TIME) has elapsed, the binary input becomes effective and generates a trip signal. If the locked rotor time is set just long enough that during normal startup the binary input >48 Rot. locked (FNo. 6805) is reliably reset during the delay time LOCK ROTOR TIME, faster tripping will be available during motor starting under locked rotor conditions. Threshold Values "cold" / "warm" Motor Parameter 4106 TEMP.COLD MOTOR determines the threshold value. It is derived from the number of cold (ncold) and warm (nwarm) motor startups. Unless specified otherwise, three cold and two warm startups (ncold = 3; nwarm = 2) will be sufficient. These are typical motor data. The limit value is thus derived:
A recommended setting value with consideration of a safety margin for TEMP.COLD MOTOR = 25%. Should the technical data of the motor make reference to four cold and two warm startups (ncold = 4; nwarm = 2), the following limit value can be determined:
The setting value should fall below the limit value. A value of 40% is recommended for that purpose.
132
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
Note Overload protection curves are also effective during motor starting conditions. However, the thermal profile during motor starting is constant. Parameter I MOTOR START at address 1107 limits the working range of the overload protection to larger current values.
2.7.2
2.7.2.1 Description
General The rotor temperature of a motor generally remains well below its maximum admissible temperature during normal operation and also under increased load conditions. However, high startup currents required during motor startup increase the risk of the rotor being thermally damaged rather the stator due to the short thermal constant of the rotor. To avoid that multiple starting attempts provoke tripping, a restart of the motor must be inhibited if it is apparent that the thermal limit of the rotor will be exceeded during this startup attempt. Therefore, the 7SK80 features the motor restart inhibit which outputs a blocking command until a new motor startup is permitted for the deactivated motor (restarting limit). The blocking signal must be configured to a binary output relay of the device whose contact is inserted in the motor starting circuit. Determining the Rotor Overtemperature Since the rotor current cannot be measured directly, the stator current must be used to generate a thermal replica of the rotor. The r.m.s. values of the currents are used for this. The rotor overtemperature R is calculated using the largest of these three phase currents. It is assumed that the thermal limit values for the rotor winding are based on the manufacturer's data regarding the nominal starting current, maximum permissible starting time, and the number of starts permitted from cold (ncold) and warm (nwarm) conditions. From this data, the device performs the necessary calculations to establish the thermal replica of the rotor and issues a blocking signal until the thermal replica of the rotor decreases below the restarting limit at which startup is permitted again.
133
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
Figure 2-38
Temperature curve at the rotor and in the thermal replica during repeated start-up attempts
Although the heat distribution on the rotor bars may severely differ during motor starting, the different maximum temperatures in the the rotor are not pertinant for motor restart inhibit (see Figure 2-38). It is much more important to establish a thermal replica, after a complete motor start, that is appropriate for the protection of the motor's thermal condition. Figure 2-38 shows, as an example, the heating processes during repeated motor starts (three starts from cold operating condition), as well as the thermal replica in the protection relay.
134
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
Restart Threshold If the rotor temperature has exceeded the restart threshold, the motor cannot be restarted. The blocking signal is not lifted unless the rotor temperature has fallen below the restarting limit, that is, when exactly one start becomes possible without exceeding the excessive rotor temperature limit. Based on the specified motor parameters the device calculates the normalized restarting limit Restart:
Where: Restart kR ISTARTUP IMOTNom Tstart max R ncold = = = = = = = Temperature threshold below which restarting is possible k-factor for the rotor, calculated internally Startup current Nominal motor current Maximum startup time Thermal time constant of the rotor, calculated internally Permissible number of startups in cold condition
The restarting limit Restart is displayed as operational measured value in the thermal measured values. Rotor Overload Detection If the rotor temperature exceeds 100% of the maximum temperature calculated from the thermal rotor profile, there is a risk of motor damage. If this threshold value is exceeded, either tripping occurs or an overload message is issued. The desired reaction can be determined via parameter 4311 ROTOR OVERLOAD. If parameter is set to OFF, rotor overload will not be detected. Restart Time The motor manufacturer allows a maximum number of cold (ncold) and warm (nwarm) startup attempts. Thereafter, another startup is not permitted. A certain time must have passed restarting time TRestart to ensure that the rotor has cooled off (operational measured value 661). Equilibrium Time This thermal behavior is provided for in the protection as follows: Each time the motor is shut down, the timer starts (address 4304 T Equal). It takes into account the different thermal conditions of the motor parts at the moment of shutdown. During the equilibrium time, the thermal replica of the rotor is not updated. It is maintained constant to replicate the equilization process in the rotor. Then, the thermal replica with the corresponding time constant (rotor time constant x extension factor) cools down. During the equilibrium time the motor cannot be restarted. As soon as the temperature sinks below the restarting limit, the next restart attempt can be made. Minimum Inhibit Time Regardless of thermal replicas, some motor manufacturers require a minimum inhibit time after the maximum number of permissible startup attempts has been exceeded. The total duration of the inhibit signal depends on which of the times TMin Inhibit or TRestart is longer.
135
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
Total Time TReclose The total waiting time TReclose before the motor can be restarted is therefore composed of the equilibrium time and the time TRestart calculated from the thermal replica, and the value that is needed to drop below the limit for restarting. If the calculated temperature rise of the rotor is above the restarting limit when the motor is shut down, the minimum inhibit time will be started together with the equilibrium time. Thus the total inhibit time TReclose can become equal to the minimum inhibit time if it is longer than the sum of the two first mentioned times: TReclose = TEqual + TRestart TReclose = TMin Inhibit for TMin Inhibit < TEqual + TRestart for TMin Inhibit TEqual + TRestart if the calculated excessive temperature > restarting limit
The operational measured value 809 TReclose (visible in the thermal measured values) is the remaining time until the next restart is permissible. When the rotor excessive temperature is below the restarting limit and thus the next restarting attempt is permitted, the operational measured value for the waiting time has reached zero. Extension of Cool Down Time Constants In order to properly account for the reduced heat exchange when a self-ventilated motor is stopped, the cool down time constants can be increased relative to the time constants for a running machine with the factor K at STOP (address 4308). The criterion for the motor stop is the undershooting of a set current threshold BkrClosed I MIN. This understands that the motor idle current is greater than this threshold. The pickup threshold BkrClosed I MIN affects also the thermal overload protective function (see Section 2.9). While the motor is running, the heating of the thermal replica is modeled with the time constant R calculated from the motor ratings, and the cool down calculated with the time constant R K at RUNNING (address 4309). In this way, the protection caters to the requirements in case of a slow cool down (slow temperature equilibrium). For calculation of the restarting time TRestart the following applies:
with kt at STOP kt at RUNNING pre R Extension factor for the time constant = K at STOP, address 4308 Extension factor for the time constant = K at RUNNING, address 4309 thermal replica at the moment of motor shutdown (depending on operational condition) Rotor time constant, calculated internally
Behavior in Case of Power Supply Failure Depending on the setting in address 235 ATEX100 of Power System Data 1 (see Section 2.1.3.2) the value of the thermal replica is either reset to zero (ATEX100 = NO) if the power supply voltage fails, or cyclically buffered in a non-volatile memory (ATEX100 = YES) so that it is maintained in the event of auxiliary supply voltage failure. In the latter case, when power supply is restored, the thermal replica uses the stored value for calculation and matches it to the operating conditions. The first option is the default setting. For further details, see /5/.
136
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
Emergency Start If, for emergency reasons, motor starting that will exceed the maximum allowable rotor temperature must take place, the motor restart inhibit signal can be removed via a binary input (>66 emer.start), thus allowing a new starting attempt. The thermal rotor profile, however, continues to function and the maximum allowable rotor temperature will be exceeded. No motor shutdown will be initiated by the motor restart inhibit, but the calculated excessive temperature of the rotor can be observed for risk assessment. Blocking If the motor restart inhibit function is blocked via binary input >BLOCK 66 or switched off, the thermal replica of the rotor overtemperature, the equilibrium time T Equal and the minimum inhibit time T MIN. INHIBIT are reset. Thus any blocking signal that is present or upcoming is disregarded. Via another binary input (>66 RM th.repl.) the thermal replica can be reset independently. This may be useful for testing and commissioning, and after a power supply voltage failure. Logic There is no pickup annunciation for the restart inhibit and no trip log is produced. The following figure shows the logic diagram for the restart inhibit.
137
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
Figure 2-39
138
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
The motor restart inhibit acts on the starting process of a motor that is shut down. A motor is considered shut down when its current consumption falls below the settable threshold 212 BkrClosed I MIN. Therefore, this threshold must be set lower than the motor idle current. The motor restart inhibit concludes the condition warm motor from the thermal replica of the restart inhibit. For this function, address 4301FCT 66 has to be enabled. Additionally, the function can trip directly if the rotor temperature exceeds the maximum admissible temperature (100%). For this purpose address 4311 ROTOR OVERLOAD is set to ON. If only monitoring is desired, set to Alarm Only, otherwise to OFF. Characteristic Values Many of the variables needed to calculate the rotor temperature are supplied by the motor manufacturer. Among these variables are the starting current ISTARTUP, the nominal motor current IMOT. NOM, the maximum allowable starting time T START MAX (address 4303), the number of allowable starts from cold conditions (ncold), and the number of allowable starts from warm conditions (nwarm). The starting current is entered at address 4302 IStart/IMOTnom , expressed as a multiple of nominal motor current. In contrast, the nominal motor current is entered as a secondary value, directly in amperes, at address 4305 I MOTOR NOMINAL. The number of warm starts allowed is entered at address 4306 (MAX.WARM STARTS) and the difference (#COLD-#WARM) between the number of allowable cold and warm starts is entered at address 4307. For motors without separate ventilation, the reduced cooling at motor stop can be accounted for by entering the factor K at STOP at address 4308. As soon as the current no longer exceeds the setting value entered at address 212 BkrClosed I MIN, motor standstill is detected and the time constant is increased by the extension factor configured. If no difference between the time constants is to be used (e.g. externally-ventilated motors), then the extension factor K at STOP should be set to 1. The cooling with the motor running is influenced by the extension factor 4309 K at RUNNING. This factor considers that motor running under load and a stopped motor do not cool down at the same speed. It becomes effective as soon as the current exceeds the value set at address 212 BkrClosed I MIN. With K at RUNNING = 1 the heating and the cooling time constant are the same at operating conditions (I > BkrClosed I MIN).
139
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
Example: Motor with the following data: Rated Voltage Nominal current Startup current Startup duration Permitted starts with cold motor Permitted starts with warm motor Current transformer VNom = 6600 V INom = 126 A ISTARTUP = 624 A TStart max. = 8.5 s ncold = 3 nwarm = 2 200 A / 1 A
The following settings are made: IStart/IMOTnom = 4.9 I MOTOR NOMINAL = 0.6 A T START MAX = 8.5 s MAX.WARM STARTS = 2 #COLD-#WARM = 1 For the rotor temperature equilibrium time, (address 4304) a setting time of approx. T Equal = 1 min has proven to be a good value. The value for the minimum inhibit time T MIN. INHIBIT depends on the motor manufacturer, or by the user's requirements. It must in any case be higher than 4304 T Equal. In this example, a value has been chosen that reflects the thermal replica (T MIN. INHIBIT = 6.0 min). The motor manufacturer's, or the requirements also determine also the extension factor for the time constant during cool-down, especially with the motor stopped. Where no other specifications are made, the following settings are recommended: K at STOP = 5 and K at RUNNING = 2. For a proper functioning, it is also important that the CT values and the current threshold for distinction between stopped and running motor (address 212 BkrClosed I MIN, recommended setting 0.1 IMOT.NOM) have been set correctly. An overview of parameters and their default settings is generally given in the setting tables.
140
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
Temperature Behavior during Changing Operating States For a better understanding of the above considerations several possible operating ranges in two different operating areas will be discussed in the following paragraph. Settings indicated above are to be used prevaling 3 cold and 2 warm startup attempts have resulted in the restart limit reaching 66.7%. A) Below the thermal restarting limit: 1. A normal startup brings the machine into a temperature range below the thermal restarting limit and the machine is stopped. The stop launches the equilibrium time 4304 T Equal and generates the message 66 TRIP. The equilibrium time expires and the message 66 TRIP is cleared. During the time T Equal the thermal replica remains "frozen" (see Figure 2-40, on the left). A normal startup brings the machine into a temperature range below the thermal restarting limit, the machine is stopped and is started by an emergency startup without waiting for the equilibrium time to expire. The equilibrium time is reset, the thermal replica is released and 66 TRIP is reported as going (see Figure 2-40, to the right).
2.
Figure 2-40
141
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
B) Above the thermal restarting limit: 1. A startup brings the machine from load operation into a temperature range far above the thermal restarting limit and the machine is stopped. The minimum inhibit time and the equilibrium time are started and 66 TRIP is reported. The temperature cool-down below the restarting limit takes longer than 4310 and T MIN. INHIBIT and 4304 T Equal, so that the time passing until the temperature falls below the temperature limit is the decisive factor for clearing the message 66 TRIP. The thermal replica remains "frozen" while the equilibrium time expires (see Figure 2-41, to the left). A startup brings the machine from load operation into a temperature range just above the thermal restarting limit and the machine is stopped. The minimum inhibit time and the equilibrium time are started and 66 TRIP is reported. Although the temperature soon falls below the restarting limit, the blocking 66 TRIP is preserved until the equilibrium time and the minimum inhibit time have expired (see Figure 2-41, to the right).
2.
Figure 2-41
142
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
2.7.3
Figure 2-42
Figure 2-43 illustrates an example of a locked rotor caused by mechanical overload. It should be noted that the current flow increases substantially as soon as the mechanical load reaches the stability limit.
143
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
Figure 2-43
Logic A continuous comparison of the motor current with the configured threshold values of the protection function takes place for the purpose of detecting a locked rotor. Figure 2-44 shows the logic diagram. The thresholdvalue comparison is blocked during the motor startup phase, as the startup currents usually move in a size similar to the occurring currents when a rotor is locked. The algorithm verifies the motor standstill according to currents and (if available) the message >52-a. As soon as a current increase is applied after detection of the motor standstill, the load jam protection is temporarily blocked in order to avoid motor shutdown during the motor startup phase. The motor is detected as being in standstill when none of the three phase currents exceeds the threshold set via address 212 BkrClosed I MIN and the binary signal >52-a is inactive. The >52-a signal is only taken into account if the binary input is allocated accordingly.
144
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
Figure 2-44
145
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
Motor Standstill and Motor Startup Due to the threshold setting below the motor startup current, the load jam protection during motor startup must be blocked. Via parameters 212 BkrClosed I MIN the open circuit breaker is detected during current-flow measurement (motor standstill). In this condition the load change protection is blocked. After having closed the circuit breaker, the blocking is maintained during motor startup by the setting 4406 T Start Blk.. In order to avoid malfunctioning, the T Start Blk. is set to the double startup time. Motor Protection Example Figure 2-45 illustrates an example of a complete motor protection characteristic. Such characteristic usually consists of different protection elements, and each element is responsible for special motor malfunctions. These are: Thermal overload protection: to avoid overheating of the motor due to inadmissible load Load jam protection: to prevent overheating and mechanical damage due to a locked rotor Motor starting protection: protects the motor against prolonged startup procedures and the consequent thermal overload of the rotor Overcurrent and high-current elements: for motor shutdown due to electrical faults
Figure 2-45
146
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
Example: Motor with the following data: Nominal voltage Nominal current Long-term current rating Startup duration Current transformer VNom = 6600 V INom = 126 A Imax = 135 A Tstartmax. = 8.5 s INomCTprim / INomCTsec = 200 A / 1 A
The setting for address 4402 Load Jam I> as secondary value is calculated as follows:
The tripping delay time can remain at the default setting of 1 s. The warning threshold is set to 75% of the tripping element (4404 I Alarm 0.95 A sec.). The tripping delay time can remain at the default setting of 2 s. In order to block the function during motor startup, the parameter 4406 T Start Blk. is set to double startup time (T Start Blk. = 2 8.5 s = 17 s).
147
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
2.7.4
Motor (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
Functions relevant to Motor Protection and Restart Inhibit for Motors and Load Jam Protection are described in the aforegoing two sections and contain information concerning configuration.
2.7.4.1 Settings
The table indicates region-specific default settings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corresponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer. Addr. 4101 4102 Parameter FCT 48 STARTUP CURRENT 1A 5A 4103 4104 4105 4106 4301 4302 4303 4304 4305 STARTUP TIME LOCK ROTOR TIME STARTUP T WARM TEMP.COLD MOTOR FCT 66 IStart/IMOTnom T START MAX T Equal I MOTOR NOMINAL 1A 5A 4306 4307 4308 4309 4310 4311 MAX.WARM STARTS #COLD-#WARM K at STOP K at RUNNING T MIN. INHIBIT ROTOR OVERLOAD C OFF ON 0.50 .. 16.00 A 2.50 .. 80.00 A 1.0 .. 180.0 sec 0.5 .. 180.0 sec; 0.5 .. 180.0 sec; 0 .. 80 %; OFF ON 1.10 .. 10.00 1 .. 320 sec 0.0 .. 320.0 min 0.20 .. 1.20 A 1.00 .. 6.00 A 1 .. 4 1 .. 2 0.2 .. 100.0 0.2 .. 100.0 0.2 .. 120.0 min ON OFF Alarm Only Setting Options Default Setting OFF 5.00 A 25.00 A 10.0 sec 2.0 sec 10.0 sec 25 % OFF 4.90 10 sec 1.0 min 1.00 A 5.00 A 2 1 5.0 2.0 6.0 min ON Maximum Number of Warm Starts Number of Cold Starts Warm Starts Extension of Time Constant at Stop Extension of Time Constant at Running Minimum Restart Inhibit Time Rotor Overload Protection Startup Time Permissible Locked Rotor Time Startup Time for warm motor Temperature limit for cold motor 66 Startup Counter for Motors I Start / I Motor nominal Maximum Permissible Starting Time Temperature Equalizaton Time Rated Motor Current Comments 48 Startup Time Supervision for Motors Startup Current
148
Functions 2.7 Motor Protection (Motor Starting Protection 48, Motor Restart Inhibit 66, Load Jam Protection)
Addr. 4401
4402
1A 5A
2.00 A 10.00 A 1.00 sec 1.80 A 9.00 A 1.00 sec 10.00 sec
Load Jam Tripping Threshold Load Jam Trip Delay Load Jam Alarm Threshold Load Jam Alarm Delay Load Jam Blocking after motor start
4403 4404
0.50 .. 12.00 A 2.50 .. 60.00 A 0.00 .. 600.00 sec 0.00 .. 600.00 sec
4405 4406
149
2.8
Applications Decrease in system frequency occurs when the system experiences an increase in the real power demand, or when a malfunction occurs with a generator governor or automatic generation control (AGC) system. The frequency protection function is also used for generators which (for a certain time) operate to an island network. This is due to the fact that the reverse power protection cannot operate in case of a drive power failure. The generator can be disconnected from the power system by means of the frequency decrease protection. Increase in system frequency occurs e.g. when large blocks of load (island network) are removed from the system, or again when a malfunction occurs with a generator governor. This entails risk of self-excitation for generators feeding long lines under no-load conditions.
2.8.1
Description
Frequency Detection The frequency is detected preferrably from the positive sequence voltage. If this voltage is too low, the phaseto-phase voltage VA-B at the device is used. If the amplitude of this voltage is too small, one of the other phase tophase voltages is used instead. Through the use of filters and repeated measurements, the frequency evaluation is free from harmonic influences and very accurate. Overfrequency/Underfrequency Frequency protection consists of four frequency elements. To make protection flexible for different power system conditions, theses elements can be used alternatively for frequency decrease or increase separately, and can be independently set to perform different control functions. Operating range The frequency can be determined as long as at least one of the phasetophase voltages is present and of sufficient magnitude. If the measured voltage sinks below a settable value Vmin, the frequency protection is blocked because no precise frequency values can be calculated from the signal. Time Delays / Logic Each frequency element has an associated settable time delay. When the time delay elapses, a trip signal is generated. When a frequency element drops out, the tripping command is immediately terminated, but not before the minimum command duration has elapsed. Each of the four frequency elements can be blocked individually via binary inputs. The following figure shows the logic diagram for the frequency protection function.
150
Figure 2-46
2.8.2
General
Setting Notes
Frequency protection is only in effect and accessible if address 154 81 O/U is set to Enabled during configuration of protective functions. If the function is not required Disabled is set. The function can be turned ON or OFF under address 5401 FCT 81 O/U. By setting the parameters 5421 to 5424, the function of each of the elements 81-1 PICKUP to 81-4 PICKUP is set individually as overfrequency or underfrequency protection or set to OFF, if the element is not required. Minimum voltage The minimum voltage below which the frequency protecion is blocked is entered in address 5402 Vmin. The threshold values is set as phase-to-phase quantity.
151
Pickup Values The setting as overfrequency or underfrequency element does not depend on the parameter threshold values of the respective element. An element can also function, for example, as an overfrequency element if its threshold value is set below the nominal frequency and vice versa. If frequency protection is used for load shedding purposes, the setting values depend on the actual power system conditions. Normally, a time coordinated load shedding is required that takes into account the importance of the consumers or consumer groups. Further application examples exist in the field of power stations. Here too, the frequency values to be set mainly depend on the specifications of the power system / power station operator. The underfrequency protection safeguards the power station's own demand by disconnecting it from the power system on time. The turbo governor regulates the machine set to the nominal speed. Consequently, the station's own demands can be continuously supplied at nominal frequency. Under the assumption that the apparent power is reduced by the same degree, turbine-driven generators can, as a rule, be continuously operated down to 95% of the nominal frequency. However, for inductive consumers, the frequency reduction not only means an increased current input, but also endangers stable operation. For this reason, only a short-term frequency reduction down to about 48 Hz (for fN = 50 Hz) or 58 Hz (for fN = 60 Hz) is permissible. A frequency increase can, for example, occur due to a load shedding or malfunction of the speed regulation (e.g. in an island network). In this way, the frequency increase protection can, for example, be used as overspeed protection. Dropout Thresholds The dropout threshold is defined via the adjustable dropout-difference address 5415 DO differential. It can thus be adjusted to the network conditions. The dropout difference is the absolute-value difference between pickup threshold and dropout threshold. The default value of 0.02 Hz can usually remain. Should, however, frequent minor frequency fluctuations be expected, this value should be increased. Time Delays The delay times 81-1 DELAY to 81-4 DELAY (addresses 5405, 5408, 5411 and 5414) allow the frequency elements to be time coordinated, e.g. for load shedding equipment. The set times are additional delay times not including the operating times (measuring time, dropout time) of the protection function.
2.8.3
Settings
Addresses which have an appended "A" can only be changed with DIGSI, under "Display Additional Settings".
Parameter FCT 81 O/U Vmin Vmin 81-1 PICKUP 81-1 PICKUP 81-1 DELAY 81-2 PICKUP OFF ON
Setting Options
Comments 81 Over/Under Frequency Protection Minimum required voltage for operation Minimum required voltage for operation 81-1 Pickup 81-1 Pickup 81-1 Time Delay 81-2 Pickup
10 .. 150 V 20 .. 150 V 40.00 .. 60.00 Hz 50.00 .. 70.00 Hz 0.00 .. 100.00 sec; 40.00 .. 60.00 Hz
152
Addr. 5407 5408 5409 5410 5411 5412 5413 5414 5415A 5421
Parameter 81-2 PICKUP 81-2 DELAY 81-3 PICKUP 81-3 PICKUP 81-3 DELAY 81-4 PICKUP 81-4 PICKUP 81-4 DELAY DO differential FCT 81-1 O/U
Setting Options 50.00 .. 70.00 Hz 0.00 .. 100.00 sec; 40.00 .. 60.00 Hz 50.00 .. 70.00 Hz 0.00 .. 100.00 sec; 40.00 .. 60.00 Hz 50.00 .. 70.00 Hz 0.00 .. 100.00 sec; 0.02 .. 1.00 Hz OFF ON f> ON f< OFF ON f> ON f< OFF ON f> ON f< OFF ON f> ON f<
Default Setting 59.00 Hz 30.00 sec 47.50 Hz 57.50 Hz 3.00 sec 51.00 Hz 61.00 Hz 30.00 sec 0.02 Hz OFF
Comments 81-2 Pickup 81-2 Time Delay 81-3 Pickup 81-3 Pickup 81-3 Time delay 81-4 Pickup 81-4 Pickup 81-4 Time delay Dropout differential 81-1 Over/Under Frequency Protection 81-2 Over/Under Frequency Protection 81-3 Over/Under Frequency Protection 81-4 Over/Under Frequency Protection
5422
OFF
5423
OFF
5424
OFF
2.8.4
No. 5203 5206 5207 5208 5209 5211 5212 5213 5214 5232 5233 5234 5235 5236 5237 5238 5239
Information List
Information >BLOCK 81O/U >BLOCK 81-1 >BLOCK 81-2 >BLOCK 81-3 >BLOCK 81-4 81 OFF 81 BLOCKED 81 ACTIVE 81 Under V Blk 81-1 picked up 81-2 picked up 81-3 picked up 81-4 picked up 81-1 TRIP 81-2 TRIP 81-3 TRIP 81-4 TRIP Type of Information SP SP SP SP SP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT >BLOCK 81O/U >BLOCK 81-1 >BLOCK 81-2 >BLOCK 81-3 >BLOCK 81-4 81 OFF 81 BLOCKED 81 ACTIVE 81 Under Voltage Block 81-1 picked up 81-2 picked up 81-3 picked up 81-4 picked up 81-1 TRIP 81-2 TRIP 81-3 TRIP 81-4 TRIP Comments
153
2.9
Applications In particular, the thermal overload protection allows the thermal status of motors, generators and transformers to be monitored. If an additional thermal input is available, the thermal replica may take the actual ambient or coolant temperature into account.
2.9.1
Description
Thermal Replica The device calculates the overtemperature in accordance with a single-body thermal replica, based on the following differential equation:
with th I k INom Obj. Present overtemperature related to the final overtemperature at maximum allowed phase current k INom Obj Thermal time constant of the protected object's heating Present true r.m.s value of phase current kfactor indicating the maximum permissible constant phase current referred to the nominal current of the protected object Nominal current of protected object
with u Nom Measured ambient temperature or coolant temperature Temperature at object nominal current
If the ambient or coolant temperature is not measured, a constant value of u = 40C is assumed so that u' = 0. The protection function therefore represents a thermal replica of the equipment to be protected (overload protection with memory capability). Both the previous history of an overload and the heat loss to the environment are taken into account.
154
When the calculated overtemperature reaches the first settable threshold 49 ALARM, an alarm annunciation is issued, e.g. to allow time for the load reduction measures to take place. When the calculated overtemperature reaches the second threshold, the protected equipment may be disconnected from the system. The highest overtemperature calculated from the three phase currents is used as the criterion. The maximum thermally permissible continuous current Imax is described as a multiple of the object nominal current INom Obj.: Imax = k INom Obj. In addition to the k factor (parameter 49 K-FACTOR), the TIME CONSTANT th and the alarm temperature 49 ALARM (in percent of the trip temperature TRIP) must be specified. Overload protection also features a current warning element (I ALARM) in addition to the temperature warning element. The current warning element may report an overload current prematurely, even if the calculated operating temperature has not yet attained the warning or tripping levels. Coolant Temperature (ambient temperature) The device can take external temperatures into account. Depending on the type of application, this may be a coolant or ambient temperature. The temperature can be measured via a temperature measuring device or the I/O-2 extension module. For this purpose, the required temperature sensor is connected to sensor input 1 of the RTD box (corresponds to RTD 1) or to the I/O-2 extension module. Ambient temperature detection is, however, disabled if there are communication problems between the sensor and the RTD box or between the RTD box and the protection device or if incorrect temperature values are measured. In these cases, an error message will be generated and the standard temperature of u = 40 C is used instead for the calculation. When measuring the coolant temperature, the maximum permissible current Imax is influenced by the temperature difference of the coolant to the standard value of 104F or 40C. Because if the ambient or coolant temperature is low, the protected object can sustain a higher current than when the temperature is high. Extension of Time Constants When using the device to protect motors, the varying thermal response at standstill or during rotation may be correctly evaluated. When running down or at standstill, a motor without external cooling looses heat more slowly, and a longer thermal time constant must be used for calculation. For a motor that is switched off, the 7SK80 increases the time constant th by a programmable factor (k factor). The motor is considered to be off when the motor currents drop below a programmable minimum current setting BkrClosed I MIN (refer to "Current Flow Monitoring" in Section 2.1.3). For externally-cooled motors, cables and transformers, the KFACTOR = 1. Current Limiting In order to ensure that overload protection, on occurrence of high fault currents (and with small time constants), does not result in extremely short tripping times thereby perhaps affecting time grading of the short circuit protection, the thermal replica is frozen (kept constant) as soon as the current exceeds the threshold value 1107 I MOTOR START.
155
Blocking The thermal memory may be reset via a binary input (>RES 49 Image) and the current-related overtemperature value is thus reset to zero. The same is accomplished via the binary input (>BLOCK 49 O/L); in this case, the entire overload protection is blocked completely, including the current warning element. When motors must be started for emergency reasons, temperatures above the maximum permissible overtemperatures can be allowed by blocking the trip signal via a binary input (>EmergencyStart). Since the thermal replica may have exceeded the tripping temperature after initiation and dropout of the binary input, the protection function features a programmable run-on time interval (T EMERGENCY) which is started when the binary input drops out and continues suppressing a trip signal. Tripping via the overload protection is suppressed until this time interval has elapsed. The binary input affects only the trip command. There is no effect on the trip log nor does the thermal replica reset. Behavior in Case of Power Supply Failure Depending on the setting in address 235 ATEX100 of Power System Data 1 (see Section 2.1.3.2) the value of the thermal replica is either reset to zero (ATEX100 = NO) if the power supply voltage fails, or cyclically buffered in a non-volatile memory (ATEX100 = YES) so that it is maintained in the event of auxiliary supply voltage failure. In the latter case, when power supply is restored, the thermal replica uses the stored value for calculation and matches it to the operating conditions. The first option is the default setting. For further details, see /5/.
156
Figure 2-47
157
2.9.2
General
Setting Notes
Overload protection is only effective and accessible if address 142 49 is set to No ambient temp or to With amb. temp.. If this function is not required, then Disabled is set. Transformers and cable are prone to damage by overloads that last for an extended period of time. Overloads cannot and should not be detected by fault protection. Time overcurrent protection should be set high enough to only detect faults since these must be cleared in a short time. Short time delays, however, do neither allow measures to discharge overloaded equipment nor do they permit to take advantage of its (limited) overload capacity. The 7SK80 devices feature an overload protection function with thermal tripping characteristic adaptable to the overload capability of the equipment being protected (overload protection with memory function). Overload protection can be switched ON or OFF or set to Alarm Only at address 4201 FCT 49. If overload protection is ON, tripping, trip log and fault recording is possible. When setting Alarm Only no trip command is given, no trip log is initiated and no spontaneous fault annunciation is shown on the display. Note Changing the function parameters resets the thermal replica. The thermal model is frozen (kept constant), as soon as the current exceeds the setting value 1107 I MOTOR START.
Overload Parameter k-factor The overload protection is set in reference values. The nominal current INom Obj. of the protected object (motor, transformer, cable) is used as the basic current for overload protection. By means of the thermal consistently permissible current Imax, a factor kprim can be calculated:
The thermally permissible continuous current for the equipment being protected is known from the manufacturers specifications. This function is normally not applicable to overhead lines since the current capability of overhead lines is generally not specified. For cables, the permissible continuous current is dependent on the cross-section, insulating material, design, and the cable routing, among other things. It may be taken from pertinent tables, or is specified by the cable manufacturer. If no specifications are available, a value of 1.1 times the nominal current rating may be assumed.
158
For the 49 K-FACTOR to be set in the device the following applies (address 4202)
with Imax prim INom Obj. INom CT prim Permissible thermal primary current of the motor Nominal current of the protected object Nominal primary CT current
Example: Motor and current transformer with the following data: Permissible Continuous Current Nominal Motor Current Current Transformer Imax prim = 1.2 INom Obj. INom Obj. = 1100 A 1200 A / 1 A
Time Constant The overload protection tracks overtemperature progression, employing a thermal differential equation whose steady state solution is an exponential function. The TIME CONSTANT th (set at address 4203) is used in the calculation to determine the threshold of overtemperature and thus, the tripping temperature. For cable protection, the heat-gain time constant is determined by cable specifications and by the cable environment. If no time-constant specification is available, it may be determined from the short-term load capability of the cable. The 1-sec current, i.e. the maximum current permissible for a one-second period of time, is often known or available from tables. Then, the time constant may be calculated with the formula:
If the short-term load capability is given for an interval other than one second, the corresponding short-term current is used in the above formula instead of the 1-second current, and the result is multiplied by the given duration. For example, if the 0.5-second current rating is known:
It is important to note, however, that the longer the effective duration, the less accurate the result.
159
Example: Cable and current transformer with the following data: Permissible continuous current Maximum current for 1 s Current transformer Thus results: Imax = 500 A at u = 40 C I1s = 45 Imax = 22.5 kA 600 A / 1 A
The settings are: 49 K-FACTOR = 0.83; TIME CONSTANT = 33.7 min Warning Elements By setting the thermal warning element 49 ALARM (address 4204), a warning message can be issued before reaching the tripping temperature. Tripping can thus be avoided by initiating early load reduction measures. This warning element simultaneously represents the dropout level for the trip signal. Only when this threshold is undershot, tthe tripping command will be reset and the protected equipment can be switched on again. The thermal element level is given in % of the tripping overtemperature. A current warning level is also available (parameter 4205 I ALARM). The setting is set as the secondary current in A (mperes) and should be equal to or slightly less than the permissible current k IN sec .. It can be used instead of the thermal warning element by setting the thermal warning element to 100 % thus virtually disabling it Extension of Time Constants TIME CONSTANT set in address 4203 is valid for a running motor. When a motor without external cooling is running down or at standstill, the motor cools down more slowly. This behavior can be modeled by increasing the time constant by factor K-FACTOR, set at address 4207. Motor stop is detected if the current falls below the threshold value BkrClosed I MIN of the current flow monitoring (see side title "Current Flow Monitoring" in Subsection 2.1.3.2). This understands that the motor idle current is greater than this threshold. The pickup threshold BkrClosed I MIN affects also the following protection functions: voltage protection and restart inhibit for motors. If no differentiation of the time constants is necessary (e.g. externally-cooled motors, cables, lines, etc.) the KFACTOR is set at 1 (default setting value). Dropout Time after Emergency Starting The dropout time to be entered at address 4208 T EMERGENCY must ensure that after an emergency startup and after dropout of the binary input >EmergencyStart the trip command is blocked until the thermal replica is below the dropout threshold again.
160
Ambient or Coolant Temperature The specifications made up to now are sufficient to model the overtemperature. The ambient or coolant temperature, however, can also be processed. This has to be communicated to the device as digitalized measured value via the interface. During configuration, parameter 142 49 must be set to With amb. temp.. If the ambient temperature detection is used, the user must be aware that the 49 K-FACTOR to be set refers to an ambient temperature of 104 F or 40 C, i.e. it corresponds to the maximum permissible current at a temperature of 104 F or 40 C. Since all calculations are performed with standardized quantities, the ambient temperature must also be standardized. The temperature at nominal current is used as standardized quantity. If the nominal current deviates from the nominal CT current, the temperature must be adapted according to the formula following. In address 4209 or 4210 49 TEMP. RISE I the temperature adapted to the nominal transformer current is set. This setting value is used as standardization quantity for the ambient temperature input.
with Nomsec Nom Mach INom CT prim INom Mach Machine temperatur at secondary nominal current = setting at the protection device (address 4209 or 4210) Machine temperature at nominal machine current Nominal primary CT current Nominal current of the machine
If the temperature input is used, the tripping times change if the coolant temperature deviates from the internal reference temperature of 104 F or 40 C. The following formula can be used to calculate the tripping time:
with k INom I IPre Nom k TIME CONSTANT (address 4203) 49 K-FACTOR (address 4202) Nominal device current in A Fault current through phase in A Prefault current Temperature at nominal current INom (address 4209 49 TEMP. RISE I) Coolant temperature input (scaling with address 4209 or 4210)
161
Example: Machine: INom Mach = 483 A Imax Mach=1.15 INom at K = 40 C Nom Mach = 93 C Temperature at INom Mach th = 600 s (thermal time constant of the machine) Current transformer: 500 A / 1 A
Motor Starting Recognition The motor starting is detected when setting I MOTOR START at address 1107 is exceeded. Information on how to perform the configuration is given under "Recognition of Running Condition (only for motors)" in Subsection2.1.3.2.
2.9.3
Settings
Addresses which have an appended "A" can only be changed with DIGSI, under "Display Additional Settings". The table indicates region-specific default settings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corresponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer.
Addr. 4201
Parameter FCT 49
Setting Options OFF ON Alarm Only 0.10 .. 4.00 1.0 .. 999.9 min 50 .. 100 %
Comments 49 Thermal overload protection 49 K-Factor Time Constant 49 Thermal Alarm Stage Current Overload Alarm Setpoint Kt-FACTOR when motor stops Emergency time 49 Temperature rise at rated sec. curr. 49 Temperature rise at rated sec. curr.
1.10 100.0 min 90 % 1.00 A 5.00 A 1.0 100 sec 100 C 212 F
0.10 .. 4.00 A 0.50 .. 20.00 A 1.0 .. 10.0 10 .. 15000 sec 40 .. 200 C 104 .. 392 F
162
2.9.4
No. 1503 1507 1511 1512 1513 1515 1516 1517 1521 1580 1581
Information List
Information >BLOCK 49 O/L >EmergencyStart 49 O / L OFF 49 O/L BLOCK 49 O/L ACTIVE 49 O/L I Alarm 49 O/L Alarm 49 Winding O/L 49 Th O/L TRIP >RES 49 Image 49 Image res. Type of Information SP SP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT SP OUT Comments >BLOCK 49 Overload Protection >Emergency start of motors 49 Overload Protection is OFF 49 Overload Protection is BLOCKED 49 Overload Protection is ACTIVE 49 Overload Current Alarm (I alarm) 49 Overload Alarm! Near Thermal Trip 49 Winding Overload 49 Thermal Overload TRIP >49 Reset of Thermal Overload Image 49 Thermal Overload Image reset
163
2.10
Monitoring Functions
The device incorporates comprehensive monitoring functions which cover both hardware and software. The measured values too are continuously checked for plausibility so that the current and voltage transformer circuits are largely included into the monitoring system.
2.10.1
Measurement Supervision
2.10.1.1 General
The device monitoring extends from the measuring inputs to the binary outputs. Monitoring checks the hardware for malfunctions and abnormal conditions. Hardware and software monitoring described in the following are enabled continuously. Settings (including the possibility to activate and deactivate the monitoring function) refer to the monitoring of external transformer circuits.
164
Measurement Value Acquisition Currents The monitoring of the device-internal measured-value acquisition of the currents can be effected via the current sum monitoring. Up to four input currents are measured by the device. If the three phase currents and the ground current from the current transformer neutral point are connected with the device, the sum of the four digitized currents must be zero. This also applies in the event of a possible transformer saturation. For that reason in order to eliminate pickup upon transformer saturation this function is only available in a Holmgreen-connection (see also Section 2.1.3.2). Faults in the current circuits are recognized if IF = | iA + iB + iC + iE | > I THRESHOLD + I FACTOR | I | I THRESHOLD (address 8106) and I FACTOR (address 8107) are setting parameters. The component I FACTOR | I | takes into account the permissible current proportional ratio errors of the input transducers which are particularly prevalent during large short-circuit currents (Figure 2-48). The dropout ratio is about 97 %.
Figure 2-48
An error in the current sum results in the message Failure I (No. 162) and blocking of the protection function. Furthermore, a fault log is initiated for a period of 100 ms. The monitoring can be switched off. The monitoring is available subject to the following conditions: The three phase currents are connected to the device (address 251 A, B, C, (Gnd)) The ground current of the current transformer neutral point is connected to the fourth current input (I4) (Holmgreen-connection). This is communicated to the device in the Power System Data 1 via address 280 YES. The fourth current input is normally designed for a I4transformer. In case of a sensitive transformer type, this monitoring is not available. The settings CT PRIMARY (address 204) and Ignd-CT PRIM (address 217) must be the same. The settings CT SECONDARY (address 205) and Ignd-CT SEC (address 218) must be the same.
165
The following logic diagram illustrates the operational mode of the current sum monitoring.
Figure 2-49
Note If the current input IN is configured as a sensitive transformer or if the connection mode A,G2,C,G; G->B or A,G2,C,G; G2->B was set for the current transformers at parameter 251 CT Connect., current sum monitoring is not possible.
AD Transformer Monitoring The digitized sampled values are being monitored in respect of their plausibility. If the result is not plausible, message 181 Error A/D-conv. is issued. The protection is blocked, thus preventing unwanted operation. Furthermore, a fault record is generated for recording of the internal fault.
166
167
Figure 2-50
Voltage Symmetry In healthy network operation it can be expected that the voltages are nearly balanced. Because the phase-tophase voltages are insensitive to ground faults, the phase-to-phase voltages are used for the symmetry monitoring. Depending of the connection mode, either the measured quantities or the calculated phase-to-phase voltages are used. From the phase-to-phase voltages, the rectified average values are generated and checked for symmetry of their values. The smallest phase voltage is compared with the largest phase voltage. | Vmin | / | Vmax | < BAL. FACTOR V as long as | Vmax | > BALANCE V-LIMIT. Where Vmax is the highest of the three voltages and Vmin the smallest. The symmetry factor BAL. FACTOR V (address 8103) represents the allowable asymmetry of the conductor voltages while the limit value BALANCE V-LIMIT (address 8102) is the lower limit of the operating range of this monitoring (see Figure 2-51). Both parameters can be set. The dropout ratio is about 97%. This failure is thus located below the curve for all values and is reported as Fail V balance.
Figure 2-51
168
Phase Sequence of Voltage and Current To detect swapped phase connections in the voltage and current input circuits, the phase sequence of the phase-to-phase measured voltages and the phase currents are checked by monitoring the sequence of same polarity zero crossing of the voltages. Direction measurement with normal voltages, path selection for fault location, and negative sequence detection all assume a phase sequence of "abc". Phase rotation of measurement quantities is checked by verifying the phase sequences. For that purpose, the phase-sequence monitoring uses the phase-to-phase voltages VAB, VBC, VCA. Voltages: VAB before VBC before VCA and Currents: IA before IB before IC. Verification of the voltage phase rotation is done when each measured voltage is at least |VAB|, |VBC|, |VCA| > 40 V. Verification of the current phase rotation is done when each measured current is at least: |IA|, |IB|, |IC| > 0.5 INom. For abnormal phase sequences, the messages Fail Ph. Seq. V or Fail Ph. Seq. I are issued, along with the switching of this message Fail Ph. Seq.. For applications in which an opposite phase sequence is expected, the protective relay should be adjusted via a binary input or the respective parameter PHASE SEQ. (address 209). If the phase sequence is changed in the relay, phases B and C internal to the relay are reversed, and the positive and negative sequence currents are thereby exchanged (see also Section 2.18.2). The phase-related messages, malfunction values, and measured values are not affected by this.
169
Mode of Operation - Grounded System The device is informed of the application of the FFM in the grounded system via address 5301 FUSE FAIL MON. Solid grounded. Note On systems where ground fault current is very small or absent (e.g. ungrounded supply transformers), fuse failure monitoring must be disabled or set to Coil.gnd./isol..
The logic diagram on the mode of operation in a grounded system is illustrated in Figure 2-52. Depending on the configuration and MLFB, the FFM operates with measured or calculated values VN or IN. If a zero sequence voltage occurs without a ground fault current being registered simultaneously, this suggests an asymmetrical fault in the secondary voltage transformer circuit. The displacement voltage element of the sensitive ground fault detection, the directional time overcurrent protection (Ground) and the undervoltage protection are blocked if parameter 5310 BLOCK PROT. is set to YES. The FFM picks up if the ground voltage VN is higher than the limit value set at 5302 FUSE FAIL 3Vo and if the ground current IN is smaller than the limit value set at 5303 FUSE FAIL RESID. Pickup occurs at the configured values. A hysteresis for the dropout of 105% is integrated for IN or 95% for VN. In the case of a low-current asymmetrical fault in a system with week infeed, the ground current caused by the fault could lie below the pickup threshold of the FFM. An overfunctioning of the FFM can, however, cause the feeder protection device to underfunction since all protection functions that use voltage signals are blocked. In order to prevent such an overfunctioning of the FFM, the phase currents are also checked. If at least one phase current lies above the pickup threshold of 5303 FUSE FAIL RESID, it can be assumed that the zero current created by a short-circuit equally exceeds this threshold. In order to immediately detect an existing fault after connection, the following applies: If a ground current IN larger than the pickup threshold of 5303FUSE FAIL RESID is detected within 10 seconds after recognition of the fuse failure criterion, the protection assumes a short-circuit and removes the blocking by the FFM for the duration of the fault. Whereas if the voltage failure criterion is present for more than about 10 seconds, the blocking is permanently active. After this time has elapsed, it can be assumed that a fuse failure has actually occurred. Only 10 seconds after the voltage criterion was removed by correction of the secondary circuit failure, is the blocking automatically reset, thereby releasing the blocked protection functions. The generation of the internal signal Alarm FFM for the mode of operation in an isolated system is illustrated in Figure 2-53.
170
Figure 2-52
Mode of Operation - Isolated System and and 3-pole Fuse Failure The FFM can also operate in isolated and compensated (resonant-grounded) systems where only low ground currents are to be expected. The device is informed of that via address 5301 FUSE FAIL MON.. The logic diagram on the mode of operation in an isolated system and for 3-pole fuse failure is illustrated in Figure 2-53. The following is a description of the principles for single-, two- and three-pole faults in a secondary voltage transformer system. If this part of the FFM logic picks up, the internal signal Alarm FFM is generated, the further processing of which is indicated in Figure 2-52.
171
Figure 2-53
Single- and Two-phase Failures in Voltage Transformer Circuits The measuring voltage failure detection is based on the fact that a significant negative sequence system is formed in the voltage during single- or two-phase voltage failure, however without influencing the current. This enables a clear distinction from asymmetries impressed by the power system. If the negative sequence system is related to the current positive sequence system, the following rules apply to the Fault-free Case:
172
If a fault occurs in the voltage transformer secondary system, the following rules apply to the Single-phase Failure:
If a fault occurs in the voltage transformer secondary system, the following rules apply to the Two-phase Failure:
In case of a failure of one or two phases of the primary system, the current also shows a negative sequence system of 0.5 or 1. Consequently, the voltage monitoring does not respond since no voltage transformer fault can be present. In order to avoid occurrence of an overfunctioning of the measuring voltage failure detection due to inaccuracy, the function is blocked below a minimum threshold of the positive sequence systems of voltage (V1 < 0.1 VNom) and current (I1 < 0.1 INom). Three-phase Failures in Voltage Transformer Circuits A 3-phase failure in the voltage transformer secondary system cannot be detected via the positive- and negative-sequence system as described above. The monitoring of the progress of current and voltage over time is required here. If a voltage dip to almost zero occurs (or if the voltage is zero), and the current remains unchanged, a 3-phase failure in the voltage transformer secondary system can be concluded. The jump detection is used for this purpose. The sensitivity of the jump detection for current can be increased via parameter FFM Idiff (3ph).
173
Mode of Operation / Logic The values required for the respective criteria are calculated from the calculated displacement voltage and the measured three phase currents and a decision is made. The resulting alarm message may be delayed. A blocking of the protection functions is however not effected. This is done by the measuring voltage failure detection. The broken wire monitoring is also active during a fault. The function may be enabled or disabled. The following logic diagram shows how the broken wire monitoring functions.
Figure 2-54
174
Note The connections of the ground paths and their adaption factors were set when configuring the general Power System Data. These settings must be correct for the measured values monitoring to function properly.
Measured value monitoring can be set to ON or OFF at address 8101 MEASURE. SUPERV. Fuse Failure Monitor (FFM) Via address 5301 FUSE FAIL MON. you select under which system conditions the FFM works. Depending on that, make the required settings in the grounded system via the parameters 5302, 5303 and 5307. In a grounded/isolated system, only the parameter 5307 is relevant. The settings for the fuse failure monitor must be selected in such manner that reliable activation occurs if a phase voltage fails, but that false activation does not occur during ground faults in a grounded network. Address 5303 FUSE FAIL RESID must be set as sensitive as required (with ground faults, below the smallest fault current). The FFM picks up if the ground voltage VN is higher than the set limit value under address 5302 FUSE FAIL 3Vo and if the ground current IN lies below the set limit value under address 5303 FUSE FAIL RESID. In order to detect a three-phase failure, the progress in time of current and voltage is monitored. If the voltage sinks below the threshold value without a change in the current value, a three-phase failure is detected. This threshold value of the current element must be set under address 5307 I> BLOCK. The threshold value should be identical with the definite time overcurrent protection. Under address 5310 BLOCK PROT. it can be determined whether the protection functions should be blocked upon pickup by the FFM.
175
Note The setting under address 5310 BLOCK PROT. has no effect on the flexible protection functions. A separate blocking can be selected for that purpose.
The function may be disabled in address 5301 FUSE FAIL MON., e.g. when performing asymmetrical tests.
2.10.1.8 Settings
Addresses which have an appended "A" can only be changed with DIGSI, under "Display Additional Settings". The table indicates region-specific default settings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corresponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer. Addr. 5201 5202 5203 5204 5205 5206 Parameter VT BROKEN WIRE V> Vph-ph max< Vph-ph min< Vph-ph max-min> I min> 1A 5A 5208 5301 T DELAY ALARM FUSE FAIL MON. C ON OFF 1.0 .. 100.0 V 1.0 .. 100.0 V 1.0 .. 100.0 V 10.0 .. 200.0 V 0.04 .. 1.00 A 0.20 .. 5.00 A 0.00 .. 32.00 sec OFF Solid grounded Coil.gnd./isol. 10 .. 100 V 1A 5A 5308A FFM Idiff (3ph) 1A 5A 5310 8101 8102 8103 8104 BLOCK PROT. MEASURE. SUPERV BALANCE V-LIMIT BAL. FACTOR V BALANCE I LIMIT 1A 5A 0.10 .. 1.00 A 0.50 .. 5.00 A 0.05 .. 1.00 A 0.25 .. 5.00 A NO YES OFF ON 10 .. 100 V 0.58 .. 0.90 0.10 .. 1.00 A 0.50 .. 5.00 A Setting Options Default Setting OFF 8.0 V 16.0 V 16.0 V 16.0 V 0.04 A 0.20 A 1.25 sec OFF Alarm delay time Fuse Fail Monitor Comments VT broken wire supervision Threshold voltage sum Maximum phase to phase voltage Minimum phase to phase voltage Symmetry phase to phase voltages Minimum line current
5302 5303
Differential Current Threshold (3phase) Block protection by FFM Measurement Supervision Voltage Threshold for Balance Monitoring Balance Factor for Voltage Monitor Current Threshold for Balance Monitoring
176
Comments Balance Factor for Current Monitor Summated Current Monitoring Threshold Summated Current Monitoring Factor Fast Summated Current Monitoring T Balance Factor for Voltage Monitor T Current Balance Monitor
1A 5A
0.05 .. 2.00 A; 0.25 .. 10.00 A; 0.00 .. 0.95 OFF ON 0 .. 100 sec 0 .. 100 sec
177
2.10.2
Applications When using two binary inputs, malfunctions in the trip circuit can be detected under all circuit breaker conditions. When only one binary input is used, malfunctions in the circuit breaker itself cannot be detected. Prerequisites A requirement for the use of trip circuit supervision is that the control voltage for the circuit breaker is at least twice the voltage drop across the binary input (Vct > 2 VBImin). Since at least 19 V are needed for the binary input, the monitor can only be used with a system control voltage of over 38 V.
2.10.2.1 Description
Supervision with Two Binary Inputs When using two binary inputs, these are connected according to Figure 2-55, parallel to the associated trip contact on one side, and parallel to the circuit breaker auxiliary contacts on the other.
Figure 2-55
178
Supervision with two binary inputs not only detects interruptions in the trip circuit and loss of control voltage, it also supervises the response of the circuit breaker using the position of the circuit breaker auxiliary contacts. Depending on the conditions of the trip contact and the circuit breaker, the binary inputs are activated (logical condition "H" in Table 2-8), or not activated (logical condition "L"). In healthy trip circuits the condition that both binary inputs are not actuated (L") is only possible during a short transition period (trip contact is closed but the circuit breaker has not yet opened). A continuous state of this condition is only possible when the trip circuit has been interrupted, a short-circuit exists in the trip circuit, a loss of battery voltage occurs, or malfunctions occur with the circuit breaker mechanism. Therefore, it is used as supervision criterion. Table 2-8 No. 1 2 3 4 Condition table for binary inputs, depending on RTC and CB position Trip contact Open Open Closed Closed Circuit breaker Closed Open Closed Open 52a Contact Closed Open Closed Open 52b Contact Open Closed Open Closed BI 1 H H L L BI 2 L H L H
The conditions of the two binary inputs are checked periodically. A check takes place about every 600 ms. If three consecutive conditional checks detect an abnormality (after 1.8 s), an annunciation is reported (see Figure 2-56). The repeated measurements determine the delay of the alarm message and avoid that an alarm is output during short transition periods. After the malfunction in the trip circuit is cleared, the fault annunciation is reset automatically after the same time period.
Figure 2-56
Logic diagram of the trip circuit supervision with two binary inputs
179
Supervision with One Binary Input The binary input is connected according to the following figure in parallel with the associated trip contact of the protection relay. The circuit breaker auxiliary contact is bridged with a bypass resistor R.
Figure 2-57
During normal operation, the binary input is activated (logical condition "H") when the trip contact is open and the trip circuit is intact, because the monitoring circuit is closed by either the 52a circuit breaker auxiliary contact (if the circuit breaker is closed) or through the bypass resistor R by the 52b circuit breaker auxiliary contact. Only as long as the trip contact is closed, the binary input is short circuited and thereby deactivated (logical condition "L"). If the binary input is continuously deactivated during operation, this leads to the conclusion that there is an interruption in the trip circuit or loss of control voltage. As the trip circuit supervision does not operate during system faults, the closed trip contact does not lead to a fault message. If, however, tripping contacts from other devices operate in parallel with the trip circuit, then the fault message must be delayed (see also Figure 2-58). The delay time can be set via parameter 8202 Alarm Delay. A message is only released after expiry of this time. After clearance of the fault in the trip circuit, the fault message is automatically reset.
Figure 2-58
The following figure shows the logic diagram for the message that can be generated by the trip circuit monitor, depending on the control settings and binary inputs.
180
Figure 2-59
181
2.10.2.3 Settings
Addr. 8201 8202 Parameter FCT 74TC Alarm Delay ON OFF 1 .. 30 sec Setting Options Default Setting ON 2 sec Comments 74TC TRIP Circuit Supervision Delay Time for alarm
2.10.3
2.10.3.1 Description
Malfunction Responses Depending on the type of malfunction discovered, an annunciation is sent, a restart of the processor system is initiated, or the device is shut down. After three unsuccessful restart attempts, the device is also shut down. The readiness relay opens and indicates with its NC contact that the device is malfunctioning. Moreover, the red "ERROR" LED lights up on the front cover and the green "RUN" LED goes out. If the internal auxiliary voltage also fails, all LEDs are dark. Table 2-9 shows a summary of the monitoring functions and the malfunction responses of the device.
182
Table 2-9
Summary of the device's malfunction responses Possible causes Malfunction response Device shutdown Annunciation (No.) All LEDs dark Output DOK2) drops out
Monitoring
Auxiliary voltage failure External (auxiliary voltage) Internal (converter) Buffer battery Hardware watchdog Software watchdog Internal (buffer battery) Internal (processor failure) Internal (processor failure)
Annunciation Device shutdown 1) Restart attempt 1) Abortion of restart, device shutdown During operation: restart attempt 1) Restart attempt 1) Device shutdown Device shutdown
Fail Battery (177) "ERROR" LED "ERROR" LED LED flashes DOK2) drops out DOK2) drops out DOK2) drops out DOK2) drops out
Working memory ROM Internal (hardware) Program memory RAM Internal (hardware) Parameter memory Sampling frequency Error in the I/O board Internal (hardware) Internal (hardware) Internal (hardware)
During boot sequence "ERROR" LED "ERROR" LED "ERROR" LED "ERROR" LED I/O-Board error (178), "ERROR" LED Error Offset (191) Failure I (162)
Internal (hardware)
Device shutdown
Internal Annunciation (measured value acquisition) External Annunciation (system or current transformer) External (system or voltage transformer) External (system or connection) External (system or connection) External (voltage transformer) External (trip circuit or control voltage) Annunciation
Current symmetry
Voltage symmetry
As allocated
As allocated
Fail Ph. Seq. I (175) As allocated VT FuseFail>10s (169) VT FuseFail (170) 74TC Trip cir. (6865) "VT brk. wire" (253) As allocated
Annunciation
As allocated
External Secondary voltage transformer circuit mon- (voltage transformer itoring circuit interruption) Capacitive voltage mea- Misconfiguration surement Adjustment data error Internal (hardware)
Annunciation
As allocated
Annunciation Annunciation
As allocated As allocated
1) 2)
After three unsuccessful restart attempts, the device is shut down. DOK = "Device okay" = readiness relay drops out, protection and control functions are blocked.
183
Group Annunciations Certain annunciations of the monitoring functions are already combined to group annunciations. These group annunciations and their composition are stated in the Appendix A.10. In this context it must be noted that the annunciation 160 Alarm Sum Event is only issued when the measured value monitoring functions (8101 MEASURE. SUPERV) are activated.
184
2.11
Applications Sensitive ground fault detection may be used in isolated or compensated systems to detect ground faults, to determine phases affected by ground faults, and to specify the direction of ground faults. In solidly or low-resistance grounded systems, sensitive ground fault detection is used to detect high impedance ground faults. This function can also be used as supplementary ground fault protection.
2.11.1
Voltage Element The voltage element relies on a pickup initiated by the displacement voltage V0 or 3 V0. Additionally, the faulty phase is determined. The displacement voltage V0 can be directly applied to the device, or the summation voltage 3 V0 can be calculated according to the connection type of the voltage transformer (see also Parameter 213 VT Connect. 3ph in Section 2.1.3). When setting Van, Vbn, Vcn, the calculation of the summation voltage 3 V0 is based on the three phase-toGround voltages. The three voltage inputs must therefore be connected to the voltage transformers in a grounded-wye configuration. When setting Vab, Vbc, VGnd, the three phase-to-Ground voltages of both connected phase-to-phase voltages and the connected displacement voltage are calculated. If the device is only provided with phase-to-phase voltages, it is not possible to calculate a displacement voltage from them. In this case the direction cannot be determined. If the displacement voltage is calculated, then: 3 V0 = VA + VB + VC If the displacement voltage is directly applied to the device, then V0 is the voltage at the device terminals. It is not affected by parameter Vph / Vdelta (address 206). The voltage element is not available with capacitive voltage measurement. The displacement voltage is used both to detect a ground fault and to determine direction. When the voltage element picks up, a preset time delay must elapse before detection of the displacement voltage is reported to be able to record stable measurement quantities. The time delay can be configured (T-DELAY Pickup) and its factory setting is 1 s. Pickup performed by the displacement voltage can be delayed (64-1 DELAY) for tripping. It is important to note that the total tripping time then consists of the displacement voltage measurement time (about 50 ms) plus the pickup time delay T-DELAY Pickup plus the tripping delay 64-1 DELAY.
185
After the voltage element picks up due to detection of a displacement voltage, the grounded phase is identified, if possible. For this purpose, the individual phase-to-Ground voltages are measured or calculated, irrespective of the connection type of the voltage transformers. If the voltage magnitude for any given phase falls below the set threshold VPH MIN, that phase is detected as the grounded phase as long as the remaining phase-toGround voltages exceed the set threshold VPH MAX.
Figure 2-60
Current Elements The current elements for ground faults operate with the magnitudes of the ground current. It is sensible to employ them only where the magnitude of the ground current can be used to specify the ground fault. This may be the case on grounded systems (solid or low-resistance) or on electrical machines which are directly connected to the busbar of an isolated power system, when in case of a network ground fault the machine supplies only a negligible ground fault current across the measurement location, which must be situated between the machine terminals and the network, whereas in case of a machine ground fault the higher ground fault current produced by the total network is available. Ground current protection is mostly used as backup protection for high resistance ground faults in solid or low resistance grounded systems when the main fault protection does not pickup. For ground current detection,a two-element current/time Curve can be set. Analogeous to the time overcurrent protection, the high-set current stage is designated as 50Ns-2 PICKUP and 50Ns-2 DELAY and is provided with a definite time characteristic. The overcurrent element may be operated with either a definite time delay (50Ns-1 PICKUP and 50Ns-1 DELAY) or with a user-defined Curve (51Ns PICKUP and 51NsTIME DIAL). The characteristics of these current elements can be configured. Each of these elements may be directional or non-directional. In case of capacitive voltage measurement, the current elements operate non-directional only since an exact angle measurement is not ensured when using the voltage V0. The pickup of the definite time overcurrent protection can be stabilized by the configured dropout delay time (address 3121 50Ns T DROP-OUT).
186
Determination of Direction When determining the sensitive ground fault direction it is not the current value that is crucial, but the part of the current which is perpendicular to a settable directional characteristic (axis of symmetry). As a prerequisite for determining the direction, the displacement voltage V0 must be exceeded as well as a configurable current part influencing the direction (active or reactive component). The following figure illustrates an example using a complex vector diagram in which the displacement voltage V0 is the reference magnitude of the real axis. The active part 3I0real of current 3I0 is calculated with reference to the displacement voltage V0 and compared with setting value RELEASE DIRECT.. The example is therefore suitable for ground fault direction in resonant grounded systems where quantity 3I0 cos is relevant. The directional limit lines are perpendicular to axis 3I0real.
Figure 2-61
The directional limit lines may be rotated by a correction angle (address PHI CORRECTION) up to 45. Therefore, in grounded systems it is possible e.g. to increase sensitivity in the resistive-inductive range with a rotation of 45, or in case of electric machines connected to the busbar of an ungrounded power system in the resistive-capacitive range with a rotation of +45 (see the following Figure). Furthermore the directional limit lines may be rotated by 90 to determine ground faults and their direction in isolated systems.
187
Figure 2-62
Fault direction is calculated with the zero sequence values from the ground current 3I0 and displacement voltage V0 or 3 V0. With these quantities ground active power and ground reactive power is calculated. The calculation algorithm used filters the measured values so that it is highly accurate and insensitive to higher harmonics (particularly the 3rd and 5th harmonics which are often present in zero sequence currents). Direction determination relies on the sign of active and reactive power. Since active and reactive components of the current - not the power - are relevant for pickup, current components are calculated from the power components. When determining the ground fault direction the active or reactive components of the ground current in reference to the displacement voltage as well as the direction of the active and reactive power are evaluated. For measurements of sin (for ungrounded systems) the following applies Ground fault (forward direction), if Q0 < 0 and 3I0reactive > setting value (RELEASE DIRECT.), Ground fault (reverse direction), if Q0 > 0 and 3I0reactive > setting value (RELEASE DIRECT.). For measurements cos (for resonant grounded systems) the following applies Ground fault (forward direction), if P0 > 0 and 3I0 active > setting value (RELEASE DIRECT.), Ground fault (reverse direction), if P0 < 0 and 3I0 active > setting value (RELEASE DIRECT.). If PHI CORRECTION is unequal 0, the angle of the directional limit lines is calculated by adding up active and reactive power components. The forward and reverse zone can be reduced at its boundaries at address 3160 1 red.dir.area and address 3161 2 red.dir.area (see Figure 2-61).
188
Logic The following figure illustrates the activation criteria of the sensitive ground fault protection. The operational mode of the ground fault detection can be set under address 3101. If set to ON, tripping is possible and a fault log is generated. If set to Alarm Only, tripping is not possible and only a ground fault log is generated. The pickup of the displacement voltage element V0 starts the ground fault recording. As the pickup of the V0 Element drops out, fault recording is terminated (see logic diagrams 2-64 and 2-65). The entire function can be blocked under the following conditions: A binary input is set, the Fuse Failure Monitor or the voltage transformer protection breaker pick up and parameter 3130 PU CRITERIA is set to Vgnd AND INs, the Fuse Failure Monitor or the voltage transformer protection breaker pick up and parameter 3130 PU CRITERIA is set to Vgnd OR INs, and both current elements are in directional operation mode. Switching off or blocking means that measurement is deactivated. Therefore, time delays and pickup messages are reset. All elements can be blocked individually via binary inputs. In this case pickup and, if possible, direction and grounded phase will still be reported, however, tripping does not take place since the time elements are blocked.
Figure 2-63
Generation of a pickup message, for both current elements, is dependent on the direction selection for each Element and the setting of parameters 3130 PU CRITERIA. If the Element is set to Non-Directional and parameter PU CRITERIA = Vgnd OR INs, a pickup message is generated as soon as the current threshold is exceeded, irrespective of the status of the V0 Element. If, however, the setting of parameter PU CRITERIA is Vgnd AND INs, the V0Element must have picked up also for non-directional mode. However, if a direction is programmed, the current element must be picked up and the direction determination results must be present to generate a message. Once again, a condition for valid direction determination is that the voltage Element V0 be picked up. Parameter PU CRITERIA specifies, whether a fault is generated by means of the AND-function or the ORcombination of displacement voltage and pickup of the ground current. The former may be advantageous if the pickup setting of displacement voltage element V0 was chosen to be very low.
189
Figure 2-64
190
Figure 2-65
191
2.11.2
Voltage Element The voltage element relies on a pickup initiated by the displacement voltage V0 or 3 V0. Additionally, the faulty phase is determined. The displacement voltage V0 can be directly applied to the device, or the summation voltage 3 V0 can be calculated according to the connection type of the voltage transformer (see also Parameter 213 VT Connect. 3ph in Section 2.1.3). When setting Van, Vbn, Vcn, the calculation of the summation voltage 3 V0 is based on the three phase-toGround voltages. The three voltage inputs must therefore be connected to the voltage transformers in a grounded-wye configuration. When setting Vab, Vbc, VGnd, the three phase-to-Ground voltages of both connected phase-to-phase voltages and the connected displacement voltage are calculated. If the device is only provided with phase-to-phase voltages, it is not possible to calculate a displacement voltage from them. In this case, the direction cannot be determined. If the displacement voltage is calculated, then: 3 V0 = VA + VB + VC If the displacement voltage is directly applied to the device, then V0 is the voltage at the device terminals. It is not affected by parameter Vph / Vdelta (address 206). The voltage element is not available with capacitive voltage measurement. Pickup performed by the displacement voltage can be delayed (64-1 DELAY) for tripping. After the voltage element picks up due to detection of a displacement voltage, the grounded phase is identified, if possible. For this purpose, the individual phase-to-Ground voltages are measured or calculated, irrespective of the connection type of the voltage transformers. If the voltage magnitude for any given phase falls below the set threshold VPH MIN, that phase is detected as the grounded phase as long as the remaining phase-toGround voltages exceed the set threshold VPH MAX.
Figure 2-66
192
Current Elements There are two current elements available. Both elements operate directionally, whereby the tripping zones can be set individually for each element (see margin heading Tripping Area). In case of capacitive voltage measurement, the current elements operate non-directional only since an exact angle measurement is not ensured when using the voltage V0. Both elements are provided with a definite time characteristic. Two current/time elements are used for ground fault protection. Analog to the time overcurrent protection function, the overcurrent element is named 50Ns-1 PICKUP and 50Ns-1 DELAY and the high-set element 50Ns-2 PICKUP and 50Ns-2 DELAY. The pickup of the definite time overcurrent protection can be stabilized by the configured dropout delay time (address 3121 50Ns T DROP-OUT). Tripping Range The U0/I0- characteristic is illustrated as a sector in the U0/I0 phasor diagram (see Figure 2-67). This sector corresponds to the tripping area. If the cursor of the ground current is in this sector, the function picks up. The tripping area is defined via several parameters: Via the angle (parameter 3154 50Ns-1 Phi or 3151 50Ns-2 Phi), the center of the zone with reference to the displacement voltage V0 is set. Via the angle (parameter 3155 50Ns-1 DeltaPhi or 3152 50Ns-2 DeltaPhi), the zone is extended to both sides of the center. The zone is further limited downwards by minimum values of the displacement voltage and ground current. These settable threshold values must be exceeded in order to be picked up. Negative angle settings turn the tripping area in the inductive direction, i.e. ground current inductive compared to ground voltage.
Figure 2-67
193
Logic The following figure illustrates the activation criteria of the sensitive ground fault protection. The operational mode of the ground fault detection can be set under address 3101. If set to ON, tripping is possible and a fault log is generated. If set to ON with GF log, tripping is possible, a fault log and a ground fault log are generated. If set to Alarm Only, tripping is not possible and only a ground fault log is generated. The pickup of the displacement voltage V0 or pickup of the 50Ns-2 element or pickup of the 50Ns-1 or 51Ns element start the ground fault recording. As the pickup of the Element drops out, fault recording is terminated (see logic diagrams 2-69 and 2-70). The entire function can be blocked under the following conditions: A binary input is set, the Fuse Failure Monitor or the voltage transformer protection breaker pick up. Switching off or blocking means that measurement is deactivated. Therefore, time delays and pickup messages are reset. All elements can be blocked individually via binary inputs. In this case pickup and, if possible, direction and grounded phase will still be reported, however, tripping does not take place since the time elements are blocked.
Figure 2-68
194
Figure 2-69
195
Figure 2-70
2.11.3
Application Example Directional determination may often be used to locate ground faults. In radial systems, locating the ground fault is relatively simple. Since all feeders from a common bus (Figure 2-71) deliver a capacitive charging current, nearly the total ground fault current of the system is available at the measuring point of the faulty line in the ungrounded system. In the resonant grounded system it is the residual wattmetric current of the Petersen coil that flows via the measuring point. Therefore, on the faulty cables a clear "forward" decision is made whereas in other feeders either "reverse" direction is sent back or no measurement is carried out in case ground current is too low. Definitely the faulty line can be determined clearly.
Figure 2-71
196
In meshed or looped systems, the measuring points of the faulty line also receive the maximum ground fault current (residual current). Only in this line, "forward" direction is signaled at both ends (Figure 2-72). The rest of the direction indications in the system may also be useful for ground fault detection. However, some indications may not be given when the ground current is too low.
Figure 2-72
Determination of the ground fault location basing on directional indicators in the meshed system
2.11.4
Setting Notes
General Settings During configuration of the protection function (Section 2.1.1, under address 131 Sens. Gnd Fault it was determined with which parameters the ground fault detection is functioning. If address Sens. Gnd Fault = Definite Time is selected, then the definite-time parameters are available. If Sens. Gnd Fault = User Defined PU is selected, a user-specified Curve can be used for the overcurrent elements 50Ns-1 or 51Ns. The superimposed high-current element 50Ns-2 is available in all these cases. If this function is not required, then Disabled is set. The user characteristics are only available, if the standard measurement procedure cos / sin has been set at address 130. The characteristic for determining the direction is set at address 130 S.Gnd.F.Dir.Ch. It is optional to select either the standard measurement method cos / sin or the V0/I0 mea. with one sector characteristic. At address 3101 Sens. Gnd Fault, the function ON or OFF can be set to either ON with GF log or Alarm Only. If settings ON and ON with GF log are applied, tripping is also possible, otherwise a fault log is created. A ground fault log is created for ON with GF log and Alarm Only. Setting ON with GF log is only available if characteristic V0/I0 mea. has been selected at address 130 S.Gnd.F.Dir.Ch. The parameters 3111 T-DELAY Pickup and 3130 PU CRITERIA are only visible if the standard measurement method cos / sin has been selected when setting the direction characteristic. The ground fault is detected and reported when the displacement voltage was sustained a certain time T-DELAY Pickup). Address 3130 PU CRITERIA specifies whether ground fault detection is enabled only for pickups of VN and INS (Vgnd AND INs) or as soon as one of the two has picked up (Vgnd OR INs). The pickup can be stabilized for ground fault protection with definite time curve by a settable dropout time delay (address 3121 50Ns T DROP-OUT). This facility is used in power systems with intermittent faults. Used together with electro-mechanical relays, it allows different dropout responses to be adjusted and time grading of digital and electro-magnetic relays to be implemented. The setting depends on the dropout time delay of the electro-magnetic relay. If no coordination is required, the preset value (zero = no dropout time delay) remains.
197
Note Please not that under address 213 VT Connect. 3ph the connection type of the voltage transformer Van, Vbn, Vcn or Vab, Vbc, VGnd must be set. Additionally, adjustment factor Vph / Vdelta for the displacement voltage must be set correctly under address 206. Depending on the type of connection of the current transformer, the primary and secondary rated current in the ground path must be set under address 217 and 218, and, if required, the primary and secondary rated current of the second ground current transformer must be set under address 238 and 239.
Overcurrent Elements Definite Time/Inverse Time A two-element current/time Curve can be set at addresses 3113 to 3120. These elements operate with the amounts of the ground current. They are therefore only useful where the magnitude of the ground current and maybe its direction can be used to specify the ground fault. This may be the case for grounded systems (solid or low-resistant) or on electrical machines connected to the busbar of an ungrounded power system, when in case of a network ground fault the machine supplies only a negligible ground fault current across the measurement location, which must be situated between the machine terminals and the network, whereas in case of a machine ground fault the total ground fault current produced by the total network is available. User-defined Curve (Inverse Time) User-defined characteristics are only used for the standard measurement method cos / sin (address 130 S.Gnd.F.Dir.Ch). During configuration of a user-defined Curve, it should be noted that there is a safety factor of approx. 1.1 between pickup and setting value - as is standard for inverse curves. This means that pickup will only be initiated when current of 1.1 times the setting value flows. The value pairs (current and time) are entered as multiples of the values at addresses 3119 51Ns PICKUP and 3120 51NsTIME DIAL. Therefore, it is recommended that these addresses are initially set to 1.00 for simplicity reasons. Once the curve has been entered, the settings at addresses 3119 and/or 3120 can be modified if necessary. The default setting of current values is . They are, therefore, not enabled and no pickup or tripping of these protective functions will occur. Up to 20 value pairs (current and time) may be entered at address 3131 M.of PU approximates the Curve, using linear interpolation. The following must be observed: The value pairs should be entered in increasing sequence. If desired, fewer than 20 pairs can be entered. In most cases, about 10 pairs is sufficient to define the Curve accurately. A value pair which will not be used has to be made invalid by entering " for the threshold! The user must ensure that the value pairs produce a clear and constant Curve The current values entered should be those from Table 2-10, along with the matching times. Deviating values I/Ip are rounded. This, however, will not be indicated. Current below the current value of the smallest curve point will not lead to an extension of the tripping time. The pickup curve (see Figure 2-73) continues, from the smallest current point parallel to the current axis. Current flows greater than the highest current value entered will not result in a reduced tripping time. The pickup curve (see Figure 2-73) continues, from the largest current point parallel to the current axis. TD. The device then
198
Table 2-10
Preferential Values of Standardized Currents for User-specific Tripping Curves MofPU = 2 to 4.75 2.00 2.25 2.50 2.75 3.00 3.25 3.50 3.75 4.00 4.25 4.50 4.75 MofPU = 5 to 7.75 5.00 5.25 5.50 5.75 6.00 6.25 6.50 6.75 7.00 7.25 7.50 7.75 MofPU p = 8 to 20 8.00 9.00 10.00 11.00 12.00 13.00 14.00 15.00 16.00 17.00 18.00 19.00 20.00
MofPU = 1 to 1.94 1.00 1.06 1.13 1.19 1.25 1.31 1.38 1.44 1.50 1.56 1.63 1.69 1.75 1.81 1.88 1.94
Figure 2-73
Determination of Ground-faulted Phase The phase connected to ground may be identified in an ungrounded or resonant grounded system, if the device is supplied by three voltage transformers connected in a grounded-wye configuration or the phase-Ground voltages are calculated. The phase in which the voltage lies below setting VPH MIN (address 3106) is identified as the faulty phase as long as the other two phase voltages simultaneously exceed setting VPH MAX (address 3107). The setting VPH MIN must be set to less than the minimum expected operational phase-to-Ground voltage. A typical setting for this address would be 40 V. Setting VPH MAX must be greater than the maximum expected operational phase-to-Ground voltage, but less than the minimum expected operational phase-to-phase voltage. For VNom = 100 V, approximately 75 V is a typical setting. These settings have no significance in a grounded system. Displacement Voltage Element V0 The displacement voltage 64-1 VGND (address 3109) or 64-1 VGND (address 3110) is the pickup of the ground fault detection and a release condition for the direction determination (when setting the direction characteristic to cos / sin ). If the direction characteristic is set to V0/I0 mea., the displacement voltage element is entirely independent of the current elements. Depending on the configuration at address 213 VT Connect. 3ph, only the applicable limit value address 3109 64-1 VGND or 3110 64-1 VGND is accessible. That is, if two phase-to-phase voltages and the displacement voltage V0 are supplied to the device, the measured displacement voltage is used directly for ground fault recognition. The threshold for V0 is set at address 3109 64-1 VGND, where a more sensitive setting can be made than with a calculated displacement voltage. Please note that with displaced voltage V0-voltage, the factor (in normal case = 1.73; see also Section 2.1.3.2)
199
specified with parameter 206 Vph / Vdelta is used. For the display of the parameters 3109 64-1 VGND in primary values, the following conversion formula applies:
If three phase-to-Ground voltages are connected to the device, the displacement voltage 3 V0 is calculated from the momentary values of phase-to-Ground voltages, and address 3110 is where the threshold is to be set. For the display of parameter 3110 in primary values, the following applies:
If the secondary values of (for example) parameters 3109 and 3110 are set equally, then their primary values differ by adjustment value Vph / Vdelta. Example: Parameter 202 Parameter 203 Parameter 206 Parameter 213 Parameter 3109 Vnom PRIMARY Vnom SECONDARY Vph / Vdelta VT Connect. 3ph 64-1 VGND = 12 kV = 100 V = 1.73 = Vab, Vbc, VGnd = 40 V
With the following configuration Parameter 213 Parameter 3110 VT Connect. 3ph 64-1 VGND = Van, Vbn, Vcn = 40 V
With regard to a ground fault in a ungrounded or resonant-grounded system, nearly the entire displacement voltage appears at the device terminals, therefore the pickup setting is not critical, and typically lies between 30 V and 60 V (for 64-1 VGND with a standard V0-connection) or 50 V and 100 V (for 64-1 VGND). Large fault resistances may require higher sensitivity (i.e. a lower pickup setting). With regard to a grounded system, a more sensitive (lower) pickup value may be set, but it must be above the maximum anticipated displacement voltage during normal (unbalanced) system operation. Pickup of just the voltage element may initiate time delayed tripping assumed that ground fault detection is configured to perform tripping (address 3101 Sens. Gnd Fault = ON or ON with GF log) and moreover address 3130 PU CRITERIA is configured Vgnd OR INs. The tripping delay is then set at address 3112 64-1 DELAY. It is important to note that the total tripping time consists of the displacement voltage measurement time (about 50 ms) plus the pickup time delay (address 3111 T-DELAY Pickup) plus the tripping time delay (address 3112 64-1 DELAY).
200
Direction Determination for cos-/ sin- Addresses 3115 to 3126 are important for direction determination. Address 3115 67Ns-2 DIRECT determines the direction of the definite high-set current element 50Ns-2 and can be set to either Forward or Reverse or Non-Directional, i.e. to both directions. The direction of the current element 50Ns-1 or or 51Ns can be set to Forward or Reverse or Non-Directional, i.e. to both directions, at address 3122 67Ns-1 DIRECT.. The elements operate non-directional for capacitive voltage measurement and for voltage connection types where no measurement or calculation of VN or 3V0 is possible. Section 2.1.3.2 gives information on this topic. Current value RELEASE DIRECT. (address 3123) is the release threshold for directional determination. It is based on the current components which are perpendicular to the directional limit lines. The position of the directional limit lines themselves are based on the settings entered at addresses 3124 and 3125. The following applies to the determination of direction during ground faults: The pickup current 3I0 DIR. (=RELEASE DIRECT. address 3123) must be set as high as possible to avoid false pickup of the device provoked by asymmetrical currents in the system and by current transformers (especially in the Holmgreen-connection). If direction determination is used in conjunction with one of the current elements discussed above (50Ns-1 PICKUP, addresses 3117 ff, or 51Ns PICKUP, addresses 3119 ff), it is sensible to select a value for address RELEASE DIRECT. that is lower than or equal to the above pickup value. A corresponding message (reverse, forward, or undefined) is issued upon direction determination. To avoid chatter for this message resulting from extremely varying ground connection currents, a dropout delay RESET DELAY, entered at address 3126, is initiated when directional determination drops out, and the message is held for this period of time. When address 3124 PHI CORRECTION is set to 0.0, in address 3125 the following signifies MEAS. METHOD = COS the resistive component of the ground current with respect to the displacement voltage is most relevant for the current value RELEASE DIRECT. (3I0 DIR.), MEAS. METHOD = SIN the reactive (capacitive) component of the ground current with respect to the displacement voltage is most relevant for the current value RELEASE DIRECT. (3I0 DIR.) (Figure 2-74).
201
Figure 2-74
In address 3124 PHI CORRECTION the directional line, in this respect, may be rotated within the range 45. Figure 2-62 "Directional characteristic for cos--measurement" in the functional description of the sensitive ground fault detection gives an example regarding this topic. The forward and reverse zone can be reduced at its boundaries at address 3160 1 red.dir.area and address 3161 2 red.dir.area (see Figure 2-74). Siemens recommends using the default setting of 2 (this corresponds to the behavior of versions without this setting option). In a grounded system in feeders with very high capacitive current, it can be reasonable to set a slightly larger angle 1 to prevent erroneous pickup due to transformer and algorithm tolerances.
202
Direction Determination for V0/I0 Measurement With the minimum voltage 50Ns-2 Vmin, address 3150 and the level of the pickup current 50Ns-2 PICKUP, address 3113, the lower limit of the circuit segment of element 50Ns-2 is set. The thresholds of the tripping range in respect of the displacement voltage is set by means of the matching phase angle 50Ns-2 Phi, address 3151 and angle 50Ns-2 DeltaPhi, address 3152. The trip delay time is set under address 3114 50Ns-2 DELAY. The actual settings are based on the respective application. The minimum voltage 50Ns-1 Vmin of the high-current element 50Ns-1 is set under address 3153, the pickup current 50Ns-1 PICKUP under 3117. The respective phase angle 50Ns-1 Phi is set under address 3154, the angle 50Ns-1 DeltaPhi is entered under address 3155. The angle should be set to 180 so that the element functions non-directionally. The trip delay time is set under address 3118 50Ns-1 DELAY. Positive angle settings (address 3151 and 3154) turn the tripping area in the capacitive direction, i.e. ground current capacitive compared to ground voltage. Negative angle settings turn the tripping area in the inductive direction, i.e. ground current inductive compared to ground voltage. Angular Error Compensation (I Transformer) The high reactive component in a resonant grounded system and the inevitable air gap of the toroidal current transformer often require the angle error of the toroidal current transformer to be compensated. In addresses 3102 to 3105 the maximum angle error CT Err. F1 and the associated secondary current CT Err. I1 as well as another operating point CT Err. F2/CT Err. I2 are set for the actually connected burden. The device thus approximates the transformation characteristic of the transformer with considerable accuracy. In ungrounded or grounded systems angle compensation is not required. Ungrounded System In an ungrounded system with a ground fault on a cable, capacitive ground currents of the galvanically connected system flow via the measuring point, except for the ground current generated in the grounded cable, since the current last-mentioned will flow directly to the fault location (i.e. not via the measuring point). A setting equal to about half the ground current is to be selected. The measurement method should be SIN , since capacitive ground current is most relevant here. Resonant-Grounded System In resonant-grounded systems, directional determination on the occurrence of a ground fault is more difficult since the low residual wattmetric current for measurement is usually dwarfed by a reactive current (be it capacitive or inductive) which is much higher. Therefore, depending on the system configuration and the position of the arc-compensating coil, the total ground current supplied to the device may vary considerably in its values with regard to magnitude and phase angle. The relay, however, must evaluate only the active component of the ground fault current, that is, INs cos . This demands extremely high accuracy, particularly with regard to phase angle measurement of all instrument transformers. Furthermore, the device must not be set to operate too sensitive. When applying this function in resonant-grounded systems, a reliable direction determination can only be achieved when toroidal current transformers are connected. Here the following rule of thumb applies: Set pickup values to about half of the expected measured current, thereby considering only the residual wattmetric current. Residual wattmetric current predominantly derives from losses of the Petersen coil. Here, the COS measurement method is used since the resistive residual wattmetric current is most relevant. Grounded System In grounded systems, a value is set below the minimum anticipated ground fault current. It is important to note that 3I0 DIR (current value RELEASE DIRECT.) only detects the current components that are perpendicular to the directional limit lines defined at addresses 3124 and 3125. COS is the method of measurement used, and the correction angle is set to 45, since the ground fault current is typically resistive-inductive (right section
203
of Figure 2-62 "Directional curve for cos--measurement" in the functional description of the sensitive ground fault detection). Electrical Machines One may set the value COS for the measurement method and use a correction angle of +45 for electrical motors supplied from a busbar in an ungrounded system, since the ground current is often composed of an overlap of the capacitive ground current from the system and the resistive current of the load resistance (left part of Figure "Directional characteristic for cos--measurement" in the functional description of the sensitive ground fault detection). Information on the Configuration of the Current Threshold With devices with sensitive ground fault input, generally settings may be entered in primary values with consideration given to the ratio of the applicable current transformer. However, problems related to the resolution of the pickup currents can occur when very small settings and small nominal primary currents are involved. The user is therefore encouraged to enter settings for the sensitive ground fault detection in secondary values.
2.11.5
Settings
Addresses which have an appended "A" can only be changed with DIGSI, under "Display Additional Settings". The table indicates region-specific default settings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corresponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer.
Addr. 3101
3102
CT Err. I1
1A 5A
0.001 .. 1.600 A 0.005 .. 8.000 A 0.05 .. 35.00 A 0.25 .. 175.00 A 0.0 .. 5.0
0.050 A 0.250 A 1.00 A 5.00 A 0.0 1.000 A 5.000 A 10.00 A 50.00 A 0.0 40 V 75 V 40.0 V 70.0 V
Current I1 for CT Angle Error Current I1 for CT Angle Error CT Angle Error at I1 Current I2 for CT Angle Error Current I2 for CT Angle Error CT Angle Error at I2 L-Gnd Voltage of Faulted Phase Vph Min L-Gnd Voltage of Unfaulted Phase Vph Max 64-1 Ground Displacement Voltage 64-1 Ground Displacement Voltage
3102
CT Err. I1
1A 5A
3103 3104
CT Err. F1 CT Err. I2 1A 5A
0.001 .. 1.600 A 0.005 .. 8.000 A 0.05 .. 35.00 A 0.25 .. 175.00 A 0.0 .. 5.0 10 .. 100 V 10 .. 100 V 1.8 .. 200.0 V; 10.0 .. 225.0 V;
3104
CT Err. I2
1A 5A
204
Default Setting 1.00 sec 10.00 sec 0.300 A 1.500 A 10.00 A 50.00 A 1.00 sec Forward
1A 5A
0.001 .. 1.600 A 0.005 .. 8.000 A 0.05 .. 35.00 A 0.25 .. 175.00 A 0.00 .. 320.00 sec; Forward Reverse Non-Directional
3113
50Ns-2 PICKUP
1A 5A
50Ns-2 Pickup
3114 3115
3117
50Ns-1 PICKUP
1A 5A
0.001 .. 1.600 A 0.005 .. 8.000 A 0.05 .. 35.00 A 0.25 .. 175.00 A 0.00 .. 320.00 sec;
0.100 A 0.500 A 2.00 A 10.00 A 2.00 sec 0.100 A 0.500 A 1.00 A 5.00 A 1.00 sec 0.00 sec Forward
50Ns-1 Pickup
3117
50Ns-1 PICKUP
1A 5A
50Ns-1 Pickup
3118 3119
0.001 .. 1.400 A 0.005 .. 7.000 A 0.05 .. 4.00 A 0.25 .. 20.00 A 0.10 .. 4.00 sec; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec Forward Reverse Non-Directional
3119
51Ns PICKUP
1A 5A
51Ns Pickup
3123
RELEASE DIRECT.
1A 5A
0.001 .. 1.200 A 0.005 .. 6.000 A 0.05 .. 30.00 A 0.25 .. 150.00 A -45.0 .. 45.0 COS SIN 0 .. 60 sec Vgnd OR INs Vgnd AND INs 1.00 .. 20.00 MofPU; 0.01 .. 999.00 TD 0.4 .. 50.0 V 10.0 .. 90.0 V -180.0 .. 180.0
Release directional element Release directional element Correction Angle for Dir. Determination Measurement method for Direction Reset Delay Sensitive Ground Fault PICKUP criteria Multiples of PU Dial Time-
3123
RELEASE DIRECT.
1A 5A
PHI CORRECTION MEAS. METHOD RESET DELAY PU CRITERIA M.of PU TD 50Ns-2 Vmin 50Ns-2 Vmin 50Ns-2 Phi
205
Parameter 50Ns-2 DeltaPhi 50Ns-1 Vmin 50Ns-1 Vmin 50Ns-1 Phi 50Ns-1 DeltaPhi 1 red.dir.area 2 red.dir.area
Setting Options 0.0 .. 180.0 0.4 .. 50.0 V 10.0 .. 90.0 V -180.0 .. 180.0 0.0 .. 180.0 1 .. 15 1 .. 15
Comments 50Ns-2 angle delta phi 50Ns-1 minimum voltage 50Ns-1 minimum voltage 50Ns-1 angle phi 50Ns-1 angle delta phi Alpha1 (reduction directional area) Alpha2 (reduction directional area)
2.11.6
No. 1201 1202 1203 1204 1207 1211 1212 1215 1217 1221 1223 1224 1226 1227 1229 1230 1264 1265 1266 1267 1271 1272 1273 1274 1276 1277 1278 16029 16030
Information List
Information >BLOCK 64 >BLOCK 50Ns-2 >BLOCK 50Ns-1 >BLOCK 51Ns >BLK 50Ns/67Ns 50Ns/67Ns OFF 50Ns/67Ns ACT 64 Pickup 64 TRIP 50Ns-2 Pickup 50Ns-2 TRIP 50Ns-1 Pickup 50Ns-1 TRIP 51Ns Pickup 51Ns TRIP Sens. Gnd block IEEa = IEEr = IEE = VGND, 3Vo Sens.Gnd Pickup Sens. Gnd Ph A Sens. Gnd Ph B Sens. Gnd Ph C SensGnd Forward SensGnd Reverse SensGnd undef. 51Ns BLK PaErr (3Vo,INs) = Type of Information SP SP SP SP SP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT VI VI VI VI OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT VI >BLOCK 64 >BLOCK 50Ns-2 >BLOCK 50Ns-1 >BLOCK 51Ns >BLOCK 50Ns/67Ns 50Ns/67Ns is OFF 50Ns/67Ns is ACTIVE 64 displacement voltage pick up 64 displacement voltage element TRIP 50Ns-2 Pickup 50Ns-2 TRIP 50Ns-1 Pickup 50Ns-1 TRIP 51Ns picked up 51Ns TRIP Sensitive ground fault detection BLOCKED Corr. Resistive Earth current Corr. Reactive Earth current Earth current, absolute Value Displacement Voltage VGND, 3Vo Sensitive Ground fault pick up Sensitive Ground fault picked up in Ph A Sensitive Ground fault picked up in Ph B Sensitive Ground fault picked up in Ph C Sensitive Gnd fault in forward direction Sensitive Gnd fault in reverse direction Sensitive Gnd fault direction undefined Sens.gnd.flt. 51Ns BLOCKED Setting Error Angle between 3Vo and INsens. Comments
206
2.12
Applications Protection from intermittent ground faults which occur, e.g. in cables due to poor insulation or water ingress in cable joints.
2.12.1
Description
Acquisition of Measured Quantities The intermittent ground fault can either be detected via the ordinary ground current input (IN), the sensitive ground current input (INS), or it is calculated from the sum of the three phase currents (3 I0). Unlike the overcurrent protection which uses the fundamental wave, the intermittent ground fault protection creates the r.m.s. value of this current and compares it to a settable threshold Iie>. This method accounts for higher order harmonics contents (up to 400 Hz) and for the direct component since both factors contribute to the thermal load. Pickup/Tripping If the pickup value Iie> is exceeded, the pickup indication IIE Fault det (see Figure 2-75) is generated. The pickups are also counted; when the counter content reaches the value of parameter Nos.det., the indicationIntermitt.EF is output. A stabilized pickup is obtained by prolonging the pickup indication IIE Fault det by a settable time T-det.ext.. This stabilization is especially important for the coordination with existing static or electromechanical overcurrent relays. The duration of the stabilized pickups IIE stab.Flt is summated with an integrator T-sum det.. If the accumulated pickup time reaches a settable threshold value, a corresponding message is generated (IEF Tsum exp.). Tripping takes place, however, only while a ground fault is present (message IEF Trip). The trip command is maintained during the entire minimum tripping time specified for the device, even if the ground fault is of short duration. After completion of the tripping command all memories are reset and the protection resumes normal condition. The (much longer) resetting time T-reset (message IEF Tres run.) is launched simultaneously with T-sum det. when a ground fault occurs. Unlike T-sum det., each new ground fault resets this time to its initial value and it expires anew. If T-reset expires and no new ground fault is recorded during that time, all memories are reset and the protection resumes normal position. T-reset thus determines the time during which the next ground fault must occur to be processed yet as intermittent ground fault in connection with the previous fault. A ground fault that occurs later will be considered a new fault event.
207
The message IIE Fault det will be entered in the fault log and reported to the system interface only until the message Intermitt.EF is issued. This prevents a burst of messages. If the message is allocated to an LED or a relay, this limitation does not apply. This is accomplished by doubling the message (message numbers 6924, 6926). Interaction with Breaker Failure Protection A pickup that is present when the time delay TRIP-Timer has expired is interpreted by the breaker failure protection as a criterion for a tripping failure. Since permanent pickup is not ensured after a tripping command by the intermittent ground fault protection, cooperation with the breaker failure protection is not sensible. Therefore, this function is not activated by the intermittent ground fault protection. Logic Diagram The following figure shows the logic diagram for the intermittent ground fault protection function.
Figure 2-75
208
Fault Logging A fault event and thus fault logging is initiated when the non-stabilized IiE Element picks up for the first time. A message IIE Fault det is produced. The message IIE Fault det is issued and entered in the fault log (and reported to the system interface) so often until the number of pickups IIE Fault det has reached the value set for parameter Nos.det.. When this happens, the message Intermitt.EF is issued and IIE Fault det is blocked for the fault log and the system interface. This method accounts for the fact that the IiE Element may also pick up for a normal short-circuit. In this case the pickup does not launch the alarm Intermitt.EF. Intermittent ground faults may cause other overcurrent elements to pick up (e.g. 50-1, 50N-1, 50Ns-1), which may result in a burst of messages. In order to avoid an overflow of the fault log, its messages are no longer entered in the fault log after detection of intermittent ground faults (indication Intermitt.EF), unless they cause a trip command. If an intermittent ground fault has been detected, the following pickup messages of the time overcurrent protection will still be reported without restraint (see Table 2-11): Table 2-11 FNo. 1800 7551 7552 7553 7554 7560 7562 7565 7566 7567 7564 Unrestricted Indications Indication 50-2 picked up 50-1 InRushPU 50N-1 InRushPU 51 InRushPU 51N InRushPU 67N-1 InRushPU 67N-TOCInRushPU Ia InRush PU Ib InRush PU Ic InRush PU Gnd InRush PU Explanation 67-2 Element picked up 50-1 inrush Element picked up 50N-1 inrush Element picked up 51 inrush Element picked up 51N inrush Element picked up 67N-1 inrush Element picked up 67N-TOC inrush Element picked up Phase A inrush picked up Phase B inrush picked up Phase C inrush picked up Ground inrush picked up
209
Table 2-12 shows all messages subject to a restraint mechanism avoiding a message burst during an intermittent ground fault: Table 2-12 FNo. 1761 1762 1763 1764 1767 1810 1820 1768 1831 1834 1837 2691 2697 2646 2681 2684 2695 5159 5165 5166 1215 1221 1224 1227 6823 Buffered Indications Indication 50(N)/51(N) PU 50/51 Ph A PU 50/51 Ph B PU 50/51 Ph C PU 50-3 picked up 50-1 picked up 51 picked up 50N-3 picked up 50N-2 picked up 50N-1 picked up 51N picked up 67/67N pickedup 67N-3 picked up 67N-2 picked up 67N-1 picked up 67N-TOCPickedup 67N picked up 46-2 picked up 46-1 picked up 46-TOC pickedup 64 Pickup 50Ns-2 Pickup 50Ns-1 Pickup 51Ns Pickup 48 pickup Explanation V50(N)/51(N) pickup VPhase A inrush picked up A VPhase B inrush picked up B VPhase C inrush picked up C 50-3 Element picked up 50-1 Element picked up 51 Element picked up 50N-3 Element picked up 50N-2 Element picked up 50N-1 Element picked up 51N Element picked up 67/67N picked up 67N-3 Element picked up 67N-2 Element picked up 67N-1 Element picked up 67N-TOC Element picked up 67N Ground picked up 46-2 picked up 46-1 picked up 46-TOC picked up 64 displacement voltage picked up 50Ns-2 Element picked up 50Ns-1 Element picked up 51Ns Element picked up Motor starting supervision pickup 48
Before they are entered in the fault log (event buffer) and transmitted to the system interface or CFC, the indications of Table 2-12 are buffered (starting with the incoming indication Intermitt.EF). The buffering does not apply to signaling to relays and LEDs as it is required by time-graded protection systems for reverse interlocking. The buffer can store a maximum of two status changes (the most recent ones) for each indication. Buffered messages are signaled to the fault log, CFC and to the system interface with the original time flag only when a TRIP command is initiated by a protection function other than the intermittent ground fault protection. This ascertains that a pickup, although delayed, is always signaled in association with each TRIP command. All pickup indications which usually do not occur during an intermittent ground fault are not affected by this mechanism. Among others this includes the pickup and TRIP commands of the following protection functions: Circuit breaker failure protection, overload protection, frequency protection and voltage protection The pickup signals of these functions will still be logged immediately. A TRIP command of one of these protective functions will cause the buffered messages to be cleared since no connection exists between tripping function and buffered message.
210
A fault event is cleared when the time T-reset has expired or the TRIP command IEF Trip has been terminated. Terminating a fault event for the intermittent ground fault protection thus is a special case. It is the time Treset that keeps the fault event opened and not the pickup.
2.12.2
General
Setting Notes
The protection function for intermittent ground faults can only take effect and is only accessible if the current to be evaluated was configured in address 133, INTERM.EF (with Ignd or with 3I0 or with Ignd,sens.). If not required, this function is set to Disabled. The function can be turned ON or OFF under address 3301 INTERM.EF. The pickup threshold (r.m.s. value) is set in address 3302 Iie>. A rather sensitive setting is possible to respond also to short ground faults since the pickup time shortens as the current in excess of the setting increases. The setting range depends on the selection of the current to be evaluated at address 133 INTERM.EF. The pickup time can be prolonged at address 3303 T-det.ext.. This pickup stabilization is especially important for the coordination with existing analog or electromechanical overcurrent relays. The time T-det.ext. can also be disabled (T-det.ext. = 0). The stabilized pickup starts the counter T-sum det.. This counter is stopped but not reset when the picked up function drops out. Based on the last counter content the counter resumes counting when the stabilized function picks up next. This sum of individual pickup times, which are to initiate tripping, is set at address 3304 T-sum det.. It represents one of the four selectivity criteria (pickup value Iie>, detection extension time Tdet.ext., counter T-sum det. and reset time T-reset) for coordinating the relays on adjacent feeders and is comparable to the time grading of the time overcurrent protection. The relay in the radial network which is closest to the intermittent fault and picks up, will have the shortest summation time T-sum det.. The reset time, after which the summation is reset in healthy operation and the protection resumes normal status, is configured to T-reset at address 3305.
Figure 2-76
Address 3306 Nos.det. specifies the number of pickups after which a ground fault is considered intermittent.
211
2.12.3
Settings
The table indicates region-specific default settings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corresponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer.
C OFF ON 1A 5A
Setting Options
Default Setting OFF 1.00 A 5.00 A 1.00 A 5.00 A 1.000 A 0.10 sec 20.00 sec 300 sec 3
Comments Intermittent earth fault protection Pick-up value of interm. E/F stage Pick-up value of interm. E/F stage Pick-up value of interm. E/F stage Detection extension time Sum of detection times Reset time No. of det. for start of int. E/F prot
0.05 .. 35.00 A 0.25 .. 175.00 A 0.05 .. 35.00 A 0.25 .. 175.00 A 0.005 .. 1.500 A 0.00 .. 10.00 sec 0.00 .. 100.00 sec 1 .. 600 sec 2 .. 10
3302
Iie>
1A 5A
2.12.4
No. 6903 6921 6922 6923 6924 6925 6926 6927 6928 6929 6930 6931 6932
Information List
Information >IEF block IEF OFF IEF blocked IEF enabled IIE Fault det IIE stab.Flt IIE Flt.det FE Intermitt.EF IEF Tsum exp. IEF Tres run. IEF Trip Iie/In= Nos.IIE= Type of Information SP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT VI VI >block interm. E/F prot. Interm. E/F prot. is switched off Interm. E/F prot. is blocked Interm. E/F prot. is active Interm. E/F detection stage Iie> Interm. E/F stab detection Interm.E/F det.stage Iie> f.Flt. ev.Prot Interm. E/F detected Counter of det. times elapsed Interm. E/F: reset time running Interm. E/F: trip Max RMS current value of fault = No. of detections by stage Iie>= Comments
212
2.13
Applications Directional protection against intermittent ground faults which occur, e.g. in cables due to poor insulation or water ingress in cable joints.
2.13.1
Description
Activating the Function The function is only available if the device is equipped with a sensitive ground current input. For voltage connection 213 VT Connect. 3ph = Vab, Vbc or Vab, Vbc, Vx and for 250 50/51 2-ph prot = ON, the directional intermittent ground fault protection is ineffective. V0 cannot be formed for these connection types. The function is blocked in case of a measuring voltage failure under the condition that the fuse-failure monitor is configured for the functioning in a grounded system (see Chapter 2.10.1, Fuse-Failure Monitor). Furthermore, the function can be blocked externally using the binary input signal >dIEF block. Measurand Acquisition The intermittent ground fault current 3I0 is measured exclusively via the sensitive ground current input INs (4th current transformer input) of the device. Also the displacement voltage Ven or 3 V0 is required to determine the direction. The displacement voltage Uen can be applied directly to the device, or the summation voltage 3 V0 can be calculated from the three phase-to-ground voltages. If the displacement voltage is calculated, then: 3 V0 = VA + VB + VC If the displacement voltage is directly applied to the device, then V0 is the voltage at the device terminals. It is not affected by parameter Vph / Vdelta (address 206).
213
Figure 2-77
Fault Log, Ground Fault Log, Fault Recording Parameter Dir. Interm. EF allows you to define the type of fault handling and fault logging. If set to ON, tripping is possible and a fault log is generated. If set to ON with GF log, tripping is possible, a fault log and a ground fault log are generated. If set to Alarm Only, no tripping is possible. Only an alarm is generated. Furthermore, only a ground fault log is created. The raising pickup of the function (indication 6972 dIEF pick up) is the criterion for opening the ground fault log.
214
Logic The following figure shows the logic diagram of the directional intermittent ground fault protection function.
Figure 2-78
Direction Determination The ground fault is detected by evaluating the fundamental component of the displacement voltage. The sensitivity is determined using the settable threshold value Vgnd> / 3V0>. Direction determination is started after the ground fault has been detected. For this purpose, the igniting current pulses are extracted from the ground current signal. The igniting current pulse and the associated maximum displacement voltage over time are compared with regard to their phase relationship. The fault direction forward or reverse is derived from this comparison. Each detected ignition pulse receives a direction information. If no clear direction determination is possible, the direction information pertaining to the pulse is undefined. The direction results of the recurring ignition pulses are counted and are available as value indication if their value is different than zero.
215
Pickup The setting of parameter Pickup defines under which conditions pickup is detected and fault recording started. For with Vgnd/3V0>, pickup is initiated once the threshold Vgnd> / 3V0> has been exceeded. For with oper. dir., pickup is initiated when a pulse is detected in the direction specified at address 3402. The pickup disappears when the displacement voltage has fallen below the threshold Vgnd> / 3V0> and the time Monitoring time has expired. Alarm/Trip The setting of parameter Direction defines whether the function operates in forward or in reverse direction. The pulses in the specified direction are counted. If the pulse counter reaches the threshold value set in parameter No. of pulses, the function trips or generates an alarm. It is possible that not every ignition pulse is recognized as such. If two ignition pulses are very close to one another in respect of time, they may not be detected separately. This is not relevant from the protection perspective, because during an intermittent fault many ignition pulses occur and the counter threshold is certainly reached. The directional pulse counter is reset under the following conditions: A different direction than the set Direction is detected. An undefined direction result does not reset the counter. The monitoring time Monitoring time has elapsed. No other pulse in the set direction was detected during that time. This time can be understood as a criterion for the disappearing of the intermittent fault. The function thus also drops out if the intermittent fault develops into a static fault. V0 is lower than the set threshold Vgnd> / 3V0> and the time Monitoring time has expired. Interaction with other Functions The directional intermittent ground fault protection does not interact with the automatic reclosing function. The function cannot start the automatic reclosing function. The directional intermittent ground fault protection interacts with the circuit-breaker failure protection. The function starts the circuit-breaker failure protection.
2.13.2
General
Setting Notes
Configuration of the protection functions at address 134 Dir. Interm. EF defines whether the directional intermittent ground fault protection is Enabled or Disabled. At address 3401 Dir. Interm. EF the directional ground fault protection is switched on or off. The following setting options are available: ON enables the function with tripping and fault record log. ON with GF log enables the function with tripping, fault record log and ground fault log. Alarm Only generates the ground fault log only. Tripping and fault record log are not possible. OFF disables the function. The pickup threshold for the displacement voltage is set at address 3405 Vgnd> / 3V0>. Exceeding this threshold is the criterion for detecting the intermittent ground fault. The direction to be protected Forward or Reverse is set in address 3402 Direction. Address 3403 No. of pulses allows you to specify how many pulses must be detected in the set direction before the alarm or tripping is initiated. It is possible that not every ignition pulse is recognized as such. If two ignition pulses are very close to one another in respect of time, they may not be detected separately. This is
216
not relevant from the protection perspective, because during an intermittent fault many ignition pulses occur and the counter threshold is certainly reached. At address 3404 Monitoring time you set the monitoring time after detection of the direction pulse in the direction parameterized at 3402. If the time has expired before the number set at 3403 No. of pulses has been reached, the associated counter is reset. This time is a criterion for the disappearing of the intermittent fault. At address 3406 Pickup you can set the criterion for the pickup of the function. For with Vgnd/3V0> pickup takes place as soon as the threshold Vgnd> / 3V0> has been exceeded, regardless of whether a real intermittent ground fault is present or not. For with oper. dir., recording starts when a direction pulse in the direction parameterized at 3402 has been detected.
2.13.3
Addr. 3401
Settings
Parameter Dir. Interm. EF Setting Options OFF ON ON with GF log Alarm Only Forward Reverse 2 .. 50 0.04 .. 10.00 sec 2.0 .. 100.0 V with Vgnd/3V0> with oper. dir. Default Setting OFF Comments Dir. Intermittent earth fault protection
Direction to be protected Pulse no. for detecting the interm. E/F Monitoring time after pickup detected Vgnd> measured / 3V0> calculated Pickup of the function
2.13.4
No. 6951 6961 6962 6963 6972 6973 6974 6975 6976 6979
Information List
Information >dIEF block dIEF OFF dIEF blocked dIEF active dIEF pick up dIEF TRIP No.forward= No.reverse= No.undef.= dIEF ALARM Type of Information SP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT VI VI VI OUT Comments >Block directional interm. E/F prot. Dir. Interm. E/F prot. is switched off Dir. Interm. E/F prot. is blocked Dir. Interm. E/F prot. is active dIEF: pick up dIEF: Trip dIEF: No. of detected forward pulses = dIEF: No. of detected reverse pulses = dIEF: No. of detected undefined pulses = dIEF: Alarm
217
2.14
2.14.1
General
Description
If after a programmable time delay, the circuit breaker has not opened, breaker failure protection issues a trip signal to isolate the failure breaker by tripping other surrounding backup circuit breaker (see example in the figure below).
Figure 2-79
Initiation The breaker failure protection function can be initiated by two different sources: Trip signals of internal protective functions of the 7SK80, external trip signals via binary inputs (>50BF ext SRC). For each of the two sources, a unique pickup message is generated, a unique time delay is initiated, and a unique trip signal is generated. The setting values of current threshold and delay time apply to both sources. Criteria There are two criteria for breaker failure detection: Check whether the current flow has effectively disappeared after a tripping command was issued, Evaluate the circuit breaker's auxiliary contacts. The criteria used to determine if the circuit breaker has operated are selectable and also depend on the protection function that initiated the breaker failure function. On tripping without fault current, e.g. via voltage protection, the current below the threshold 50BF PICKUP is not a reliable indication of the proper functioning of the circuit breaker. In such cases, pickup exclusively depends on the auxiliary contact criterion. In protection functions based on the measurement of currents (including all short-circuit protection functions), the current flow is a preferential criterion, i.e. it is given priority, as opposed to the auxiliary contacts. If current flows above
218
the set threshold or thresholds (enabled w/ 3I0>) are detected, the breaker failure protection trips even if the auxiliary criterion indicates Breaker Open. Monitoring of the Current Flow Address 170 50BF can be set in such a way that either the current criterion can already be met by a single phase current (setting Enabled) or that another current is taken into consideration in order to check the plausibility (setting enabled w/ 3I0>), see Figure . The currents are filtered through numerical filters to evaluate only the fundamental harmonic. They are monitored and compared to the set threshold values. Besides the three phase currents, two additional currents are provided to enable a plausibility check. Separate threshold values can be used for this plausibility check if this is configured accordingly. To detect ground faults more quickly, the threshold value for the ground current can also be used for checking the plausibility of the phase currents. This function is activated via binary input >50BFactiv.3I0> (see Figure 2-82). The ground current IN (3I0) is preferably used as plausibility current. Via the parameters 613 you decide whether the measured (Ignd (measured)) or the calculated (3I0 (calcul.)) values are to be used. In case of system faults not involving ground currents, no increased ground currents/residual currents are flowing, and therefore the calculated triple negative sequence current 3I2 or a second phase current is used as plausibility current.
Figure 2-80
219
Monitoring of the Circuit Breaker Auxiliary Contacts Evaluation of the circuit breaker's auxiliary contacts depends on the type of contacts, and how they are connected to the binary inputs: the auxiliary contacts for circuit breaker "open" (4602 >52-b) and "closed" (4601 >52-a) are configured, only the auxiliary contact for circuit breaker "open" is configured(4602 >52-b), only the auxiliary contact for circuit breaker "closed" is configured (4601 >52-a), none of the two auxiliary contacts is configured. Feedback information of the auxiliary status of the circuit breaker is evaluated, depending on the allocation of binary inputs and auxiliary contacts. After a trip command has been issued it is the aim to detect if possible by means of the feedback of the circuit breaker's auxiliary contacts whether the breaker is open or in intermediate position. If valid, this information can be used for a proper initiation of the breaker failure protection function. The logic diagram illustrates the monitoring of the circuit breaker's auxiliary contacts.
Figure 2-81
Logic diagram for breaker failure protection, monitoring of the circuit-breaker auxiliary contacts
Logic If breaker failure protection is initiated, an alarm message is generated and a settable delay time is started. If once the time delay has elapsed, criteria for a pickup are still met, a trip signal is issued to a superordinate circuit breaker. Therefore, the trip signal issued by the breaker failure protection is configured to one of the output relays. The following figure shows the logic diagram for the breaker failure protection function. The entire breaker failure protection function may be turned on or off, or it can be blocked dynamically via binary inputs. If the criteria that led to the pickup are no longer met when the time delay has elapsed, such pickup thus drops out and no trip signal is issued by the breaker failure protection function. To protect against nuisance tripping due to excessive contact bounce, a stabilization of the binary inputs for external trip signals takes place. This external signal must be present during the entire period of the delay time, otherwise the timer is reset and no trip signal is issued.
220
Figure 2-82
221
2.14.2
General
Setting Notes
Breaker failure protection is only effective and accessible if address 170 50BF is set to Enabled or enabled w/ 3I0>. Setting Enabled considers the three phase currents for total current monitoring. Setting enabled w/ 3I0> additionally evaluates the ground current or the negative sequence system when only one phase current occurs. If this function is not required, then Disabled is set. The function can be set to ON or OFF under address 7001 FCT 50BF. Criteria Address 7004 Chk BRK CONTACT establishes whether or not the breaker auxiliary contacts connected via binary inputs are to be used as a criterion for pickup. If this address is set to ON, then current criterion and/or the auxiliary contact criterion apply. This setting must be selected if the breaker failure protection is started by functions, which do not always have a certain criterion for detection of an open circuit breaker, e.g. voltage protection. Time Delay The time delay is entered at address 7005 TRIP-Timer. This setting should be based on the maximum circuit breaker operating time plus the dropout time of the current flow monitoring element plus a safety margin which takes into consideration the tolerance of the time delay. Figure 2-83 illustrates the time sequences.
Figure 2-83
Time sequence example for normal clearance of a fault, and with circuit breaker failure
Pickup Values The pickup value of the current flow monitoring is set under address 7006 50BF PICKUP, and the pickup value of the ground current monitoring under address 7007 50BF PICKUP IE>. The threshold values must be set at a level below the minimum fault current for which the total current monitoring must operate. A setting of 10 % below the minimum fault current for which breaker failure protection must operate is recommended. The pickup value should not be set too low since otherwise there is a risk that transients in the current transformer secondary circuit may lead to extended dropout times if extremely high currents are switched off. Via binary input 1404 >50BFactiv.3I0> you can activate the threshold value 50BF PICKUP IE> also for checking the plausibility of the phase currents.
222
2.14.3
Settings
The table indicates region-specific default settings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corresponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer.
C OFF ON OFF ON
Setting Options
Default Setting OFF OFF 0.25 sec 0.10 A 0.50 A 0.10 A 0.50 A
Comments 50BF Breaker Failure Protection Check Breaker contacts TRIP-Timer 50BF Pickup current threshold 50BF Pickup earth current threshold
0.06 .. 60.00 sec; 1A 5A 0.05 .. 20.00 A 0.25 .. 100.00 A 0.05 .. 20.00 A 0.25 .. 100.00 A
7007
1A 5A
2.14.4
No. 1403 1404 1431 1451 1452 1453 1456 1457 1471 1480 1481
Information List
Information >BLOCK 50BF >50BFactiv.3I0> >50BF ext SRC 50BF OFF 50BF BLOCK 50BF ACTIVE 50BF int Pickup 50BF ext Pickup 50BF TRIP 50BF int TRIP 50BF ext TRIP Type of Information SP SP SP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT >BLOCK 50BF >50BF Activate 3I0> threshold >50BF initiated externally 50BF is switched OFF 50BF is BLOCKED 50BF is ACTIVE 50BF (internal) PICKUP 50BF (external) PICKUP 50BF TRIP 50BF (internal) TRIP 50BF (external) TRIP Comments
223
2.15
2.15.1
General
Description
The function is a combination of a standard protection logic and a characteristic (measured quantity or derived quantity) that is adjustable via parameters. The characteristics listed in table 2-13 and the derived protection functions are available. Please note that the power values are not available if you are using capacitive voltage measurement, or if you have set address 213 VT Connect. 3ph to Vab, Vbc or Vab, Vbc, Vx. Table 2-13 Characteristic Group Current I Irms Possible Protection Functions Characteristic / Measured Quantity Protective Function ANSI No. Mode of Operation Threephase RMS value of fundamental com- Overcurrent protection ponent Undercurrent monitoring True RMS (RMS value) Overcurrent protection Thermal overload protection Undercurrent monitoring Time overcurrent protection, ground 50, 50G 37 50, 50G 49 37 50N X X Singlephase X X
Zero sequence system Positive-sequence component Negative-sequence component Positive/negative sequence component ratio Frequency Frequency change RMS value of fundamental component True RMS (RMS value) Zero sequence system Positive-sequence component Negative-sequence component Voltage change
X X
X X
Frequency protection
81U/O
Frequency change protec- 81R tion Voltage protection Displacement voltage Voltage protection Displacement voltage Displacement voltage Voltage protection Voltage asymmetry Voltage change protection 27, 59, 59G 27, 59, 59G 59N 27, 59 47 27R, 59R
224
Protective Function
ANSI No.
Reverse power protection Power protection Power protection Power factor Direct coupling
32R, 32, 37 32 55
X X X
Section 2.16 gives an application example of the function reverse power protection. The maximum 20 configurable protection functions operate independently of each other. The following description concerns one function; it can be applied accordingly to all other flexible functions. The logic diagram 2-84 illustrates the description. Function Logic The function can be switched ON and OFF or, it can be set to Alarm Only. In this status, a pickup condition will neither initiate fault recording nor start the trip time delay. Tripping is thus not possible. Changing the Power System Data 1 after flexible functions have been configured may cause these functions to be set incorrectly. Message (FNo.235.2128 $00 inval.set) reports this condition. The function is inactive in this case and function's setting has to be modified. Blocking Functions The function can be blocked via binary input (FNo. 235.2110 >BLOCK $00) or via local operating terminal (Control -> Tagging -> Set). Blocking will reset the function's entire measurement logic as well as all running times and indications. Blocking via the local operating terminal may be useful if the function is in a status of permanent pickup which does not allow the function to be reset. In context with voltage-based characteristics, the function can be blocked if one of the measuring voltages fails. Recognition of this status is either accomplished by the relay's internal Fuse-Failure-Monitor (FNo. 170 VT FuseFail; see section 2.10.1) or via auxiliary contacts of the voltage transformer CB (FNo. 6509 >FAIL:FEEDER VT and FNo. 6510 >FAIL: BUS VT). This blocking mechanism can be enabled or disabled in the according parameters. The associated parameter BLK.by Vol.Loss is only available if the characteristic is based on a voltage measurement. When using the flexible function for power protection or power monitoring, it will be blocked if currents fall below 0.03 INom. Parameter BLK f out of r allows you to specify whether the protection function is blocked if the measured power frequency is outside the operating range of the function (25 Hz to 70 Hz).
225
Operating Mode, Measured Quantity, Measurement Method The flexible function can be tailored to assume a specific protective function for a concrete application in parameters OPERRAT. MODE, MEAS. QUANTITY, MEAS. METHOD and PICKUP WITH. Parameter OPERRAT. MODE can be set to specify whether the function works 3-phase, 1-phase or no reference, i.e. without a fixed phase reference. The three-phase method evaluates all three phases in parallel. This implies that threshold evaluation, pickup indications and trip time delay are accomplished selectively for each phase and parallel to each other. This may be for example the typical operating principle of a three-phase time overcurrent protection. When operating single-phase, the function employs either a phase's measured quantity, which must be stated explicitly, (e.g. evaluating only the current in phase Ib), the measured ground current In or the measured displacement voltage Vn. If the characteristic relates to the frequency or if external trip commands are used, the operating principle is without (fixed) phase reference. Additional parameters can be set to specify the used MEAS. QUANTITY and the MEAS. METHOD. The MEAS. METHOD determines for current and voltage measured values whether the function uses the RMS value of the fundamental component or the normal RMS value (true RMS) that evaluates also harmonics. All other characteristics use always the rms value of the fundamental component. Parameter PICKUP WITH moreover specifies whether the function picks up on exceeding the threshold (>-Element) or on falling below the threshold (<-Element). Characteristic Curve The function's characteristic curve is always definite time; this means that the time delay is not affected by the measured quantity. Function Logic Figure 2-84 shows the logic diagram of a three-phase function. If the function operates on one phase or without phase reference, phase selectivity and phase-specific indications are not relevant.
226
Figure 2-84
The parameters can be set to monitor either exceeding or dropping below of the threshold. The configurable pickup time delay will be started once the threshold (>-Element) has been exceeded. When the time delay has elapsed and the threshold is still violated, the pickup of the phase (e.g. no. 235.2122 $00 pickup A)and of the function (no. 235.2121 $00 picked up) is reported. If the pickup delay is set to zero, the pickup will occur simultaneously with the detection of the threshold violation. If the function is enabled, the pickup will start the trip time delay and the fault log. This is not the case if set to "Alarm only". If the threshold violation persists after the trip time delay has elapsed, the trip will be initiated upon its expiration (no. 235.2126 $00 TRIP). The timeout is reported via (no. 235.2125 $00 Time Out). Expiry of the trip time delay can be blocked via
227
binary input (no. 235.2113 >$00 BLK.TDly). The time delay will not be started as long as the binary input is active; a trip can thus be initiated. The time delay is started after the binary input has dropped out and the pickup is still present. It is also possible to bypass the expiration of the time delay by activating binary input (no. 235.2111 >$00 instant.). The trip will be launched immediately when the pickup is present and the binary input has been activated. The trip command can be blocked via binary inputs (no. 235.2115 >$00 BL.TripA) and (no. 235.2114 >$00 BLK.TRIP). The phase-selective blocking of the trip command is required for interaction with the inrush restraint (see Interaction with other functions). The function's dropout ratio can be set. If the threshold (>-Element) is undershot after the pickup, the dropout time delay will be started. The pickup is maintained during that time, a started trip delay time continues to count down. If the trip time delay has elapsed while the dropout time delay is still during, the trip command will only be given if the current threshold is exceeded. The element will only drop out when the dropout time delay has elapsed. If the time is set to zero, the dropout will be initiated immediately once the threshold is undershot. External Trip Commands The logic diagram does not explicitly depict the external trip commands since their functionality is analogous. If the binary input is activated for external trip commands (no. 235.2112 >$00 Dir.TRIP), it will be logically treated as threshold overshooting, i.e. once it has been activated, the pickup time delay is started. If the pickup time delay is set to zero, the pickup condition will be reported immediately starting the trip time delay. Otherwise, the logic is the same as depicted in Figure 2-84. Interaction with Other Functions The flexible protection functions interact with a number of other functions such as the Breaker failure protection: The breaker failure protection is started automatically if the function initiates a trip. The trip will, however, only take place if the current criterion is met at this time, i.e. the set minimum current threshold 212 BkrClosed I MIN (Power System Data 1) has been exceeded. Fuse-Failure-Monitor (see description at Blocking Functions). Inrush restraint: Direct interaction with the inrush restraint is not possible. In order to block a flexible function by the inrush restraint, the blocking must be carried out in CFC. The flexible function provides three binary inputs for blocking trip commands selectively for each phase (no. 235.2115 to 235.2117). They have to be linked with the phase-selective indications for detecting the inrush (no. 1840 to 1842). Activating a crossblock function requires the phase-selective inrush indications to be logically combined with the binary input for blocking the function trip command (no. 235.2114 >$00 BLK.TRIP). The flexible function also needs to be delayed by at least 20 ms to make sure that the inrush restraint picks up before the flexible function. Entire relay logic: The pickup signal of the flexible function is added to the general device pickup, the trip signal is added to the general device trip (see also Chapter 2.19). All functions associated with general device pickup and tripping are thus also applied to the flexible function. After the picked up element has dropped out, the trip signals of the flexible protection functions are held up at least for the specified minimum trip command time 210 T TRIPCOM MIN.
228
2.15.2
Setting Notes
The setting of the functional scope determines the number of flexible protection functions to be used (see Chapter 2.1.1). If a flexible function in the functional scope is disabled (by removing the checkmark), this will result in losing all settings and configurations of this function or its settings will be reset to their default settings.
General In the DIGSI setting dialog General, parameter FLEXIBLE FUNC. can be set to OFF, ON or Alarm Only. If the function is enabled in operational mode Alarm Only, no faults are recorded, no Effective-indication is generated, no trip command issued and neither will the circuit-breaker protection be affected. Therefore, this operational mode is preferred when a flexible function is not required to operate as a protection function. Furthermore, the OPERRAT. MODE can be configured: Three-phase functions evaluate the three-phase measuring system, i.e. all three phases are processed simultaneously. A typical example is the three-phase operating time overcurrent protection. Single-phase functions evaluate only the individual measured value. This can be an individual phase value (e.g. VB) or Vx or a ground value (VN, IN or IN2 ). Setting no reference determines the evaluation of measured variables irrespective of a single or threephase connection of current and voltage. Table 2-13 provides an overview regarding which variables can be used in which mode of operation. Parameter BLK f out of r allows you to specify whether the protection function is blocked if the measured power frequency is outside the operating range of the function (25 Hz to 70 Hz). SIEMENS recommends using the default setting (YES). A release beyond the normal operating range is only required for special applications. Measured values In the setting dialog Measured Variable the measured variables to be evaluated by the flexible protection functions can be selected, which may be a calculated or a directly measured variable. The setting options that can be selected here are dependent on the mode of measured-value processing as predefined in parameter OPERRAT. MODE (see the following table). Table 2-14 Parameter Operating Mode and Measured Quantity Parameter MEAS. QUANTITY Setting Options Current Voltage P forward P reverse Q forward Q reverse Power factor dV/dt rising dV/dt falling Frequency df/dt rising df/dt falling Binray Input
The power values are not available if you are using a capacitive voltage connection or if you have selected the setting Vab, Vbc or Vab, Vbc, Vx as connection type for the voltage transformers in address 213 VT Connect. 3ph.
229
Measurement method The measurement procedures as set out in the following table can be configured for the measured variables current, voltage and power. The dependencies of the available measurement procedures of configurable modes of operation and the measured variable are also indicated. Table 2-15 Mode of Operation Three-phase Parameter in the Settings Dialog "Measurement Procedure", Mode of Operation three-phase Measured Variable Current, Voltage Parameter MEAS. METHOD Setting Options Fundamental Harmonic Only the fundamental harmonic is evaluated, higher harmonics are suppressed. This is the standard measurement procedure of the protection functions. Important: The voltage threshold is always parameterized as phase-to-phase voltage independently of parameter VOLTAGE SYSTEM. True RMS The "true" RMS value is determined, i.e. higher harmonics are evaluated. This procedure is applied, for example, if a simple overload protection is to be implemented on the basis of a current measurement, as the higher harmonics contribute to thermal heating. Important: The voltage threshold is always parameterized as phase-to-phase voltage independently of parameter VOLTAGE SYSTEM. Positive sequence system, Negative sequence system, Zero sequence system In order to implement certain applications, the positive sequence system or negative sequence system can be configured as measurement procedure. Examples are: - I2 (tripping monitoring system) - U2 (voltage asymmetry) Selecting the selection zero-sequence system enables additional zero-sequence current or zero-sequence voltage functions to be implemented that operate independently of the ground variables IN and VN, which are measured directly via transformers. Important: The voltage threshold value is always parameterized according to the definition of the symmetrical components independent of parameter VOLTAGE SYSTEM. Current Ratio I2/I1 The ratio negative/positive sequence current is evaluated Please note that the function only operates if I2 or I1 has exceeded the threshold value 0.1 INom. Notes
Voltage
Parameter VOLTAGE SYSTEM Setting Options Phase-to-phase Phase-to-Ground If you have configured address 213 VT Connect. 3ph to Van, Vbn, Vcn or Vab, Vbc, VGnd, you can select whether a threephase voltage function will evaluate the phase-to-Ground voltage or the phase-to-phase voltages. When selecting phase-to-phase, these variables are derived from the phase-to-Ground voltages. The selection is, for example, important for single-pole faults. If the faulty voltage drops to zero, the affected phase-to-Ground voltage is zero, whereas the affected phase-to-phase voltages collapse to the size of a phase-to-Ground voltage. With phase-to-phase voltage connections the parameter is hidden.
230
Note With regard to the phase-selective pickup messages, a special behavior is observed in the three-phase voltage protection with phase-to-phase variables, because the phase-selective pickup message "Flx01 Pickup Lx" is allocated to the respective measured-value channel "Lx". Single-phase faults: If, for example, voltage VA drops to such degree that voltages VAB and VCA exceed their threshold values, the device indicates pickups Flx01 Pickup A and Flx01 Pickup C, because the undershooting was detected in the first and third measured-value channel. Two-phase faults: If, for example, voltage VAB drops to such degree that its threshold value is reached, the device then indicates pickup "Flx01 Pickup A", because the undershooting was detected in the first measured-value channel.
231
Parameter in the Setting Dialog "Measurement Procedure", Mode of Operation 1-phase Measured Variable Current, voltage Parameter MEAS. METHOD Setting Options Fundamental Harmonic Only the fundamental harmonic is evaluated, higher harmonics are suppressed. This is the standard measurement procedure of the protection functions. True RMS The True RMS value is determined, i.e. higher harmonics are evaluated. This procedure is applied, for example, if a simple overload protection is to be implemented on the basis of a current measurement, as the higher harmonics contribute to thermal heating. Notes
Current
Parameter CURRENT Setting Selection IA IB IC IN INS IN2 It is determined which current measuring channel is evaluated by the function. Depending on the device version, either IN (normalsensitive ground current input), INS (sensitive ground current input) or IN2 (second ground current connected to the device) can be selected. If parameter 251 is set to A,G2,C,G; G2->B, the setting IN refers to the current at the second current (IN2). The setting INS refers to the sensitive ground current at the fourth current input. If parameter 251 is set to A,G2,C,G; G->B, the setting IN2 refers to the current at the second current (IN2). The setting INS or INS refers to the sensitive or highly sensitive ground current at the fourth current input.
Voltage
Parameter VOLTAGE Setting Selection VAB VBC VCA VAN VBN VCN VN Vx It is determined which voltage-measuring channel is evaluated by the function. When selecting phase-to-phase voltage, the threshold value must be set as a phase-to-phase value, when selecting a phase-to-Ground variable as phase-to-Ground voltage. The extent of the setting texts depends on the connection of the voltage transformer (see address 213 VT Connect. 3ph).
Parameter POWER Setting Selection IA VAN IB VBN IC VCN It is determined which power-measuring channel (current and voltage) is evaluated by the function. The extent of the setting texts depends on the connection of the voltage transformer (see address 213 VT Connect. 3ph). When selecting Vab, Vbc, VGnd, the phase-to-Ground voltages will be calculated if phase-toGround is configured. When selecting phase-to-phase, the connected phase-to-phase voltages are used and VCA is calculated from VAB and VBC.
The forward direction of power (P forward, Q reverse) is the direction of the line. Parameter (1108 P,Q sign) for sign inversion of the power display in the operating measured values is ignored by the flexible functions. Via parameter PICKUP WITH it is determined whether the function must be triggered on exceeding or undershooting of the set threshold value.
232
Settings The pickup thresholds, time delays and dropout ratios of the flexible protection function are set in the Settings dialog box in DIGSI. The pickup threshold of the function is configured via parameter P.U. THRESHOLD. The OFF-command time delay is set via parameter T TRIP DELAY. Both setting values must be selected according to the required application. The pickup can be delayed via parameter T PICKUP DELAY. This parameter is usually set to zero (default setting) in protection applications, because a protection function should pick up as quickly as possible. A setting deviating from zero may be appropriate if a trip log is not desired to be started upon each short-term exceeding of the pickup threshold, for example, with power protection or when a function is not used as a protection, but as a monitoring function. When setting the power threshold values, it is important to take into consideration that a minimum current of 0.03 IN is required for power calculation. The power calculation is blocked for lower currents. The dropout of pickup can be delayed via parameter T DROPOUT DELAY. This setting is also set to zero by default (standard setting) A setting deviating from zero may be required if the device is utilized together with electro-magnetic devices with considerably longer dropout ratios than the digital protection device (see Chapter 2.2 for more information). When utilizing the dropout time delay, it is recommended to set it to a shorter time than the OFF-command time delay in order to avoid both times to "race". The dropout ratio of the function can be selected in parameter DROPOUT RATIO. The standard dropout ratio of protection functions is 0.95 (default setting). If the function is used as power protection, a dropout ratio of at least 0.9 should be set. The same applies to the utilization of the symmetrical components of current and voltage. If the dropout ratio is decreased, it would be sensible to test the pickup of the function regarding possible "chatter". The dropout difference of the frequency elements is set under parameter DO differential. Usually, the default setting of 0.02 Hz can be retained. A higher dropout difference should be set in weak systems with larger, short-term frequency fluctuations to avoid chattering of the message. A fixed dropout difference of 0.1 Hz/s is used for the frequency change (df/dt) measurand. The same applies to the voltage change (dU/dt) measurand. The permanent dropout difference here is 3 V/s. Parameter BLK.by Vol.Loss determines whether a function whose measured variable is based on a voltage measurement (measured quantities voltage, P forward, P reverse, Q forward, Q reverse and power factor), should be blocked in case of a measured voltage failure (set to YES) or not (set to NO). Renaming Messages, Checking Configurations After parameterization of a flexible function, the following steps should be noted: Open matrix in DIGSI Rename the neutral message texts in accordance with the application. Check configurations on contacts and in operation and fault buffer, or set them according to the requirements. Further Information The following instruction should be noted: As the power factor does not differentiate between capacitive and inductive, the sign of the reactive power may be used with CFC-help as an additional criterion.
233
2.15.3
Settings
Addresses which have an appended "A" can only be changed with DIGSI, under "Display Additional Settings". The table indicates region-specific default settings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corresponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer.
Addr. 0
Setting Options OFF ON Alarm Only 3-phase 1-phase no reference YES NO Please select Current Voltage P forward P reverse Q forward Q reverse Power factor dV/dt rising dV/dt falling Frequency df/dt rising df/dt falling Binray Input Fundamental True RMS Positive seq. Negative seq. Zero sequence Ratio I2/I1 Exceeding Dropping below Ia Ib Ic In In sensitive In2 Please select Va-n Vb-n Vc-n Va-b Vb-c Vc-a Vn Vx
OPERRAT. MODE
3-phase
Mode of Operation
0 0
MEAS. METHOD
Fundamental
0 0
Exceeding Ia
VOLTAGE
Please select
Voltage
234
Addr. 0
Parameter POWER
Comments
0 0 0
Phase-Phase 2.00 A 2.00 A 10.00 A 0.100 A 0.500 A 110.0 V 110.0 V 51.00 Hz 61.00 Hz 5.00 Hz/s 200.0 W 1000.0 W 0.50 20 % 60 V/s 110.0 V 1.00 sec 0.00 sec 0.00 sec 0.00 sec YES 0.95 1.05 0.03 Hz
0.05 .. 40.00 A 0.25 .. 200.00 A 0.001 .. 1.500 A 0.005 .. 7.500 A 2.0 .. 260.0 V 2.0 .. 200.0 V 40.00 .. 60.00 Hz 50.00 .. 70.00 Hz 0.10 .. 20.00 Hz/s
P.U. THRESHOLD
1A 5A
Pickup Threshold
0 0 0 0 0 0
P.U. THRESHOLD P.U. THRESHOLD P.U. THRESHOLD P.U. THRESHOLD P.U. THRESHOLD P.U. THRESHOLD 1A 5A
Pickup Threshold Pickup Threshold Pickup Threshold Pickup Threshold Pickup Threshold Pickup Threshold
2.0 .. 10000.0 W 10.0 .. 50000.0 W -0.99 .. 0.99 15 .. 100 % 4 .. 100 V/s 2.0 .. 260.0 V 0.00 .. 3600.00 sec 0.00 .. 60.00 sec 0.00 .. 28800.00 sec 0.00 .. 60.00 sec NO YES 0.70 .. 0.99 1.01 .. 3.00 0.02 .. 1.00 Hz
0 0 0 0 0 0A 0 0A 0A 0A 0A 0
P.U. THRESHOLD P.U. THRESHOLD P.U. THRESHOLD P.U. THRESHOLD T TRIP DELAY T PICKUP DELAY T PICKUP DELAY T DROPOUT DELAY BLK.by Vol.Loss DROPOUT RATIO DROPOUT RATIO DO differential
Pickup Threshold Pickup Threshold Pickup Threshold Pickup Threshold Trip Time Delay Pickup Time Delay Pickup Time Delay Dropout Time Delay Block in case of Meas.Voltage Loss Dropout Ratio Dropout Ratio Dropout differential
235
2.15.4
No.
Information List
Information Type of Information SP SP SP SP SP SP SP SP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT IntSP >BLOCK Function $00 >Function $00 instantaneous TRIP >Function $00 Direct TRIP >Function $00 BLOCK TRIP Time Delay >Function $00 BLOCK TRIP >Function $00 BLOCK TRIP Phase A >Function $00 BLOCK TRIP Phase B >Function $00 BLOCK TRIP Phase C Function $00 is BLOCKED Function $00 is switched OFF Function $00 is ACTIVE Function $00 picked up Function $00 Pickup Phase A Function $00 Pickup Phase B Function $00 Pickup Phase C Function $00 TRIP Delay Time Out Function $00 TRIP Function $00 has invalid settings BLOCK Flexible Function Comments
235.2110 >BLOCK $00 235.2111 >$00 instant. 235.2112 >$00 Dir.TRIP 235.2113 >$00 BLK.TDly 235.2114 >$00 BLK.TRIP 235.2115 >$00 BL.TripA 235.2116 >$00 BL.TripB 235.2117 >$00 BL.TripC 235.2118 $00 BLOCKED 235.2119 $00 OFF 235.2120 $00 ACTIVE 235.2121 $00 picked up 235.2122 $00 pickup A 235.2123 $00 pickup B 235.2124 $00 pickup C 235.2125 $00 Time Out 235.2126 $00 TRIP 235.2128 $00 inval.set 236.2127 BLK. Flex.Fct.
236
2.16
2.16.1
General
By means of the flexible protection functions, a single-element or multi-element reverse power protection can be realized. Each reverse power element can be operated in single-phase or three-phase. Depending on the chosen option, the elements can evaluate active power forward, active power reverse, reactive power forward or reactive power reverse as measured value. The pickup of the protection elements can occur on exceeding or falling below a threshold. Possible applications for reverse power protection are set out in Table 2-17. Table 2-17 Overview of reverse power protection applications Type of evaluation Direction P forward reverse Exceeding Falling below Monitoring of the forward power limits of operational equipment (trans- Detection of idling formers, lines) motors Protection of a local industrial network against feedback into the power supply network Detection of feedback from motors Monitoring of the reactive power limits of operational equipment (transformers, lines) Connection of a capacitor bank for reactive power compensation Monitoring of the reactive power limits of operational equipment (transformers, lines) Disconnection of a capacitor bank
forward
reverse
The following example depicts a typical application where the flexible function acts as reverse power protection. Disconnection Facility Figure 2-85 gives an example of an industrial substation with self-supply via the illustrated generator. All illustrated lines and the busbar are three-phase (except for the ground connections and the connection to the voltage measurement at the generator). Both feeders 1 and 2 supply the consumers of the customer. Usually the industrial customer receives his current from the power supply company. The generator runs synchronously without feeding power. If the power supply company can no longer guarantee the required supply, the substation is to be separated from the power supply company's system and the generator to take over the self-supply. In this example, the substation is to be disconnected from the power supply company's system as soon as the frequency leaves the nominal range (e.g. 1 - 2% deviation from the nominal frequency), the voltage exceeds or falls below a set value, or the generator's active power is fed back into the power supply company's system. Depending on the user's philosophy, some of these criteria may be combined. This would be realized via the CFC. The example illustrates how a reverse power protection is implemented by means of the flexible protection functions. Frequency protection and voltage protection are described in Sections 2.8 and 2.5.
237
Figure 2-85
238
Substation Layout On the high-voltage side, the substation is linked to the power supply company's system via a 110 kV line. The circuit breaker CB1 is part of the power supply company's system. Disconnection of the substation from the power supply company's system is effected via the switch disconnector. The transformer with a transformation ratio of 10:1 transforms the voltage level to 11 kV. On the low-voltage side, the transformer, generator and two feeders are linked via a busbar. The circuit breakers CB2 to CB5 separate the consumers and operational equipment from the busbar. Table 2-18 System data for the application example System data Generator nominal power Transformer nominal power Nominal voltage of the high-voltage side Nominal voltage of busbar side Nominal primary CT current on the busbar side Nominal secondary CT current on the busbar side Nominal primary VT voltage on the busbar side Nominal secondary VT voltage on the busbar side SNom,Gen = 38.1 MVA SNom,Transf = 38.1 MVA VNom = 110 kV VNom = 11 kV INom,prim = 2000 A INom,sec = 1 A VNom,prim = 11 kV VNom,sec = 100 V
Protection Functionality With the protection device 7SK80, the substation is disconnected from the generator upon its feedback into the power supply company's system (protection function P reverse>). This function is implemented by means of a flexible protection function. Disconnection will also be initiated if frequency or voltage fluctuations occur in the power grid (protection function f<, f>, 27-1 PICKUP, 59-1 PICKUP, 67N-1 PICKUPdir). The protection receives the measured values via a three-phase current and voltage transformer set. In the case of a disconnection, the circuit breaker CB2 is triggered. The transformer is protected by a differential protection and inverse or definite time overcurrent protection functions for the phase-to-phase currents. In the event of a fault, the circuit-breaker CB1 in the power supply company's system is activated via a remote link. In addition, the circuit breaker CB2 is activated. Overcurrent protection functions protect the feeders 1 and 2 against short circuits and overload caused by the connected consumers. The phase-to-phase currents and the zero currents of the feeders can be protected by inverse and definite time overcurrent protection elements. In the event of a fault, the circuit breakers CB4 and CB5 are activated. In addition, the busbar could be equipped with the 7UT635 differential protection relay for multiple ends. The current transformers required for that are already included in Figure 2-85. Wiring Diagram, Power Direction Figure 2-86 shows the wiring of the device for reverse power protection. The power flow in positive or forward direction occurs from the high-voltage busbar (not shown) via the transformer to the low-voltage busbar.
239
Figure 2-86
2.16.2
General
The names of messages can be edited in DIGSI and adjusted accordingly for this example. The names of the parameters are fixed. Determination of the Reverse Power The reverse power protection evaluates the active power from the symmetrical components of the fundamental harmonics of the voltages and currents. The evaluation of the positive sequence systems causes reverse power determination to be independent of the asymmetries in currents and voltages and reflects the real load of the driving end. The calculated active power value corresponds to the total active power. The connection in the example illustrates positive measurement of power in the direction extending from the busbar to the transformer of the device.
240
Functional Logic The following logic diagram depicts the functional logic of the reverse power protection.
Figure 2-87
Logic diagram of the reverse power determination with flexible protection function
The reverse power protection picks up once the configured pickup threshold has been exceeded. If the pickup condition persists during the equally settable pickup delay, the pickup message P.rev.PU is generated and starts the trip delay time. If the pickup condition does not drop out while the trip delay time is counting down, the trip indication P. rev. TRIP and the timeout indication P. rev. timeout (not shown) are generated. The picked up element drops out when the value falls below the dropout threshold. The blocking input >P rev. block blocks the entire function, i.e. pickup, trip and running times are reset. After the blocking has been released, the reverse power must exceed the pickup threshold and both times must run out before the protection function trips. Pickup Value, Dropout Ratio The pickup value of the reverse power protection is set to 10% of the nominal generator output. In this example, the setting value is configured as secondary power in watts. The following relationship exists between the primary and the secondary power:
On the basis of the indicated data, the pickup values are calculated considering P prim = 3.81 MW (10% of 38.1 MW) on the primary level to
on the secondary level. The dropout ratio is set to 0.9. This yields a secondary dropout threshold of Psec, dropout = 15.6 W. If the pickup threshold is reduced to a value near the lower setting limit of 0.5 W, the dropout ratio should equally be reduced to approximately 0.7. Delay for Pickup, Dropout and Trip The reverse power protection does not require short tripping times as protection from undesired power feedback. In the present example, it is useful to delay pickup and dropout by about 0.5 s and the trip by approx. 1 s. Delaying the pickup will minimize the number of fault logs which are opened when the reverse power oscillates around the threshold. When using the reverse power protection to disconnect the substation quickly from the power supply company's system if faults occur, it is useful to select a larger pickup value (e.g. 50% of nominal power) and shorter time delays.
241
2.16.3
Figure 2-88
Select Additional Functions in the Parameters menu to view the flexible function. The parameter selection options for the flexible protection functions primarily depend on the settings made in the Power System Data 1 for the connection of the voltage and current transformers (addresses 213 and 251).
242
Figure 2-89
First activate the function at Customize --> General and select the mode of operation Three-Phase.
Figure 2-90
In the menu items Meas. Quantity and Meas. Method, Active Power reverse or Exceeding must be set. If the box Display additional settings is enabled in the Settings menu item, pickup threshold, pickup time delay and dropout time delay can be configured. As the power direction cannot be determined in the case of a measuring voltage failure, a protection blocking is sensible in this case.
243
Figure 2-91
Allocation of the Reverse Power Protection The DIGSI configuration matrix initially shows the following indications (after having selected Indications and commands only and No filter):
Figure 2-92
Clicking the texts allows for editing short text and long text as required by the application.
Figure 2-93
The indications are allocated in the same way as the indications of other protection functions.
244
2.17
Applications In particular, the thermal status of motors, generators and transformers can thus be monitored. Rotating machines are additionally monitored for a violation of the bearing temperature thresholds. The temperatures are measured by temperature sensors (RTD = Resistance Temperature Detector) in different locations of the protected object and forwarded to the device via a 7XV5662 RTD box or via the I/O 2 extension module.
2.17.1
Description
Temperature Measurement using RTD Boxes The RTD box determines the temperature of each measuring point from the resistance value of the temperature detectors (Pt 100, Ni 100 or Ni 120) connected via two- or three-wire cable and converts it into a digital value. The digital values are held available at the corresponding port (RS485 or Ethernet as ordered). Note Although this is not recommended by the manufacturer, you can connect Ni 100 or Ni 120 temperature sensors to the RTD box. But you have to bear in mind that the values have to be converted in the protection device. The values displayed at the RTD box are not correct when using Ni 100 or Ni 120 temperature sensors.
Communication with the Protection Device The 7XV5662 RTD box can be connected to the protection device either via RS485 (port B) or Ethernet (port A). The RTD box is an external device that is mounted on a DIN rail. It has 12 temperature inputs. Therefore, up to 12 temperature measuring points are available in this way. For greater distances to the protection device the communication via fiber optic cables is recommended. Alternative communication structures are shown in Appendix A.3. Note You can connect one RTD box either via RS485 (port B) or Ethernet (port A). Combining both connection types is not possible.
Temperature Detection via the I/O 2 Extension Module Up to 5 temperature sensors (Pt100, Ni 100 or Ni 120) can be connected to the 7SK80 via the I/O 2 extension module. Use a shielded three-wire cable to make the connection. The temperature at the corresponding measuring points is determined via the internal measuring function. The calculation is analogous to the RTD box.
245
Processing Temperatures The evaluation of the temperatures measured via RTD box or the internal measuring function (temperature detection via I/O 2 extension module) is identical. The temperature raw data are converted into a temperature in degrees Celsius or Fahrenheit. The conversion depends on the temperature sensor used. For each temperature detector two threshold decisions can be performed which are available for further processing. The user can make the corresponding allocations in the configuration matrix. Each temperature sensor issues an alarm in case of a short-circuit or interruption of the sensor circuit or if a sensor is configured but not assigned. Additionally, a group indication is formed across all temperature sensors of the RTD box, or across all temperature sensors when measuring the temperature via the I/O 2 extension module (14101 Fail: RTD). An error message is generated when the communication between RTD box and protection device is faulted or in the event of an internal fault of the internal temperature measurement. Indication 264 Fail: RTD-Box 1( for RTD 1 through RTD 6) or 267 Fail: RTD-Box 2 (for RTD 7 through RTD 12) for temperature detection via RTD box, indication 208 Fail: RTD int. for temperature detection via I/O 2 extension module. Figure 2-94 shows the logic diagram of the temperature processing via RTD box. The manual supplied with the RTD box contains a connection circuit diagram and a dimensioned drawing. Figure 2-95 shows the logic diagram of the temperature processing via I/O 2 extension module.
Figure 2-94
246
Figure 2-95
2.17.2
General
Setting Notes
Note In the following, "RTD box" is used to designate both the temperature detection via RTD box (RS485 and Ethernet port) and the temperature measurement via the I/O 2 extension module.
Temperature detection is only effective and accessible if it was activated during configuration of the protection functions (Section 2.1.1) and if the connection type was selected. Temperature supervision is activated at address 190 RTD INPUT. The number of sensor inputs and the communication mode are set at address 191 RTD CONNECTION. The temperature unit (C or F) is set in the Power System Data 1 at address 276 TEMP. UNIT. When connecting the RTD box 7XV5662-8AD10 with 12 temperature sensor inputs via the Ethernet interface, set the same IP address for the parameters 9001 IP address[0] through 9004 IP address[3] and 9006 through 9009. At address 9000 UDP Port you define the communication port, e.g. 5000. At address 9005 UDP Port enter an address that must be 1 higher than the address at 9000, e.g. 5001.
247
For the RTD box, for example, the IP address 192.168.100.20 is entered as follows:
Figure 2-96
Device Settings The settings are the same for each input and are here shown at the example of measuring input 1. Set the type of temperature detector for RTD 1 (temperature sensor for measuring point 1) at address 9011 RTD 1 TYPE. You can choose between Pt 100 , Ni 120 and Ni 100 . If no temperature detector is available for RTD 1, set RTD 1 TYPE = Not connected. This setting is only possible via DIGSI at Display Additional Settings. Address 9012 RTD 1 LOCATION informs the device on the mounting location of RTD 1. You can choose between Oil, Ambient, Winding, Bearing and Other. The selection is not evaluated in the device but only serves the purpose of providing information about the medium in which the temperature measurement is carried out. This setting is only possible in DIGSI at Display Additional Settings. You can also set an alarm temperature and a tripping temperature. Depending on the temperature unit selected in the Power System Data (Section 2.1.1.2 in address 276 TEMP. UNIT), the alarm temperature can be expressed in degrees Celsius (C) (address 9013 RTD 1 STAGE 1) or degrees Fahrenheit (F) (address 9014 RTD 1 STAGE 1). The tripping temperature is set to degrees Celsius (C) in address 9015 RTD 1 STAGE 2 or to degrees Fahrenheit (F) at address 9016 RTD 1 STAGE 2. Note There is no conversion when changing the temperature unit. You have to re-parameterize the threshold value according to the selected unit.
The settings for all connected temperature detectors of the first and second RTD box. can be made accordingly.
248
Settings at the RTD box for RS485 connection If temperature detectors are used with two-wire connection, the line resistance (for short-circuited temperature detector) must be measured and adjusted. For this purpose, select mode 6 in the RTD-box and enter the resistance value for the corresponding temperature detector (range 0 to 50.6 ). If a 3-wire connection is used, no further settings are required to this end. The values in the following table are applicable for setting the bus address at the RTD box. The default setting in DIGSI is 6 RTD HDX. For simplex operation, set the address at the RTD box to 0 and activate the parameter 191 6 RTD simplex in DIGSI. Table 2-19 Setting the bus address at the RTD box 7XV5662 Mode simplex half duplex Address RTD 1 to RTD 6: 0 RTD 1 to RTD 6: 1 RTD 7 to RTD 12: 2
Further information is provided in the operating manual of the RTD-box. Settings at the RTD box for Ethernet connection The RTD box is put into operation using Web Browser Interface via PC. The procedure for starting up the RTD box is described in detail in the manual supplied with the RDT box. When using temperature sensors with 2-wire connection, proceed as described in the section "Settings at the RTD box for RS485 connection". The settings can be changed either directly at the device or via the Web Browser Interface. Processing Measured Values and Messages The RTD box is visible in DIGSI as part of the 7SK80 device, i.e. messages and measured values appear in the configuration matrix just like the internal functions and can be allocated and processed in the same way. Messages and measured values can thus be forwarded to the integrated user-defined logic (CFC) and interconnected as desired. Pickup signals RTD x St. 1 p.up and RTD x St. 2 p.up, however, are neither included in the group alarms 501 Relay PICKUP and 511 Relay TRIP nor do they trigger a trip log. If it is desired that a message should appear in the event log, a cross must be entered in the intersecting box of column/row.
249
2.17.3
Settings
Addresses which have an appended "A" can only be changed with DIGSI, under "Display Additional Settings".
Addr. 9000 9001 9002 9003 9004 9005 9006 9007 9008 9009 9011A
Parameter UDP Port IP address[0] IP address[1] IP address[2] IP address[3] UDP Port IP address[0] IP address[1] IP address[2] IP address[3] RTD 1 TYPE
Setting Options 0 .. 65535 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 0 .. 65535 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100 Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100 Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other
Comments UDP service port in the RTD box IP address[0] of RTD box, connec. by UDP IP address[1] of RTD box, connec. by UDP IP address[2] of RTD box, connec. by UDP IP address[3] of RTD box, connec. by UDP UDP service port in the RTD box IP address[0] of RTD box, connec. by UDP IP address[1] of RTD box, connec. by UDP IP address[2] of RTD box, connec. by UDP IP address[3] of RTD box, connec. by UDP RTD 1: Type
9012A
RTD 1 LOCATION
Oil
RTD 1: Location
RTD 1 STAGE 1 RTD 1 STAGE 1 RTD 1 STAGE 2 RTD 1 STAGE 2 RTD 2 TYPE
RTD 1: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 1: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 1: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 1: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 2: Type
9022A
RTD 2 LOCATION
Other
RTD 2: Location
250
Parameter RTD 2 STAGE 1 RTD 2 STAGE 1 RTD 2 STAGE 2 RTD 2 STAGE 2 RTD 3 TYPE
Setting Options -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100 Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100 Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100
Comments RTD 2: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 2: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 2: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 2: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 3: Type
9032A
RTD 3 LOCATION
Other
RTD 3: Location
RTD 3 STAGE 1 RTD 3 STAGE 1 RTD 3 STAGE 2 RTD 3 STAGE 2 RTD 4 TYPE
RTD 3: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 3: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 3: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 3: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 4: Type
9042A
RTD 4 LOCATION
Other
RTD 4: Location
RTD 4 STAGE 1 RTD 4 STAGE 1 RTD 4 STAGE 2 RTD 4 STAGE 2 RTD 5 TYPE
RTD 4: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 4: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 4: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 4: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 5: Type
251
Addr. 9052A
Setting Options Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100 Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100 Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F;
RTD 5 STAGE 1 RTD 5 STAGE 1 RTD 5 STAGE 2 RTD 5 STAGE 2 RTD 6 TYPE
RTD 5: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 5: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 5: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 5: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 6: Type
9062A
RTD 6 LOCATION
Other
RTD 6: Location
RTD 6 STAGE 1 RTD 6 STAGE 1 RTD 6 STAGE 2 RTD 6 STAGE 2 RTD 7 TYPE
RTD 6: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 6: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 6: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 6: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 7: Type
9072A
RTD 7 LOCATION
Other
RTD 7: Location
RTD 7: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 7: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 7: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 7: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup
252
Addr. 9081A
Setting Options Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100 Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100 Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100 Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C;
9082A
RTD 8 LOCATION
Other
RTD 8: Location
RTD 8 STAGE 1 RTD 8 STAGE 1 RTD 8 STAGE 2 RTD 8 STAGE 2 RTD 9 TYPE
RTD 8: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 8: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 8: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 8: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 9: Type
9092A
RTD 9 LOCATION
Other
RTD 9: Location
RTD 9 STAGE 1 RTD 9 STAGE 1 RTD 9 STAGE 2 RTD 9 STAGE 2 RTD10 TYPE
RTD 9: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 9: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 9: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 9: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD10: Type
9102A
RTD10 LOCATION
Other
RTD10: Location
RTD10: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD10: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD10: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup
253
Setting Options -58 .. 482 F; Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100 Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100 Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Port B Port B
9112A
RTD11 LOCATION
Other
RTD11: Location
RTD11 STAGE 1 RTD11 STAGE 1 RTD11 STAGE 2 RTD11 STAGE 2 RTD12 TYPE
RTD11: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD11: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD11: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD11: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD12: Type
9122A
RTD12 LOCATION
Other
RTD12: Location
RTD12 STAGE 1 RTD12 STAGE 1 RTD12 STAGE 2 RTD12 STAGE 2 Module Port Module Port
RTD12: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD12: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD12: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD12: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RS485 module port for the RTD box RS485 module port for the RTD box
254
2.17.4
No. 208 264 267 14101 14111 14112 14113 14121 14122 14123 14131 14132 14133 14141 14142 14143 14151 14152 14153 14161 14162 14163 14171 14172 14173 14181 14182 14183 14191 14192 14193 14201 14202 14203 14211 14212 14213 14221 14222 14223
Information List
Information Fail: RTD int. Fail: RTD-Box 1 Fail: RTD-Box 2 Fail: RTD Fail: RTD 1 RTD 1 St.1 p.up RTD 1 St.2 p.up Fail: RTD 2 RTD 2 St.1 p.up RTD 2 St.2 p.up Fail: RTD 3 RTD 3 St.1 p.up RTD 3 St.2 p.up Fail: RTD 4 RTD 4 St.1 p.up RTD 4 St.2 p.up Fail: RTD 5 RTD 5 St.1 p.up RTD 5 St.2 p.up Fail: RTD 6 RTD 6 St.1 p.up RTD 6 St.2 p.up Fail: RTD 7 RTD 7 St.1 p.up RTD 7 St.2 p.up Fail: RTD 8 RTD 8 St.1 p.up RTD 8 St.2 p.up Fail: RTD 9 RTD 9 St.1 p.up RTD 9 St.2 p.up Fail: RTD10 RTD10 St.1 p.up RTD10 St.2 p.up Fail: RTD11 RTD11 St.1 p.up RTD11 St.2 p.up Fail: RTD12 RTD12 St.1 p.up RTD12 St.2 p.up Type of Information OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT Failure: RTD-Box 1 Failure: RTD-Box 2 Fail: RTD (broken wire/shorted) Fail: RTD 1 (broken wire/shorted) RTD 1 Temperature stage 1 picked up RTD 1 Temperature stage 2 picked up Fail: RTD 2 (broken wire/shorted) RTD 2 Temperature stage 1 picked up RTD 2 Temperature stage 2 picked up Fail: RTD 3 (broken wire/shorted) RTD 3 Temperature stage 1 picked up RTD 3 Temperature stage 2 picked up Fail: RTD 4 (broken wire/shorted) RTD 4 Temperature stage 1 picked up RTD 4 Temperature stage 2 picked up Fail: RTD 5 (broken wire/shorted) RTD 5 Temperature stage 1 picked up RTD 5 Temperature stage 2 picked up Fail: RTD 6 (broken wire/shorted) RTD 6 Temperature stage 1 picked up RTD 6 Temperature stage 2 picked up Fail: RTD 7 (broken wire/shorted) RTD 7 Temperature stage 1 picked up RTD 7 Temperature stage 2 picked up Fail: RTD 8 (broken wire/shorted) RTD 8 Temperature stage 1 picked up RTD 8 Temperature stage 2 picked up Fail: RTD 9 (broken wire/shorted) RTD 9 Temperature stage 1 picked up RTD 9 Temperature stage 2 picked up Fail: RTD10 (broken wire/shorted) RTD10 Temperature stage 1 picked up RTD10 Temperature stage 2 picked up Fail: RTD11 (broken wire/shorted) RTD11 Temperature stage 1 picked up RTD11 Temperature stage 2 picked up Fail: RTD12 (broken wire/shorted) RTD12 Temperature stage 1 picked up RTD12 Temperature stage 2 picked up Comments Failure: RTD Int. Temperature Measurem.
255
2.18
Phase Rotation
A phase rotation reversal is implemented in the 7SK80 using binary inputs and parameters.
Applications Phase rotation reversal ensures that all protection and monitoring functions operate correctly even with counter-clockwise rotation, without the need for two phases to be reversed.
2.18.1
General
Description
Various functions of the 7SK80 only operate correctly if the phase rotation of the voltages and currents is known. Among these functions are negative sequence protection, undervoltage protection (based on positive sequence voltages) and several measured quantity monitors. If an counter-clockwise phase rotation is present, the appropriate setting is made during configuration of the Power System Data. If the phase rotation can change during operation (e.g. the direction of a motor is changed), a reversal signal sent to the binary input routed for this purpose is sufficient to inform the protective device of the phase sequence reversal. Logic Phase rotation is permanently established at address 209 PHASE SEQ. (Power System Data). Via the exclusive-OR gate the binary input >Reverse Rot. inverts the sense of the phase rotation applied with setting.
Figure 2-97
Influence on Protection and Monitoring Functions The swapping of the phases affects only the calculation of the positive and negative sequence quantities and the calculation of phase-to-phase quantities by subtracting two phase-to-Ground voltage and vice versa so that the phase-selective messages, fault values and operational measured values are not distorted. This function thus influences the negative sequence protection, the voltage protection, the flexible protection functions and some of the monitoring functions that generate messages if the defined and calculated phase rotations do not match.
256
2.18.2
Setting Notes
Setting the Function Parameter The normal phase sequence is set at 209 (see Section 2.1.3). If, on the system side, phase rotation is reversed temporarily, then this is communicated to the protection device using the binary input >Reverse Rot. (5145).
257
2.19
Function Logic
The function logic coordinates the execution of protection and auxiliary functions, it processes the resulting decisions and information received from the system. This includes in particular: Fault Detection / Pickup Logic Processing Tripping Logic
2.19.1
General Device Pickup The pickup signals for all protection functions in the device are connected via an OR logic and lead to the general device pickup. 4 It is initiated by the first function to pick up and drop out when the last function drops out. As a consequence, the following message is reported: 501 Relay PICKUP. The general pickup is a prerequisite for a number of internal and external consequential functions. The following are among the internal functions controlled by general device pickup: Start of a trip log: From general device pickup to general device dropout, all fault messages are entered in the trip log. Initialization of Oscillographic Records: The storage and maintenance of oscillographic values can also be made dependent on the general device pickup. Exception: Apart from the settings ON or OFF, some protection functions can also be set to Alarm Only. With setting Alarm Only no trip command is given, no trip log is created, fault recording is not initiated and no spontaneous fault annunciations are shown on the display. External functions may be controlled via an output contact. Examples are: Automatic reclosing devices, Starting of additional devices, or similar.
258
2.19.2
General Tripping The trip signals for all protective functions are connected by OR and generate the message 511 Relay TRIP. This message can be configured to an LED or binary output, just as the individual tripping messages can. Terminating the Trip Signal Once the trip command is output by the protection function, it is recorded as message Relay TRIP (see figure 2-98). At the same time, the minimum trip command duration TMin TRIP CMD is started. This ensures that the command is transmitted to the circuit breaker for a sufficient amount of time, even if the function which issued the trip signal drops out quickly. The trip commands can be terminated first when the last protection function has dropped out (no function is in pickup mode) AND the minimum trip signal duration has expired. Finally, it is possible to latch the trip signal until it is manually reset (lockout function). This allows the circuitbreaker to be locked against reclosing until the cause of the fault has been clarified and the lockout has been manually reset. The reset takes place either by pressing the LED reset key or by activating an appropriately allocated binary input (>Reset LED). A precondition, of course, is that the circuit-breaker close coil as usual remains blocked as long as the trip signal is present, and that the trip coil current is interrupted by the auxiliary contact of the circuit breaker.
Figure 2-98
2.19.3
Setting Notes
Trip Signal Duration The minimum trip command duration TMin TRIP CMD was described already in Section 2.1.3. This setting applies to all protective functions that initiate tripping.
259
2.20
Auxiliary Functions
The general functions of the device are described in chapter Auxiliary Functions.
2.20.1
Message Processing
After the occurrence of a system fault, information regarding the response of the protective relay and the measured values is important for a detailed analysis. An information processing function in the device takes care of this. The procedure for allocating information is described in the SIPROTEC 4 System Description.
Applications LEDs and Binary Outputs Information via Display Field of the Device or via PC Information to a Control Center Prerequisites The SIPROTEC 4 System Description provides a detailed description of the configuration procedure (see /1/).
260
Figure 2-99
261
Retrievable Messages The messages for the last eight network faults can be retrieved and read out. The definition of a network fault is such that the time period from fault detection up to final clearing of the disturbance is considered to be one network fault. If auto-reclosing occurs, then the network fault ends after the last reclosing shot, which means after a successful reclosing or lockout. Therefore the entire clearing process, including all reclosing shots, occupies only one trip log buffer. Within a network fault, several fault messages can occur (from the first pickup of a protective function to the last dropout of a protective function). Without auto-reclosing each fault event represents a network fault. In total 600 indications can be recorded. Oldest data are erased for newest data when the buffer is full. Ground Fault Messages In devices with sensitive ground fault detection, separate ground fault logs are provided for ground fault recording. These logs are completed if the ground fault detection is not set to tripping but to Alarm Only (address 3101 = Alarm Only) or the setting ON with GF log has been selected. With setting ON with GF log, there is also a trip, apart from the opening of the ground fault log. For cos- / sin- measurements, a criterion for the opening of the ground fault log is the pickup of the VN>Element. For U0/I0- measurements the ground fault log is opened as soon as a VN>-Element has responded and the angle condition is fulfilled. (Detailed information is provided in the logic diagrams for ground fault detection, Section 2.11). As soon as the pickup drops out, the fault recording is terminated. The ground fault log is opened as soon as the message 1271 Sens.Gnd Pickup (appearing) is issued and terminated upon disappearing of such message. Up to 45 ground fault messages can be recorded for the last 3 ground faults. If more ground fault messages are generated, the oldest are deleted consecutively. General Interrogation The general interrogation which can be retrieved via DIGSI enables the current status of the SIPROTEC 4 device to be read out. All messages requiring general interrogation are displayed with their present value. Spontaneous Messages The spontaneous messages displayed using DIGSI reflect the present status of incoming information. Each new incoming message appears immediately, i.e. the user does not have to wait for an update or initiate one.
262
2.20.2
Statistics
The number of trips initiated by the 7SK80 and the operating hours under load are counted. An additional counter allows the number of hours to be determined in which the circuit breaker is positioned in condition open. Further statistical data can be collected to optimize the intervals for circuit breaker maintenance. The counter and memory levels are secured against loss of auxiliary voltage.
2.20.2.1 Description
Number of Trips In order to count the number of trips of 7SK80, the 7SK80 relay has to be informed of the position of the circuit breaker auxiliary contacts via binary inputs. Hereby, it is necessary that the internal pulse counter is allocated in the matrix to a binary input that is controlled by the circuit breaker OPEN position. The pulse count value "Number of TRIPs CB" can be found in the "Statistics" group if the option "Measured and Metered Values Only" was enabled in the configuration matrix. Operating Hours The operating hours under load are also stored (= the current value in at least one phase is greater than the limit value BkrClosed I MIN set under address 212). Hours Meter "CB open" A meter can be realized as a CFC application if it adds up the number of hours in state Circuit Breaker open similarly to the operating hours meter. The universal hours meter is linked to a respective binary input and counts if the binary input is active. Alternatively, the undershooting of the parameter value 212 BkrClosed I MIN may be used as a criterion for starting the meter. The meter can be set or reset. A CFC application example for such meter is available on the Internet (SIPROTEC Download Area).
The universal CB maintenance accumulates the tripping currents of the trips initiated by the protective functions and comprises the four following autonomous subfunctions: Summation tripping current (I-procedure) Summation of tripping powers (Ix-procedure) Two-point procedure for calculating the remaining lifetime (2P-procedure) Sum of all Squared Fault Current Integral (I2t-procedure); Measured value acquisition and preparation operates phase-selectively for all four subfunctions. The three results are each evaluated using a threshold which is specific for each procedure (see Figure 2-100).
263
Figure 2-100
The I procedure is always present and active as a basic functionality. However, the other procedures (Ix, 2P and I2t) can be selected via a common configuration parameter. As the load on the switch depends on the current amplitude and duration of the actual switching action, including arc deletion, determination of the start and end criteria is of great importance. The procedures Ix, 2P and I2t make use of the same criteria for that purpose. The logic of the start and end criterion is illustrated in Figure 2-101. The start criterion is fulfilled by an internal protective tripping initiated by the group indication "device TRIP". Trips initiated via the internal control function are taken into consideration for the circuit breaker maintenance if the respective command is indicated via the parameter 265 Cmd.via control. An externally initiated trip command can be taken into consideration if the message >52 Wear start is sent simultaneously via a binary input. The edge of the sent message >52-a can also be used as a further criterion as this signals that the mechanism of the circuit breaker is put in motion in order to separate the contacts. As soon as the start criterion has been fulfilled, the parameterized opening time of the circuit breaker is started. The time of commencement of separation of the circuit breaker contacts is thus determined. The end of the trip procedure, including arc deletion is determined via another given parameter (CB tripping time) supplied by the manufacturer of the circuit breaker. In order to prevent an incorrect calculation procedure in case of circuit breaker failure, the current criterion 212 BkrClosed I MIN verifies whether the current actually returned to zero after two additional cycles. When the phase-selective logic release is fulfilled by the current criterion, the calculation and evaluation methods of the respective procedures are initiated. After these have been completed, the end criterion of the circuit breaker maintenance is fulfilled and ready for a new initiation. Please note that CB maintenance will be blocked if parameter settings are made incorrectly. This condition is indicated by the message 52 WearSet.fail, 52WL.blk n PErr or 52WL.blk I PErr (see Section 2.1.6.2, Power System Data 2). The latter two indications can only take effect if the 2P-procedure was configured.
264
Figure 2-101
265
I-Procedure Being a basic function, the I-procedure is unaffected by the configuration and does not require any procedurespecific settings. All tripping currents occurring 1 periods after a protective trip, are summed up for each phase. These tripping currents are r.m.s. values of the fundamental harmonic. The interrupted current in each pole is determined for each trip signal. The interrupted fault current is indicated in the fault messages and is added up with previously stored fault current values in the statistic-counters. Measured values are indicated in primary terms. The I method does not feature integrated threshold evaluation. But using CFC it is possible to implement a threshold, which logically combines and evaluates the three summation currents via an OR operation. Once the summation current exceeds the threshold, a corresponding message will be triggered. Ix Procedure While the I-procedure is always enabled and active, use of the Ix-procedure depends on the CB maintenance configuration. This procedure operates analogously to the I-procedure. The differences relate to the involution of the tripping currents and their reference to the exponentiated rated operating current of the CB. Due to the reference to Irx, the result is an approximation to the number of make-break operations specified by the CB manufacturer. The displayed values can be interpreted as the number of trips at rated operational current of the CB. They are displayed in the statistics values without unit and with two decimal places. The tripping currents used for calculation are a result of the rms values of the fundamental harmonic, which is recalculated each cycle. If the start criterion is satisfied (as described in Section General), the r.m.s. values, which are relevant after expiration of the opening time, are checked for each phase as to whether they comply with the current criterion. If one of the values does not satisfy the criterion, its predecessor will be used instead for calculation. If no r.m.s. value satisfies the criterion up to the predecessor of the starting point, which is marked by the start criterion, a trip has taken place which only affects the mechanical lifetime of the breaker and is consequently not detected by this procedure. If the current criterion grants the logic release after the opening time has elapsed, the recent primary tripping currents (Ib) are involuted and related to the exponentiated rated operating current of the CB. These values are then added to the existing statistic values of the Ix-procedure. Subsequently, threshold comparison is started using threshold I^x> as well as the output of the new related summation tripping current powers. If one of the new statistic values lies above the threshold, the message Threshold I^x> is generated. 2P-Procedure The application of the two-point procedure for the calculation of the remaining lifespan depends on the CMD configuration. The data supplied by the CB manufacturer is transformed in such manner that, by means of measuring the fault currents, a concrete statement can be made with regard to the still possible operating cycles. The CB manufacturer's double-log operating cycle diagrams form the basis of the measured fault currents at the time of contact separation. Determination of the fault currents is effected in accordance with the method as described in the above section of the Ixprocedure. The three results of the calculated remaining lifetime are represented as statistic value. The results represent the number of still possible trips, if the tripping takes place when the current reaches the rated operational current. They are displayed without unit and without decimals. As with the other procedures, a threshold logically combines the three remaining lifetime results via an OR operation and evaluates them. It forms the lower threshold, since the remaining lifetime is decremented with each trip by the corresponding number of operating cycles. If one of the three phase values drops below the threshold, a corresponding message will be triggered. A double-logarithmic diagram provided by the CB manufacturer illustrates the relationship of operating cycles and tripping current (see example in Figure 2-102). This diagram allows the number of yet possible trips to be determined (for tripping with equal tripping current). According to the example, approximately 1000 trips can
266
yet be carried out at a tripping current of 10 kA. The characteristic is determined by two vertices and their connecting line. Point P1 is determined by the number of permitted operating cycles at rated operating current Ir, point P2 by the maximum number of operating cycles at rated fault tripping current Isc. The associated four values can be configured.
Figure 2-102
As Figure 2-102 illustrates a double-log diagram, the straight line between P1 and P2 can be expressed by the following exponential function: n = bIbm where n is the number of operating cycles, b the operating cycles at Ib = 1A, Ib the tripping current, and m the directional coefficient. The general line equation for the double-logarithmic representation can be derived from the exponential function and leads to the coefficients b and m. Note Since a directional coefficient of m < -4 is technically irrelevant, but could theoretically be the result of incorrect settings, it is limited to -4. If a coefficient is smaller than -4, the exponential function in the operating cycles diagram is deactivated. The maximum number of operating cycles with Isc (263 OP.CYCLES Isc) is used instead as the calculation result for the current number of operating cycles, see Figure 2-103.
267
Figure 2-103
If the current criterion described in the Section General grants the phase-selective logic release, the present number of operating cycles is calculated based on the tripping currents determined when the CB operating time on tripping has elapsed. They are set off against the remaining lifetime allowing the present statistic values to be displayed and the evaluation to be started using the specified threshold. If one of the new values lies above the threshold, the message Thresh.R.Endu.< is generated. Three additional phase-selective statistic values are provided to determine the portion of purely mechanical trips among the results of the remaining lifetime (e.g. for phase A: mechan.TRIP A=). They act as counters which count only the trips whose tripping currents are below the value of the current criterion. I2t-Procedure During the I2t-procedure the squared fault current integral occurring per trip is added up phase-selectively. The integral is derived from the squared instantaneous values of the currents occurring during arc time of the circuit breaker. This results in: T CB arc = (parameter 266 T 52 BREAKTIME) (parameter 267 T 52 OPENING). The three sums of the calculated integrals are represented as statistic values referred to the squared device nominal current (Inom2). As with the other procedures, a threshold logically combines the three sums via an OR operation and evaluates them. The calculated squared tripping currrent integrals are added to the existing statistic values. Subsequently, threshold comparison is started using threshold I^2t>, and the new statistic values are output. If one of the values lies above the threshold, the message Thresh. I^2t> is generated.
268
Commissioning Usually, no measures are required for commissioning. However, should the protection device be exchanged (e.g. old circuit breaker and a new protection device), the initial values of the respective limit or statistical values must be determined via the switching statistics of the respective circuit breaker.
269
Figure 2-104
Current flow monitoring 212 BkrClosed I MIN, which some protective functions rely upon to detect a closed CB, is used as the current zero criterion. It should be set with respect to the actually used device functions (see also margin heading Current Flow Monitoring (CB) in Section 2.1.3.2.
270
I Procedure Being the basic function of summation current formation, the I-procedure is always active and does not require any additional settings. This is irrespective of the configuration in address 172 52 B.WEAR MONIT. This method does not offer integrated threshold evaluation. The latter could, however, be implemented using CFC. Ix Procedure Parameter 172 52 B.WEAR MONIT can be set to activate the Ix procedure. In order to facilitate evaluating the sum of all tripping current powers, the values are referred to the involuted CB rated operational current. This value is indicated in the CB data at address 260 Ir-52 in the P.System Data 1 and can be set as primary value. This reference allows the threshold of the Ix procedure to correspond to the maximum number of make-break operations. For a circuit breaker, whose contacts have not yet been worn, the maximum number of make-break operations can be entered directly as threshold. The exponent for the involution of the rated operational current and of the tripping currents is set at address 264 Ix EXPONENT. To meet different customer requirements, this exponent 264 Ix EXPONENT can be increased from 1.0 (default setting = 2.0) to 3.0. For the procedure to operate correctly, the time response of the circuit breaker must be specified in parameters 266 T 52 BREAKTIME and 267 T 52 OPENING. The summated values can be interpreted as the number of tripping operations at rated operational current of the CB. They are displayed in the statistical values without unit and with two decimal places. 2P-Procedure Parameter 172 52 B.WEAR MONIT can be set to activate the 2P procedure. An operating cycles diagram (see sample diagram in the functional description of the 2P procedure), provided by the manufacturer, shows the relationship of make-break operations and tripping current. The two vertices of this characteristic in a double logarithmic scale are decisive for the setting of addresses260 to 263: Point P1 is determined by the number of permitted make-break operations (parameter 261 OP.CYCLES AT Ir) for rated operational current Ir (parameter 260 Ir-52) Point P2 is determined by the maximum number of make-break operations (parameter 263 OP.CYCLES Isc) for rated fault tripping current Isc (parameter 262 Isc-52). For the procedure to operate correctly, the time response of the circuit breaker must be specified in parameters 266 T 52 BREAKTIME and 267 T 52 OPENING. I2t-Procedure The I2t-procedure is activated via configuration parameter 172 52 B.WEAR MONIT. The square fault current integrals are referred to the squared device nominal current. For purposes of determining the arc time, the device must be informed of the CB tripping time T 52 BREAKTIME as well as the CB opening time T 52 OPENING of the circuit breaker. For recognition of the last zero crossing (arc deletion) of the currents after tripping, the Current-zero Criterion is required.
271
272
2.20.3
Measurement
A series of measured values and the values derived from them are constantly available for call up on site, or for data transfer.
Applications Information on the actual status of the system Conversion of secondary values to primary values and percentages Prerequisites Except for secondary values, the device is able to indicate the primary values and percentages of the measured values. A precondition correct display of the primary and percentage values is the complete and correct entry of the nominal values for the instrument transformers and the protected equipment as well as current and voltage transformer ratios in the ground paths when configuring the device. The following table shows the formulas which are the basis for the conversion of secondary values to primary values and percentages. When using the capacitive voltage connection, or with the connection types Vab, Vbc or Vab, Vbc, Vx of the voltage transformers (address 213VT Connect. 3ph), the measured values for power P, Q, S, power factor, energy and the derived values, such as mean values etc. are not available. Measured values which cannot be calculated due to the selected voltage connection are shown as dots.
IN = measured IN sec value from the IN input INs (INs, I3I0real, I3I0reactive IN2 = measured value from the IE2 input VA, VB, VC, V0, V1, V2 INs sec.
IN2 sec.
VPh-N sec.
273
Measured values Vx
secondary Vx sec.
primary
P, Q, S (P and Q No secondary measured values phase-segregated) Power factor (phase-segregated) Frequency cos cos cos 100 in %
f in Hz
f in Hz
Table 2-21
Legend for the conversion formulae Parameter Address 202 203 204 205 206 232 233 Parameter Ignd-CT PRIM Ignd-CT SEC Ignd2-CT PRIM. Ignd2-CT SEC. FullScaleVolt. FullScaleCurr. 217 218 238 239 1101 1102 Address
Vnom PRIMARY Vnom SECONDARY CT PRIMARY CT SECONDARY Vph / Vdelta VXnom PRIMARY VXnom SECONDARY
Depending on the type of device ordered and the device connections, some of the operational measured values listed below may not be available. The phasetoGround voltages are either measured directly, if the voltage inputs are connected phasetoGround, or they are calculated from the phasetophase voltages VAB and VBC and the displacement voltage VN. The displacement voltage VN is either measured directly or calculated from the phase-to-Ground voltages:
Please note that value V0 is indicated in the operational measured values. The ground current IN is either measured directly or calculated from the conductor currents.
274
In addition, the following may be available: / Trip thermal measured value of overload protection value for stator in % of the trip initiating overtemperature / LTrip thermal measured value of restart inhibit (rotor winding) Restart restarting limit of restart inhibit TReclose total time, before the motor can be restarted RTD 1 to RTD 12 temperature values at the RTD box. Upon delivery, the power and operating values are set in such manner that power in line direction is positive. Active components in line direction and inductive reactive components in line direction are also positive. The same applies to the power factor cos. It is occasionally desired to define the power drawn from the line (e.g. as seen from the consumer) positively. Using parameter 1108 P,Q sign the signs for these components can be inverted. The calculation of the operational measured values also takes place while a fault is running. The values are updated at intervals of > 0.3 s and < 1 s.
275
276
No. 16031 30701 30702 30703 30704 30705 30706 30707 30708 30709 30800 30801
Type of Information MV MV MV MV MV MV MV MV MV MV MV MV
Comments Angle between 3Vo and INsens. Pa (active power, phase A) Pb (active power, phase B) Pc (active power, phase C) Qa (reactive power, phase A) Qb (reactive power, phase B) Qc (reactive power, phase C) Power Factor, phase A Power Factor, phase B Power Factor, phase C Voltage VX Voltage phase-neutral
2.20.4
Average Measurements
The long-term averages are calculated and output by the 7SK80.
2.20.4.1 Description
Long-Term Averages The long-term averages of the three phase currents Ix, the positive sequence components I1 for the three phase currents, and the real power P, reactive power Q, and apparent power S are calculated within a set period of time and indicated in primary values. For the long-term averages mentioned above, the length of the time window for averaging and the frequency with which it is updated can be set.
277
2.20.4.3 Settings
Addr. 8301 Parameter DMD Interval Setting Options 15 Min., 1 Sub 15 Min., 3 Subs 15 Min.,15 Subs 30 Min., 1 Sub 60 Min., 1 Sub 60 Min.,10 Subs 5 Min., 5 Subs On The Hour 15 After Hour 30 After Hour 45 After Hour Default Setting 60 Min., 1 Sub Comments Demand Calculation Intervals
8302
DMD Sync.Time
On The Hour
2.20.5
2.20.5.1 Description
Minimum and Maximum Values The minimum and maximum values for the three phase currents Ix, the three phase-to-ground voltages Vxg, the three phase-to-phase voltages Vxy, the positive sequence components I1 and V1, the displacement voltage V0, the thermal measured value of overload protection /off, the real power P, reactive power Q, and apparent power S, the frequency; and the power factor cos are calculated as primary values (including the date and time they were last updated). The minimum and maximum values of the long-term averages listed in the previous section are also calculated. The minimum and maximum values can be reset at any time via binary inputs or by using the integrated control panel or the DIGSI software. Additionally, the reset can be carried out cyclically, starting at a preset point of time.
278
2.20.5.3 Settings
Addr. 8311 8312 8313 8314 Parameter MinMax cycRESET MiMa RESET TIME MiMa RESETCYCLE MinMaxRES.START NO YES 0 .. 1439 min 1 .. 365 Days 1 .. 365 Days Setting Options Default Setting YES 0 min 7 Days 1 Days Comments Automatic Cyclic Reset Function MinMax Reset Timer MinMax Reset Cycle Period MinMax Start Reset Cycle in
279
No. 844 845 846 847 848 849 850 851 852 853 854 855 856 857 858 859 860 861 862 863 864 865 867 868 869 870 871 872 873 874 875 876 877 878 879 880 881 882 883 884 885 1058 1059 I1dmdMax PdMin= PdMax= QdMin= QdMax= SdMin= SdMax= Ia Min= Ia Max= Ib Min= Ib Max= Ic Min= Ic Max= I1 Min= I1 Max= Va-nMin= Va-nMax= Vb-nMin= Vb-nMax= Vc-nMin= Vc-nMax= Va-bMin= Va-bMax= Vb-cMin= Vb-cMax= Vc-aMin= Vc-aMax= Vn Min = Vn Max = V1 Min = V1 Max = Pmin= Pmax= Qmin= Qmax= Smin= Smax= fmin= fmax= PF Max= PF Min=
Information
Type of Information MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT MVT
Comments I1 (positive sequence) Demand Maximum Active Power Demand Minimum Active Power Demand Maximum Reactive Power Minimum Reactive Power Maximum Apparent Power Minimum Apparent Power Maximum Ia Min Ia Max Ib Min Ib Max Ic Min Ic Max I1 (positive sequence) Minimum I1 (positive sequence) Maximum Va-n Min Va-n Max Vb-n Min Vb-n Max Vc-n Min Vc-n Max Va-b Min Va-b Max Vb-c Min Vb-c Max Vc-a Min Vc-a Max V neutral Min V neutral Max V1 (positive sequence) Voltage Minimum V1 (positive sequence) Voltage Maximum Active Power Minimum Active Power Maximum Reactive Power Minimum Reactive Power Maximum Apparent Power Minimum Apparent Power Maximum Frequency Minimum Frequency Maximum Power Factor Maximum Power Factor Minimum Overload Meter Max Overload Meter Min
/TrpMax= /TrpMin=
280
2.20.6
Applications This monitoring program works with multiple measurement repetitions and a lower priority than the protection functions. Therefore, it may not pick up if measured values are changed spontaneously in the event of a fault, before a pickup or tripping of the protection function occurs. This monitoring program is therefore absolutely unsuitable for blocking protection functions.
281
2.20.7
2.20.7.1 Description
For the statistical counters, limit values may be entered so that a message is generated as soon as they are reached. These messages can be allocated to both output relays and LEDs.
282
2.20.8
Energy Metering
Metered values for active and reactive energy are determined by the device. They can be output via the display of the device, read out with DIGSI via the operator interface or transmitted to a control center via port B.
2.20.8.1 Description
Metered Values for Active and Reactive Energy Metered values of the real power Wp and reactive power (Wq) are acquired in kilowatt, megawatt or gigawatt hours primary or in kVARh, MVARh or GVARh primary, separately according to the input (+) and output (), or capacitive and inductive. The measured-value resolution can be configured. The signs of the measured values appear as configured in address 1108 P,Q sign (see Section Display of Measured Values).
2.20.8.3 Settings
Addr. 8315 Parameter MeterResolution Setting Options Standard Factor 10 Factor 100 Default Setting Standard Comments Meter resolution
283
2.20.9
Commissioning Aids
In test mode or during commissioning, the device information transmitted to a central or storage device can be influenced. There are tools available for testing the system interface (port B) and the binary inputs and outputs of the device.
Applications Test Mode Commissioning Prerequisites In order to be able to use the commissioning aids described in the following, the device must be connected to a control center via port B.
2.20.9.1 Description
Influencing Information to the Control Center During Test Mode Some of the available protocols allow for identifying all messages and measured values transmitted to the control center with "test mode" as the message cause while the device is tested on site. This identification prevents the message from being incorrectly interpreted as resulting from an actual fault. Moreover, a transmission block can be set during the test so that no messages are transferred to the control center. This can be implemented via binary inputs, using the interface on the device front and a PC. The SIPROTEC 4 System Description states in detail how to activate and deactivate test mode and blocked data transmission. Testing the Connection to a Control Center Via the DIGSI device control it can be tested whether messages are transmitted correctly. A dialog box shows the display texts of all messages which were allocated to the system interface (port B) in the DIGSI matrix. In another column of the dialog box, a value for the messages to be tested can be defined (e.g. message ON / message OFF). After having entered password no. 6 (for hardware test menus), the corresponding message is issued and can be read out in the event log of the SIPROTEC 4 device and in the substation control center. The procedure is described in detail in Chapter "Mounting and Commissioning". Checking the Binary Inputs and Outputs The binary inputs, outputs, and LEDs of a SIPROTEC 4 device can be individually and precisely controlled in DIGSI. This feature can be used, for example, to verify control wiring from the device to substation equipment (operational checks), during start-up. A dialog box shows all binary inputs and outputs as well as LEDs of the device with their present status. The operating equipment, commands, or messages that are configured (masked) to the hardware components are also displayed. After having entered password no. 6 (for hardware test menus), it is possible to switch to the opposite status in another column of the dialog box. Thus, you can energize every single output relay to check the wiring between protected device and the system without having to create the alarm allocated to it. The procedure is described in detail in Chapter "Mounting and Commissioning".
284
Creating Oscillographic Recordings for Tests During commissioning, energization sequences should be carried out to check the stability of the protection also during closing operations. Oscillographic event recordings contain the maximum information on the behavior of the protection. Along with the capability of storing fault recordings via pickup of the protection function, the 7SK80 also has the capability of capturing the same data when commands are given to the device via the service program DIGSI, the serial interface, or a binary input. For the latter, event >Trig.Wave.Cap. must be allocated to a binary input. Triggering for the oscillographic recording then occurs, for instance, via the binary input when the protection object is energized. An oscillographic recording that is triggered externally (that is, without a protective element pickup) are processed by the device as a normal oscillographic record. For each oscillographic record a fault record is created which is given its individual number to ensure that assignment can be made properly. However, these oscillographic recordings are not displayed in the fault log buffer in the display as they are no network fault events. The procedure is described in detail in Chapter "Mounting and Commissioning".
285
2.21
Command Processing
A control command function is integrated in the SIPROTEC 4 7SK80 to coordinate the operation of circuit breakers and other equipment in the power system. Control commands can originate from four command sources: Local control at the device's operator panel Operation using DIGSI Remote control via network control center or substation controller (e.g. SICAM) Automatic functions (e.g., via binary input) Switchgear with single and multiple busbars are supported. The number of switchgear devices to be controlled is limited only by the number of binary inputs and outputs. Interlocking checks ensure high security against maloperation and a multitude of switchgear types and operating modes are available.
2.21.1
Control Device
Switchgear can also be controlled via the device's operator panel, DIGSI or a connection to the substation control equipment.
Applications Switchgear with single and double busbars Prerequisites The number of switchgear devices to be controlled is limited by the existing binary inputs existing binary outputs.
2.21.1.1 Description
Operation Using the Device's Operator Panel For controlling the device, there are two independent colored keys located below the graphic display. If you are somewhere in the menu system outside the control submenu, you can return to the control mode via one of these keys. Then, select the switchgear to be operated with the help of the navigation keys. The switching direction is determined by operating the I or O pushbutton. The selected switching direction is displayed flashing in the bottom line of the following security prompt. Password and security prompts prevent unintended switching operations. With ENTER the entries are confirmed. Cancellation is possible at any time before the control command is issued or during switch selection via the ESC key. Command end, feedback or any violation of the interlocking conditions are indicated. For further information on the device operation, please refer to Chapter 2.22.
286
Operation using DIGSI Switchgear can be controlled via the operator control interface with a PC using the DIGSI software. The procedure to do so is described in the SIPROTEC 4 System Description (Control of Switchgear). Operation Using the System Interface Switchgear can be controlled via the serial system interface and a connection to the substation control equipment. For that it is necessary that the required periphery is physically existing in the device as well as in the substation. Furthermore, certain settings for the serial interface need to be made in the device (see SIPROTEC 4 System Description).
287
2.21.2
Command Types
In conjunction with the power system control several command types can be distinguished for the device:
2.21.2.1 Description
Commands to the Process These are all commands that are directly output to the switchgear to change their process state: Switching commands for controlling the circuit breakers (not synchronized), disconnectors and ground electrodes Step commands, e.g. raising and lowering transformer LTCs Set-point commands with configurable time settings, e.g. to control Petersen coils Internal / Pseudo Commands They do not directly operate binary outputs. They serve to initiate internal functions, simulate changes of state, or to acknowledge changes of state. Manual overriding commands to manually update information on process-dependent objects such as annunciations and switching states, e.g. if the communication with the process is interrupted. Manually overridden objects are flagged as such in the information status and can be displayed accordingly. Tagging commands (for "setting") of the information value of internal objects, for example switching authority (remote/local), settings group switching, data transmission block and deleting/presetting metered values. Acknowledgment and resetting commands for setting and resetting internal buffers or data states. Information status command to set/reset the additional information "information status" of a process object, such as: Input blocking Output blocking
288
2.21.3
Command Sequence
Safety mechanisms in the command sequence ensure that a command can only be released after a thorough check of preset criteria has been successfully concluded. Standard Interlocking checks are provided for each individual control command. Additionally, user-defined interlocking conditions can be programmed separately for each command. The actual execution of the command is also monitored afterwards. The overall command task procedure is described in brief in the following list:
2.21.3.1 Description
Check Sequence Please observe the following: Command Entry, e.g. using the keypad on the local user interface of the device Check Password Access Rights Check Switching Mode (interlocking activated/deactivated) Selection of Deactivated interlocking Recognition. User configurable interlocking checks Switching Authority Device Position Check (set vs. actual comparison) Interlocking, Zone Controlled (logic using CFC) System Interlocking (centrally, using SCADA system or substation controller) Double Operation (interlocking against parallel switching operation) Protection Blocking (blocking of switching operations by protective functions). Fixed Command Checks Internal Process Time (software watch dog which checks the time for processing the control action between initiation of the control and final close of the relay contact) Setting Modification in Process (if setting modification is in process, commands are denied or delayed) Operating equipment enabled as output (if an operating equipment component was configured, but not configured to a binary input, the command is denied) Output Block (if an output block has been programmed for the circuit breaker, and is active at the moment the command is processed, then the command is denied) Board Hardware Error Command in Progress (only one command can be processed at a time for one operating equipment, object-related Double Operation Block) 1-of-n-check (for schemes with multiple assignments, such as relays contact sharing a common terminal a check is made if a command is already active for this set of output relays). Monitoring the Command Execution The following is monitored: Interruption of a command because of a Cancel Command Runtime Monitor (feedback message monitoring time)
289
2.21.4
Interlocking
System interlocking is executed by the user-defined logic (CFC).
2.21.4.1 Description
Interlocking checks in a SICAM / SIPROTEC 4 system are normally divided in the following groups: System interlocking relies on the system data base in the substation or central control system. Bay interlocking relies on the object data base (feedbacks) of the bay unit. Cross-bay interlocking via GOOSE messages directly between bay units and protection relays (inter-relay communication with GOOSE is accomplished via the EN100 module). The extent of the interlocking checks is determined by the configuration of the relay. To obtain more information about GOOSE, please refer to the SIPROTEC 4 System Description /1/. Switching objects that require system interlocking in a central control system are assigned to a specific parameter inside the bay unit (via configuration matrix). For all commands, operation with interlocking (normal mode) or without interlocking (Interlocking OFF) can be selected: For local commands by reprogramming the settings with password prompt For automatic commands, via command processing. by CFC and deactivated interlocking recognition, For local / remote commands, using an additional interlocking disable command, via Profibus. Interlocked / Non-Interlocked Switching The configurable command checks in the SIPROTEC 4 devices are also called "standard interlocking". These checks can be activated via DIGSI (interlocked switching/tagging) or deactivated (non-interlocked). Deactivated interlock switching means the configured interlocking conditions are not checked in the relay. Interlocked switching means that all configured interlocking conditions are checked within the command processing. If a condition is not fulfilled, the command will be rejected by a message with a minus added to it (e.g. "CO"), immediately followed by a message. The following table shows the possible types of commands in a switching device and their corresponding annunciations. For the device the messages designated with *) are displayed in the event logs, for DIGSI they appear in spontaneous messages. Type of Command Control issued Manual tagging (positive / negative) Information state command, input blocking Information state command, output blocking Cancel command Command Switching Manual tagging Input blocking Output blocking Cancel CO MT ST ST CA Cause Message CO+/ MT+/ ST+/ *) ST+/ *) CA+/
The "plus" appearing in the message is a confirmation of the command execution. The command execution was as expected, in other words positive. The minus sign means a negative confirmation, the command was rejected. Possible command feedbacks and their causes are dealt with in the SIPROTEC 4 System Description. The following figure shows operational indications relating to command execution and operation response information for successful switching of the circuit breaker. The check of interlocking can be programmed separately for all switching devices and tags that were set with a tagging command. Other internal commands such as manual entry or abort are not checked, i.e. carried out independent of the interlocking.
290
Figure 2-105
Standard Interlocking (default) The standard interlockings contain the following fixed programmed tests for each switching device, which can be individually enabled or disabled using parameters: Device Status Check (set = actual): The switching command is rejected, and an error indication is displayed if the circuit breaker is already in the set position. (If this check is enabled, then it works whether interlocking, e.g. zone controlled, is activated or deactivated.) This condition is checked in both interlocked and non-interlocked status modes. System Interlocking: To check the power system interlocking, a local command is transmitted to the central unit with Switching Authority = LOCAL. A switching device that is subject to system interlocking cannot be switched by DIGSI. Zone control: User-specific logic links created with CFC are interrogated and considered during interlocked switching. Blocking by Protection: Switch-ON commands are rejected with interlocked switches, as soon as one of the protection functions of the unit has opened a fault case. The OPEN-command, by contrast, can always be executed. Please be aware, activation of thermal overload protection elements or sensitive ground fault detection can create and maintain a fault condition status, and can therefore block CLOSE commands. If the interlocking is removed, consider that, on the other hand, the restart inhibit for motors will not automatically reject a CLOSE command to the motor. Therefore, a restart inhibit must be provided by other means, e.g. by a bay interlocking using CFC. Double Operation Block: Parallel switching operations are interlocked against one another; while one command is processed, a second cannot be carried out. Switching Authority LOCAL: A switch command from local control (command with source LOCAL) is only allowed if local control is enabled at the device (by configuration). Switching Authority DIGSI: Switching commands that are issued locally or remotely via DIGSI (command with source DIGSI) are only allowed if remote control is enabled at the device (by configuration). If a DIGSI computer logs on to the device, it leaves a Virtual Device Number (VD). Only commands with this VD (when Switching Authority = REMOTE) will be accepted by the device. Remote switching commands will be rejected. Switching authority REMOTE: A remote switch command (command with source REMOTE) is only allowed if remote control is enabled at the device (by configuration).
291
Figure 2-106
Standard interlockings
292
The following figure shows the configuration of the interlocking conditions using DIGSI.
Figure 2-107
The configured interlocking causes are displayed on the device display. They are marked by letters explained in the following table. Table 2-22 Command types and corresponding messages Interlocking Commands Switching Authority System interlocking Zone controlled SET = ACTUAL (switch direction check) Protection blocking Abbrev. L S Z P B Display L A Z P B
Control Logic using CFC For bay interlocking, a release logic can be created using CFC. Via specific release conditions the information "released" or "bay interlocked" are available (e.g. object "52 Close" and "52 Open" with the data values: ON/OFF).
293
Switching Authority The interlocking condition "Switching authority" serves for determining the switching authority. It enables the user to select the authorized command source. The following switching authority ranges are defined in the following priority sequence: LOCAL DIGSI REMOTE The "Switching authority" object serves for interlocking or enabling LOCAL control but not REMOTE or DIGSI commands. With a 7SK80, the switching authority can be changed between "REMOTE" and "LOCAL" on the operator panel after having entered the password or by means of CFC also via binary inputs and a function key. The "Switching authority DIGSI" object is used for interlocking or enabling operation via DIGSI. This allows for local as well as remote DIGSI connections. When a (local or remote) DIGSI PC logs on to the device, it enters its virtual device number (VD). Only commands with this VD (when switching authority = OFF or REMOTE) are accepted by the device. When the DIGSI PC logs off again, the VD is canceled. Commands are checked for their source CS and the device settings and compared to the current status set in the objects "Switching authority" and "Switching authority DIGSI". Configuration Switching authority available Switching authority DIGSI available: Specific device (e.g. switchgear) Specific device (e.g. switchgear) y/n (create appropriate object) y/n (create appropriate object) Switching authority LOCAL (check for LOCAL status): y/n Switching authority REMOTE (check for LOCAL, REMOTE or DIGSI commands): y/n
Table 2-23
Interlocking logic Command issued with CS=LOCAL or REMOTE Interlocked 2) - "Switching authority LOCAL" Interlocked 2) - "Switching authority LOCAL" Command issued with CS=DIGSI
Current switching Switching authority DIGSI Command issued authority status with CS3)=LOCAL LOCAL (ON) LOCAL (ON) Not registered Registered Enabled Enabled
Interlocked - "DIGSI not registered" Interlocked 2) "Switching authority LOCAL" Interlocked - "DIGSI not registered" Enabled
REMOTE (OFF)
Not registered
Interlocked 1) Enabled "Switching authority REMOTE" Interlocked 1) Interlocked 2) - "Switching "Switching authority authority DIGSI" DIGSI"
REMOTE (OFF)
Registered
1) 2) 3)
also "Enabled" for: "Switching Authority LOCAL (check for LOCAL status): n" also "Enabled" for: "Switching authority REMOTE (check for LOCAL, REMOTE or DIGSI commands): n" CS = command source
CS = Auto: Commands that are initiated internally (command processing in the CFC) are not subject to the switching authority and are therefore always "enabled".
294
Switching Mode The switching mode serves for activating or deactivating the configured interlocking conditions at the time of the switching operation. The following switching modes (local) are defined: For local commands (CS = LOCAL) locked (normal) or unlocked (unlatched) switching. With a 7SK80, the switching mode can be changed between "locked" and "unlocked" on the operator panel after having entered the password or by means of CFC also via binary inputs and a function key. The following switching modes (remote) are defined: For remote or DIGSI commands (CS = LOCAL, REMOTE or DIGSI) locked or unlocked (unlatched) switching. Here, deactivation of the interlocking is accomplished via a separate unlocking command. For commands from CFC (CS = Auto), please observe the notes in the CFC manual (component: BOOL to command). Zone Controlled / Field Interlocking Zone controlled / field interlocking (e.g. via CFC) includes the verification that predetermined switchgear position conditions are satisfied to prevent switching errors (e.g. disconnector vs. ground switch, ground switch only if no voltage applied) as well as verification of the state of other mechanical interlocking in the switchgear bay (e.g. High Voltage compartment doors). Interlocking conditions can be programmed separately, for each switching device, for device control CLOSE and/or OPEN. The enable information with the data "switching device is interlocked (OFF/NV/FLT) or enabled (ON)" can be set up, directly, using a single-point or double-point indication or internal message (tagging), or by means of a control logic via CFC. When a switching command is initiated, the actual status is scanned cyclically. The assignment is done via "Release object CLOSE/OPEN". System Interlocking Substation Controller (System interlocking) involves switchgear conditions of other bays evaluated by a central control system. Double Activation Blockage Parallel switching operations are interlocked. As soon as the command has arrived all command objects subject to the interlocking are checked to know whether a command is being processed. While the command is being executed, interlocking is enabled for other commands.
295
Blocking by Protection The pickup of protective elements blocks switching operations. Protective elements are configured, separately for each switching component, to block specific switching commands sent in CLOSE and TRIP direction. When enabled, "Block CLOSE commands" blocks CLOSE commands, whereas "Block TRIP commands" blocks TRIP signals. Switching operations in progress will immediately be aborted by the pickup of a protective element. Device Status Check (set = actual) For switching commands, a check takes place whether the selected switching device is already in the set/desired position (set/actual comparison). This means, if a circuit breaker is already in the CLOSED position and an attempt is made to issue a closing command, the command will be refused, with the operating message "set condition equals actual condition". If the circuit breaker / switchgear device is in the intermediate position, then this check is not performed. bypassing interlocks Bypassing configured interlockings at the time of the switching action happens device-internal via interlocking recognition in the command job or globally via so-called switching modes. SC=LOCAL The user can switch between the modes interlocked or non-interlocked (bypassed) in the operator panel after entering the password or using CFC via binary input and function key. REMOTE and DIGSI Commands issued by SICAM or DIGSI are unlocked via a global switching mode REMOTE. A separate request must be sent for the unlocking. The unlocking applies only for one switching operation and for commands caused by the same source. Job order: command to object "Switching mode REMOTE", ON Job order: switching command to "switching device" Command via CFC (automatic command, SC=Auto SICAM): Behavior configured in the CFC block ("BOOL to command").
296
2.21.5
Command Logging
During the processing of the commands, independent of the further message routing and processing, command and process feedback information are sent to the message processing center. These messages contain information on the cause. With the corresponding allocation (configuration) these messages are entered in the event list, thus serving as a report.
Prerequisites A listing of possible operating messages and their meaning as well as the command types needed for tripping and closing of the switchgear or for raising and lowering of transformer taps are described in the SIPROTEC 4 System Description.
2.21.5.1 Description
Acknowledgment of Commands to the Device Front All messages with the source of command LOCAL are transformed into a corresponding response and shown in the display of the device. Acknowledgment of commands to Local / Remote / Digsi The acknowledgment of messages with source of command Local/ Remote/DIGSI are sent back to the initiating point independent of the routing (configuration on the serial digital interface). The acknowledgment of commands is therefore not executed by a response indication as it is done with the local command but by ordinary command and feedback information recording. Monitoring of Feedback Information The processing of commands monitors the command execution and timing of feedback information for all commands. At the same time the command is sent, the monitoring time is started (monitoring of the command execution). This time controls whether the device achieves the required final result within the monitoring time. The monitoring time is stopped as soon as the feedback information arrives. If no feedback information arrives, a response "Timeout command monitoring time" appears and the process is terminated. Commands and information feedback are also recorded in the event list. Normally the execution of a command is terminated as soon as the feedback information (FB+) of the relevant switchgear arrives or, in case of commands without process feedback information, the command output resets and a message is output. The "plus" sign appearing in a feedback information confirms that the command was successful. The command was as expected, in other words positive. The "minus" is a negative confirmation and means that the command was not executed as expected. Command Output and Switching Relays The command types needed for tripping and closing of the switchgear or for raising and lowering of transformer taps are described in the configuration section of the SIPROTEC 4 System Description /1/ .
297
2.22
2.22.1
Different operation
Pushbuttons of the Control Panels Pushbutton Function/meaning Confirming entries and navigating forward in the menus Navigating to the main menu (where necessary, press repeatedly), navigating backwards in the menus, discarding entries Testing the LEDs Resetting the LED memory and binary outputs Function key Fn for displaying the assignment of the function keys. If several function keys have been assigned, a second page is displayed for the assignment when leafing through, if required. Combined pushbutton with numeric keys for a faster navigation (e.g. Fn + 1 operational messages) Navigation to the main menu with Fn in combination with the numeric key 0. For setting the contrast, keep the pushbutton pressed for about 5 seconds. Set the contrast in the menu with the scrolling keys (downward: less contrast, upward: more contrast).
Entry of Negative Signs Only a few parameters can reach a negative value, i.e. a negative sign can only be entered for these. If a negative sign is permissible, the prompt -/+ --> v/^ appears in the bottom line when changing the parameter. The sign can be determined via the scrolling keys: downward = negative sign, upward = positive sign. Display The SIPROTEC 4 System Description applies to devices with a 4-line ASCII display. Apart from that there are devices with a graphical display and a size of 30 lines. The 7SK80 uses the outputs of the graphical display, but with 6 lines. Therefore, the representation might differ from the representations in the System Description. The basic differences of the device with regard to the representation are the following: The current selection is indicated by inverse representation (not by the prefix >)
Figure 2-108
298
In part, the sixth line is used for representing e.g. the active parameter group.
Figure 2-109
299
300
This chapter is intended for experienced commissioning staff. He must be familiar with the commissioning of protection and control systems, the management of power systems and the safety rules and regulations. Hardware adjustments to the power system data might be necessary. The primary tests require the protected object (line, transformer, etc.) to carry load.
Mounting and Connections Checking Connections Commissioning Final Preparation of the Device
301
3.1
General
WARNING!
Warning of improper transport, storage, installation or assembly of the device. Failure to observe these precautions can result in death, personal injury, or serious material damage. Trouble-free and safe use of this device depends on proper transport, storage, installation, and assembly of the device according to the warnings in this device manual. Of particular importance are the general installation and safety regulations for work in a high-voltage environment (for example, ANSI, IEC, EN, DIN, or other national and international regulations). These regulations must be observed.
3.1.1
Configuration Information
Prerequisites For installation and connections the following conditions must be met: The rated device data have been checked as recommended in the SIPROTEC 4 System Description. It has been verified that these data comply with the power system data. General Diagrams Block diagrams for the terminal assignment of the 7SK80 are shown in Appendix A.2. Connection examples for the current and voltage transformer circuits are provided in Appendix A.3. Voltage Connection Examples Connection examples for voltage transformers are provided in Appendix A.3. It must be checked that the configuration of the Power System Data 1 (Section 2.1.3.2) corresponds with the connections. The normal connection is set at address 213 VT Connect. 3ph = Van, Vbn, Vcn. When connecting an open delta winding of the voltage transformer set, address 213 VT Connect. 3ph must be set to Vab, Vbc, VGnd. Another example shows the connection mode 213 = Vab, Vbc, Vx. The voltage connected to the third transformer Vx is only used by the flexible protection functions. Furthermore, you will find connection examples for Vab, Vbc. Binary Inputs and Outputs The configuration options of the binary in- and outputs, i.e. the procedure for the individual adaptation to the plant conditions, are described in the SIPROTEC 4 System Description. The connections to the plant are dependent on this configuration. The presettings of the device are listed in Appendix A.5. Please also check that the labeling strips on the front panel correspond to the configured message functions.
302
Setting Group Change Function If binary inputs are used to switch setting groups, please observe the following: Two binary inputs must be dedicated to the purpose of changing setting groups when four groups are to be switched. One binary input must be set for >Set Group Bit0, the other input for >Set Group Bit1. If either of these input functions is not assigned, then it is considered as not controlled. For the control of 2 setting groups one binary input is sufficient, namely >Set Group Bit0, since the non-assigned binary input >Set Group Bit1 is then regarded as not connected. The control signals must be permanently active so that the selected setting group is and remains active. The following table shows the allocation of the binary inputs to the setting groups A to D and a simplified connection diagram for the two binary inputs is illustrated in the following figure. The figure illustrates an example in which both Set Group Bits 0 and 1 are configured to be controlled (actuated) when the associated binary input is energized (high). Where: no = yes = Table 3-1 not energized or not connected energized Changing setting groups using binary inputs Binary Input >Set Group Bit 0 No Yes No Yes >Set Group Bit 1 No No Yes Yes Group A Group B Group C Group D Active Group
Figure 3-1
Connection diagram (example) for setting group switching using binary inputs
Trip Circuit Supervision Please note that two binary inputs or one binary input and one bypass resistor R must be connected in series. The pick-up threshold of the binary inputs must therefore stay substantially below half the rated control DC voltage. If one binary input is used, a bypass resistor R must be used (see following figure). The resistor R is inserted into the circuit of the 52b circuit breaker auxiliary contact to facilitate the detection of a malfunction also when the 52a circuit breaker auxiliary contact is open and the trip contact has dropped out. The value of this resistor must be such that in the circuit breaker open condition (therefore 52a is open and 52b is closed), the circuit breaker trip coil (52TC) is no longer energized and binary input (BI1) is still energized if the command relay contact is open.
303
Figure 3-2
This results in an upper limit for the resistance dimension, Rmax, and a lower limit Rmin, from which the optimal value of the arithmetic mean R should be selected:
In order that the minimum voltage for controlling the binary input is ensured, Rmax is derived as:
So the circuit breaker trip coil does not remain energized in the above case, Rmin is derived as:
Constant current with activated BI ( = 0.25 mA) Minimum control voltage for BI (= 19 V at delivery setting for nominal voltages of 24 V/ 48 V; 88 V at delivery setting for nominal voltages of 60 V/ 110 V/ 125 V/ 220 V/ 250 V) Control voltage for trip circuit Ohmic resistance of the circuit breaker coil Maximum voltage on the circuit breaker coil that does not lead to tripping
304
If the calculation has the result Rmax < Rmin, the calculation has to be repeated with the next smaller threshold VBI min. This threshold is determined via the parameters 220 Threshold BI 1 to 226 Threshold BI 7 The settings Thresh. BI 176V, Thresh. BI 88V, Thresh. BI 19V are possible. For the power consumption of the resistance:
Example IBI (HIGH) VBI min VCTR RCBTC VCBTC (LOW) 0.25 mA (SIPROTEC 4 7SK80) 19 V at delivery setting for nominal voltages of 24 V/ 48 V; 88 V at delivery setting for nominal voltages of 60 V/ 110 V/ 125 V/ 220 V/ 250 V) 110 V (from the system / trip circuit) 500 (from the system / trip circuit) 2 V (from the system / trip circuit)
The closest standard value 200 k is selected; the following applies for the power:
305
3.1.2
Hardware Modifications
3.1.2.1 Disassembly
Work on the Printed Circuit Boards Note Before carrying out the following steps, make sure that the device is not operative.
Note Apart from the communication modules and the fuse, there are no further components that can be configured or operated by the user inside the device. Any service activities exceeding the installation or exchange of communication modules must only be carried out by Siemens personnel.
For preparing the workplace, a pad suitable for electrostatic sensitive devices (ESD) is required. Additionally, the following tools are required: a screwdriver with a 5 mm to 6 mm (0.20 0.24 in) wide blade, a Philips screwdriver size 1, a 5 mm (0.20 in) socket or nut driver In order to disassemble the device, first remove it from the substation installation. To do so, perform the steps stated in Sections Panel Flush Mounting, Panel Surface Mounting or Cubicle Mounting in reverse order. Note The following must absolutely be observed: Disconnect the communication connections at the device bottom (ports A and B). If this is not observed, the communication lines and/or the device might be destroyed.
Note To use the device, all terminal blocks must be plugged in.
Caution!
Mind electrostatic discharges Failure to observe these precautions can result in personal injury or material damage. Any electrostatic discharges while working at the electronics block are to be avoided. We recommend ESD protective equipment (grounding strap, conductive grounded shoes, ESD-suitable clothing, etc.). Alternatively, an electrostatic charge is to be discharged by touching grounded metal parts.
306
Note In order to minimize the expenditure for reconnecting the device, remove the completely wired terminal blocks from the device. To do so, open the elastic holders of the terminal blocks in pairs with a flat screwdriver and remove the terminal blocks to the back. When reinstalling the device, insert the terminal blocks back into the device like assembled terminals (Sections Panel Flush Mounting, Panel Surface Mounting or Cubicle Mounting).
In order to install or exchange communication modules or to replace the fuse, proceed as follows: Remove the two covers at the top and bottom. Thus, 1 housing screw each at the top and bottom becomes accessible. First, only unscrew the bottom housing screw so far that its tip no longer looks out of the thread of the mounting bracket (the housing screws are captive, they remain in the front cover even when unscrewed). Unscrew all screws that fasten any existing communication modules in the module cover on the bottom side of the device. Also unscrew the 4 countersunk screws that fasten the module cover on the bottom side of the device. Carefully pull the entire module cover out of the device. Only now completely unscrew the two housing screws at the top and bottom in the cover and carefully remove the complete electronics block from the housing (Figure 3-3). Note If you have not removed the terminal blocks from the rear panel, much more force is required for removing and reinstalling the electronics block, which might lead to the damaging of the device. Therefore, we absolutely recommend to remove the terminal blocks before removing the electronics block.
Figure 3-3
307
Replacing the Fuse The fuse holder is located at the edge of the basic I/O board close to the power supply connection.
Figure 3-4
Remove the defective fuse. Insert the new fuse with the following technical data into the fuse holder: 5 mm x 20 mm (0.20 * 0.79 in) safety fuse T characteristic 2.0 A nominal current 250 V nominal voltage Switching capability 1500 VA/ 300 VDC Only UL-approved fuses may be used. This data applies to all device types (24 V/48 V and 60 V 250 V). Make sure that the defective fuse has not left any obvious damage on the device. If the fuse trips again after reconnection of the device, refrain from any further repairs and send the device to Siemens for repair. The device can now be reassembled again (see Section Reassembly).
308
Figure 3-5
Ring lug
For complying with the required insulation clearances, insulated ring lugs have to be used. Otherwise, the crimp zone has to be insulated with corresponding means (e.g. by pulling a shrink-on sleeve over). We recommend ring lugs of the PIDG range from Tyco Electronics. Two ring lugs can be mounted per connection.
Figure 3-6
As single wires, solid conductors as well as stranded conductors with conductor sleeves can be used. Up to two single wires with identical cross-sections can be used per connection.
309
Alternatively jumpers (Order No. C53207-A406-D193-1) can be used with terminal points in a stacked arrangement. When using jumpers, only ring lugs are allowed. When connecting single wires, the following cross-sections are allowed: Cable cross-section: Connector sleeve with plastic collar Stripping length: (when used without conductor sleeve) AWG 14-10 (2.0 mm2 to 5.2 mm2) L = 10 mm (0.39 in) or L = 12 mm (0.47 in) 15 mm (0.59 in) Use exclusively solid copper conductors.
Mechanical Requirements The fixing elements and the connected components are designed for the following mechanical requirements: Permissible tightening torque at the terminal screw 2.7 Nm (23.9 lb.in) With solid conducters the allowed maximum tighting torque is 2 Nm 80 N based on IEC 60947-1 (VDE 660, Part 100)
With terminal points lying one below the other you may connect single conductors and jumpers (Order No. C53207-A406-D194-1) together. Please make sure that neighboring jumpers are built in/connected alternately. Mechanical Requirements The fixing elements and the connected components are designed for the following mechanical requirements: Permissible tightening torque at the terminal screw Permissible traction per connected conductor 1.0 Nm (8.85 lb.in) 50 N based on IEC 60947-1 (VDE 660, Part 100)
310
311
Figure 3-7
Cable connection
312
Figure 3-8
313
Figure 3-9
Figure 3-10
Now, a SIPROTEC 4 communication module can be installed (see Section Installation or Replacement of a SIPROTEC 4 Communication Module). Otherwise, the device can be reassembled again (see Section Reassembly). Installation or Replacement of a SIPROTEC 4 Communication Module The following description assumes the normal case that a SIPROTEC 4 communication module which has not yet been existing is retrofitted. If a SIPROTEC 4 communication module has to be removed or replaced, the steps are to be performed in reverse order. Note The installation can only be performed alone or after the installation of the Ethernet module.
314
The SIPROTEC 4 communication module is inserted via the large window in the plastic supporting plate. The direction of insertion is not arbitrary. The module is held at its mounting bracket. The opposite end of the module is inserted with the same orientation in the window opening, under the supporting plate and any existing extension I/O. The module bracket is turned towards the Ethernet module locking latch at the supporting plate. Thus, even the longest connection elements of the communication module can be moved in this space between the lower supporting plate reinforcement and the locking latch in the direction of the transformer module. The mounting bracket of the module is now drawn up to the stop in the direction of the lower supporting plate reinforcement. Thus, the 60-pin plug connector on the module and the basic I/O board are aligned on top of each other. The alignment has to be checked via the opening at the bottom of the rack. Attach the module's mounting rail from the back side of the basic I/O using 2 M 2.5 screws.
Figure 3-11
315
3.1.2.6 Reassembly
The reassembly of the device is performed in the following steps: Carefully insert the complete electronics block into the housing. Please observe the following: The connections of the communication modules point at the bottom of the housing. If there is no communication module, orient yourself to the connections for the current terminal. These connections are located on the side of the printed circuit board pointing at the device bottom. Insert the electronics block into the housing, until the supporting part rests against the front edge of the housing. Press the left housing wall slightly out and insert the electronics block carefully further into the housing. When the front edge of the housing and the inside of the front plate touch, center the front plate by carful lateral movements. This makes sure that the front plate encloses/surrounds the housing. The electronics block can only be inserted centered up to the end stop.
Figure 3-12
Reassembly of Device
Fix the front cover to the housing with the two medium screws at the top and bottom of the front cover. The two covers can be inserted again either now or after the reinstallation of the device. Now install the device in accordance with the Sections Panel Flush Mounting, Panel Surface Mounting or Cubicle Mounting. Note Insert the current and voltage terminal blocks again and lock them in place!
316
3.1.3
Installation
3.1.3.1 General
The 7SK80 relay has a housing size 1/6. The housing has 2 covers and 4 fixing holes each at the top and bottom (see Figure 3-13 and Figure 3-14).
Figure 3-13
Figure 3-14
317
Figure 3-15
318
Figure 3-16
319
Figure 3-17
320
3.2
3.2.1
Checking Connections
Checking the Data Connections of the Interfaces
Pin Assignment The following tables show the pin assignment of the various interfaces. The position of the connections can be seen in the following figures.
Figure 3-18
USB interface
Figure 3-19
Figure 3-20
321
USB Interface The USB interface can be used to establish a connection between the protection device and your PC. For the communication, the Microsoft Windows USB driver is used which is installed together with DIGSI (as of version V4.82). The interface is installed as a virtual serial COM port. We recommend the use of standard USB cables with a maximum length of 5 m/16 ft. Table 3-2 Pin No. USB Assignment of the USB socket 1 VBUS (unused) D2 D+ 3 GND 4 Housing Shield
Connections at port A If the interface is used for communication with the device, the data connection is to be checked. When using the interface as input for an RTD box, check the interconnection according to one of the connection examples in A.3. Table 3-3 Pin No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Assignment of the port A socket Ethernet interface Tx+ TxRx+ Rx
Connections at port B When a serial interface of the device is connected to a control center, the data connection must be checked. A visual check of the assignment of the transmit and receive channels is important. With RS232 and fiber optic interfaces, each connection is dedicated to one transmission direction. For that reason the data output of one device must be connected to the data input of the other device and vice versa.
322
Assignment of the port B sockets RS232 RS485 Profibus DP, RS485 Modbus RS485 DNP3.0 RS485 Ethernet EN 100 Tx+ A RTS (TTL level) GND1 VCC1 B Tx Rx+ Rx not available IEC 608705103 redundant B/B (RxD/TxD-P) A/A (RxD/TxD-N) not available
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
1)
Shield (electrically connected with shield shroud) RxD TxD GND RTS CTS A/A (RxD/TxD-N) C/C' (GND) 1) B/B (RxD/TxD-P) B/B (RxD/TxD-P) CNTR-A (TTL) C/C' (GND) +5 V (max. load <100 mA) A/A (RxD/TxD-N)
Pin 7 also carries the RTS signal with RS232 level when operated as RS485 interface. Pin 7 must therefore not be connected!
With data cables, the connections are designated according to DIN 66020 and ISO 2110: TxD = Data output RxD = Data input RTS = Request to send CTS = Clear to send GND = Signal/Chassis Ground The cable shield is to be grounded at both ends. For extremely EMC-prone environments, the GND may be connected via a separate individually shielded wire pair to improve immunity to interference. Fiber-optic Cables
WARNING!
Laser Radiation! Class 1 Do not look directly into the fiber-optic elements!
Signals transmitted via optical fibers are unaffected by interference. The fibers guarantee electrical isolation between the connections. Transmit and receive connections are represented by symbols. The standard setting of the character idle state for the optical fiber interface is Light off. If the character idle state is to be changed, use the operating program DIGSI as described in the SIPROTEC 4 System Description.
323
RTD Box / I/O 2 Extension Module If you are using an RTD box or the I/O2 extension module for temperature measurement, check their connections and the transmission parameters, if necessary, such as the bus number, IP address etc. For more information, see the operating instructions enclosed with the RTD box. Please observe that sensor input 1 (RTD1) of the RTD box is reserved for input of the ambient temperature or coolant temperature of the overload protection. Connection of temperature sensors directly to the device (only 7SK805/7SK806 ): It is generally possible to connect temperature sensors with 2-wire or 3-wire technology. Siemens recommends using only the 3-wire technology. When using the 2-wire connection, a jumper must be installed e.g. for RTD 2 between D3 and D5.
Figure 3-21
Example: Connection of the temperature sensors RTD 1 (3-wire connection) and RTD 2 (2-wire connection) at terminal D1 to D5
RTD-Box to RS485 If a 7XV5662-6AD10 RTD box is connected, check its connections to the interface (port B). Verify also the termination: The terminating resistors must be connected to 7SK80 (see margin heading Termination). For more information on the 7XV5662-6AD10, please refer to the enclosed device manual. Check the transmission parameters at the RTD box. In addition to the baud rate and the parity, the bus number is important, too. When connecting a 7XV5662-6AD10 RTD box, set the following bus numbers at the RTD box: : Bus number = 1 for RTD 1 through 6 Bus number = 2 for RTD 7 through 12. Termination The RS485 interface is capable of half-duplex service with the signal A/A' and B/B' with a common relative potential C/C' (GND). Verify that only the last device on the bus has the terminating resistors connected, and that the other devices on the bus do not. The jumpers for the terminating resistors are on the interface module RS485 or on the PROFIBUS RS485. The terminating resistors can also be connected externally. In this case, the terminating resistors located on the module must be disabled. In case ofa bus extension, it must be ensured that only the last device on the bus has the terminating resistors connected, and that the other devices on the bus do not.
324
3.2.2
Caution!
Take care when operating the device without a battery on a battery charger. Non-observance of the following measures can lead to unusually high voltages and consequently, the destruction of the device. Do not operate the device on a battery charger without a connected battery. (For limit values see also Technical Data, Section 4.1).
If undervoltage protection is configured and enabled in the device and if, at the same time, the current criterion is disabled, the device picks up right after auxiliary voltage has been connected, since no measuring voltage is available. To make the device configurable, pickup is to be stopped, i.e. the measuring voltage is connected or voltage protection is blocked. This can be performed by operation. Before the device is energized for the first time, it should be in the final operating environment for at least 2 hours to equalize the temperature, to minimize humidity and to avoid condensation. Connections are checked with the device at its final location. The plant must first be switched off and grounded. Proceed as follows for checking the system connections: Circuit breakers for the auxiliary power supply and the measuring voltage must be opened. Check the continuity of all current and voltage transformer connections against the system and connection diagrams: Are the current transformers grounded properly? Are the polarities of the current transformer connections the same? Is the phase assignment of the current transformers correct? Are the voltage transformers grounded properly? Are the polarities of the voltage transformer connections the same and correct? Is the phase assignment of the voltage transformers correct? Is the polarity for the current input IN, INs correct (if used)? Is the polarity for the voltage input V3 correct (if used e.g. for broken delta winding or busbar voltage)?
325
If the voltage measurement is carried out via feedthrough capacitances, the feedthrough capacitance for the 7SK80 must be available exclusively.. Parallel connections such as, for example, CAPDIS are not permissible. In the case of a voltage measurement via feedthrough capacitances, the value of the individual capacitances C1 and C2 for the three phases must be known approximately (also see Section 2.1.3.2, Capacitive Voltage Measurement). These capacitance values are configured via the parameter addresses 241 Volt.trans.A:C1 to 246 Volt.trans.C:C2 in the Power System Data 1. The value for the feedthrough capacitances (C1) is usually in the range from 5 pF to 10 pF. The values for the line capacitances (C2) - also including the stray capacitance - basically depend on the cable type used and the cable length for the measuring voltage connection. When entering the parameter for C2, the value of the capacitance of the voltage input has to be added. This input capacitance can be estimated as 2200 pF. Inexactly configured capacitance values will result in deviations during the measurement of the voltage amplitude and the voltage phase angle. If the phase-selective voltages on the primary side are known (usually the nominal voltage of the system divided by 3), the values for the capacitances C1 can be optimized afterwards. The configured values of C2 can also be optimized if the phase angles between the phase-to-ground voltages and the phase currents are know. An explanation of the procedure for optimizing the input capacitances is to be found in Section 2.1.3.2,Capacitive Voltage Measurement. If test switches are used for the secondary testing of the device, their functions must also be checked, in particular that in the Check position the current transformer secondary lines are automatically short-circuited. Connect an ammeter in the supply circuit of the power supply. A range of about 2.5 A to 5 A for the meter is appropriate. Switch on m.c.b. for auxiliary voltage (supply protection), check the voltage level and, if applicable, the polarity of the voltage at the device terminals or at the connection modules. The current input should correspond to the power input in neutral position of the device. The measured steady state current should be insignificant. Transient movement of the ammeter merely indicates the charging current of capacitors. Remove the voltage from the power supply by opening the protective switches. Disconnect the measuring test equipment; restore the normal power supply connections. Apply voltage to the power supply. Close the protective switches for the voltage transformers. Verify that the voltage phase rotation at the device terminals is correct. Open the protective switches for the voltage transformers and the power supply. Check the trip and close circuits to the power system circuit breakers. Verify that the control wiring to and from other devices is correct. Check the signaling connections. Switch the mcb back on.
326
3.3
Commissioning
WARNING!
Warning of dangerous voltages when operating an electrical device Non-observance of the following measures can result in death, personal injury or substantial property damage. Only qualified people shall work on and around this device. They must be thoroughly familiar with all warnings and safety notices in this instruction manual as well as with the applicable safety steps, safety regulations, and precautionary measures. Before making any connections, the device must be grounded at the protective conductor terminal. Hazardous voltages can exist in all switchgear components connected to the power supply and to measurement and test circuits. Hazardous voltages can be present in the device even after the power supply voltage has been removed (capacitors can still be charged). After switching off the auxiliary voltage, wait a minimum of 10 seconds before reconnecting this voltage so that steady conditions can be established. The limit values given in Technical Data (Chapter 4) must not be exceeded, neither during testing nor during commissioning.
When testing the device with secondary test equipment, make sure that no other measurement quantities are connected and that the trip and close circuits to the circuit breakers and other primary switches are disconnected from the device.
DANGER!
Hazardous voltages during interruptions in secondary circuits of current transformers Non-observance of the following measure will result in death, severe personal injury or substantial property damage. Short-circuit the current transformer secondary circuits before current connections to the device are opened.
Switching operations have to be carried out during commissioning. A prerequisite for the prescribed tests is that these switching operations can be executed without danger. They are accordingly not intended for operational checks.
WARNING!
Warning of dangers evolving from improper primary tests Non-observance of the following measures can result in death, personal injury or substantial property damage. Primary tests are only allowed to be carried out by qualified personnel, who are familiar with the commissioning of protection systems, the operation of the plant and the safety rules and regulations (switching, grounding, etc.).
327
3.3.1
Activation and Deactivation If the device is connected to a central or main computer system via the SCADA interface, then the information that is transmitted can be influenced. This is only possible with some of the protocols available (see Table Protocol-dependent functions in the Appendix A.6). If the test mode is switched on, the messages sent by a SIPROTEC 4 device to the main system has an additional test bit. This bit allows the messages to be recognized as not resulting from actual faults. Furthermore, it can be determined by activating the transmission block that no annunciations are transmitted via the system interface during test mode. The SIPROTEC 4 System Manual describes in detail how to activate and deactivate the test mode and blocked data transmission. Please note that when DIGSI is being used for device editing, the program must be in the online operating mode for the test features to be used.
3.3.2
Prefacing Remarks If the device features a system interface which is used to communicate with a control center, the DIGSI device operation can be used to test if messages are transmitted correctly. This test option should however definitely not be used while the device is in service on a live system.
DANGER!
Danger evolving from operating the equipment (e.g. circuit breakers, disconnectors) by means of the test function Non-observance of the following measure will result in death, severe personal injury or substantial property damage. Equipment used to allow switching such as circuit breakers or disconnectors is to be checked only during commissioning. Do not under any circumstances check them by means of the test function during real operation by transmitting or receiving messages via the system interface.
Note After termination of the system interface test the device will reboot. Thereby, all annunciation buffers are erased. If required, these buffers should be extracted with DIGSI prior to the test.
The interface test is carried out using DIGSI in the Online operating mode: Open the Online directory by double-clicking; the operating functions for the device appear. Click on Test; the function selection appears in the right half of the screen. Double-click Generate Indications in the list view. The Generate Indications dialog box opens (see following figure). Structure of the Test Dialog Box In the column Indication the display texts of all indications are displayed which were allocated to the system interface in the matrix. In the column SETPOINT Status the user has to define the value for the messages to be tested. Depending on annunciation type, several input fields are offered (e.g. message ON / message OFF). By clicking on one of the fields you can select the desired value from the pull-down menu.
328
Figure 3-22
Changing the Operating State When clicking one of the buttons in the column Action for the first time, you will be prompted for the password no. 6 (for hardware test menus). After correct entry of the password, individual annunciations can be initiated. To do so, click on the button Send on the corresponding line. The corresponding message is issued and can be read out either from the event log of the SIPROTEC 4 device or from the substation control system. As long as the window is open, further tests can be performed. Test in Message Direction For all information that is transmitted to the central station, test the options in the list which appears in SETPOINT Status: Make sure that each checking process is carried out carefully without causing any danger (see above and refer to DANGER!) Click on Send in the function to be tested and check whether the transmitted information reaches the central station and shows the desired reaction. Data which are normally linked via binary inputs (first character >) are likewise indicated to the central power system with this procedure. The function of the binary inputs itself is tested separately. Exiting the Test Mode To end the System Interface Test, click on Close. The device is briefly out of service while the start-up routine is executed. The dialog box closes. Test in Command Direction The information transmitted in command direction must be indicated by the central station. Check whether the reaction is correct.
329
3.3.3
Required Settings in DIGSI 4 The following applies in general: In the case of a first-time installation or replacement of a communication module, the ordering number (MLFB) does not need to be changed. The ordering number can be retained. Thus, all previously created parameter sets remain valid for the device. Changes in the DIGSI Manager In order that the protection device can access the new communication module, a change has to be made in the parameter set within the DIGSI Manager. Mark the SIPROTEC device in your project in DIGSI 4 Manager and choose the menu entry Edit - Object Properties to open the dialog box Properties SIPROTEC 4 Device zu ffnen (see pict. 3-23). In the properties box communications module for 11. Port B (on back of device bottom) and for 12. Port A (on front of device bottom) an interface has to be selected via the Pull-Down button. The entry further protocols, see addition L has to be selected for Profibus DP, Modbus or DNP3.0. The type of communication module for port B is to be stated in the dialog box "Additional information"which can be reached via the pushbutton "L: ...".
Figure 3-23
330
Mapping File For Profibus DP, Modbus, DNP3.0 and VDEW Redundant, a matching bus mapping has to be selected. For the selection of the mapping file please open the SIPROTEC device in DIGSI and choose the function Interfaces in Parameter (see pict. 3-24). The dialog box "Interface parameters" offers the following dialog elements in the properties tab "Additional protocols on the device": Display of the selected communication module Selection box "Mapping file listing all Profibus DP, Modbus, DNP3.0 and VDEW Redundant mapping files available for the respective device type, with their names and reference to the corresponding bus mapping document Edit field "Module-specific settings for changing the bus-specific parameters
Figure 3-24
Note If the mapping file assignment for a SIPROTEC device has been changed, this is usually connected with a change of the allocations of the SIPROTEC objects to the system interface. After having selected a new mapping file, please check the allocations to "Target system interface" or "Source system interface" in the DIGSI allocation matrix.
Edit Field "Module-specific settings" In the edit field "Module-specific settings", only change the numbers in the lines not starting with "//" and observe the semicolon at the end of the lines. Further changes in the edit field might lead to an error message when closing the dialog box "Interface parameters". Please select the bus mapping corresponding to your requirements. The documentation of the individual bus mappings is available on the Internet (www.siprotec.com in the download area). After having selected the bus mapping, the area of the mapping file in which you can make device-specific settings appears in the window (see Figure 3-25). The type of this setting depends of the protocol used and is described in the protocol documentation. Please only perform the described changes in the settings window and confirm your entries with "OK".
331
Figure 3-25
Module-specific settings
Then, transfer the data to the protection device (see the following figure).
Figure 3-26
Transmitting data
Terminal Test The system interface (EN 100) is preassigned with the default value zero and the module is thus set to DHCP mode. The IP address can be set in the DIGSI Manager (Object properties... / Communication parameters / System interface [Ethernet]).
332
The Ethernet interface is preassigned with the following IP address and can be changed on the device at any time (DIGSI device processing / Parameters / Interfaces / Ethernet service): IP address: 192.168.100.10 Network mask: 255.255.255.0
The following restrictions must be observed: For subnet mask: 255.255.255.0 the IP bandwidth 192.168.64.xx is not available. For subnet mask 255.255.255.0, the IP-Band 192.168.1.xx is not available For subnet mask: 255.255.0.0 the IP bandwidth 192.168.xx.xx is not available. For subnet mask: 255.0.0.0 the IP band 192.xx.xx.xx is not available.
3.3.4
Prefacing Remarks The binary inputs, outputs, and LEDs of a SIPROTEC 4 device can be individually and precisely controlled in DIGSI. This feature is used to verify control wiring from the device to plant equipment (operational checks) during commissioning. This test option should however definitely not be used while the device is inreal operation.
DANGER!
Danger evolving from operating the equipment (e.g. circuit breakers, disconnectors) by means of the test function Non-observance of the following measure will result in death, severe personal injury or substantial property damage. Equipment used to allow switching such as circuit breakers or disconnectors is to be checked only during commissioning. Do not under any circumstances check them by means of the test function during real operation by transmitting or receiving messages via the system interface.
Note After finishing the hardware tests, the device will reboot. Thereby, all annunciation buffers are erased. If required, these buffers should be read out with DIGSI and saved prior to the test.
The hardware test can be carried out using DIGSI in the Online operating mode: Open the Online directory by double-clicking; the operating functions for the device appear. Click on Test; the function selection appears in the right half of the screen. Double-click in the list view on Hardware Test. The dialog box of the same name opens (see the following figure). Structure of the Test Dialog Box The dialog box is classified into three groups: BI for binary inputs, REL for output relays, and LED for lightemitting diodes. On the left of each of these groups is an accordingly labeled button. By double-clicking a button, information regarding the associated group can be shown or hidden.
333
In the column Status the present (physical) state of the hardware component is displayed. Indication is made by symbols. The physical actual states of the binary inputs and outputs are indicated by an open or closed switch symbol, the LEDs by a dark or illuminated LED symbol. The opposite state of each element is displayed in the column Scheduled. The display is made in plain text. The right-most column indicates the commands or messages that are configured (masked) to the hardware components.
Figure 3-27
Changing the Operating State To change the status of a hardware component, click on the associated button in the Scheduled column. Password No. 6 (if activated during configuration) will be requested before the first hardware modification is allowed. After entry of the correct password a status change will be executed. Further status changes remain possible while the dialog box is open. Test of the Output Relays Each individual output relay can be energized for checking the wiring between the output relay of the 7SK80 and the substation, without having to generate the message assigned to it. As soon as the first change of state for any one of the output relays is initiated, all output relays are separated from the internal device functions and can only be operated by the hardware test function. This for example means that a switching command coming from a protection function or a control command from the operator panel to an output relay cannot be executed. Proceed as follows in order to check the output relay: Ensure that the switching of the output relay can be executed without danger (see above under DANGER!). Each output relay must be tested via the corresponding Scheduled-cell in the dialog box. Finish the testing (see margin title below Exiting the Test Mode), so that during further testings no unwanted switchings are initiated.
334
Test of the Binary Inputs To test the wiring between the substation and the binary inputs of the 7SK80, the condition in the substation which initiates the binary input must be generated and the response of the device checked. To do so, the dialog box Hardware Test must be opened again to view the physical state of the binary inputs. The password is not yet required. Proceed as follows in order to check the binary inputs: Activate each of function in the system which causes a binary input to pick up. Check the reaction in the Status column of the dialog box. To do so, the dialog box must be updated. The options may be found below under the margin heading Updating the Display. Finish the testing (see margin heading below Exiting the Test Mode). If ,however, the effect of a binary input must be checked without carrying out any switching in the plant, it is possible to trigger individual binary inputs with the hardware test function. As soon as the first state change of any binary input is triggered and the password No. 6 has been entered, all binary inputs are separated from the plant and can only be activated via the hardware test function. Test of the LEDs The LEDs may be tested in a similar manner to the other input/output components. As soon as the first state change of any LED has been triggered, all LEDs are separated from the internal device functionality and can only be controlled via the hardware test function. This means e.g. that no LED is illuminated anymore by a protection function or by pressing the LED reset button. Updating the Display As the Hardware Test dialog opens, the operating states of the hardware components which are current at this time are read in and displayed. An update is made: for each hardware component, if a command to change the condition is successfully performed, for all hardware components if the Update button is clicked, for all hardware components with cyclical updating (cycle time is 20 seconds) if the Automatic Update (20sec) field is marked. Exiting the Test Mode To end the hardware test, click on Close. The dialog box is closed. The device becomes unavailable for a brief start-up period immediately after this. Then all hardware components are returned to the operating conditions determined by the plant settings.
3.3.5
General
If the device provides a breaker failure protection and if this is used, the integration of this protection function in the system must be tested under practical conditions. Due to the variety of application options and the available system configurations, it is not possible to make a detailed description of the necessary tests. It is important to observe local conditions and protection and system drawings.
335
Before starting the circuit breaker tests it is recommended to isolate the circuit breaker of the tested feeder at both ends, i.e. line isolators and busbar isolators should be open so that the breaker can be operated without risk.
Caution!
Also for tests on the local circuit breaker of the feeder a trip command to the surrounding circuit breakers can be issued for the busbar. Nonobservance of the following measure can result in minor personal injury or property damage. Therefore, primarily it is recommended to interrupt the tripping commands to the adjacent (busbar) breakers, e.g. by interrupting the corresponding pickup voltages.
Before the breaker is finally closed for normal operation, the trip command of the feeder protection routed to the circuit breaker must be disconnected so that the trip command can only be initiated by the breaker failure protection. Although the following lists do not claim to be complete, they may also contain points which are to be ignored in the current application. Auxiliary Contacts of the CB The circuit breaker auxiliary contact(s) form an essential part of the breaker failure protection system in case they have been connected to the device. Make sure the correct assignment has been checked. External Initiation Conditions If the breaker failure protection can be started by external protection devices, the external start conditions must be checked. In order for the breaker failure protection to be started, a current must flow at least via the monitored phase. This may be a secondary injected current. Start by trip command of the external protection: binary input functions >50BF ext SRC (FNo 1431) (in spontaneous or fault annunciations). After every start, the message 50BF ext Pickup (FNo 1457) must appear in the spontaneous or fault annunciations. After time expiration TRIP-Timer (address 7005) tripping command of the breaker failure protection. Switch off test current. If start is possible without current flow: Closing the circuit breaker to be monitored to both sides with the disconnector switches open. Start by trip command of the external protection: Binary input functions >50BF ext SRC (FNo 1431) (in spontaneous or fault annunciations). After every start, the message 50BF ext Pickup (FNo 1457) must appear in the spontaneous or fault annunciations. After time expiration TRIP-Timer (address 7005) tripping command of the breaker failure protection. Open the circuit breaker again.
336
Busbar Tripping For testing the distribution of the trip commands in the substation in the case of breaker failures it is important to check that the trip commands to the adjacent circuit breakers are correct. The adjacent circuit breakers are those of all feeders which must be tripped in order to ensure interruption of the fault current should the local breaker fail. These are therefore the circuit breakers of all feeders which feed the busbar or busbar section to which the feeder with the fault is connected. A general detailed test guide cannot be specified because the layout of the adjacent circuit breakers largely depends on the system topology. In particular with multiple busbars, the trip distribution logic for the adjacent circuit breakers must be checked. Here it should be checked for every busbar section that all circuit breakers which are connected to the same busbar section as the feeder circuit breaker under observation are tripped, and no other breakers. Termination All temporary measures taken for testing must be undone, e.g. especially switching states, interrupted trip commands, changes to setting values or individually switched off protection functions.
3.3.6
CFC Logic
The device has a vast capability for allowing functions to be defined by the user, especially with the CFC logic. Any special function or logic added to the device must be checked. Of course, general test procedures cannot be given. Configuration of these functions and the target conditions must be actually known beforehand and tested. Possible interlocking conditions of switching devices (circuit breakers, disconnectors, ground switch) are of particular importance. They must be observed and tested.
3.3.7
Preliminary Remark Note The voltage and phase rotation test is only relevant for devices with voltage transformers.
10 % of Load Current The connections of the current and voltage transformers are tested using primary quantities. Secondary load current of at least 10 % of the nominal current of the device is necessary. The line is energized and will remain in this state during the measurements. With proper connections of the measuring circuits, none of the measured-values supervision elements in the device should pick up. If an element detects a problem, the causes which provoked it may be viewed in the Event Log. If current or voltage summation errors occur, then check the matching factors. Messages from the symmetry monitoring could occur because there actually are asymmetrical conditions in the network. If these asymmetrical conditions are normal service conditions, the corresponding monitoring functions should be made less sensitive.
337
Current and Voltage Values Currents and voltages can be seen in the display field on the front of the device or the operator interface via a PC. They can be compared to the quantities measured by an independent source, as primary and secondary quantities. If the measured values are not plausible, the connection must be checked and corrected after the line has been isolated and the current transformer circuits have been short-circuited. The measurements must then be repeated. Note If the voltage measurement is carried out via feed through capacitances, the display of the values of the phaseto-ground voltages and phase angle between the phase-to-ground voltages and the phase currents can be used to optimize the configured capacitance values afterwards and to achieve an improvement of the measuring accuracy. An explanation of the procedure for optimizing the input capacitances is to be found in Section 2.1.3.2, Capacitive Voltage Measurement.
Phase Rotation The phase rotation must correspond to the configured phase rotation, in general a clockwise phase rotation. If the system has an anti-clockwise phase rotation, this must have been considered when the power system data was set (address 209 PHASE SEQ.). If the phase rotation is incorrect, the alarm Fail Ph. Seq. (FNo 171) is generated. The measured value phase allocation must be checked and corrected, if required, after the line has been isolated and current transformers have been short-circuited. The measurement must then be repeated. Voltage Transformer Miniature Circuit Breaker (VT mcb) The VT mcb of the feeder (if used) must be opened. The measured voltages in the operational measured values appear with a value close to zero (small measured voltages are of no consequence). Check in the spontaneous annunciations that the VT mcb trip was entered (annunciation >FAIL:FEEDER VT ON in the spontaneous annunciations). Beforehand it has to be assured that the position of the VT mcb is connected to the device via a binary input. Close the VT mcb again: The above messages appear under the spontaneous messages as OFF, i.e. >FAIL:FEEDER VT OFF. If one of the events does not appear, the connection and allocation of these signals must be checked. If the ON-state and OFFstate are swapped, the contact type (Hactive or Lactive) must be checked and remedied.
338
3.3.8
(only if used) Testing reverse interlocking is available if at least one of the binary inputs available is configured for this purpose (e.g. presetting of binary input BI1 >BLOCK 50-2 and >BLOCK 50N-2 to open circuit system). Tests can be performed with phase currents or ground current. For ground current the corresponding ground current settings apply. Please note that the blocking function can either be configured for the pickup current connected (open circuit system) or the pickup current missing (closed circuit system). For open circuit system the following tests are to be proceeded: The feeder protection relays of all associated feeders must be in operation. At the beginning no auxiliary voltage is fed to the reverse interlocking system. A test current higher than the pickup values of 50-2 PICKUP and 50-1 PICKUP or 51 PICKUP is set. As a result of the missing blocking signal, the protection function trips after (short) time delay 50-2 DELAY.
Caution!
Test with currents above 20 A continuous current cause an overload of the input circuits. Perform the test only for a short time (see Technical Data, Section 4.1). Afterwards, the device has to cool off!
The direct voltage for reverse interlocking is now switched on to the line. The precedent test is repeated, the result will be the same. Subsequently, at each of the protection devices of the feeders, a pickup is simulated. Meanwhile, another fault is simulated for the protection function of the infeed, as described before. Tripping is performed within time 501 DELAY (longer time period) (with definite time overcurrent protection) or according to Curve (with inverse time overcurrent protection). These tests also check the proper functioning of the wiring for reverse interlocking.
339
3.3.9
Preliminary Remark Note The direction check is only relevant for devices with voltage transformers.
10 % of Load Current The correct connection of the current and voltage transformers is tested via the protected line using the load current. For this purpose, connect the line. The load current the line carries must be at least 0.1 INom. The load current should be in-phase or lagging the voltage (resistive or resistive-inductive load). The direction of the load current must be known. If there is any doubt, network or ring loops should be opened. The line remains energized during the test. The direction can be derived directly from the operational measured values. Initially the correlation of the measured load direction with the actual direction of load flow is checked. In this case the normal situation is assumed whereby the forward direction (measuring direction) extends from the busbar towards the line P positive, if active power flows into the line, P negative, if active power flows towards the busbar, Q positive, if reactive power flows into the line, Q negative, if reactive power flows toward the busbar.
Figure 3-28
All signs of powers may be inverted deliberately. Check whether polarity is inverted in address 1108 P,Q sign in the P.System Data 2. In that case the signs for active and reactive power are inverse as well. The power measurement provides an initial indication as to whether the measured values have the correct polarity. If both the active power and the reactive power have the wrong sign and 1108 P,Q sign is set to not reversed, the polarity according to address 201 CT Starpoint must be checked and corrected. The line is switched off again after completion.
340
Note Reset the pickup values changed for the check to valid values.
3.3.10
3.3.11
Ungrounded Systems The ground fault check is only necessary if the device is operated in an isolated or resonant-grounded system and ground fault detection is used. This requires the device to be set to Sens. Gnd Fault = Enabled (address 131) when configuring the device functions. In all other cases, this section is not relevant. Determination of the ground fault direction only works in devices that have an E in the 15th position of their MLFB number. The primary check serves to find out the correct polarity of the transformer connections for the determination of the ground fault direction.
DANGER!
Energized equipment of the power system ! Capacitive coupled voltages at disconnected equipment of the power system ! Non-observance of the following measure will result in death, severe personal injury or substantial property damage. Primary measurements must only be carried out on disconnected and grounded equipment of the power system !
Using the primary ground fault method a most reliable test result is guaranteed. Therefore please proceed as follows: Isolate the line and ground it on both ends. During the whole testing procedure the line must be open at the remote end. Make a test connection between a single phase and ground. On overhead lines it can be connected anywhere, however, it must be located behind the current transformers (looking from the busbar of the feeder to be checked). Cables are grounded on the remote end (sealing end). Remove the protective grounding of the line. Connect a circuit breaker to the line end that is to be tested. Check the direction indication (LED if allocated) The faulty phase (FNo 1272 for A or 1273 for B or 1274 for C) and the direction of the line, i.e. SensGnd Forward (FNo 1276) must be indicated in the ground fault protocol.
341
The active and reactive components of the ground current are also indicated (INs Reac, FNo. 702). The reactive current INs Real, FNo. 701) is the most relevant for isolated systems. If the display shows the message SensGnd Reverse (FNo. 1277), either the current or voltage transformer terminals are swapped in the neutral path. If message SensGnd undef. (FNo 1278) appears, the ground current may be too low. Deenergize and ground the line. The test is then finished.
3.3.12
General
If the standard connection of the device is used with current input IN connected in the neutral point of the set of current transformers (see also connection circuit diagram in Appendix A.3), then the correct polarity of the ground current path usually occurs automatically. If, however, current IN is derived from a separate summation CT (see e.g. a connection circuit diagram in the Appendix A.3), an additional direction check with this current is necessary. If the device features the sensitive current input for IN and if it is used in an isolated or resonant-grounded system, the polarity check for IN was already carried out with the ground fault check according to the previous section. Then this section is not relevant. Otherwise the test is done with a disconnected trip circuit and primary load current. It must be noted that during all simulations that do not exactly correspond with situations that may occur in practice, the non-symmetry of measured values may cause the measured value monitoring to pick up. This must therefore be ignored during such tests.
DANGER!
Hazardous voltages during interruptions in secondary circuits of current transformers Non-observance of the following measure will result in death, severe personal injury or substantial property damage. Short-circuit the current transformer secondary circuits before current connections to the device are opened.
Directional Testing for Grounded Systems The check can either be carried out with function directional ground fault protection (address 116) or with the function ground fault detection (address 131), which can be operated as additional fault protection. In the following the check is described using the directional ground fault protection function (address 116) as an example. To generate a displacement voltage, the en winding of one phase in the voltage transformer set (e.g. A) is bypassed (see Figure 3-29). If no connection on the en windings of the voltage transformer is provided, the corresponding phase is disconnected on the secondary side (see Figure 3-30). Only the current of the transformer which is not provided with voltage in its voltage path is fed into the current path. If the line carries resistive-inductive load, the protection is subject to the same conditions as exist during a ground fault in line direction. The directional ground fault protection must be configured to enabled and activated (address 116 or 131). Its pickup threshold must be below the load current of the line; if necessary the pickup threshold must be reduced. The parameters that have been changed, must be noted.
342
After switching the line on and off again, the direction indication must be checked: In the fault log the messages 67N picked up and Ground forward must at least be present. If the directional pickup is not present, either the ground current connection or the displacement voltage connection is incorrect. If the wrong direction is indicated, either the direction of load flow is from the line toward the busbar or the ground current path has a swapped polarity. In the latter case, the connection must be rectified after the line has been isolated and the current transformers short-circuited. If the pickup message is missing, the measured ground (residual) current or the displacement voltage emerged may be too small. This can be checked via operational measured values. Important! If parameters were changed for this test, they must be returned to their original state after completion of the test !
Figure 3-29
Polarity testing for IN, example with current transformers configured in a Holmgreen-connection (VTs with broken delta connection -- e-n winding)
343
Figure 3-30
Polarity testing for IN, example with current transformers configured in a Holmgreen-connection (VTs Wye-connected)
3.3.13
Temperature Detection via RTD Box When connecting an RTD box to the RS485 interface, check the setting of the bus address at the protection device as described in Section 3.2. When connecting an RTD box to the Ethernet interface, you have to carry out the preparatory steps for commissioning first which are described in the operating instruction. Make sure that the IP address at the RTD box corresponds to that at the protection device. If the settings are correct, you can start checking the measured values and thresholds of the temperature. If temperature sensors with 2-phase connection are used, you must first determine the line resistance for the temperature detector being short-circuited. Proceed as described in the operating manual. Enter the resistance value determined for the corresponding sensor at the RTD box (range: 0 to 50.6 ). When using the preset 3-phase connection for the temperature detectors no further entry must be made. Checking the Measured Temperature Values Pt100 temperature sensors are standard for temperature detection via both the RTD box and the I/O 2 extension module. When using Ni100 or Ni120 temperature sensors, the device will convert the temperature displayed at the RTD box. For checking the measured temperature values, the temperature detectors are replaced by adjustable resistors (e.g. precision resistance decade) and the correct assignment of the resistance value and the displayed temperature for 2 or 3 temperature values from the following table are verified.
344
Table 3-5
Assignment of the resistance value and the temperature of the sensors Temperature in F 58 40 22 4 14 32 50 68 86 104 122 140 158 176 194 212 230 248 266 284 302 320 338 356 374 392 410 428 446 464 482 Ni 100 DIN 43760 74.255 79.1311726 84.1457706 89.2964487 94.581528 100 105.551528 111.236449 117.055771 123.011173 129.105 135.340259 141.720613 148.250369 154.934473 161.7785 168.788637 175.971673 183.334982 190.88651 198.63475 206.58873 214.757989 223.152552 231.782912 240.66 249.79516 259.200121 268.886968 278.868111 289.15625 Ni 120 DIN 34760 89.106 94.9574071 100.974925 107.155738 113.497834 120 126.661834 133.483738 140.466925 147.613407 154.926 162.408311 170.064735 177.900442 185.921368 194.1342 202.546364 211.166007 220.001979 229.063812 238.3617 247.906476 257.709587 267.783063 278.139495 288.792 299.754192 311.040145 322.664362 334.641733 346.9875 Pt 100 IEC 60751 80.3062819 84.270652 88.2216568 92.1598984 96.085879 100 103.902525 107.7935 111.672925 115.5408 119.397125 123.2419 127.075125 130.8968 134.706925 138.5055 142.292525 146.068 149.831925 153.5843 157.325125 161.0544 164.772125 168.4783 172.172925 175.856 179.527525 183.1875 186.835925 190.4728 194.098125
Temperature in C 50 40 30 20 10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130 140 150 160 170 180 190 200 210 220 230 240 250
Temperature thresholds that are configured in the protection device can be checked by slowly approaching the resistance value.
345
3.3.14
Control by Local Command If the configured equipment was not switched sufficiently in the hardware test already described, configured equipment must be switched on and off from the device via the integrated control element. The feedback information on the circuit breaker position injected via binary inputs is to be read out at the device and compared with the actual breaker position. The switching procedure is described in the SIPROTEC 4 System Description. The switching authority must be set according to the command source used. The switching mode can be selected from interlocked and noninterlocked switching. Please note that non-interlocked switching can be a safety hazard. Control by Protective Functions Please bear in mind that a trip signal sent to the circuit breaker can result in a trip-close-trip event of the circuit breaker by an external reclosing device.
DANGER!
A test cycle successfully started by the automatic reclosure function can lead to the closing of the circuit breaker ! Non-observance of the following statement will result in death, severe personal injury or substantial property damage. Be fully aware that OPEN-commands sent to the circuit breaker can result in a trip-close-trip event of the circuit breaker by an external reclosing device.
Control from a Remote Control Center If the device is connected to a remote substation via a system interface, the corresponding switching tests may also be checked from the substation. Please also take into consideration that the switching authority is set in correspondence with the source of commands used.
3.3.15
General
In order to be able to test the stability of the protection during switchon procedures also, switchon trials can also be carried out at the end. Oscillographic records obtain the maximum information about the behaviour of the protection. Requirements To be able to trip a test fault record, parameter Osc Fault Rec. must be configured to in the Functional Scope. Apart from the option to store fault records via pickup of the protection function, the 7SK80 also allows for initiating a measured value recording via the DIGSI operating program, the serial interface and binary input. For the latter, the information >Trig.Wave.Cap. must have been allocated to a binary input. Triggering for the oscillographic recording then occurs, for instance, via the binary input when the protection object is energized. Those that are externally triggered (that is, without a protective element pickup) are processed by the device as a normal oscillographic record. For each oscillographic record a fault record is created which is given its individual number to ensure that assignment can be made properly. However, these recordings are not displayed in the fault indication buffer, as they are not fault events.
346
Triggering Oscillographic Recording To trigger test measurement recording with DIGSI, click on Test in the left part of the window. Double click the entry Test Wave Form in the list of the window.
Figure 3-31
Oscillographic recording is started immediately. During recording, a report is given in the left part of the status bar. Bar segments additionally indicate the progress of the procedure. The SIGRA or the Comtrade Viewer program is required to view and analyse the oscillographic data.
347
3.4
Caution!
Inadmissable Tightening Torques Nonobservance of the following measure can result in minor personal injury or property damage. The tightening torques must not be exceeded as the threads and terminal chambers may otherwise be damaged!
The settings should be checked again, if they were changed during the tests. Check if all protection, control and auxiliary functions to be found with the configuration parameters are set correctly (Section 2.1.1, Functional Scope) and all desired functions are set to ON. Keep a copy of all setting values on a PC. The device-internal clock should be checked and set, if necessary. The annunciation buffers are deleted under MAIN MENU Annunciations Set/Reset, so that future information will only apply to actual events and states (see also SIPROTEC 4 System Description). The counters in the switching statistics should be reset to the values that were existing prior to the testing (see also SIPROTEC 4 System Description). Reset the counter of the operational measured values (e.g. operation counter, if available) under MAIN MENU Measured Values Reset (also see SIPROTEC 4 System Description). Press the ESC key (several times if necessary), to return to the default display. The default display appears in the display box (e.g. the display of operational measured values). Clear the LEDs on the front panel of the device by pressing the LED key so that they will show only real events and states in the future. In this context, also output relays probably memorized are reset. While pressing the LED key, the allocatable LEDs on the front panel light up, therefore this also serves as an LED test. LEDs indicating current conditions remain on, of course. For more information on the operation, see 2.22 and the SIPROTEC 4 System Description. The green RUN LED must light up, whereas the red ERROR must not light up. Close the protective switches. If test switches are available, then these must be in the operating position. The device is now ready for operation.
348
Technical Data
This chapter provides the technical data of the device SIPROTEC 7SK80 and its individual functions, including the limit values that may not be exceeded under any circumstances. The electrical and functional data for the maximum functional scope are followed by the mechanical specifications with dimensioned drawings.
4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 4.6 4.7 4.8 4.9 4.10 4.11 4.12 4.13 4.14 4.15 4.16 4.17 4.18 4.19 4.20 4.21 4.22 4.23 4.24
General Device Data Definite-time Overcurrent Protection Inverse-time Overcurrent Protection Directional overcurrent protection ground Inrush Restraint Dynamic Cold Load Pickup Voltage Protection 27, 59 Negative Sequence Protection (definite-time characteristic) Negative Sequence Protection (inverse-time characteristics) Motor Starting Time Supervision Motor Restart Inhibit Load Jam Protection Frequency Protection Thermal Overload Protection Ground Fault Detection (Sensitive/Insensitive) Intermittent Ground Fault Protection Directional intermittent ground fault protection Breaker Failure Protection 50BF Flexible Protection Functions Temperature Detection User-defined Functions (CFC) Additional Functions Switching Device Control Dimensions
350 360 362 373 374 375 376 378 379 385 386 387 388 389 391 395 396 397 398 401 403 408 413 414
349
4.1
4.1.1
Current Inputs Nominal Frequency Operating range frequency (not dependent on the nominal frequency Nominal current Ground current, sensitive Burden per phase and ground path - at INom = 1 A - at INom = 5 A - for sensitive ground fault detection at 1 A - for sensitive ground fault detection at 5 A Load capacity current path - thermal (rms) INom INs fNom 50 Hz or 60 Hz 25 Hz to 70 Hz 1 A or 5 A 1,6 INom linear range 1) 0.05 VA 0.3 VA 0.05 VA 0.3 VA 500 A for 1 s 150 A for 10 s 20 A continuous 1250 A (half-cycle) 300 A for 1 s 100 A for 10 s 15 A continuous 750 A (half-cycle) (adjustable)
- dynamic (peak value) Load capacity input for sensitive ground fault detection INs 1) - thermal (rms)
only in models with input for sensitive ground fault detection (see ordering data in Appendix A.1)
Temperature Detectors at the I/O 2 Extension Module (only 7SK805/7SK806) See chapter Temperature Detection
Voltage Inputs Nominal voltage 34 V 225 V (adjustable) for connection of phase-to-ground voltages 34 V 200 V (adjustable) for connection of phase-to-phase voltages 0 V to 200 V at 100 V approx. 0.005 VA 230 V continuous
Measuring Range Burden Overload capacity in the voltage path thermal (rms)
350
4.1.2
Auxiliary voltage
Direct Voltage Voltage supply via an integrated converter Nominal auxiliary DC voltage VAux Permissible voltage ranges Overvoltage category, IEC 60255-27 AC ripple voltage peak to peak, IEC 60255-11 Power input 7SK80 DC 24 V to 48 V DC 19 V to 60 V III 15 % of auxiliary voltage Quiescent approx. 5 W Energized approx. 12 W DC 60 V to 250 V DC 48 V to 300 V
Alternating Voltage Voltage supply via an integrated converter Nominal auxiliary AC voltage VH Permissible voltage ranges Overvoltage category, IEC 60255-27 Power input (at 115 VAC / 230 VAC) Bridging time for failure/short-circuit AC 115 V AC 92 V to 132 V III < 15 VA 10 ms at V = 115 V/230 V AC 230 V AC 184 V to 265 V
4.1.3
Binary Inputs Variant 7SK801/803/805/806 7SK802/804 Nominal Direct Voltage Range Quantity 3 (configurable) 7 (configurable) 24 V to 250 V
Current input, energized (independent of the control Approx. 0.4 mA voltage) Pickup time Response Time of the binary output after trigger signal via binary input Dropout time Response Time of the binary output after trigger signal via binary input Secured switching thresholds for nominal voltages for nominal voltages Approx. 3 ms approx. 9 ms Approx. 4 ms approx. 5 ms
(adjustable) 24 to 125 VDC 110 to 250 VDC V high > 19 VDC V low < 10 VDC V high > 88 VDC V low < 44 VDC
351
220 Vdc across 220nF at a recovery time between two switching operations 60 ms
Output Relays Signal/command Relay, Alarm Relay Quantity and data Order variant 7SK801/803/805/806 7SK802/804 Switching capability MAKE Switching capability BREAK Switching voltage AC and DC Permissible current per contact (continuous) Permissible current per contact (close and hold) Interference suppression capacitor at the relay outputs 2.2 nF, 250 V, ceramic Frequency 50 Hz 60 Hz depending on the order variant (allocatable) NO contact 3 6 NO/NC selectable 2 (+ 1 life contact not allocatable) 2 (+ 1 life contact not allocatable) 1000 W / 1000 VA 40 W or 30 VA at L/R 40 ms 250 V 5A 30 A for 1 s (NO contact) Impedance 1,4 106 20 % 1,2 106 20 %
4.1.4
Communication Interfaces
User Interface Terminal Front side, non-isolated, USB type B socket for connecting a personal computer Operation from DIGSI V4.82 via USB 2.0 full speed With DIGSI up to 12 Mbit/s max. 5m
Port A Ethernet electrical for DIGSI or Operation RTD box or SICAM I/O Unit Connection 7XV5673 With DIGSI Front case bottom, mounting location "A", RJ45 socket 100BaseT in acc. with IEEE802.3 LED yellow: 10/100 Mbit/s (on/off) LED green: connection/no connection (on/off) 500 V; 50 Hz 10/100 Mbit/s 20 m (66 ft)
352
Port B IEC 60870-5-103 single RS232 Terminal Test voltage Transmission speed Bridgeable distance RS485 Terminal Test voltage Transmission speed Bridgeable distance Fiber optic cable (FO) FO connector type Terminal Optical wavelength ST connector Back case bottom, mounting location "B" = 820 nm Back case bottom, mounting location "B", 9pin DSUB socket 500 V; 50 Hz min. 1,200 Bd; max. 115,000 Bd; factory setting 9,600 Bd max. 1 km Back case bottom, mounting location "B", 9pin DSUB socket 500 V; 50 Hz min. 1,200 Bd; max. 115,000 Bd; factory setting 9,600 Bd 15 m
Laser Class 1 according to EN When using glass fiber 50 m/125 m or 60825-1/-2 glass fiber 62.5 m/125 m Permissible optical signal attenuation Bridgeable distance Character idle state IEC 60870-5-103 redundant RS485 max. 8 dB, with glass fiber 62.5 m/125 m max. 1.5 km Configurable; factory setting Light off
Isolated interface for data transfer to a control center Terminal Test voltage Transmission speed Bridgeable distance Back case bottom, mounting location "B", RJ45 socket 500 V; 50 Hz min. 2,400 Bd, max. 57,600 Bd; factory setting 19,200 Bd max. 1 km Back case bottom, mounting location "B", 9pin DSUB socket 500 V; 50 Hz Up to 1.5 MBd 1 000 m (3 300 ft) at 93.75 kBd 500 m (1 600 ft) at 187.5 kBd 200 m (660 ft) at 1.5 MBd
Profibus RS485 (DP) Terminal Test voltage Transmission speed Bridgeable distance
353
Profibus FO (DP) FO connector type Terminal Transmission speed Recommended: Optical wavelength ST connector Double ring Back case bottom, mounting location "B" Up to 1.5 MBd > 500 kBd with normal casing = 820 nm
Laser Class 1 according to EN When using glass fiber 50 m 125 m or 60825-1/-2 glass fiber 62.5 m/125 m Permissible optical signal attenuation Bridgeable distance DNP3.0 /MODBUS RS485 Terminal Test voltage Transmission speed Bridgeable distance DNP3.0 /MODBUS FO FO connector type Terminal Transmission speed Optical wavelength ST connector transmitter/receiver Back case bottom, mounting location "B" Up to 19,200 Bd = 820 nm Back case bottom, mounting location "B", 9pin DSUB socket 500 V; 50 Hz Up to 19,200 Bd max. 1 km max. 8 dB, with glass fiber 62.5/125 m max. 2 km
Laser Class 1 according to EN When using glass fiber 50 m/125 m or 60825-1/-2 glass fiber 62.5 m/125 m Permissible optical signal attenuation Bridgeable distance Ethernet electrical (EN 100) for DIGSI Terminal IEC61850 DNP3 TCP PROFINET Test voltage (with regard to the or SICAM I/O unit 7XV5673 socket) Transmission speed Bridgeable distance Ethernet optical (EN 100) for DIGSI IEC61850 DNP3 TCP PROFINET or SICAM I/O unit 7XV5673 Terminal Transmission speed Optical wavelength Bridgeable distance max. 8 dB, with glass fiber 62.5 m/125 m max. 1.5 km Back case bottom, mounting location "B", 2 x RJ45 socket 100BaseT in acc. with IEEE802.3 500 V; 50 Hz 100 Mbit/s 21.87 yd Back case bottom, mounting location "B", Duplex-LC, 100BaseF acc. to IEEE802.3 100 Mbit/s 1300 nm max. 2 km (1.24 mi)
354
4.1.5
Electrical Tests
Regulations Standards: IEC 60255 IEEE Std C37.90, see individual functions VDE 0435 for more standards see also individual functions
Voltage test (routine test) of all circuits except auxil- 2.5 kV, 50 Hz iary voltage, binary inputs and communication ports Voltage test (routine test) of auxiliary voltage and binary inputs Voltage test (routine test) of isolated communication ports only (A and B) DC 3.5 kV 500 V, 50 Hz
Impulse voltage test (type test) of all process circuits 6 kV (peak value); (except for communication ports) against the inter- 1.2 s/50 s; 0.5 J; nal electronics 3 positive and 3 negative impulses at intervals of 1 s Impulse voltage test (type test) of all process circuits 5 kV (peak value); against each other (except for communication 1.2 s/50 s; 0.5 J; ports) and against the PE terminal of class III 3 positive and 3 negative impulses at intervals of 1 s
Insulation Test of Temperature Detectors Temperature detectors (PT 100 inputs) 500 V; 50 Hz
EMC Tests for Immunity (Type Tests) Standards: IEC 60255-6 and -22, (product standards) IEC/EN 61000-6-2 VDE 0435 For more standards see also individual functions 2.5 kV (Peak); 1 MHz; = 15 s; 400 Surges per s; Test duration 2 s; Ri = 200 8 kV contact discharge; 15 kV air discharge, both polarities; 150 pF; Ri = 330 10 V/m; 80 MHz to 2.7 GHz; 80 % AM; 1 kHz 4 kV; 5 ns/50 ns; 5 kHz; burst length = 15 ms; repetition rate 300 ms; both polarities: Ri = 50 ; test duration 1 min
1 MHz test, Class III IEC 60255-22-1, IEC 61000-4-18, IEEE C37.90.1 Electrostatic discharge, Class IV IEC 60255-22-2, IEC 61000-4-2 Radio frequency electromagnetic field, amplitude-modulated, Class III IEC 60255-22-3, IEC 61000-4-3 Fast transient bursts, Class IV IEC 60255-22-4, IEC 61000-4-4, IEEE C37.90.1
High energy surge voltages (SURGE), Installation Class III IEC Impulse: 1.2 s/50 s 60255-22-5, IEC 61000-4-5 Auxiliary voltage Measuring inputs, binary inputs and relay outputs common mode: 4 kV; 12 ; 9 F Diff. mode:1 kV; 2 ; 18 F common mode: 4 kV; 42 ; 0,5 F Diff. mode: 1 kV; 42 ; 0,5 F
355
HF on lines, amplitude-modulated, Class III IEC 60255-22-6, IEC 61000-4-6 Power system frequency magnetic field IEC 61000-4-8, Class IV; Radiated Electromagnetic Interference IEEE Std C37.900.2 Damped oscillations IEC 61000-4-18
10 V; 150 kHz to 80 MHz; 80 % AM; 1 kHz 30 A/m continuous; 300 A/m for 3 s; 20 V/m; 80 MHz to 1 GHz; 80 % AM; 1 kHz 2.5 kV (peak value); 100 kHz; 40 pulses per s; Test Duration 2 s; Ri = 200
EMC Tests for Noise Emission (Type Test) Standard: Radio noise voltage to lines, only auxiliary voltage IEC-CISPR 11 Interference field strength IEC-CISPR 11 IEC/EN 61000-6-4 150 kHz to 30 MHz Limit Class A 30 MHz to 1000 MHz Limit Class A
Harmonic currents on the network lead at AC 230 V Device is to be assigned Class D (applies only to devices IEC 61000-3-2 with > 50 VA power consumption) Voltage fluctuations and flicker on the network lead Limit values are kept at AC 230 V IEC 61000-3-3
4.1.6
Mechanical Tests
Vibration and Shock Stress during Steady-State Operation Standards: Oscillation IEC 60255-21-1, Class II; IEC 60068-2-6 IEC 60255-21 and IEC 60068 Sinusoidal 10 Hz to 60 Hz: 0.075 mm amplitude; 60 Hz to 150 Hz: 1g acceleration frequency sweep rate 1 octave/min 20 cycles in 3 orthogonal axes. Semi-sinusoidal 5 g acceleration, duration 11 ms, each 3 shocks in both directions of the 3 axes Sinusoidal 1 Hz to 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude (horizontal axis) 1 Hz to 8 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude (vertical axis) 8 Hz to 35 Hz: 2 g acceleration (horizontal axis) 8 Hz to 35 Hz: 1 g acceleration (vertical axis) Frequency sweep 1 octave/min 1 cycle in 3 orthogonal axes
Shock IEC 60255-21-2, Class I; IEC 60068-2-27 Seismic Vibration IEC 60255-21-3, Class II; IEC 60068-3-3
356
Vibration and Shock Stress during Transport Standards: Oscillation IEC 60255-21-1, Class 2; IEC 60068-2-6 IEC 60255-21 and IEC 60068 Sinusoidal 5 Hz to 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude; 8 Hz to 150 Hz: 2 g acceleration Frequency sweep 1 octave/min 20 cycles in 3 orthogonal axes Semi-sinusoidal 15 g acceleration, duration 11 ms, each 3 shocks (in both directions of the 3 axes) Semi-sinusoidal 10 g acceleration, duration 16 ms, each 1000 shocks (in both directions of the 3 axes)
Shock IEC 60255-21-2, Class 1; IEC 60068-2-27 Continuous Shock IEC 60255-21-2, Class 1; IEC 60068-2-29
4.1.7
Temperatures Standards: Type test (in acc. with IEC 60068-2-1 and -2, Test Bd for 16 h) Permissible temporary operating temperature (tested for 96 h) Recommended for permanent operation (in acc. with IEC 60255-6) Limit temperatures for storage Limit temperatures for transport Storage and transport with factory packaging IEC 60255-6 25 C to +85 C or 13 F to +185 F 20 C to +70 C or 4 F to +158 F (clearness of the display may be impaired from +55 C or +131 F) 5 C to +55 C or +23 F to +131 F 25 C to +55 C or 13 F to +131 F 25 C to +70 C or 13 F to +158 F
Humidity Permissible humidity Mean value per year 75 % relative humidity; on 56 days of the year up to 93 % relative humidity; condensation must be avoided!
Siemens recommends that all devices be installed such that they are not exposed to direct sunlight, nor subject to large fluctuations in temperature that may cause condensation to occur.
357
4.1.8
Service conditions
The protection device is designed for installation in normal relay rooms and plants so that electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) is ensured if installation is done properly. We also recommend: All contacts and relays that operate in the same cubicle, cabinet, or relay panel as the numerical protective device should always be equipped with proper surge suppression components. For substations with operating voltages of 100 kV and higher, all external cables should be shielded with a conductive shield grounded at both ends. No special measures are normally required in a medium-voltage substation. Do not withdraw or insert individual modules or boards while the protective device is energized. When handling modules outside the case, the standards for components sensitive to electrostatic discharge (Electrostatically Sensitive Devices) must be observed. They are not endangered inside the case. Only temperature sensors with 3-wire connection and shielded connection cables may be connected. Connect the cable shield as short as possible at the terminal D-14 designed for this purpose.
4.1.9
Constructive Design
Case Dimensions Device 7SK80**-*B 7SK80**-*E for panel flush mounting 7XP20 see dimensional drawings, Section 4.24 Case for panel surface mounting
1/ 6 1 /6
Size
Protection type acc. to IEC 60529 For equipment in the surface-mounting case For equipment in flush mounting case for operator protection Degree of pollution, IEC 60255-27 IP 50 Front IP 51 Rear IP 50 IP 2x for current terminal IP 1x for voltage terminal 2
358
4.1.10
UL certification conditions
Output Relays 24 VDC 48 VDC 240 VDC 240 VAC 120 VAC 250 VAC B300, R300 Voltage Inputs Battery Input voltage range 300 V 5 A General Purpose 0.8 A General Purpose 0.1 A General Purpose 5 A General Purpose 1/3 hp 1/2 hp
Servicing of the circuitry involving the batteries and replacement of the lithium batteries shall be done by a trained technician. Replace Battery with VARTA or Panasonic Cat. Nos. CR 1/2 AA or BR 1/2 AA only. Use of another Battery may present a risk of fire or explosion. See manual for safety instructions. Caution: The battery used in this device may present a fire or chemical burn hazard if mistreated. Do not recharge, disassemble, heat above 100 C (212 F) or incinerate. Dispose of used battery promptly. Keep away from children. Surrounding air temperature tsurr: max. 70 C (158 F), normal operation
Design
Field Wires of Control Circuits shall be separated from other circuits with respect to the end use requirements! Type 1 if mounted into a door or front cover of an enclosure.
359
4.2
Measuring Method All elements 51Ns-3 First harmonic, r.m.s. value (true RMS) Additional instantaneous values
Setting Ranges / Increments Pickup current 501, 502 (phas- forINom = 1 A 0.10 A to 35.00 A or (disabled) es) for INom = 5 A 0.50 A to 175.00 A or (disabled) Pickup current 503 (phases) Pickup Current 50N1, 50N2 (ground) Pickup Current 50N3 (ground) Time delays T Dropout time delays 50 T DROP-OUT, 50N T DROP-OUT for INom = 1 A 1.0 A to 35.00 A or (disabled) for INom = 5 A 5.0 A to 175.00 A or (disabled) for INom = 1 A 0.05 A to 35.00 A or (disabled) for INom = 5 A 0.25 A to 175.00 A or (disabled) for INom = 1 A 0.25 A to 35.00 A or (disabled) for INom = 5 A 1.25 A to 175.00 A or (disabled) 0.00 s to 60.00 s or (disabled) 0.00 s to 60.00 s Increments 0.01 s Increments 0.01 s Increments 0.01 A Increments 0.01 A
Times Pickup times (without inrush restraint, with restraint + 1 period) First harmonic, rms value - for 2 x setting value - for 10 x setting value Instantaneous value - for 2 x setting value - for 10 x setting value Dropout Times First harmonic, rms value Instantaneous value approx. 30 ms Approx. 20 ms approx. 16 ms approx. 16 ms approx. 30 ms approx. 40 ms
Dropout Ratio Dropout ratio for - first harmonic, rms value - instantaneous value
approx. 0,95 for I/INom 0.3 approx. 0,90 for I/INom 0.3
360
Influencing Variables for Pickup and Dropout Auxiliary DC voltage in range 0.8 VAux/VAuxNom 1.15 Frequency in the range of 25 Hz 70 Hz Frequency in the range of 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 (fNom = 50 Hz 1 % or 60 Hz) Frequency outside range 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 Harmonics - up to 10 % 3rd harmonic - up to 10 % 5th harmonic at instantaneous value of 50-3/50N-3 elements Transient overreaction for > 100 ms (with full displacement) Increased tolerances 1% 1% Increased tolerances <5 % 1%
361
4.3
Modes of Operation Three-phase Two-phase voltage-independent, voltage-controlled, voltage-dependent Standard Phases A and C
Measuring Technique All elements First harmonic, rms value (true rms)
Setting Ranges / Increments Pickup currents 51 (phases) Pickup currents 51N (ground) Time multiplier T for 51, 51N for IEC characteristics Time multiplier T for 51, 51N for ANSI characteristics for INom = 1 A 0.10 A to 4.00 A for INom = 5 A 0.50 A to 20.00 A for INom = 1 A 0.05 A to 4.00 A for INom = 5 A 0.25 A to 20.00 A 0.05 s to 3.20 s or (disabled) 0.50 s to 15.00 s or (disabled) Increments 0.01 A Increments 0.01 A Increments 0.01 s Increments 0.01 s Increments 0.1 V
Trip Time Curves acc. to IEC Acc. to IEC 60255-3 or BS 142, Section 3.5.2 (see also Figures 4-1 and 4-2)
The tripping times for I/Ip 20 are identical with those for I/Ip = 20 For zero sequence current, read 3I0p instead of Ip and T3I0p instead of Tp; for ground fault, read IEp instead of Ip and TIEp instead of Tp Pickup threshold approx. 1.10 Ip
362
Dropout Time Characteristics with Disk Emulation acc. to IEC Acc. to IEC 60255-3 or BS 142, Section 3.5.2 (see also Figures 4-1 and 4-2)
The dropout time curves apply to (I/Ip) 0.90 For zero sequence current, read 3I0p instead of Ip and T3I0p instead of Tp; for ground fault, read IEp instead of Ip and TIEp instead of Tp Dropout Setting IEC without Disk Emulation IEC with Disk Emulation approx. 1.05 setting value Ip for Ip/IN 0.3, this corresponds to approx. 0.95 pickup value approx. 0.90 Ip setting value
Tolerances Pickup/dropout thresholds Ip, IEp Trip time for 2 I/Ip 20 Dropout time for I/Ip 0.90 3 % of setting value or 15 mA for INom = 1 A, or 75 mA for INom = 5 A 5 % of reference (calculated) value +2 % current tolerance, or 30 ms 5 % of reference (calculated) value +2 % current tolerance, or 30 ms
Influencing Variables for Pickup and Dropout Power supply direct voltage in range 0.8 VAux/VAuxNom 1.15 Temperature in Range 23.00 F (5 C) amb 131.00 F (55 C) Frequency in range of 25 Hz 70 Hz Frequency in range of 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 (fNom = 50 Hz or 60 Hz) Frequency in Range 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 Harmonics - up to 10 % 3rd harmonic - up to 10 % 5th harmonic Transient overreaction during first harmonic measuring technique for > 100 ms (with full displacement) 1% Increased Tolerances 1% 1% <5 % 1% 0.5 %/10 K
363
Figure 4-1
Dropout time and trip time curves of the inverse time overcurrent protection, acc. to IEC
364
Figure 4-2
Dropout time and trip time curves of the inverse time overcurrent protection, acc. to IEC
365
Trip Time Curves acc. to ANSI Acc. to ANSI/IEEE (see also Figures 4-3 to 4-6)
The tripping times for I/Ip 20 are identical with those for I/Ip = 20. For zero sequence current read 3I0p instead of Ip and T3I0p instead of Tp; for ground fault read IEp instead of Ip and TIEp instead of Tp Pickup Threshold approx. 1.10 Ip
366
Dropout Time Characteristics with Disk Emulation acc. to ANSI/IEEE Acc. to ANSI/IEEE (see also Figures 4-3 to 4-6)
The dropout time curves apply to (I/Ip) 0.90 For zero sequence current read 3I0p instead of Ip and T3I0p instead of Tp; for ground fault read IEp instead of Ip and TIEp instead of Tp Dropout Setting ANSI without Disk Emulation ANSI with Disk Emulation approx. 1.05 setting value Ip for Ip/IN 0.3; this corresponds to approx. 0.95 pickup value approx. 0.90 Ip setting value
Tolerances Pickup and Dropout Thresholds Ip, INp Trip Time for 2 I/Ip 20 Dropout Time for I/Ip 0,90 3 % of setting value or 15 mA for INom = 1 A or 75 mA for INom = 5 A 5 % of reference (calculated) value +2 % current tolerance, or 30 ms 5 % of reference (calculated) value +2 % current tolerance, or 30 ms
367
Influencing Variables for Pickup and Dropout Power supply direct voltage in range 0.8 VAux/VAuxNom 1.15 Temperature in range 23.00 F (5 C) amb 131.00 F (55 C) Frequency in range of 25 Hz 70 Hz Frequency in range of 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 (fNom = 50 Hz or 60 Hz) Frequency in range 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 Harmonics - up to 10 % 3rd harmonic - up to 10 % 5th harmonic Transient overreaction during first harmonic measuring technique for > 100 ms (with full displacement) 1% Increased Tolerances 1% 1% <5 % 1% 0.5 %/10 K
368
Figure 4-3
Dropout time and trip time curves of the inverse time overcurrent protection, acc. to ANSI/IEEE
369
Figure 4-4
Dropout time and trip time curves of the inverse time overcurrent protection, acc. to ANSI/IEEE
370
Figure 4-5
Dropout time and trip time curves of the inverse time overcurrent protection, acc. to ANSI/IEEE
371
Figure 4-6
Dropout time and trip time curve of the inverse time overcurrent protection, acc. to ANSI/IEEE
372
4.4
Time Overcurrent Elements The same specifications and characteristics apply as for non-directional time overcurrent protection (see previous Sections).
For Ground Faults Polarization Forward range Rotation of the reference voltage Vref,rot Dropout difference Directional sensitivity with zero sequence quantities 3V0, 3I0 Vref,rot 86 -180 to +180 Increments 1 3 VN 2.5 V displacement voltage, measured 3V0 5 V displacement voltage, calculated with negative sequence quantities 3V2, 3I2 Vref,rot 86 -180 to +180 Increments 1 3 3V2 5 V negative sequence voltage 3I2 45 mA negative sequence current with INom = 1 A 3I2 225 mA negative sequence current with INom = 5 A
Polarization Forward range Rotation of the reference voltage Vref,rot Dropout difference Directional sensitivity
Times Pickup times (without inrush restraint, with inrush restraint + 1 cycle) 67N-1, 67N-2, 67N-3 - for 2 x setting value - for 10 x setting value Dropout times 67N-1, 67N-2, 67N-3 approx. 45 ms approx. 40 ms approx. 40 ms
Influencing variables Frequency influence approx. 1 in the range of 0.95 < f/fN < 1.05
373
4.5
Inrush Restraint
Controlled Functions Overcurrent elements 50-1, 50N-1, 51, 51N, 67-1, 67N-1
Setting Ranges / Increments Stabilization factor I2f/I Functional Limits Lower function limit phases for INom = 1 A at least one phase current (50 Hz and 100 Hz) 50 mA for INom = 5 A at least one phase current (50 Hz and 100 Hz) 125 mA Lower function limit ground for INom = 1 A Ground current (50 Hz and 100 Hz) 50 mA for INom = 5 A Ground current (50 Hz and 100 Hz) 125 mA Upper function limit, configurable for INom = 1 A 0.30 A to 25.00 A for INom = 5 A 1.50 A to 125.00 A Increments 0.01 A Increments 0.01 A 10 % to 45 % Increments 1 %
374
4.6
Timed changeover of settings Controlled elements Initiation criteria Non-directional time overcurrent protection (separate phase and ground settings) 50(N), 51(N) Current criterion BkrClosed I MIN Interrogation of the circuit breaker position Binary input Time control Current control 3 time elements (TCB Open., TActive, TStop) Current threshold BkrClosed I MIN (reset on current falling below threshold: monitoring with timer)
Setting Ranges / Increments Current Control for INom = 1 A 0.04 A to 1.00 A for INom = 5 A 0.20 A to 5.00 A Time Until Changeover To Dynamic Settings 0 s to 21600 s (= 6 h) TCB OPEN Period Dynamic Settings are Effective After a 1 s to 21600 s (= 6 h) Reclosure TActive Fast Reset Time TStop Dynamic Settings of Pickup Currents and Time Delays or Time Multipliers Increments 0.01 A Increments 1 s Increments 1 s
1 s to 600 s (= 10 min) or (fast reset inactive) Increments 1 s Adjustable within the same ranges and with the same increments as the directional and non-directional time overcurrent protection
375
4.7
Setting ranges / increments Undervoltages 27-1, 27-2 Measured quantity used - Positive sequence system of the voltages - Smallest phase-to-phase voltage - Smallest phase-to-Ground voltage 10 V to 120 V 10 V to 210 V 10 V to 210 V 10 V to 120 V 10 V to 120 V 1.01 to 3.00 Increments 1 V Increments 1 V Increments 1 V Increments 1 V Increments 1 V Increments 0.01
Connection of phase-to-Ground voltages: - Evaluation of phase-to-Ground voltages - Evaluation of phase-to-phase voltages - Evaluation of positive sequence system Connection of phase-to-phase voltages Connection: Single-phase Dropout ratio r for 27-1, 27-2 1) Dropout threshold for (r 27-1) or (r 27-2)
max. 130 V for phase-to-phase voltage max. 225 V for phase-to-Ground voltage Minimum hysteresis 0.6 V 0.00 s to 100.00 s or (disabled) Increments 0.01 s Increments 0.01 A
Time delays T 27-1, T 27-2 Current criterion "BkrClosed I MIN" Overvoltages 59-1, 59-2 Measured quantity used
- Positive sequence system of the voltages - Negative sequence system of the voltages - Largest phase-to-phase voltage - Largest phase-to-Ground voltage 20 V to 150 V 20 V to 260 V 20 V to 150 V 2 V to 150 V 20 V to 150 V 20 V to 150 V 2 V to 150 V 20 V to 150 V 0.90 to 0.99 Increments 1 V Increments 1 V Increments 1 V Increments 1 V Increments 1 V Increments 1 V Increments 1 V Increments 1 V Increments 0.01 V
Connection of phase-to-Ground voltages: - Evaluation of phase-to-Ground voltages - Evaluation of phase-to-phase voltages - Evaluation of positive sequence system - Evaluation of negative sequence system Connection of phase-to-phase voltages: - Evaluation of phase-to-phase voltages - Evaluation of positive sequence system - Evaluation of negative sequence system Connection: Single-phase Dropout ratio r for 27-1, 27-2 1) Dropout threshold for (r 59-1) or (r 59-2)
max. 150 V for phase-to-phase voltage max. 260 V for phase-to-Ground voltage Minimum hysteresis 0.6 V 0.00 s to 100.00 s or (disabled) Increments 0.01 s
1)
r = Vdropout/Vpickup
376
Times Pickup Times - Undervoltage 27-1, 27-2, 27-1 V1, 27-2 V1 - Overvoltage 59-1, 59-2 - Overvoltage 59-1 V1, 59-2 V1, 59-1 V2 , 59-2 V2 Dropout Times - Undervoltage 27-1, 27-2, 27-1 V1, 27-2 V1 - Overvoltage 59-1, 59-2 - Overvoltage 59-1 V1, 59-2 V1, 59-1 V2 , 59-2 V2 Tolerances Voltage limit values Delay times T 3 % of setting value or 1 V 1 % of setting value or 10 ms Approx. 50 ms Approx. 50 ms Approx. 60 ms Approx. 50 ms Approx. 50 ms Approx. 60 ms
Influencing Variables Auxiliary DC voltage in range 0.8 VAux/VAuxNom 1.15 Temperature in range 5 C (41 F) amb 55 C (131 F) Frequency in range of 25 Hz 70 Hz Frequency in range of 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 (fNom = 50 Hz or 60 1 % Hz) Frequency outside range 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 Harmonics - up to 10 % 3rd harmonic - up to 10 % 5th harmonic Increased tolerances 1% 1% 1% 0.5 %/10 K
377
4.8
Setting Ranges / Increments Unbalanced load tripping element for INom = 1 A 0.05 A to 3.00 A or (disabled) 46-1,46-2 for INom = 5 A 0.25 A to 15.00 A or (disabled) Delay Times 46-1, 46-2 Dropout Delay Times 46 T DROP-OUT 0.00 s to 60.00 s or (disabled) 0.00 s to 60.00 s Increments 0.01 A Increments 0.01 s Increments 0.01 s
Functional Limit Functional Limit for INom = 1 A all phase currents 10 A for INom = 5 A all phase currents 50 A for INom = 1 A one phase current 0.05 A for INom = 5 A one phase current 0.25 A Times Pickup Times Dropout Times Approx. 35 ms Approx. 35 ms
Dropout Ratio Characteristic 46-1, 46-2 Approx. 0.95 for I2/INom 0.3
Tolerances Pickup values 46-1, 46-2 Time Delays 3 % of setting value or 15 mA for INom = 1 A, or 75 mA for INom = 5 A 1 % or 10 ms
Influencing Variables for Pickup Values Auxiliary DC voltage in range 0.8 VAux/VAuxNom 1.15 Temperature in range 5 C (41 F) amb 55 C (131 F) Frequency in range of 25 Hz 70 Hz Frequency in range of 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 (fNom = 50 Hz or 60 Hz) Frequency outside range 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 Harmonics - up to 10 % 3rd harmonic - up to 10 % 5th harmonic Transient overreaction for > 100 ms (with full displacement) 1% Increased tolerances 1% 1% <5 % 1% 0.5 %/10 K
378
4.9
Setting Ranges / Increments Pickup value 46-TOC (I2p) Time Multiplier TI2p (IEC) Time Multiplier DI2p (ANSI) Functional Limit Functional Limit for INom = 1 A all phase currents 10 A for INom = 5 A all phase currents 50 A Trip Time Curves acc. to IEC See also Figure 4-7 for INom = 1 A 0.05 A to 2.00 A for INom = 5 A 0.25 A to 10.00 A 0.05 s to 3.20 s or (disabled) 0.50 s to 15.00 s or (disabled) Increments 0.01 s Increments 0.01 s Increments 0.01 A
The trip times for I2/I2p 20 are identical to those for I2/I2p = 20. Pickup Threshold Approx. 1.10 I2p
379
Trip Time Curves acc. to ANSI It can be selected one of the represented trip time characteristic curves in the figures 4-8 and 4-9 each on the right side of the figure.
The trip times for I2/I2p 20 are identical to those for I2/I2p = 20. Pickup Threshold Approx. 1.10 I2p
Tolerances Pickup threshold I2p Time for 2 I/I2p 20 3 % of setting value or 15 mA for INom = 1 A or 75 mA at INom = 5 A 5 % of reference (calculated) value +2 % current tolerance, or 30 ms
Dropout Time Curves with Disk Emulation acc. to ANSI Representation of the possible dropout time curves, see figure 4-8 and 4-9 each on the left side of the figure
380
The dropout time constants apply to (I2/I2p) 0.90 Dropout Value IEC and ANSI (without Disk Emulation) ANSI with Disk Emulation Approx. 1.05 I2p setting value, which is approx. 0.95 pickup thresholdI2 Approx. 0.90 I2p setting value
Tolerances Dropout value I2p Time for I2/I2p 0.90 3 % of setting value or 15 mA for INom = 1 A or 75 mA for INom = 5 A 5 % of reference (calculated) value +2 % current tolerance, or 30 ms
Influencing Variables for Pickup Values Power Supply DC Voltage in Range 0,8 VAux/VAuxNom 1.15 Temperature in range 23.00 F (5 C) amb 131.00 F (55 C) Frequency in range of 25 Hz 70 Hz Frequency in range of 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 (fNom = 50 Hz or 60 Hz) Frequency in range 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 Harmonics - up to 10 % 3rd harmonic - up to 10 % 5th harmonic Transient overreaction for > 100 ms (with full displacement) 1% Increased Tolerances 1% 1% <5 % 1% 0.5 %/10 K
381
Figure 4-7
Trip time characteristics of the inverse time negative sequence element 46-TOC, acc. to IEC
382
Figure 4-8
Dropout time and trip time characteristics of the inverse time unbalanced load stage, acc. to ANSI
383
Figure 4-9
Dropout time and trip time characteristics of the inverse time unbalanced load stage, acc. to ANSI
384
4.10
Setting Ranges / Increments Startup current of the motor ISTARTUP Pickup threshold IMOTOR START for INom = 1 A 0.50 A to 16.00 A for INom = 5 A 2.50 A to 80.00 A for INom = 1 A 0.40 A to 10.0 A for INom = 5 A 2.00 A to 50.00 A Permissible startup time TMax.STARTUP Permissible locked rotor time TLOCKED ROTOR Maximum startup time with warm motor TMax.STARTUP W Maximum startup time with cold motor 1.0 s to 180.0 s 0.5 s to 180.0 s or (disabled) 0.5 s to 180.0 s or (disabled) 0 % to 80 % or (disabled) Increments 0.1 s Increments 0.1 s Increments 0.1 s Increments 1 % Increment 0.01 A Increment 0.01 A
Trip Curve
Tolerances Pickup threshold Time delay 3 % of setting value or 15 mA for INom = 1 A or 75 mA for INom = 5 A 5 % or 30 ms
Influencing variables Power supply direct voltage in range 0.8 VPS/VPSNom 1.15 Temperature in range 5 C amb 55 C Frequency in the range from 25 Hz to 70 Hz Frequency in the range of 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 (fNom = 50 Hz or 60 Hz) Frequency outside range of 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 Harmonics - up to 10 % 3rd harmonic - up to 10 % 5th harmonic 1% Increased tolerances 1% 1% 1% 0.5 %/10 K
385
4.11
Setting Ranges / Increments Motor starting current relative to nominal motor current IStart/IMotor Nom. Nominal motor current IMotor Nom. Max. permissible starting time TSTART max. Equilibrium time TEqual Minimum inhibit time TMIN. INHIBIT TIME Maximum permissible number of warm startups nWARM Difference between cold and warm startups nCOLD - nWARM Extension of Time Constant at stop k at STOP Extension of Time constant at running k at RUNNING Restart Threshold 1.1 to 10.0 Increment 0.1 Increment 0.01 A Increments 1 s Increments 0.1 min Increments 0.1 min Increment 1 Increment 1 Increment 0.1 Increment 0.1
for INom = 1 A 0.20 A to 1.20 A for INom = 5 A 1.00 A to 6.00 A 1 s to 320 s 0.0 min to 320.0 min 0.2 min to 120.0 min 1 to 4 1 to 2 0.2 to 100.0 0.2 to 100.0
Where:
RESTART = Temperature limit below which restarting is possible kR = k-factor for the rotor ISTARTUP = Startup current IMotNom = Motor nominal current Tstart max = Max. startup time R = Thermal rotor time constant ncold = Max. number of cold starts
Influencing variables Power supply direct voltage in range 0.8 VPS/VPSNom 1.15 Temperature in range 5 C amb 55 C Frequency in the range from 25 Hz to 70 Hz Frequency in the range of 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 (fNom = 50 Hz or 60 Hz) Frequency outside range of 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 1% Increased tolerances 1% 0.5 %/10 K
386
4.12
Setting Ranges / Increments Tripping threshold Alarm threshold Trip delay Message delay Blocking duration after motor start for INom = 1 A 0.50 A to 12.00 A for INom = 5 A 2.50 A to 60.00 A for INom = 1 A 0.50 A to 12.00 A for INom = 5 A 2.50 A to 60.00 A 0.00 s to 600.00 s 0.00 s to 600.00 s 0.00 s to 600.00 s Increments 0.01 s Increments 0.01 s Increments 0.01 s Increments 0.01 A Increments 0.01 A
Dropout ratio Dropout ratio tripping stage Dropout ratio warning stage approx. 0.95 approx. 0.95
Tolerances Pickup threshold Time delay for INom = 1 A 3 % of setting value or 15 mA for INom = 5 A 3 % of setting value or 75 mA 1 % or 10 ms
Influencing variables Power supply direct voltage in range 0.8 VPS/VPSNom 1.15 Temperature in range 5 C amb 55 C Frequency in the range from 25 Hz to 70 Hz Frequency in the range of 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 (fNom = 50 Hz or 60 Hz) Frequency outside range of 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 Harmonics - up to 10 % 3rd harmonic - up to 10 % 5th harmonic 1% Increased tolerances 1% 1% 1% 0.5 %/10 K
387
4.13
Frequency Protection
Setting ranges / increments Number of frequency elements Pickup values f> or f< for fNom = 50 Hz Pickup values f> or f< for fNom = 60 Hz Dropout threshold = |pickup threshold - dropout threshold| Delay times T Undervoltage blocking 4; each can be set to f> or f< 40.00 Hz to 60.00 Hz 50.00 Hz to 70.00 Hz 0.02 Hz to 1.00 Hz 0.00 s to 100.00 s or (disabled) 10 V to 150 V Increments 0.01 Hz Increments 0.01 Hz Increments 0.01 Hz Increments 0.01 s Increments 1 V
Times Pickup times f>, f< Dropout times f>, f< approx. 100 ms at fNom = 50 Hz approx. 80 ms at fNom = 60 Hz approx. 100 ms at fNom = 50 Hz approx. 80 ms at fNom = 60 Hz
Tolerances Pickup frequencies 81/O or 81U Undervoltage blocking Time delays 81/O or 81/U 15 mHz (with V = Vnom, f = fNom 5 Hz) 3 % of setting value or 1 V 1 % of setting value or 10 ms
Influencing Variables Power supply direct voltage in range 0.8 VPS/VPSNom 1.15 Temperature in range 23.00 F (-5 C) amb 131.00 F (55 C) Harmonics - up to 10 % 3rd harmonic - up to 10 % 5th harmonic 1% 0.5 %/10 K 1% 1%
388
4.14
Setting Ranges / Increments K-Factor per IEC 60255-8 Time Constant th Thermal Alarm Alarm/Trip Current Overload IAlarm 0.10 to 4.00 1.0 min to 999.9 min for INom = 1 A 0.10 A to 4.00 A for INom = 5 A 0.50 A to 20.00 A Extension k Factor when Machine Stopped Emergency Time TEmergency Nominal Overtemperature (for INom) Trip Characteristic Formula for primary values: 1.0 to 10.0 relative to the time constant for the Increments 0.1 machine running 10 s to 15000 s 40 C to 200 C = 13 F to +185 F Increments 1 s Increments 1 C Increments 0.01 Increments 0.1 min Increments 0.01 A
Dropout Ratios /Trip /Alarm I/IAlarm Tolerances Referring to k INom Referring to trip time 3 % or 15 mA for INom = 1 A, or 75 mA for INom = 5 A, 2 % class according to IEC 60255-8 3 % or 1 s for I/(k INom) > 1.25; 3 % class according to IEC 60255-8 Drops out with Alarm Approx. 0.99 Approx. 0.97
Influencing Variables Referring to k INom Auxiliary DC voltage in range 0,8 VAux/VAuxNom 1.15 Temperature in range 5 C (41 F) amb 55 C (131 F) Frequency in range of 25 Hz 70 Hz Frequency in the range of 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 (fNom = 50 Hz or 60 Hz) Frequency outside range 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 1% Increased tolerances 1% 0.5 %/10 K
389
Figure 4-10
390
4.15
Displacement Voltage Element For all Types of Ground Faults Displacement voltage, measured Displacement voltage, calculated Pickup delay T-DELAY Pickup Additional tripping delay 64-1 DELAY Operating time Dropout value Measurement tolerance V0 > (measured) 3V0 > (calculated) Operating time tolerances V0 > 1.8 V to 200.0 V 3V0 > 10.0 V to 225.0 V 0.04 s to 320.00 s or 0.10 s to 40000.00 s or (disabled) approx. 50 ms 0.95 or (pickup value 0.6 V) 3 % of setting value or 0.3 V 3 % of setting value or 3 V 1 % of setting value or 10 ms Increments 0.1 V Increments 0.1 V Increments 0.01 s Increments 0.01 s
Phase Detection for Ground Faults on an Ungrounded System Measuring Principle VPHASE MIN (Ground Fault Phase) VPHASE MAX (Healthy Phase) Voltage measurement (phase-Ground) 10 V to 100 V 10 V to 100 V Increments 1V Increments 1V
Ground Fault Pickup for All Types of Ground Faults (Definite Time Characteristic) Pickup current 50Ns-2 PICKUP, 50Ns-1 PICKUP for sensitive 1 A transformer for sensitive 5 A transformer for normal 1 A transformer for normal 5 A transformer Time delay 50Ns-2 DELAY, 50Ns-1 DELAY Dropout time delay 50Ns T DROP-OUT Operating time Dropout ratio Measurement tolerance sensitive
0.001 A to 1.600 A 0.005 A to 8.000 A 0.05 A to 35.00 A 0.25 A to 175.00 A 0.00 s to 320.00 s or (disabled) 0.00 s to 60.00 s 50 ms (non-directional) 50 ms (directional) approx. 0.95 for 50Ns > 50 mA
Increments 0.001 A Increments 0.005 A Increments 0.01 A Increments 0.05 A Increments 0.01 s Increments 0.01 s
3 % of setting value or 1 mA for INom = 1 A, or 5 mA for INom = 5 A for setting values < 10 mA approx. 20 % 3 % of setting value or 15 mA for INom = 1 A, or 75 mA for INom = 5 A 1 % of setting value or 10 ms
391
Ground Fault Pickup for All Types of Ground Faults (Inverse Time Characteristic) User-defined characteristic (defined by a maximum of 20 value pairs of current and time delay in direction measurement method "cos phi and sin phi") Pickup current 51Ns for sensitive 1 A transformer for sensitive 5 A transformer for normal 1 A transformer for normal 5-A transformer 0.001 A to 1.400 A 0.005 A to 7.000 A 0.05 A to 4.00 A 0.25 A to 20.00 A Increments 0.001 A Increments 0.005 A Increments 0.01 A Increments 0.05 A Increments 0.01 s
Time multiplier T51Ns Pickup threshold Dropout ratio Measurement tolerance sensitive
0.10 s to 4.00 s or (disabled) Approx. 1.10 I51Ns Approx. 1.05 I51Ns for I51Ns > 50 mA
3 % of setting value or 1 mA at INom = 1 A or 5 mA at INom = 5A for setting values < 10 mA approx. 20 % 3 % of setting value or 15 mA for INom = 1 A or 75 mA for INom =5A 7 % of reference (calculated) value for 2 I/I51Ns 20 + 2 % current tolerance, or 70 ms
Influencing Variables Auxiliary DC voltage in range 0,8 VAux/VAuxNom 1.15 Temperature in range 5 C (41 F) amb 55 C (131 F) Frequency in range of 25 Hz 70 Hz Frequency in range of 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 (fNom = 50 Hz 1 % or 60 Hz) Frequency outside range 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 Harmonics - up to 10 % 3rd harmonic - up to 10 % 5th harmonic Increased tolerances 1% 1% 1% 0.5 %/10 K
Note: When using the sensitive transformer, the linear range of the measuring input for sensitive ground fault detection is from 0.001 A to 1.6 A or 0.005 A to 8.0 A, depending on parameter 205 CT SECONDARY. The function is however still preserved for larger currents.
392
Direction Determination for all Types of Ground Fault with cos / sin Measurement Direction measurement Measuring principle Measuring release RELEASE DIRECT. (current component perpendicular (90) to directional limit line) for sensitive 1 A transformer for sensitive 5 A transformer for normal 1 A transformer for normal 5-A transformer - IN and VN measured - 3I0 and 3V0 calculated Active/reactive power measurement
Dropout ratio Measurement method Directional limit line PHI CORRECTION Dropout delay RESET DELAY Limitation of the directional areas using 1 and 2 Angle tolerance
Approx. 0.80 cos and sin -45.0 to +45.0 1 s to 60 s 1 to 15 3 Increments 0.1 Increments 1 s Increments 1
Direction Determination for all Types of Ground Fault with V0 / I0 Measurement Direction measurement Measuring principle 50Ns-1 element Minimum voltage 50Ns-1 Vmin V0 measured 3V0 calculated Phase angle 50Ns-1 Phi Delta phase angle 50Ns-1 DeltaPhi 50Ns-2 element Minimum voltage 50Ns-2 Vmin V0 measured 3V0 calculated Phase angle 50Ns-2 Phi Delta phase angle 50Ns-2 DeltaPhi 0.4 V to 50 V 10 V to 90 V - 180 to 180 0 to 180 Increments 0.1 V Increments 1 V Increments 1 Increments 1 0.4 V to 50 V 10 V to 90 V - 180 to 180 0 to 180 Increments 0.1 V Increments 1 V Increments 1 Increments 1 - IN and VN measured - 3I0 and 3V0 calculated U0 / I0 phase angle measurement
393
Angle Correction Angle correction for cable converter in two operating points F1/I1 and F2/I2: Angle correction F1, F2 (for resonant-grounded system) Current values I1, I2 for angle correction for sensitive 1 A transformer for sensitive 5 A transformer for normal 1 A transformer for normal 5 A transformer Measurement tolerance sensitive 0.0 to 5.0 Increments 0.1
3 % of setting value or 1 mA at IN = 1 A or 5 mA at INom =5A for setting values < 10 mA approx. 20 % 3 % of setting value or 15 mA at INom = 1 A or 75 mA at INom = 5 A 3
Note: Due to the high sensitivity, the linear range of the measuring input INom with integrated sensitive input transformer is from 0.001 INom to 1.6 INom. For currents greater than 1.6 INom, correct direction determination can no longer be guaranteed.
394
4.16
Setting Ranges / Increments Pickup threshold with INom with 3I0 with INs Pickup extension time Tv Ground Fault Accumulation Time Tsum Reset Time for Accumulation Tres
for INom = 1 A for INom = 5 A for INom = 1 A for INom = 5 A for INom = 1 A for INom = 5 A
0.05 A to 35.00 A 0.25 A to 175.00 A 0.05 A to 35.00 A 0.25 A to 175.00 A 0.005 A to 1.500 A 0.025 A to 7.500 A 0.00 s to 10.00 s 0.00 s to 100.00 s 1 s to 600 s
Increments 0.01 A Increments 0.01 A Increments 0.01 A Increments 0.01 A Increments 0.001 A Increments 0.001 A Increments 0.01 s Increments 0.01 s Increments 1 s Increments 1
Times Pickup Times Current = 1.25 x Pickup Value for 2 Pickup Value Dropout Time (without extension time)
Tolerances Pickup threshold I Times TV, Tsum, Tres Influencing Variables Power supply direct voltage in range 0.8 VPS/VPSNom 1.15 Frequency in range 25 Hz to 70 Hz <1 % <5% relating to the set time 3 % of setting value or 10 mA for INom = 1 A or 50 mA for INom = 5 A 1 % of setting value or 10 ms
395
4.17
Setting Ranges / Increments Pickup threshold Vgnd> / 3V0> Monitoring time after pickup detected Pulse no. for detecting the interm. E/F 2.0 V to 100.0 V 0.04 s ... 10.00 s 2 ... 50 Increments 1 V Increents 0.01 s Increments 1
Dropout ratio Dropout ratio Vgnd> / 3V0> 0,95or (pickup value - 0,6 V)
Tolerances Measurement tolerance Vgnd> / 3V0> Times 3 % of setting value 1 % of setting value or 10 ms
Influencing Variables Power supply direct voltage in range 0.8 VPS/VPSNom 1.15 <1 %
396
4.18
Setting Ranges / Increments Pickup threshold 50-1 BF Pickup threshold 50N-1 BF Time delay 50 BF trip timer for INom = 1 A 0.05 A to 20.00 A for INom = 5 A 0.25 A to 100.00 A for INom = 1 A 0.05 A to 20.00 A for INom = 5 A 0.25 A to 100.00 A 0.06 s to 60.00 s or Increments 0.01 s Increments 0.01 A Increments 0.01 A
Times Pickup times - for internal start - for external start Dropout time Dropout ratio
Included in time delay Included in time delay approx. 25 ms = 0,95 (minimal hysteresis between pickup and tripping 32,5 mA)
Tolerances Pickup threshold 50-1 BF, 50N-1 BF 3 % of setting value, or 15 mA for INom = 1 A or 75 mA for INom = 5 A 1 % or 20 ms
Influencing Variables for Pickup Values Auxiliary DC voltage in range 0.8 VAux/VAuxNom 1.15 Temperature in range 5 C (41 F) amb 55 C (131 F) Frequency in range 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 Harmonics - up to 10 % 3rd harmonic - up to 10 % 5th harmonic
1)
1% 0.5 %/10 K 1% 1% 1%
A further delay for the current may be caused by compensation in the secondary CT circuit.
397
4.19
Measured Values / Modes of Operation Three-phase Single-phase Without fixed phase reference Measurement method for I, V I, 3I0, I1, I2, I2/I1, V, 3V0, V1, V2, dV/dt, P forward, P reverse, Q forward, Q reverse, cos I, IN, INs,IN2, V, VN,Vx, P forward, P reverse, Q forward, Q reverse, cos f, df/dt, binary input Fundamental, r.m.s. value (true RMS), positive sequence system, negative sequence system, zero sequence system exceeding threshold value or falling below threshold value
Pickup on
Setting Ranges / Increments Pickup thresholds: Current I, I1, I2, 3I0, IN Relationship I2/I1 Sensitive ground current INs Voltage V, V1, V2, 3V0 Displacement voltage VN Power P, Q Power factor cos Frequency Frequency change df/dt Voltage change dV/dt Dropout ratio > element Dropout ratio < element Dropout difference f Pickup delay (standard) Pickup delay for I2/I1 Command delay time Dropout delay for fNom = 50 Hz for fNom = 60 Hz for IN = 1 A for IN = 5 A for IN = 1 A for IN = 5 A 0.05 A to 40.00 A 0.25 A to 200.00 A 15 % to 100 % 0.001 A to 1.500 A 2.0 V to 260.0 V 2.0 V to 200.0 V 2.0 W to 10000 W 10 W to 50000 W -0.99 to +0.99 40.0 Hz to 60.0 Hz 50.0 Hz to 70.0 Hz 0.10 Hz/s to 20.00 Hz/s 4 V/s to 100 V/s 1.01 to 3.00 0.70 to 0.99 0.02 Hz to 1.00 Hz 0.00 s to 60.00 s 0.00 s to 28800.00 s 0.00 s to 3600.00 s 0.00 s to 60.00 s Increments 0.01 Increments 0.01 Hz Increments 0.01 Hz Increments 0.01 Hz/s Increments 1 V/s Increments 0.01 Increments 0.01 Increments 0.01 Hz Increments 0.01 s Increments 0.01 s Increments 0.01 s Increments 0.01 s Increments 1% Increments 0.001 A Increments 0.1 V Increments 0.1 V Increment 0.1 W Increments 0.01 A
Fixed Dropout Difference Dropout difference df/dt Dropout difference dV/dt 0.1 Hz/s 3 V/s
398
Function Limits Power measurement three-phase Power measurement single-phase Relationship I2/I1 measurement for INom = 1 A for INom = 5 A for INom = 1 A for INom = 5 A for INom = 1 A for INom = 5 A Positive sequence system current > 0.03 A Positive sequence system current > 0.15 A Phase current > 0.03 A Phase current > 0.15 A Positive or negative sequence system current > 0.1 A Positive or negative sequence system current > 0.5 A
Times Pickup times: Current, voltage (phase quantities) for 2 times the setting value for 10 times the setting value Current, voltage (symmetrical components) for 2 times the setting value for 10 times the setting value Power typical maximum (small signals and threshold values) Power factor Frequency Frequency change for 1.25 times the setting value Voltage change dV/dt for 2 times the setting value Binary input Dropout times: Current, voltage (phase quantities) Current, voltage (symmetrical components) Power typical maximum Power factor Frequency Frequency change Voltage change Binary input < 20 ms < 30 ms < 50 ms < 350 ms < 300 ms < 100 ms < 200 ms <200 ms < 10 ms approx. 30 ms approx. 20 ms approx. 40 ms approx. 30 ms approx. 120 ms approx. 350 ms 300 to 600 ms approx. 100 ms approx. 220 ms approx. 220 ms approx. 20 ms
399
Tolerances Pickup thresholds: Current Current (symmetrical components) Current (I2/I1) Voltage Voltage (symmetrical components) Voltage change dV/dt Power Power factor Frequency Frequency change Times for INom = 1 A for INom = 5 A for INom = 1 A for INom = 5 A for INom = 1 A for INom = 5 A 3% of setting value or 15 mA 3% of setting value or 75 mA 4% of setting value or 20 mA 4% of setting value or 100 mA 4% of setting value 3% of setting value or 0.2 V 4% of setting value or 0.2 V 5 % of setting value or 2 V/s 3% of setting value or 0.5 W 3% of setting value or 2.5 W 3 15 mHz 5% of setting value or 0.05 Hz/s 1% of setting value or 10 ms
Influencing Variables for Pickup Values Auxiliary DC voltage in range 0.8 VAux/VAuxNom 1.15 Temperature in range 5 C (41 F) amb 55 C (131 F) Frequency in range of 25 Hz to 70 Hz Frequency in the range of 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 (fNom = 50 Hz 1 % or 60 Hz) Frequency outside range 0.95 f/fNom 1.05 Harmonics - up to 10 % 3rd harmonic - up to 10 % 5th harmonic Increased tolerances 1% 1% 1% 0.5 %/10 K
400
4.20
Temperature Detection
Temperature Detectors Connectable RTD-box Number of temperature detectors Measuring method Mounting identification 1 7XV5662-6AD10 with 12 temperature sensor inputs max. 12 Pt 100 or Ni 100 or Ni 120 selectable 2 or 3 phase connection Oil or Ambient or Stator or Bearing or Other
Temperature Detectors with Direct Connection (only 7SK805/7SK806) Number of temperature detectors at the I/O 2 exten- max. 5 sion module Measurement method Installation identification Pt 100 or Ni 100 or Ni 120 3-wire connection, shielded cable Oil or Ambient or Stator or Bearing or Other
Operational Measured Values via External Temperature Detection Number of measuring points Temperature Unit Measuring Range for Pt 100 for Ni 100 for Ni 120 Resolution Tolerance Maximal of 12 temperature measuring points C or F, adjustable 199 C to 800 C (326 F to 1472 F) 54 C to 278 C (65 F to 532 F) 52 C to 263 C (62 F to 505 F) 1 C or 1 F 0.5 % of measured value 1 digit
Operational Measured Values via the I/O 2 Extension Module Number of Measuring Points Temperature Unit Measuring Range - for Pt 100 - for Ni 100 or Ni 120 Resolution at temperatures 100 C at temperatures < 100 C Tolerance Current sensor Line resistance Max. 5 temperature measuring points C or F, adjustable 65 C to 710 C (85 F to 1310 F) 50 C to 250 C (58 F to 482 F) 0.5 % of measured value 1 C or 1 F 1.5 C 0.5 % of measured value 1 digit 3.58 mA 14
401
Indication Thresholds for each measuring point Stage 1 50 C to 250 C 58 F to 482 F or (no message) 50 C to 250 C 58 F to 482 F or (no message) (increment 1 C) (increment 1 F) (increment 1 C) (increment 1 F)
Stage 2
402
4.21
Function Blocks and Their Possible Assignments to Task Levels Function block Explanation MW_ BEARB ABSVALUE ADD ALARM AND BLINK BOOL_TO_CO BOOL_TO_DI BOOL_TO_IC BUILD_DI CMD_CANCEL CMD_CHAIN CMD_INF COMPARE CONNECT COUNTER DI_GET_STATUS DI_SET_STATUS D_FF D_FF_MEMO DI_TO_BOOL DINT_TO_REAL DIST_DECODE Magnitude Calculation Addition Alarm AND - Gate Blink block Boolean to Control (conversion) Boolean to Double Point (conversion) Bool to Internal SI, Conversion Create Double Point Annunciation Cancel command Switching Sequence Command Information Metered value comparison Connection Counter Decode status of double-point indication Generate double-point indication with status D- Flipflop Status Memory for Restart Double Point to Boolean (conversion) Adaptor Convert double-point indication with status into four single-point indications with status Division Decode Double Point Dynamic OR Conversion SICAM I/O Unit Live-zero, non-linear Curve Timer (max.1193h) Feedback Loop X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X Task level PLC1_ BEARB X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X PLC_ BEARB X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X SFS_ BEARB X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
X X X X
X X X X X X X
X X X X X X
X X X X X X
403
Function block
LOWER_SETPOINT MUL MV_GET_STATUS MV_SET_STATUS NAND NEG NOR OR REAL_TO_DINT REAL_TO_INT REAL_TO_UINT RISE_DETECT RS_FF RS_FF_MEMO SQUARE_ROOT SR_FF SR_FF_MEMO ST_AND ST_NOT ST_OR SUB TIMER TIMER_SHORT UINT_TO_REAL UPPER_SETPOINT X_OR ZERO_POINT
Lower Limit Multiplication Decode status of a value Set status of a value NAND - Gate Negator NOR - Gate OR - Gate Adaptor Conversion Conversion Edge detector RS- Flipflop RS- Flipflop with status memory Root Extractor SR- Flipflop SR- Flipflop with status memory AND gate with status Inverter with status OR gate with status Substraction Timer Simple timer Conversion Upper Limit XOR - Gate Zero Supression
X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Device-specific CFC Blocks Table 4-1 ASWITCH This block is used to switch between two REAL inputs (RMS values). Name Input SWITCH IN1 IN2 Output OUT Type BOOL REAL REAL REAL Description Analog value selection Analog value Analog value Selected analog value Default function FALSE 0.0 0.0
404
Task levels:
Recommendation: Into task levels PLC1_BEARB and PLC_BEARB, because these levels are directly triggered. Note: If you use thi block in the task levels MW_BEARB and SFS_BEARB, a change of the SWITCH signal is only recognized if the signal lasts longer than the processing cycle of the task level.
General Limits Description Maximum number of all CFC charts considering all task levels Maximum number of all CFC charts considering one task level Maximum number of all CFC inputs considering all charts Maximum number of reset-resistant flipflops D_FF_MEMO Limit 32 Comment If the limit is exceeded, the device rejects the parameter set with an error message, restores the last valid parameter set and restarts using that parameter set. When the limit is exceeded, an error message is output by the device. Consequently, the device starts monitoring. The red ERROR-LED lights up. When the limit is exceeded, an error message is output by the device. Consequently, the device starts monitoring. The red ERROR-LED lights up. When the limit is exceeded, an error message is output by the device. Consequently, the device starts monitoring. The red ERROR-LED lights up.
16
400
350
Device-Specific Limits Description Limit Comment When the limit is exceeded, an error message is output by the device. Consequently, the device starts monitoring. The red ERROR-LED lights up.
Maximum number of synchronous 165 changes of chart inputs per task level Maximum number of chart outputs per 150 task level
Additional Limits Additional limits 1) for the following CFC blocks: Task Level TIMER MW_BEARB PLC1_BEARB PLC_BEARB SFS_BEARB
1) 2) 3)
2)
3)
When the limit is exceeded, an error message is iisued by the device. Consequently, the device starts monitoring. The red ERROR-LED lights up. The following condition applies for the maximum number of timers: (2 number of TIMER + number of TIMER_SHORT) < 30. TIMER and TIMER_SHORT hence share the available timer resources within the frame of this inequation. The limit does not apply to the LONG_TIMER. The time values for the blocks TIMER and TIMER_SHORT must not be selected shorter than the time resolution of the device of 10 ms, as then, the blocks will not then start with the starting pulse.
405
Maximum Number of TICKS in the Task Levels Task level MW_BEARB (measured value processing) PLC1_BEARB (slow PLC processing) PLC_BEARB (fast PLC processing) SFS_BEARB (interlocking)
1)
When the sum of TICKS of all blocks exceeds the limits mentioned before, an error message is output in the CFC.
Processing Times in TICKS for the Individual Elements Individual element Block, basic requirement Each input from the 3rd additional input on for generic modules Combination with input signal border Combination with output signal border Additionally for each chart Arithmetic ABS_VALUE ADD SUB MUL DIV SQUARE_ROOT Base logic AND CONNECT DYN_OR NAND NEG NOR OR RISE_DETECT X_OR Information status SI_GET_STATUS CV_GET_STATUS DI_GET_STATUS MV_GET_STATUS SI_SET_STATUS DI_SET_STATUS MV_SET_STATUS ST_AND ST_OR ST_NOT Number of TICKS 5 1 6 7 1 5 26 26 26 54 83 5 4 6 5 4 5 5 4 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
406
Individual element Memory D_FF D_FF_MEMO RS_FF RS_FF_MEMO SR_FF SR_FF_MEMO Control commands BOOL_TO_CO BOOL_TO_IC CMD_INF CMD_INF_EXE CMD_CHAIN CMD_CANCEL LOOP Type converter BOOL_TO_DI BUILD_DI DI_TO_BOOL DM_DECODE DINT_TO_REAL DIST_DECODE UINT_TO_REAL REAL_TO_DINT REAL_TO_UINT Comparison COMPARE LOWER_SETPOINT UPPER_SETPOINT LIVE_ZERO ZERO_POINT Metered value (counter) Time and clock pulse COUNTER TIMER TIMER_LONG TIMER_SHORT ALARM BLINK Other IO_UNIT
Number of TICKS 5 6 4 4 4 4 5 5 4 4 34 3 8 5 5 5 8 5 8 5 10 10 12 5 5 5 5 6 5 5 8 21 11 17
Routable in Matrix In addition to the defined preassignments, indications and measured values can be freely routed to buffers, preconfigurations can be removed.
407
4.22
Additional Functions
Operational measured values Currents IA; IB; IC Positive Sequence Component I1 Negative Sequence Component I2 IN or 3I0 Range Tolerance 1) Phase-to-ground voltages VA-N, VB-N, VC-N Phase-to-phase voltages VA-B, VB-C, VC-A VN, Vph-gnd, Vx or V0 Positive sequence component V1 Negative sequence component V2 Range Tolerance 1) S, apparent power Range Tolerance 1) P, active power Range Tolerance 1) in A (kA) primary and in A secondary or in % of INom
10 % to 150 % INom 1.5 % of measured value or 1 % INom and from 151 % to 200 % INom 3 % of measured value in kV primary, in V secondary or in % of VNom
10 % to 120 % of VNom 1.5 % of measured value, or 0.5 % of VNom in kVAr (MVAR or GVAR) primary and in % of SNom 0 % to 120 % SNom 1.5 % of SNom For V/VNom and I/INom = 50 to 120% with sign, total and phase-segregated in kW (MW or GW) primary and in % SNom 0 % to 120 % SNom 2 % of SNom For V/VN and I/INom = 50 to 120% and | cos | = 0.707 to 1 With SNom =3 VNom INom with sign, total and phase-segregated in kVAr (MVAr or GVAr) primary and in % SNom 0 % to 120 % SNom 2 % of SNom For V/VNom and I/INom = 50 to 120% and | sin | = 0.707 to 1 With SNom =3 VNom INom total and phase-segregated 1 to +1 2 % for | cos | 0.707 in degrees ( ) 0 to 180 0,5 in Hz fNom 5 Hz 20 mHz in %. 0 % to 400 % 5% class accuracy per IEC 60255-8 in A (kA) primary and in mA secondary
cos , power factor2) Range Tolerance 1) Angle A; B; C, Range Tolerance 1) Frequency f Range Tolerance 1) Temperature overload protection /Trip Range Tolerance 1) Currents of sensitive ground fault detection (total, active, and reactive current) INs, INs real; INs reactive
408
Range Tolerance 1) Temperature Restart inhibit L /L Trip Range Tolerance 1) Restart threshold Restart /L Trip Inhibit time TReclose
Phase angle between zero sequence voltage in and sensitive ground current (3V0, INs) Range Tolerance 1) RTD box
1) 2)
at nominal frequency Display of cos above I/INom and V/VNom greater than 10%
Long-Term Mean Values Time Window Frequency of Updates Long-Term Averages of Currents of Real Power of Reactive Power of Apparent Power IAdmd; IBdmd; ICdmd; I1dmd in A (kA) Pdmd in W (kW, MW) Qdmd in VAr (kVAr, MVAr) Sdmd in VAr (kVAr, MVAr) 5, 15, 30 or 60 minutes adjustable
Min./Max. Memory Storage of Measured Values Reset automatic Manual Reset with date and time Time of day adjustable (in minutes, 0 to 1439 min) Time frame and starting time adjustable (in days, 1 to 365 days, and ) Using binary input Using keypad Via communication IA; IB; IC; I1 (positive sequence component) VA-N; VB-N; VC-N; V1 (Positive Sequence Component); VA-B; VB-C; VC-A S, P; Q, cos ; frequency /Trip IAdmd; IBdmd; ICdmd; I1 (positive sequence component); Sdmd; Pdmd; Qdmd
Min/Max Values for Power Min/Max Values for Overload Protection Min/Max Values for Mean Values
409
Fuse Failure Monitor Setting range of the displacement voltage 3U0 above which voltage failure is detected 10 - 100 V
Setting range of the ground current above which no 0.1 - 1 A for IBdmd = 1 A 0.5 - 5A for IBdmd = 5A voltage failure is assumed Setting range of the pickup threshold I> above which no voltage failure is assumed Measuring voltage monitoring 0.1 - 35 A for IBdmd = 1 A 0.5 - 175 A for IBdmd = 5A depends on the MLFB and configuration with measured and calculated values VN and IN
Broken-wire Monitoring of Voltage Transformer Circuits suited for single-, two- or three-pole broken-wire detection of voltage transformer circuits; only for connection of phase-Ground voltages
Local Measured Value Monitoring Current asymmetry Voltage asymmetry Current sum Imax/Imin > symmetry factor, for I > Ilimit Vmax/Vmin > symmetry factor, for V > Vlimit | iA + iB + iC + kI iN | > limit value, with
Fault Logging Recording of indications of the last 8 power system faults Recording of indications of the last 3 power system ground faults
Time Allocation Resolution for Event Log (Operational Annuncia- 1 ms tions) Resolution for Trip Log (Fault Annunciations) Maximum Time Deviation (Internal Clock) Battery 1 ms 0.01 % Lithium battery 3 V/1 Ah, type CR 1/2 AA Message Battery Fault for insufficient battery charge
Fault Recording maximum of 8 fault records saved; memory maintained by buffer battery in the case of auxiliary voltage failure Recording time Intervals at 50 Hz Intervals at 60 Hz 5 s per fault record, in total up to 18 s at 50 Hz (max. 15 s at 60 Hz) 1 instantaneous value each per 1.0 ms 1 instantaneous value each per 0.83 ms
410
Energy Counter Meter Values for Energy in kWh (MWh or GWh) and in kVARh (MVARh or GVARh) Wp, Wq (real and reactive energy) Range 28 bit or 0 to 2 68 435 455 decimal for IEC 60870-5-103 (VDEW protocol) 31 bit or 0 to 2 147 483 647 decimal for other protocols (other than VDEW) 2 % for I > 0.1 INom, V > 0.1 VNom and | cos | 0.707
Tolerance 1)
1)
At nominal frequency
Accumulated interrupted current (separate for each up to 4 decimal places breaker pole)
Motor Statistics Total number of motor startups Total operating time Total down-time Ratio operating time / down-time Active energy and reactive energy Motor start-up data: - Start-up time - Start-up current (primary) - Start-up voltage (primary) 0 to 9999 0 to 99999 h 0 to 99999 h 0 to 100 % of the last 5 start-ups 0.30 s to 9999.99 s 0 A to 1000 kA 0 V to 100 kV Resolution1 Resolution1 h Resolution1 h Resolution 0.1 %
Operating Hours Counter Display Range Criterion Up to 7 digits Overshoot of an adjustable current threshold (element 50-1, BkrClosed I MIN)
Circuit Breaker Monitoring Calculation method Measured value acquisition/processing Evaluation Saved number of statistical values on r.m.s. value basis: I, Ix, 2P; on instantaneous value basis: I2t phase-selective one limit value each per subfunction up to 13 decimal places
411
Commissioning Aids - Phase rotation test - Operational measured values - Circuit breaker test by means of control function - Creation of a test fault report - Creation of messages
Clock Time synchronization Modes of operation for time tracking No. 1 2 3 4 5 Mode of operation Internal IEC 60870-5-103 Pulse via binary input Explanations Internal synchronization using RTC (presetting) External synchronization using port B (IEC 60870-5-103) External synchronization with pulse via binary input Binary input Communication
Fieldbus (DNP (serial or DNP3 TCIP, External synchronization using field bus Modbus, IEC 60870-5-103 redundant) SNTP (IEC 61850, DNP3 TCP, PROFINET IO) SNTP (no IEC61850) External synchronization using port B (IEC 61850) External synchronization via port A Parameterization via device; notes under 2.1.2.2
Group Switchover of the Function Parameters Number of available setting groups Switchover can be performed via 4 (parameter group A, B, C and D) the keypad on the device DIGSI using the operator interface protocol using port B binary input
IEC 61850 GOOSE (Inter-Relay Communication) The GOOSE communication service of IEC 61850 is qualified for switchgear interlocking. Since the transmission time of GOOSE messages depends on both the number of IEC 61850 clients and the relay's pickup condition, GOOSE is not generally qualified for protection-relevant applications. The protective application is to be checked with regard to the required transmission time and cleared with the manufacturer.
412
4.23
413
4.24
4.24.1
Dimensions
Panel Flush and Cubicle Mounting (Housing Size 1/6)
Figure 4-11
Dimensional drawing of a 7SK80 for panel flush or cubicle mounting (housing size 1/6)
Note: A set of mounting brackets (consisting of upper and lower mounting rail) (order no. C73165-A63-D200-1) is required for cubicle mounting. When using the Ethernet interface, it may be necessary to rework the lower mounting rail. Provide for sufficient space at the device bottom side or below the device to accommodate the cables of the communication modules.
4.24.2
Figure 4-12
414
4.24.3
Figure 4-13
Dimensional drawing of a 7SK80 for panel surface mounting (housing size 1/6)
415
4.24.4
Bottom view
Figure 4-14
416
Appendix
This appendix is primarily a reference for the experienced user. This section provides ordering information for the models of this device. Connection diagrams indicating the terminal connections of the models of this device are included. Following the general diagrams are diagrams that show the proper connections of the devices to primary equipment in many typical power system configurations. Tables with all settings and all information available in this device equipped with all options are provided. Default settings are also given.
A.1 A.2 A.3 A.4 A.5 A.6 A.7 A.8 A.9 A.10 A.11
Ordering Information and Accessories Terminal Assignments Connection Examples Current Transformer Requirements Default Settings Protocol-dependent Functions Functional Scope Settings Information List Group Alarms Measured Values
418 423 429 442 445 451 452 454 471 490 491
417
A.1
A.1.1
Number of binary inputs and outputs Housing 1/6 19 4 x I, 3 BI, 5 BO (2 changeover contacts), 1 life status contact Housing 1/6 19 4 x I, 7 BI, 8 BO (2 changeover contacts), 1 life status contact Housing 1/6 19 4 x I, 3x V, 3 BI, 5 BO (2 changeover contacts), 1 life status contact Housing 1/6 19 4 x I, 3x V, 7 BI, 8 BO (2 changeover contacts), 1 life status contact Housing 1/6 19 4 x I, 3 BI, 5 BO (2 changeover contacts), 5 temperature sensors, 1 life status contact Housing 1/6 19 4 x I, 3x V, 3 BI, 5 BO (2 changeover contacts), 5 temperature sensors, 1 life status contact Measuring inputs (4 x I) Iph = 1 A, In = 1 A / 5 A Iph = 1 A, Ins (sensitive) = 0.001 to 1.6 A / 0.005 to 8 A Auxiliary voltage (power supply, pilot voltage) DC 24 V/48 V DC 60 V / 110 V / 125 V / 220 V / 250 V, AC 115 V, AC 230 V Construction Surface-mounting case, screw-type terminals Flush mounting case, screw-type terminals Region-specific default settings / function versions and language default settings Region DE, IEC, language German (language can be changed, standard front panel Region world, IEC/ANSI, language English (language can be changed), standard front panel Region US, ANSI, language US-English (language can be changed), US front panel Region FR, IEC/ANSI, language French (language can be changed), standard front panel Region world, IEC/ANSI, language Spanish (language can be changed), standard front panel Region world, IEC/ANSI, language Italian (language can be changed), standard front panel Region RUS, IEC/ANSI, language Russian (language can be changed), standard front panel Region CHN, IEC/ANSI, language Chinese (language can not be changed), standard front panel Chinese B E 1 5 1 2 1 2 3 4 5 6
Pos. 6
Pos. 7
Pos. 8
Pos. 9
Pos. 10 A B C D E F G K
418
Port B (bottom side of device, rear) not equipped IEC60870-5-103 or DIGSI4/modem, electrical RS232 IEC60870-5-103, DIGSI4/modem or RTD box, electrical RS485 IEC60870-5-103, DIGSI4/Modem or RTD box, optical 820nm, ST connector For further interface options, see Additional Information in the following Additional information for additional ports (bottom side of device, rear, port B) Profibus DP Slave, electrical RS485 Profibus DP Slave, 820 nm, optical double ring, ST connector Modbus, electrical RS485 Modbus, optical 820 nm, ST connector DNP3.0, electrical RS485 DNP3.0, optical 820 nm, ST connector IEC 60870-5-103 Protocol, redundant, electrical RS485, RJ45 connector IEC 61850, 100Mbit Ethernet electrical, double, RJ45 connector IEC 61850 100 Mbit Ethernet optical, double, LC connector DNP3 TCP, 100 Mbit Ethernet electrical, double, RJ45 connector DNP3 TCP, 100 Mbit Ethernet optical, double, LC connector PROFINET 100Mbit Ethernet electrical, double, RJ45 connector PROFINET 100 Mbit Ethernet optical, double, LC connector Converter SIEMENS OLM1) SIEMENS OLM1)
1)
Pos. 11 0 1 2 3 9 Supplementary +L0A +L0B +L0D +L0E +L0G +L0H +L0P +L0R +L0S +L2R +L2S +L3R +L3S
The converter requires an operating voltage of 24 VDC. If the available operating voltage is > 24 VDC the additional power supply 7XV58100BA00 is required.
Pos. 12 0
with Ethernet interface (DIGSI interface, RTD box connection, I/O unit connection, not IEC61850), RJ45 con- 6 nector Measurement / Fault Recording With fault recording With fault recording, average values, min/max values Pos. 13 1 3
419
Functions Name
3)
Pos. 15 D
ANSI No. 50/51 50N/51N 50N(s)/ 51N(s) 49 74TC 46 50BF 86 48 37 66/86 14 51M
Description Control Time overcurrent protection phase 50-1, 50-2, 50-3, 51 Time overcurrent protection ground 50N-1, 50N-2, 50N-3, 51N Ground fault protection/ ground short-circuit protection 50Ns-1, 50Ns-2, 51Ns 1) Intermittent ground fault protection Thermal overload protection Trip circuit supervision Negative sequence overcurrent protection Breaker failure protection Lock out Motor Starting Protection Undercurrent surveillance Restart inhibit for motors Locked rotor protection Load jam protection Motor statistics Cold-load pickup Monitoring functions Circuit breaker control Flexible protection functions (parameters from current) Inrush restraint Voltage-controlled inverse-time overcurrent protection Directional ground fault protection 67N-1, 67N-2, 67N-3, 67N-TOC Directional ground fault protection/ground short circuit protection 67Ns-1, 67Ns-2, 67Ns-TOC 1) Directional intermittent ground fault protection2) Displacement voltage Undervoltage / overvoltage Underfrequency / overfrequency, f< ,f> Phase sequence
Basic design 4) + ground fault direction detection + voltage protection + frequency protection + directional intermittent ground fault protection
32/55/81R/ Flexible protection functions 27R/59R (parameters from current and voltage): Voltage protection, power protection, power factor protection, frequency change protection and voltage change protection
1)
2) 3) 4)
depending on ground current input at position 7, the function works either as ground fault protection (sensitive input) or as ground short circuit protection (normal Ie input) only with sensitive input, Position 7=2 only deliverable with position 6 = 1, 2 or 5 only deliverable with position 6 = 3, 4 or 6 (3 x V)
420
Special model
Supplementary
with ATEX 100 approval for the protection of explosion-protected motors of protection type increased +Z X 9 9 safety "e"
A.1.2
Accessories
Exchangeable interface modules Name RS232 RS485 FO 820 nm Profibus DP RS485 Profibus DP double ring Modbus RS485 Modbus 820 nm DNP 3.0 RS 485 DNP 3.0 820 nm Ethernet electrical (EN 100) Ethernet optical (EN 100), 4 ST connectors Ethernet electrical (EN 100, PROFINET IO) Ethernet optical (EN 100, PROFINET IO) Ethernet electrical (EN 100, DNP3 TCP ) Ethernet optical (EN 100, DNP3 TCP), multimode IEC 608705103 protocol, redundant, RS485 Ethernet port electrical at port A Order No. C53207-A351-D641-1 C53207-A351-D642-1 C53207-A351-D643-1 C53207-A351-D611-1 C53207-A351-D613-1 C53207-A351-D621-1 C53207-A351-D623-1 C53207-A351-D631-1 C53207-A351-D633-1 C53207-A351-D675-2 C53207-A351-D676-1 C53207-A351-D688-1 C53207-A351-D689-1 C53207-A351-D684-1 C53207-A351-D686-1 C53207-A351-D644-1 C53207-A351-D151-1
RTD Box (Thermobox) Name RTD box RS 485, Vaux = 24 to 240 V AC/DC RTD box with Ethernet connection, VH = 24 to 240 V AC/DC Order number 7XV56626AD10 7XV5662-8AD10
RS485 FO converter RS485 FO converter 820 nm; FCConnector 820 nm, with ST-Connector Order No. 7XV5650-0AA00 7XV5650-0BA00
421
Mounting Rail for 19"-Racks Name Mounting Rail Set Order Number C73165-A63-D200-1
Surface mounting console (converts flush mounting variants into surface mounting variant) Surface mounting console C53207-A356-D850-1
Battery Lithium battery 3 V/1 Ah, type CR 1/2 AA VARTA Panasonic Order No. 6127 101,301 BR-1/2AA
Terminals Voltage terminal block C or block E Voltage terminal block D (inverse printed) 1) shield for voltage terminals (block D) 1) Current terminal block 4xI Current terminal block 3xI,1xINs (sensitive) Current terminal short circuit links, 3 pieces Voltage terminal short circuit links, 6 pieces
1)
If the voltage terminal is used for internal temperature detection (7SK805 and 7SK806), the shield for the voltage terminal is additionally required.
Varistor Voltage-limiting resistor for high-impedance differential protection Name 125 Veff, 600 A, 1S/S256 240 Veff, 600 A, 1S/S1088 Order number W73028-V3125-A1 W73028-V3300-A2
422
A.2
A.2.1
Terminal Assignments
7SK80 Housing for panel flush mounting and cubicle installation and for panel surface mounting
7SK801*
Figure A-1
423
7SK802*
Figure A-2
424
7SK803*
Figure A-3
425
7SK804*
Figure A-4
426
7SK805*
Figure A-5 *)
The shielding of the connecting cable is connected directly to the shield cap.
427
7SK806*
Figure A-6 *)
The shield of the connecting cable is connected directly to the shield cover.
428
A.3
Connection Examples
Figure A-7
Current transformer connections to three current transformers and neutral rpoint current (ground current) (Holmgreen connection) appropriate for all networks
Figure A-8
Current transformer connections to two current transformers only for isolated or resonantgrounded networks
429
Current transformer connections to three current transformers, ground current from additional summation current transformer preferably for effectively or low-resistance grounded networks Grounding of the cable shield must be effected at the cable side
The switchover of the current polarity (address 201) also reverses the polarity of the current input IN!
Figure A-10
Current transformer connections to two current transformers - additional cable-type current transformer for sensitive ground fault detection - only for isolated or resonant-grounded networks Grounding of the cable shield must be effected at the cable side
Important: Note:
The switchover of the current polarity (address 201) also reverses the polarity of the current input INs!
430
Current transformer connections to three current transformers - ground current from additional cable-type current transformer for sensitive ground fault detection Grounding of the cable shield must be effected at the cable side
The switchover of the current polarity (address 201) also reverses the polarity of the current input INs!
Figure A-12
Transformer connections to three current transformers and three voltage transformers (phase-to-ground voltages), normal circuit layout appropriate for all networks
431
Figure A-13
Transformer connections to three current transformers and three voltage transformers capacitive -
432
Figure A-14
Transformer connections to three current transformers, two voltage transformers (phase-to-phase voltages) and broken delta winding (da-dn) appropriate for all networks
433
Figure A-15
Current transformer connections to two current transformers and as open-delta connection the voltage transformer for isolated or resonant-grounded networks when no directional ground protection is needed
Figure A-16
Current transformer connections to three current transformers, two voltage transformers in open-deltaconnection, only for isolated or resonant-grounded networks; no directional ground protection since displacement voltage cannot be calculated
Hint
If the system has only 2 voltage transformers (open-delta connection), the device, too, should be connected in open-delta connection and the unused voltage input should be short-circuited.
434
Transformer connections to three current transformers, cable-type current transformer and broken delta winding, maximum precision for sensitive ground fault detection Grounding of the cable shield must be effected at the cable side
For busbar-side grounding of the current transformers, the current polarity of the device is changed via address 0201. This also reverses the polarity of the current input IN/INs. When using a cable-type current transformer, the connection of k and I at F8 and F7 must be exchanged.
435
Figure A-18
Current transformer connections to two phase-current transformers and a ground-current transformer; the ground current is taken via the highly sensitive and sensitive ground input.
Important! Grounding of the cable shield must be effected at the cable side For busbar-side grounding of the current transformers, the current polarity of the device is changed via address 0201. This also reverses the polarity of current input INs. When using a cable-type current transformer, the connection of k and I at F8 and F7 must be exchanged.
436
Figure A-19
Current transformer connections to two phase currents and two ground currents; IN/INs ground current of the line, IN2 ground current of the transformer starpoint
Important! Grounding of the cable shield must be effected at the cable side For busbar-side grounding of the current transformers, the current polarity of the device is changed via address 0201. This also reverses the polarity of the current input IN/INs. When using a cable-type current transformer, the connection of k and l at F8 and F7 must be exchanged.
Figure A-20
Example for the connection type "VAN, VBN, VCN" with voltage connection on the feeder side
437
Figure A-21
Voltage transformer connections to two voltage transformers (phase-to-phase voltages) and broken delta winding (da-dn) appropriate for all networks
Figure A-22
Example for connection type "VAN, VBN, VCN" busbar-side voltage connection
438
Figure A-23
Figure A-24
439
Figure A-25
Example for connection type "VAB, VBC" with phase voltage connection as open-delta connection
A.3.1
Figure A-26 *
Half-duplex operation with one RTD-Box, above: optical design (2 FOs); below: design with RS485 optionally Ethernet via port A (EN100LC).
A.3.2
Figure A-27 1 2
Connection of 2 SICAM I/O Units to Port A via Y-cabel (up to 2 SICAM I/O-Units connectable)
440
Figure A-28 1 2
Connection of 2 SICAM I/O units and 1 RTD box via Y cable (up to 2 SICAM I/O units connectable)
441
A.4
A.4.1
Effective and Rated Accuracy Limiting Factor Required minimum effective accuracy limiting factor but at least 20 with KALF' 50-2PU IpNom Resulting rated accuracy limiting factor Minimum effective accuracy limiting factor Primary pickup value of the high-current element Primary nominal transformer current
with KALF RBC RBN RCt Calculation example according to IEC 600441 IsNom = 1 A KALF' = 20 RBC = 0.6 (device and cables) RCt = 3 RBN = 5 (5 VA) with IsNom = secondary transformer nominal current KALF set to 10, so that: 5P10, 5 VA Rated accuracy limiting factor Connected burden resistance (device and cables) Nominal burden resistance Transformer internal burden resistance
442
A.4.2
Class conversion
Table A-1 Conversion into other classes
IsNom = 5 A (typical value) IEC 60044-6 (transient response), class TPS K 1 KSSC KALF Calculation See ChapterA.4.1 Accuracy limiting factors with: KSSC KALF TP depending on power system and specified closing sequence with Vk RCt RBN IsNom KALF Vs.t.max Val K KSSC TP Knee-point voltage Internal burden resistance Nominal burden resistance Secondary nominal transformer current Rated accuracy limiting factor Sec. terminal voltage at 20 IpNom Sec. magnetization limit voltage Dimensioning factor Factor symmetr. Rated fault current Primary time constant
A.4.3
General
The requirements to the cable core balance current transformer are determined by the function sensitive ground fault detection. The recommendations are given according to the standard IEC 60044-1. Requirements Transformation ratio, typical 60 / 1 It may be necessary to select a different transformation ratio to suit the specific power system and thus the amount of the maximum ground fault current. Accuracy limiting factor Minimum power Maximum connected load For secondary current threshold values 20 mA For secondary current threshold values < 20 mA FS = 10 1.2 VA 1.2 VA ( 1.2 ) 0.4 VA ( 0.4 )
443
Class accuracy Table A-2 Minimum required class accuracy depending on neutral grounding and function operating principle isolated Class 1 Class 3 resonant-grounded Class 1 Class 1 high-resistance grounded Class 1 Class 3
For extremely small ground fault currents it may become necessary to correct the angle at the device (see function description of sensitive ground fault detection).
444
A.5
Default Settings
When the device leaves the factory, many LED indications, binary inputs, binary outputs and function keys are already preset. They are summarized in the following table.
A.5.1
LEDs
Table A-3 LEDs LED1 LED2 LED3 LED4 LED5 LED6 7SK801* or 7SK805* Default function Relay TRIP 50/51 Ph A PU 50/51 Ph B PU 50/51 Ph C PU 50N/51NPickedup Failure I Fail I balance Fail Ph. Seq. I Not configured Brk OPENED 7SK802* Default function Relay TRIP 50/51 Ph A PU 50/51 Ph B PU 50/51 Ph C PU 50N/51NPickedup Failure I Fail I balance Fail Ph. Seq. I Not configured Brk OPENED 7SK803* Default function Relay TRIP 50/51 Ph A PU 50/51 Ph B PU 50/51 Ph C PU 50N/51NPickedup 67N picked up Failure I Fail I balance Fail V balance Fail Ph. Seq. I Fail Ph. Seq. V VT brk. wire Not configured Brk OPENED Function No. 511 1762 1763 1764 1765 2695 162 163 167 175 176 253 1 Description Relay GENERAL TRIP command 50/51 Phase A picked up 50/51 Phase B picked up 50/51 Phase C picked up 50N/51N picked up 67N/67N-TOC picked up Failure: Current Summation Failure: Current Balance Failure: Voltage Balance Failure: Phase Sequence Current Failure: Phase Sequence Voltage Failure VT circuit: broken wire No Function configured Breaker OPENED Function No. 511 1762 1763 1764 1765 162 163 175 1 Description Relay GENERAL TRIP command 50/51 Phase A picked up 50/51 Phase B picked up 50/51 Phase C picked up 50N/51N picked up Failure: Current Summation Failure: Current Balance Failure: Phase Sequence Current No Function configured Breaker OPENED Function No. 511 1762 1763 1764 1765 162 163 175 1 Description Relay GENERAL TRIP command 50/51 Phase A picked up 50/51 Phase B picked up 50/51 Phase C picked up 50N/51N picked up Failure: Current Summation Failure: Current Balance Failure: Phase Sequence Current No Function configured Breaker OPENED
LED7 LED8 Table A-4 LEDs LED1 LED2 LED3 LED4 LED5 LED6
LED7 LED8 Table A-5 LEDs LED1 LED2 LED3 LED4 LED5 LED6
LED7 LED8
445
7SK804* or 7SK806* Default function Relay TRIP 50/51 Ph A PU 50/51 Ph B PU 50/51 Ph C PU 50N/51NPickedup 67N picked up Failure I Fail I balance Fail V balance Fail Ph. Seq. I Fail Ph. Seq. V VT brk. wire Not configured Brk OPENED Function No. 511 1762 1763 1764 1765 2695 162 163 167 175 176 253 1 Description Relay GENERAL TRIP command 50/51 Phase A picked up 50/51 Phase B picked up 50/51 Phase C picked up 50N/51N picked up 67N/67N-TOC picked up Failure: Current Summation Failure: Current Balance Failure: Voltage Balance Failure: Phase Sequence Current Failure: Phase Sequence Voltage Failure VT circuit: broken wire No Function configured Breaker OPENED
LED7 LED8
A.5.2
Binary Input
Table A-7 Binary Input BI1 BI2 BI3 Binary input presettings for all devices and ordering variants Default function >BLOCK 50-2 >BLOCK 50N-2 >52-b 52Breaker >52-a 52Breaker Function No. 1721 1724 4602 4601 Description >BLOCK 50-2 >BLOCK 50N-2 >52-b contact (OPEN, if bkr is closed) 52 Breaker >52-a contact (OPEN, if bkr is open) 52 Breaker
Further binary input presettings for 7SK802* or 7SK804* Default function not pre-assigned not pre-assigned not pre-assigned not pre-assigned Function No. Description
446
A.5.3
Binary Output
Table A-9 Output Relay Presettings for All Devices and Ordering Variants Function No. 511 Description Relay GENERAL TRIP command 52 Breaker 52 Breaker 52 Breaker 162 163 167 175 176 253 501 Failure: Current Summation Failure: Current Balance Failure: Voltage Balance Failure: Phase Sequence Current Failure: Phase Sequence Voltage Failure VT circuit: broken wire Relay PICKUP
Binary Output Default function BO1 Relay TRIP 52Breaker BO2 52Breaker BO3 BO4 52Breaker Failure I Fail I balance Fail V balance Fail Ph. Seq. I Fail Ph. Seq. V VT brk. wire Relay PICKUP
Further Output Relay Presettings for 7SK802* or 7SK804* Function No. Description
Binary Output Default function BO6 not pre-assigned BO7 not pre-assigned BO8 not pre-assigned
A.5.4
Function Keys
Table A-11 Applies to All Devices and Ordered Variants Default function Display of the operational indications Display of the primary operational measured values Display of the last fault log buffer not pre-assigned not pre-assigned not pre-assigned not pre-assigned not pre-assigned not pre-assigned
Function Keys F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 F6 F7 F8 F9
447
A.5.5
Default Display
A number of pre-defined measured value pages are available depending on the device type. The start page of the default display appearing after startup of the device can be selected in the device data via parameter 640 Start image DD.
Figure A-29
Default display of the 7SK80 for models with V without extended measured values
With the V0/IO measurement, the measured ground current IN2 is displayed under N and the ground current IN or INs under Ns.
448
Figure A-30
Default display of 7SK80 for models with V with extended measured values
Figure A-31
Default display of the 7SK80 for models without V and extended measured values
449
Figure A-32
Default display of the 7SK80 for models without V with extended measured values
Spontaneous Fault Display After a fault has occurred, the most important fault data are automatically displayed after general device pickup in the order shown in the picture below.
Figure A-33
450
A.6
Protocol Function
Protocol-dependent Functions
IEC 60870- IEC 608705-103, 5-103, single redundant Yes Yes Yes No Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes IEC 61850 PROFINET Profibus DP DNP3 TCP DNP3.0 Ethernet Ethernet Ethernet Modbus (EN 100) (EN100) (EN100) ASCII/RTU Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No No Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No No Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No No Yes Yes Yes
Operational measured values Metered values Fault recording Remote protection setting
User-defined indications Yes and switching objects Time synchronization Messages with time stamp Commissioning aids Data transmission stop Creating test messages Physical mode Transmission mode Yes Yes Asynchronous cyclic/ event 1,200 to 115,000 Yes Yes
No No
No No Asynchronous
No No
No No Asynchronous
cyclically
cyclic
cyclically / event
Baud rate
up to 100 MBaud
Type
RS485 Ethernet RS485 optical fiber TP optical fiber (double ring) Ethernet optical fiber
451
A.7
Addr. 103 104 112
Functional Scope
Parameter Grp Chge OPTION OSC. FAULT REC. Charac. Phase Setting Options Disabled Enabled Disabled Enabled Disabled Definite Time TOC IEC TOC ANSI Disabled Definite Time TOC IEC TOC ANSI Disabled Definite Time TOC IEC TOC ANSI Disabled Enabled Disabled Enabled cos / sin V0/I0 mea. Disabled Definite Time User Defined PU Disabled with Ignd with 3I0 with Ignd,sens. Disabled Enabled Disabled TOC ANSI TOC IEC Definite Time Disabled Enabled Disabled No ambient temp With amb. temp. Disabled Enabled Disabled Enabled Disabled Enabled Disabled Enabled Default Setting Disabled Enabled Definite Time Comments Setting Group Change Option Oscillographic Fault Records 50/51
113
Charac. Ground
Definite Time
50N/51N
116
67N/67N-TOC
Definite Time
67N, 67N-TOC
Cold Load Pickup 2nd Harmonic Inrush Restraint (sens.) Ground fault dir. characteristic (sensitive) Ground fault
133
INTERM.EF
Disabled
134 140
Dir. Interm. EF 46
Disabled Disabled
141 142
48 49
66 Startup Counter for Motors Load Jam Protection 27, 59 Under/Overvoltage Protection 81 Over/Underfrequency Protection
452
Parameter
Setting Options Disabled Enabled enabled w/ 3I0> Disabled Ix-Method 2P-Method I2t-Method Disabled 2 Binary Inputs 1 Binary Input Disabled Enabled 6 RTD simplex 6 RTD HDX 12 RTD HDX 6 RTD Eth 12 RTD Eth Int.Temp.Meas. NO YES Disabled T103 DIGSI RTD-RS485 Flex. Function 01 Flex. Function 02 Flex. Function 03 Flex. Function 04 Flex. Function 05 Flex. Function 06 Flex. Function 07 Flex. Function 08 Flex. Function 09 Flex. Function 10 Flex. Function 11 Flex. Function 12 Flex. Function 13 Flex. Function 14 Flex. Function 15 Flex. Function 16 Flex. Function 17 Flex. Function 18 Flex. Function 19 Flex. Function 20
172
52 B.WEAR MONIT
Disabled
182
74 Trip Ct Supv
Disabled
190 191
192 617
NO T103
Please select
Flexible Functions
453
A.8
Settings
Addresses which have an appended "A" can only be changed with DIGSI, under "Display Additional Settings". The table indicates region-specific default settings. Column C (configuration) indicates the corresponding secondary nominal current of the current transformer.
Addr. 0
Function
Setting Options OFF ON Alarm Only 3-phase 1-phase no reference YES NO Please select Current Voltage P forward P reverse Q forward Q reverse Power factor dV/dt rising dV/dt falling Frequency df/dt rising df/dt falling Binray Input Fundamental True RMS Positive seq. Negative seq. Zero sequence Ratio I2/I1 Exceeding Dropping below Ia Ib Ic In In sensitive In2 Please select Va-n Vb-n Vc-n Va-b Vb-c Vc-a Vn Vx Ia Va-n Ib Vb-n Ic Vc-n Phase-Phase Phase-Ground 0.05 .. 40.00 A OFF
Default Setting
OPERRAT. MODE
Flx
3-phase
Mode of Operation
0 0
Flx Flx
MEAS. METHOD
Flx
Fundamental
0 0
Flx Flx
Exceeding Ia
VOLTAGE
Flx
Please select
Voltage
POWER
Flx
Ia Va-n
Power
0 0 0
Phase-Phase 2.00 A 2.00 A 10.00 A 0.100 A 0.500 A 110.0 V 110.0 V 51.00 Hz 61.00 Hz 5.00 Hz/s
0.05 .. 40.00 A 0.25 .. 200.00 A 0.001 .. 1.500 A 0.005 .. 7.500 A 2.0 .. 260.0 V 2.0 .. 200.0 V 40.00 .. 60.00 Hz 50.00 .. 70.00 Hz 0.10 .. 20.00 Hz/s
P.U. THRESHOLD
Flx
1A 5A
Pickup Threshold
0 0 0 0 0
P.U. THRESHOLD P.U. THRESHOLD P.U. THRESHOLD P.U. THRESHOLD P.U. THRESHOLD
Pickup Threshold Pickup Threshold Pickup Threshold Pickup Threshold Pickup Threshold
454
Addr. 0
Function
C 1A 5A
Setting Options 2.0 .. 10000.0 W 10.0 .. 50000.0 W -0.99 .. 0.99 15 .. 100 % 4 .. 100 V/s 2.0 .. 260.0 V 0.00 .. 3600.00 sec 0.00 .. 60.00 sec 0.00 .. 28800.00 sec 0.00 .. 60.00 sec NO YES 0.70 .. 0.99 1.01 .. 3.00 0.02 .. 1.00 Hz Sensitive Normal towards Line towards Busbar 0.10 .. 800.00 kV 34 .. 225 V 10 .. 50000 A 1A 5A 1.00 .. 3.00 ABC ACB 0.01 .. 32.00 sec
Default Setting 200.0 W 1000.0 W 0.50 20 % 60 V/s 110.0 V 1.00 sec 0.00 sec 0.00 sec 0.00 sec YES 0.95 1.05 0.03 Hz Normal towards Line 20.00 kV 100 V 400 A 1A 1.73 ABC 0.15 sec 0.04 A 0.20 A Van, Vbn, Vcn
0 0 0 0 0 0A 0 0A 0A 0A 0A 0 132 201 202 203 204 205 206A 209 210A 212
P.U. THRESHOLD P.U. THRESHOLD P.U. THRESHOLD P.U. THRESHOLD T TRIP DELAY T PICKUP DELAY T PICKUP DELAY T DROPOUT DELAY BLK.by Vol.Loss DROPOUT RATIO DROPOUT RATIO DO differential GND CT Scaling CT Starpoint Vnom PRIMARY Vnom SECONDARY CT PRIMARY CT SECONDARY Vph / Vdelta PHASE SEQ. TMin TRIP CMD BkrClosed I MIN
Flx Flx Flx Flx Flx Flx Flx Flx Flx Flx Flx Flx Device, General P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 1A 5A
Pickup Threshold Pickup Threshold Pickup Threshold Pickup Threshold Trip Time Delay Pickup Time Delay Pickup Time Delay Dropout Time Delay Block in case of Meas.-Voltage Loss Dropout Ratio Dropout Ratio Dropout differential Ground CT Scaling CT Starpoint Rated Primary Voltage Rated Secondary Voltage (L-L) CT Rated Primary Current CT Rated Secondary Current Matching ratio Phase-VT To Open-Delta-VT Phase Sequence Minimum TRIP Command Duration Closed Breaker Min. Current Threshold VT Connection, three-phase
0.04 .. 1.00 A 0.20 .. 5.00 A Van, Vbn, Vcn Vab, Vbc, VGnd Vab, Vbc Vab, Vbc, Vx 50 Hz 60 Hz 1 .. 50000 A 1A 5A Thresh. BI 176V Thresh. BI 88V Thresh. BI 19V Thresh. BI 176V Thresh. BI 88V Thresh. BI 19V Thresh. BI 176V Thresh. BI 88V Thresh. BI 19V Thresh. BI 176V Thresh. BI 88V Thresh. BI 19V Thresh. BI 176V Thresh. BI 88V Thresh. BI 19V Thresh. BI 176V Thresh. BI 88V Thresh. BI 19V Thresh. BI 176V Thresh. BI 88V Thresh. BI 19V 0.10 .. 800.00 kV
213
VT Connect. 3ph
P.System Data 1
50 Hz 60 A 1A Thresh. BI 176V
Rated Frequency Ignd-CT rated primary current Ignd-CT rated secondary current Threshold for Binary Input 1
221
Threshold BI 2
P.System Data 1
Thresh. BI 176V
222
Threshold BI 3
P.System Data 1
Thresh. BI 176V
223
Threshold BI 4
P.System Data 1
Thresh. BI 176V
224
Threshold BI 5
P.System Data 1
Thresh. BI 176V
225
Threshold BI 6
P.System Data 1
Thresh. BI 176V
226
Threshold BI 7
P.System Data 1
Thresh. BI 176V
232
VXnom PRIMARY
P.System Data 1
20.00 kV
455
Addr. 233 235A 238 239 241 242 243 244 245 246 250A 251A
Parameter VXnom SECONDARY ATEX100 Ignd2-CT PRIM. Ignd2-CT SEC. Volt.trans.A:C1 Volt.trans.A:C2 Volt.trans.B:C1 Volt.trans.B:C2 Volt.trans.C:C1 Volt.trans.C:C2 50/51 2-ph prot CT Connect.
Function P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1
Setting Options 100 .. 225 V NO YES 1 .. 50000 A 1A 5A 1.0 .. 100.0 pF 250 .. 10000 pF 1.0 .. 100.0 pF 250 .. 10000 pF 1.0 .. 100.0 pF 250 .. 10000 pF OFF ON A, B, C, (Gnd) A,G2,C,G; G->B A,G2,C,G; G2->B not reversed reversed 10 .. 50000 A 100 .. 1000000 10 .. 100000 A 1 .. 1000 1.0 .. 3.0 (Setting options depend on configuration) 1 .. 600 ms 1 .. 500 ms Celsius Fahrenheit NO YES Group A Group B Group C Group D Binary Input Protocol 10 .. 50000 A 1 .. 5000 A 1 .. 50000 A 0.01 .. 5000.00 A 10.0 .. 1000.0 mV 10.0 .. 1000.0 mV 0.9000 .. 1.1000 0.9000 .. 1.1000
Default Setting 100 V YES 400 A 1A 10.0 pF 2200 pF 10.0 pF 2200 pF 10.0 pF 2200 pF OFF A, B, C, (Gnd)
Comments Rated Secondary Voltage X Storage of th. Replicas w/o Power Supply Ignd2-CT rated primary c. (conn. to I2) Ignd2-CT rated secondary current (I2) Voltage transducer A: Capacity C1 Voltage transducer A: Capacity C2 Voltage transducer B: Capacity C1 Voltage transducer B: Capacity C2 Voltage transducer C: Capacity C1 Voltage transducer C: Capacity C2 50, 51 Time Overcurrent with 2ph. prot. CT Connection
252 260 261 262 263 264 265 266 267 276 280 302
Ph LPCT pol. Ir-52 OP.CYCLES AT Ir Isc-52 OP.CYCLES Isc Ix EXPONENT Cmd.via control T 52 BREAKTIME T 52 OPENING TEMP. UNIT Holmgr. for i CHANGE
P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 Change Group
Phase LPCT orientation / polarity Rated Normal Current (52 Breaker) Switching Cycles at Rated Normal Current Rated Short-Circuit Breaking Current Switch. Cycles at Rated ShortCir. Curr. Exponent for the Ix-Method 52 B.Wear: Open Cmd. via Control Device Breaktime (52 Breaker) Opening Time (52 Breaker) Unit of temperature measurement Holmgreen-conn. (for fast sum-imonit.) Change to Another Setting Group
Iph-PRIM ref. Iph-LPCT PRIM Ignd-PRIM ref. Ignd-LPCT PRIM Vph-LPCT SEC Vgnd-LPCT SEC Corr.factor IL1 Corr.factor IL2
P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1
Primary refer. phase current for prot. Rated primary phase current LPCT Primary refer. ground current for prot. Rated primary ground current LPCT Rated secondary phase voltage LPCT Rated secondary ground voltage LPCT Correction factor for magnitude IL1 Correction factor for magnitude IL2
456
Parameter Corr.factor IL3 Corr.factor IE Corr.factor IEE V-LPVT SEC V-LPVT PHA WAVEFORMTRIGGER
Function P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 Osc. Fault Rec.
Setting Options 0.9000 .. 1.1000 0.9000 .. 1.1000 0.9000 .. 1.1000 3.00 .. 17.00 V -10.00 .. 10.00 Save w. Pickup Save w. TRIP Start w. TRIP 0.30 .. 5.00 sec 0.05 .. 0.50 sec 0.05 .. 0.50 sec 0.10 .. 5.00 sec; Target on PU Target on TRIP YES NO Ignd (measured) 3I0 (calcul.) Vphph Vph-n V1 V2 V1 Vphph Vph-n image 1 image 2 image 3 image 4 image 5 image 6 OFF ON 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 OFF ON OFF ON -1440 .. 1440 min -1440 .. 1440 min 1 .. 12 1 .. 5 Monday Tuesday Wednesday Thursday Friday Saturday Sunday 1 .. 24
Comments Correction factor for magnitude IL3 Correction factor for magnitude IE Correction factor for magnitude IEE rated secondary voltage LPVT phase angle LPVT Waveform Capture
MAX. LENGTH PRE. TRIG. TIME POST REC. TIME BinIn CAPT.TIME FltDisp.LED/LCD Spont. FltDisp. Gnd O/Cprot. w. OP. QUANTITY 59
Osc. Fault Rec. Osc. Fault Rec. Osc. Fault Rec. Osc. Fault Rec. Device, General Device, General P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1
2.00 sec 0.25 sec 0.10 sec 0.50 sec Target on PU NO Ignd (measured) Vphph
Max. length of a Waveform Capture Record Captured Waveform Prior to Trigger Captured Waveform after Event Capture Time via Binary Input Fault Display on LED / LCD Spontaneous display of flt.annunciations Ground Overcurrent protection with Opera. Quantity for 59 Overvolt. Prot.
615A
OP. QUANTITY 27
P.System Data 1
V1
640
Start image DD
Device, General
image 1
651 660 661 662 663 664 665 666 667 668 669 670 671 672 673 674
ParEN100(LC)blk IP adr[0](Prim) IP adr[1](Prim) IP adr[2](Prim) IP adr[3](Prim) IP adr[0] (Sec) IP adr[1] (Sec) IP adr[2] (Sec) IP adr[3] (Sec) Client activ Daylight Set Offset TZ/min Offset DayT/min W2S month W2S week W2S day
Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General
DIGSI-config. over EN100 (LC) blocked IP address [0] (NTP-Primary) IP address [1] (NTP-Primary) IP address [2] (NTP-Primary) IP address [3] (NTP-Primary) IP address [0] (NTP-Sekundary) IP address [1] (NTP-Sekundary) IP address [2] (NTP-Sekundary) IP address [3] (NTP-Sekundary) Client activ Daylight Set Offset for time zone in minutes Offset for daylight in minutes month of time set winter to summer week of time set winter to summer day of time set winter to summer
675
W2S hour
Device, General
457
Setting Options 1 .. 12 1 .. 5 Monday Tuesday Wednesday Thursday Friday Saturday Sunday 1 .. 24 YES NO 0.10 .. 800.00 kV 10 .. 50000 A 10 5
Default Setting
Comments month of time set summer to winter week of time set summer to winter day of time set summer to winter
Sunday
Device, General Device, General P.System Data 2 P.System Data 2 P.System Data 2 1A 5A
3 NO 20.00 kV 400 A 2.50 A 12.50 A not reversed ON 4.00 A 20.00 A 0.00 sec 1.00 A 5.00 A 0.50 sec 1.00 A 5.00 A 0.50 sec 5.00 Disk Emulation Normal Inverse
hour of time set summer to winter GOOSE-Stop Measurem:FullScaleVoltage(Equipm.rating) Measurem:FullScaleCurrent(Equipm.rating) Motor Start Current (Block 49, Start 48) P,Q operational measured values sign 50, 51 Phase Time Overcurrent 50-2 Pickup
0.10 .. 35.00 A; 0.50 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; 0.10 .. 35.00 A; 0.50 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec;
1203 1204
1205 1207
0.10 .. 4.00 A 0.50 .. 20.00 A 0.05 .. 3.20 sec; 0.50 .. 15.00 ; Instantaneous Disk Emulation Normal Inverse Very Inverse Extremely Inv. Long Inverse Very Inverse Inverse Short Inverse Long Inverse Moderately Inv. Extremely Inv. Definite Inv. 50-3 instant. 50-2 instant. 50 -1 instant. 51 instant. Inactive Always 0.00 .. 60.00 sec Always 1.00 .. 35.00 A; 5.00 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; Fundamental True RMS Instantaneous Fundamental True RMS Fundamental True RMS
1212
51 ANSI CURVE
50/51 Overcur.
Very Inverse
ANSI Curve
1213A
MANUAL CLOSE
50/51 Overcur.
50-2 instant.
1218 1219A
1220A 1221A
Fundamental Fundamental
458
Setting Options Fundamental True RMS NO Volt. controll. Volt. restraint 10.0 .. 125.0 V ON OFF
75.0 V ON 0.50 A 2.50 A 0.10 sec 0.20 A 1.00 A 0.50 sec 0.20 A 1.00 A 0.20 sec 5.00 Disk Emulation Normal Inverse
51V V< Threshold for Release Ip 50N, 51N Ground Time Overcurrent 50N-2 Pickup
0.05 .. 35.00 A; 0.25 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; 0.05 .. 35.00 A; 0.25 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec;
1303 1304
1305 1307
0.05 .. 4.00 A 0.25 .. 20.00 A 0.05 .. 3.20 sec; 0.50 .. 15.00 ; Instantaneous Disk Emulation Normal Inverse Very Inverse Extremely Inv. Long Inverse Very Inverse Inverse Short Inverse Long Inverse Moderately Inv. Extremely Inv. Definite Inv. 50N-3 instant. 50N-2 instant. 50N-1 instant. 51N instant. Inactive Always 0.00 .. 60.00 sec Always 0.25 .. 35.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; Fundamental True RMS Instantaneous Fundamental True RMS Fundamental True RMS Fundamental True RMS Forward Reverse Non-Directional Forward Reverse Non-Directional Forward Reverse Non-Directional Forward Reverse Non-Directional OFF ON
51N TIME DIAL 51N TIME DIAL 51N Drop-out 51N IEC CURVE
51N Time Dial 51N Time Dial Drop-Out Characteristic IEC Curve
1312
50/51 Overcur.
Very Inverse
ANSI Curve
1313A
MANUAL CLOSE
50/51 Overcur.
50N-2 instant.
50N-2 active 50N T DROP-OUT 50N-3 active 50N-3 PICKUP 50N-3 DELAY 50N-3 measurem.
50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur.
50N-2 active 50N Drop-Out Time Delay 50N-3 active 50N-3 Pickup 50N-3 Time Delay 50N-3 measurement of
1524
67-1 Direction
67 Direct. O/C
Forward
67-1 Direction
1525
67-TOC Direct.
67 Direct. O/C
Forward
67-TOC Direction
1526
67-3 Direction
67 Direct. O/C
Forward
67-3 Direction
1601
FCT 67N/67N-TOC
67 Direct. O/C
OFF
459
Addr. 1602
C 1A 5A
Setting Options 0.05 .. 35.00 A; 0.25 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; 0.05 .. 35.00 A; 0.25 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec;
Default Setting 0.50 A 2.50 A 0.10 sec 0.20 A 1.00 A 0.50 sec 0.20 A 1.00 A 0.20 sec 5.00 Disk Emulation Normal Inverse
1603 1604
1605 1607
0.05 .. 4.00 A 0.25 .. 20.00 A 0.05 .. 3.20 sec; 0.50 .. 15.00 ; Instantaneous Disk Emulation Normal Inverse Very Inverse Extremely Inv. Long Inverse Very Inverse Inverse Short Inverse Long Inverse Moderately Inv. Extremely Inv. Definite Inv. 67N-3 instant. 67N-2 instant. 67N-1 instant. 67N-TOC instant Inactive always with VN and IN with V2 and I2 0.00 .. 60.00 sec -180 .. 180 Fundamental True RMS Fundamental True RMS Fundamental True RMS Forward Reverse Non-Directional Forward Reverse Non-Directional Forward Reverse Non-Directional Forward Reverse Non-Directional Fundamental True RMS 0.50 .. 35.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; always with 79 active OFF ON No Current Breaker Contact 0 .. 21600 sec 0 .. 21600 sec 1 .. 600 sec;
67N-TOC Time Dial 67N-TOC Time Dial Drop-Out Characteristic IEC Curve
1612
67N-TOC ANSI
67 Direct. O/C
Very Inverse
ANSI Curve
1613A
MANUAL CLOSE
67 Direct. O/C
67N-2 instant.
67N-2 active 67N POLARIZAT. 67N T DROP-OUT ROTATION ANGLE 67N-2 MEASUREM. 67N-1 MEASUREM. 67N-TOC MEASUR. 67N-2 Direction
67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C
always with VN and IN 0.00 sec -45 Fundamental Fundamental Fundamental Forward
67N-2 active Ground Polarization 67N Drop-Out Time Delay Rotation Angle of Reference Voltage 67N-2 measurement of 67N-1 measurement of 67N-TOC measurement of 67N-2 Direction
1624
67N-1 Direction
67 Direct. O/C
Forward
67N-1 Direction
1625
67N-TOC Direct.
67 Direct. O/C
Forward
67N-TOC Direction
1626
67N-3 Direction
67 Direct. O/C
Forward
67N-3 Direction
67N-3 MEASUREM. 67N-3 PICKUP 67N-3 DELAY 67N-3 active COLDLOAD PICKUP Start Condition CB Open Time Active Time Stop Time
67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C ColdLoadPickup ColdLoadPickup ColdLoadPickup ColdLoadPickup ColdLoadPickup
Fundamental A 0.00 sec always OFF No Current 3600 sec 3600 sec 600 sec
67N-3 measurement of 67N-3 Pickup 67N-3 Time Delay 67N-3 active Cold-Load-Pickup Function Start Condition Circuit Breaker OPEN Time Active Time Stop Time
460
Addr. 1801
Function ColdLoadPickup
C 1A 5A
Setting Options 0.10 .. 35.00 A; 0.50 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; 0.10 .. 35.00 A; 0.50 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec;
Default Setting 10.00 A 50.00 A 0.00 sec 2.00 A 10.00 A 0.30 sec 1.50 A 7.50 A 0.50 sec 5.00 A A 0.00 sec 7.00 A 35.00 A 0.00 sec 1.50 A 7.50 A 0.30 sec 1.00 A 5.00 A 0.50 sec 5.00 A 0.00 sec A A 0.00 sec 7.00 A 35.00 A 0.00 sec 1.50 A 7.50 A 0.30 sec 1.00 A 5.00 A 0.50 sec 5.00 A 0.00 sec OFF 15 % NO 0.00 sec 7.50 A 37.50 A OFF
1802 1803
ColdLoadPickup ColdLoadPickup 1A 5A
1804 1805
ColdLoadPickup ColdLoadPickup 1A 5A
0.10 .. 4.00 A 0.50 .. 20.00 A 0.05 .. 3.20 sec; 0.50 .. 15.00 ; 1.00 .. 35.00 A; 5.00 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; 0.05 .. 35.00 A; 0.25 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; 0.05 .. 35.00 A; 0.25 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec;
1809 1901
ColdLoadPickup ColdLoadPickup 1A 5A
1902 1903
ColdLoadPickup ColdLoadPickup 1A 5A
1904 1905
ColdLoadPickup ColdLoadPickup 1A 5A
0.05 .. 4.00 A 0.25 .. 20.00 A 0.05 .. 3.20 sec; 0.50 .. 15.00 ; 0.05 .. 35.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; 1.00 .. 35.00 A; 5.00 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; 0.05 .. 35.00 A; 0.25 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; 0.05 .. 35.00 A; 0.25 .. 175.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec;
51Nc T-DIAL 51Nc T-DIAL 50Nc-3 PICKUP 50Nc-3 DELAY 67c-3 PICKUP
51Nc Time Dial 51Nc Time Dial 50Nc-3 Pickup 50Nc-3 Time Delay 67c-3 Pickup
2009 2101
ColdLoadPickup ColdLoadPickup 1A 5A
2102 2103
ColdLoadPickup ColdLoadPickup 1A 5A
2104 2105
ColdLoadPickup ColdLoadPickup 1A 5A
0.05 .. 4.00 A 0.25 .. 20.00 A 0.05 .. 3.20 sec; 0.50 .. 15.00 ; 0.25 .. 35.00 A; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; OFF ON 10 .. 45 % NO YES 0.00 .. 180.00 sec
67Nc-TOC T-DIAL 67Nc-TOC T-DIAL 67Nc-3 PICKUP 67Nc-3 DELAY INRUSH REST. 2nd HARMONIC CROSS BLOCK CROSS BLK TIMER I Max
ColdLoadPickup ColdLoadPickup ColdLoadPickup ColdLoadPickup 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 1A 5A
67Nc-TOC Time Dial 67Nc-TOC Time Dial 67Nc-3 Pickup 67Nc-3 Time Delay Inrush Restraint 2nd. harmonic in % of fundamental Cross Block Cross Block Time Maximum Current for Inrush Restraint (Sensitive) Ground Fault
3101
3102
CT Err. I1
1A 5A
0.050 A 0.250 A
461
Addr. 3102
Parameter CT Err. I1
C 1A 5A
Default Setting 1.00 A 5.00 A 0.0 1.000 A 5.000 A 10.00 A 50.00 A 0.0 40 V 75 V 40.0 V 70.0 V 1.00 sec 10.00 sec 0.300 A 1.500 A 10.00 A 50.00 A 1.00 sec Forward
3103 3104
CT Err. F1 CT Err. I2
0.001 .. 1.600 A 0.005 .. 8.000 A 0.05 .. 35.00 A 0.25 .. 175.00 A 0.0 .. 5.0 10 .. 100 V 10 .. 100 V 1.8 .. 200.0 V; 10.0 .. 225.0 V; 0.04 .. 320.00 sec; 0.10 .. 40000.00 sec;
3104
CT Err. I2
1A 5A
CT Err. F2 VPH MIN VPH MAX 64-1 VGND 64-1 VGND T-DELAY Pickup 64-1 DELAY 50Ns-2 PICKUP
Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault 1A 5A
CT Angle Error at I2 L-Gnd Voltage of Faulted Phase Vph Min L-Gnd Voltage of Unfaulted Phase Vph Max 64-1 Ground Displacement Voltage 64-1 Ground Displacement Voltage Time-DELAY Pickup 64-1 Time Delay 50Ns-2 Pickup
0.001 .. 1.600 A 0.005 .. 8.000 A 0.05 .. 35.00 A 0.25 .. 175.00 A 0.00 .. 320.00 sec; Forward Reverse Non-Directional
3113
50Ns-2 PICKUP
1A 5A
50Ns-2 Pickup
3114 3115
3117
50Ns-1 PICKUP
1A 5A
0.001 .. 1.600 A 0.005 .. 8.000 A 0.05 .. 35.00 A 0.25 .. 175.00 A 0.00 .. 320.00 sec;
0.100 A 0.500 A 2.00 A 10.00 A 2.00 sec 0.100 A 0.500 A 1.00 A 5.00 A 1.00 sec 0.00 sec Forward
50Ns-1 Pickup
3117
50Ns-1 PICKUP
1A 5A
50Ns-1 Pickup
3118 3119
0.001 .. 1.400 A 0.005 .. 7.000 A 0.05 .. 4.00 A 0.25 .. 20.00 A 0.10 .. 4.00 sec; 0.00 .. 60.00 sec Forward Reverse Non-Directional
3119
51Ns PICKUP
1A 5A
51Ns Pickup
3123
RELEASE DIRECT.
1A 5A
0.001 .. 1.200 A 0.005 .. 6.000 A 0.05 .. 30.00 A 0.25 .. 150.00 A -45.0 .. 45.0 COS SIN 0 .. 60 sec Vgnd OR INs Vgnd AND INs 1.00 .. 20.00 MofPU; 0.01 .. 999.00 TD 0.4 .. 50.0 V 10.0 .. 90.0 V -180.0 .. 180.0 0.0 .. 180.0 0.4 .. 50.0 V
3123
RELEASE DIRECT.
1A 5A
3124 3125 3126 3130 3131 3150 3150 3151 3152 3153
PHI CORRECTION MEAS. METHOD RESET DELAY PU CRITERIA M.of PU TD 50Ns-2 Vmin 50Ns-2 Vmin 50Ns-2 Phi 50Ns-2 DeltaPhi 50Ns-1 Vmin
Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault
Correction Angle for Dir. Determination Measurement method for Direction Reset Delay Sensitive Ground Fault PICKUP criteria Multiples of PU Time-Dial
50Ns-2 minimum voltage 50Ns-2 minimum voltage 50Ns-2 angle phi 50Ns-2 angle delta phi 50Ns-1 minimum voltage
462
Parameter 50Ns-1 Vmin 50Ns-1 Phi 50Ns-1 DeltaPhi 1 red.dir.area 2 red.dir.area INTERM.EF Iie>
Function Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Intermit. EF Intermit. EF
Default Setting 15.0 V -160.0 100.0 2 2 OFF 1.00 A 5.00 A 1.00 A 5.00 A 1.000 A 0.10 sec 20.00 sec 300 sec 3 OFF
Comments 50Ns-1 minimum voltage 50Ns-1 angle phi 50Ns-1 angle delta phi Alpha1 (reduction directional area) Alpha2 (reduction directional area) Intermittent earth fault protection Pick-up value of interm. E/F stage Pick-up value of interm. E/F stage Pick-up value of interm. E/F stage Detection extension time Sum of detection times Reset time No. of det. for start of int. E/F prot Dir. Intermittent earth fault protection
1A 5A
0.05 .. 35.00 A 0.25 .. 175.00 A 0.05 .. 35.00 A 0.25 .. 175.00 A 0.005 .. 1.500 A 0.00 .. 10.00 sec 0.00 .. 100.00 sec 1 .. 600 sec 2 .. 10 OFF ON ON with GF log Alarm Only Forward Reverse 2 .. 50 0.04 .. 10.00 sec 2.0 .. 100.0 V with Vgnd/3V0> with oper. dir. OFF ON
3302
Iie>
Intermit. EF
1A 5A
Direction No. of pulses Monitoring time Vgnd> / 3V0> Pickup FCT 46 46-1 PICKUP
Dir. Interm. EF Dir. Interm. EF Dir. Interm. EF Dir. Interm. EF Dir. Interm. EF 46 Negative Seq 46 Negative Seq 1A 5A
Forward 5 2.00 sec 20.0 V with Vgnd/3V0> OFF 0.10 A 0.50 A 1.50 sec 0.50 A 2.50 A 1.50 sec Extremely Inv.
Direction to be protected Pulse no. for detecting the interm. E/F Monitoring time after pickup detected Vgnd> measured / 3V0> calculated Pickup of the function 46 Negative Sequence Protection 46-1 Pickup
4003 4004
0.05 .. 3.00 A 0.25 .. 15.00 A 0.00 .. 60.00 sec; Normal Inverse Very Inverse Extremely Inv. Extremely Inv. Inverse Moderately Inv. Very Inverse
4005 4006
4007
46 ANSI CURVE
46 Negative Seq
Extremely Inv.
ANSI Curve
4008
46-TOC PICKUP
46 Negative Seq
1A 5A
0.05 .. 2.00 A 0.25 .. 10.00 A 0.50 .. 15.00 ; 0.05 .. 3.20 sec; Instantaneous Disk Emulation 0.00 .. 60.00 sec OFF ON
0.90 A 4.50 A 5.00 0.50 sec Instantaneous 0.00 sec OFF 5.00 A 25.00 A 10.0 sec 2.0 sec
46-TOC Pickup
46-TOC TIMEDIAL 46-TOC TIMEDIAL 46-TOC RESET 46 T DROP-OUT FCT 48 STARTUP CURRENT
46 Negative Seq 46 Negative Seq 46 Negative Seq 46 Negative Seq 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor 1A 5A
46-TOC Time Dial 46-TOC Time Dial 46-TOC Drop Out 46 Drop-Out Time Delay 48 Startup Time Supervision for Motors Startup Current
0.50 .. 16.00 A 2.50 .. 80.00 A 1.0 .. 180.0 sec 0.5 .. 180.0 sec;
4103 4104
463
Setting Options 0.5 .. 180.0 sec; 0 .. 80 %; OFF ON Alarm Only 0.10 .. 4.00 1.0 .. 999.9 min 50 .. 100 %
Comments Startup Time for warm motor Temperature limit for cold motor 49 Thermal overload protection
49 K-FACTOR TIME CONSTANT 49 ALARM I ALARM K-FACTOR T EMERGENCY 49 TEMP. RISE I 49 TEMP. RISE I FCT 66 IStart/IMOTnom T START MAX T Equal I MOTOR NOMINAL
1.10 100.0 min 90 % 1.00 A 5.00 A 1.0 100 sec 100 C 212 F OFF 4.90 10 sec 1.0 min 1.00 A 5.00 A 2 1 5.0 2.0 6.0 min ON
49 K-Factor Time Constant 49 Thermal Alarm Stage Current Overload Alarm Setpoint
0.10 .. 4.00 A 0.50 .. 20.00 A 1.0 .. 10.0 10 .. 15000 sec 40 .. 200 C 104 .. 392 F OFF ON 1.10 .. 10.00 1 .. 320 sec 0.0 .. 320.0 min
49 Th.Overload 49 Th.Overload 49 Th.Overload 49 Th.Overload 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor 1A 5A
Kt-FACTOR when motor stops Emergency time 49 Temperature rise at rated sec. curr. 49 Temperature rise at rated sec. curr. 66 Startup Counter for Motors I Start / I Motor nominal Maximum Permissible Starting Time Temperature Equalizaton Time Rated Motor Current
0.20 .. 1.20 A 1.00 .. 6.00 A 1 .. 4 1 .. 2 0.2 .. 100.0 0.2 .. 100.0 0.2 .. 120.0 min ON OFF Alarm Only OFF ON Alarm Only
48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor
Maximum Number of Warm Starts Number of Cold Starts - Warm Starts Extension of Time Constant at Stop Extension of Time Constant at Running Minimum Restart Inhibit Time Rotor Overload Protection
4401
48/66/51M Motor
OFF
4402
48/66/51M Motor
1A 5A
2.00 A 10.00 A 1.00 sec 1.80 A 9.00 A 1.00 sec 10.00 sec OFF
4403 4404
0.50 .. 12.00 A 2.50 .. 60.00 A 0.00 .. 600.00 sec 0.00 .. 600.00 sec OFF ON Alarm Only 20 .. 260 V 20 .. 150 V 0.00 .. 100.00 sec; 20 .. 260 V 20 .. 150 V 0.00 .. 100.00 sec; 2 .. 150 V 2 .. 150 V 0.90 .. 0.99 0.90 .. 0.99
Load Jam Alarm Delay Load Jam Blocking after motor start 59 Overvoltage Protection
5002 5003 5004 5005 5006 5007 5015 5016 5017A 5018A
59-1 PICKUP 59-1 PICKUP 59-1 DELAY 59-2 PICKUP 59-2 PICKUP 59-2 DELAY 59-1 PICKUP V2 59-2 PICKUP V2 59-1 DOUT RATIO 59-2 DOUT RATIO
27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt.
110 V 110 V 0.50 sec 120 V 120 V 0.50 sec 30 V 50 V 0.95 0.95
59-1 Pickup 59-1 Pickup 59-1 Time Delay 59-2 Pickup 59-2 Pickup 59-2 Time Delay 59-1 Pickup V2 59-2 Pickup V2 59-1 Dropout Ratio 59-2 Dropout Ratio
464
Function 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt.
Setting Options 20 .. 150 V 20 .. 150 V OFF ON Alarm Only 10 .. 210 V 10 .. 120 V 0.00 .. 100.00 sec; 10 .. 210 V 10 .. 120 V 0.00 .. 100.00 sec; 1.01 .. 3.00 1.01 .. 3.00 OFF ON ON OFF 1.0 .. 100.0 V 1.0 .. 100.0 V 1.0 .. 100.0 V 10.0 .. 200.0 V
5102 5103 5106 5110 5111 5112 5113A 5114A 5120A 5201 5202 5203 5204 5205 5206
27-1 PICKUP 27-1 PICKUP 27-1 DELAY 27-2 PICKUP 27-2 PICKUP 27-2 DELAY 27-1 DOUT RATIO 27-2 DOUT RATIO CURRENT SUPERV. VT BROKEN WIRE V> Vph-ph max< Vph-ph min< Vph-ph max-min> I min>
27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. Measurem.Superv Measurem.Superv Measurem.Superv Measurem.Superv Measurem.Superv Measurem.Superv 1A 5A
75 V 45 V 1.50 sec 70 V 40 V 0.50 sec 1.20 1.20 ON OFF 8.0 V 16.0 V 16.0 V 16.0 V 0.04 A 0.20 A 1.25 sec OFF
27-1 Pickup 27-1 Pickup 27-1 Time Delay 27-2 Pickup 27-2 Pickup 27-2 Time Delay 27-1 Dropout Ratio 27-2 Dropout Ratio Current Supervision VT broken wire supervision Threshold voltage sum Maximum phase to phase voltage Minimum phase to phase voltage Symmetry phase to phase voltages Minimum line current
0.04 .. 1.00 A 0.20 .. 5.00 A 0.00 .. 32.00 sec OFF Solid grounded Coil.gnd./isol. 10 .. 100 V
5208 5301
Measurem.Superv Measurem.Superv
5302 5303
Measurem.Superv Measurem.Superv 1A 5A
30 V 0.10 A 0.50 A 0.10 A 0.50 A YES OFF 65 V 35 V 49.50 Hz 59.50 Hz 60.00 sec 49.00 Hz 59.00 Hz 30.00 sec 47.50 Hz 57.50 Hz 3.00 sec 51.00 Hz 61.00 Hz 30.00 sec 0.02 Hz OFF
0.10 .. 1.00 A 0.50 .. 5.00 A 0.05 .. 1.00 A 0.25 .. 5.00 A NO YES OFF ON 10 .. 150 V 20 .. 150 V 40.00 .. 60.00 Hz 50.00 .. 70.00 Hz 0.00 .. 100.00 sec; 40.00 .. 60.00 Hz 50.00 .. 70.00 Hz 0.00 .. 100.00 sec; 40.00 .. 60.00 Hz 50.00 .. 70.00 Hz 0.00 .. 100.00 sec; 40.00 .. 60.00 Hz 50.00 .. 70.00 Hz 0.00 .. 100.00 sec; 0.02 .. 1.00 Hz OFF ON f> ON f<
5308A
Measurem.Superv
1A 5A
Differential Current Threshold (3phase) Block protection by FFM 81 Over/Under Frequency Protection Minimum required voltage for operation Minimum required voltage for operation 81-1 Pickup 81-1 Pickup 81-1 Time Delay 81-2 Pickup 81-2 Pickup 81-2 Time Delay 81-3 Pickup 81-3 Pickup 81-3 Time delay 81-4 Pickup 81-4 Pickup 81-4 Time delay Dropout differential 81-1 Over/Under Frequency Protection
5310 5401 5402 5402 5403 5404 5405 5406 5407 5408 5409 5410 5411 5412 5413 5414 5415A 5421
BLOCK PROT. FCT 81 O/U Vmin Vmin 81-1 PICKUP 81-1 PICKUP 81-1 DELAY 81-2 PICKUP 81-2 PICKUP 81-2 DELAY 81-3 PICKUP 81-3 PICKUP 81-3 DELAY 81-4 PICKUP 81-4 PICKUP 81-4 DELAY DO differential FCT 81-1 O/U
Measurem.Superv 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq.
465
Addr. 5422
Setting Options OFF ON f> ON f< OFF ON f> ON f< OFF ON f> ON f< OFF ON OFF ON 0.06 .. 60.00 sec; OFF
Default Setting
Comments 81-2 Over/Under Frequency Protection 81-3 Over/Under Frequency Protection 81-4 Over/Under Frequency Protection 50BF Breaker Failure Protection Check Breaker contacts TRIP-Timer 50BF Pickup current threshold
5423
81 O/U Freq.
OFF
5424
81 O/U Freq.
OFF
OFF OFF 0.25 sec 0.10 A 0.50 A 0.10 A 0.50 A ON 50 V 0.75 0.50 A 2.50 A 0.50 0.10 A 0.50 A 0.10 ON 5 sec 5 sec ON 2 sec 60 Min., 1 Sub
0.05 .. 20.00 A 0.25 .. 100.00 A 0.05 .. 20.00 A 0.25 .. 100.00 A OFF ON 10 .. 100 V 0.58 .. 0.90
7007
50BF BkrFailure
1A 5A
50BF Pickup earth current threshold Measurement Supervision Voltage Threshold for Balance Monitoring Balance Factor for Voltage Monitor Current Threshold for Balance Monitoring Balance Factor for Current Monitor Summated Current Monitoring Threshold Summated Current Monitoring Factor Fast Summated Current Monitoring T Balance Factor for Voltage Monitor T Current Balance Monitor 74TC TRIP Circuit Supervision Delay Time for alarm Demand Calculation Intervals
8105 8106
BAL. FACTOR I I THRESHOLD I FACTOR FAST i MONIT T BAL. V LIMIT T BAL. I LIMIT FCT 74TC Alarm Delay DMD Interval
Measurem.Superv Measurem.Superv 1A 5A
0.05 .. 2.00 A; 0.25 .. 10.00 A; 0.00 .. 0.95 OFF ON 0 .. 100 sec 0 .. 100 sec ON OFF 1 .. 30 sec 15 Min., 1 Sub 15 Min., 3 Subs 15 Min.,15 Subs 30 Min., 1 Sub 60 Min., 1 Sub 60 Min.,10 Subs 5 Min., 5 Subs On The Hour 15 After Hour 30 After Hour 45 After Hour NO YES 0 .. 1439 min 1 .. 365 Days 1 .. 365 Days Standard Factor 10 Factor 100 0 .. 65535 0 .. 255 0 .. 255
Measurem.Superv Measurem.Superv Measurem.Superv Measurem.Superv 74TC TripCirc. 74TC TripCirc. Demand meter
8302
DMD Sync.Time
Demand meter
On The Hour
Automatic Cyclic Reset Function MinMax Reset Timer MinMax Reset Cycle Period MinMax Start Reset Cycle in Meter resolution
5000 0 0
UDP service port in the RTD box IP address[0] of RTD box, connec. by UDP IP address[1] of RTD box, connec. by UDP
466
Parameter IP address[2] IP address[3] UDP Port IP address[0] IP address[1] IP address[2] IP address[3] RTD 1 TYPE
Setting Options 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 0 .. 65535 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 0 .. 255 Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100 Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100 Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100 Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100 0 0
Default Setting
Comments IP address[2] of RTD box, connec. by UDP IP address[3] of RTD box, connec. by UDP UDP service port in the RTD box IP address[0] of RTD box, connec. by UDP IP address[1] of RTD box, connec. by UDP IP address[2] of RTD box, connec. by UDP IP address[3] of RTD box, connec. by UDP RTD 1: Type
5000 0 0 0 0 Pt 100
9012A
RTD 1 LOCATION
RTD-Box
Oil
RTD 1: Location
RTD 1 STAGE 1 RTD 1 STAGE 1 RTD 1 STAGE 2 RTD 1 STAGE 2 RTD 2 TYPE
RTD 1: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 1: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 1: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 1: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 2: Type
9022A
RTD 2 LOCATION
RTD-Box
Other
RTD 2: Location
RTD 2 STAGE 1 RTD 2 STAGE 1 RTD 2 STAGE 2 RTD 2 STAGE 2 RTD 3 TYPE
RTD 2: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 2: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 2: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 2: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 3: Type
9032A
RTD 3 LOCATION
RTD-Box
Other
RTD 3: Location
RTD 3 STAGE 1 RTD 3 STAGE 1 RTD 3 STAGE 2 RTD 3 STAGE 2 RTD 4 TYPE
RTD 3: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 3: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 3: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 3: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 4: Type
467
Addr. 9042A
Function RTD-Box
Setting Options Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100 Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100 Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100 Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100
RTD 4 STAGE 1 RTD 4 STAGE 1 RTD 4 STAGE 2 RTD 4 STAGE 2 RTD 5 TYPE
RTD 4: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 4: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 4: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 4: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 5: Type
9052A
RTD 5 LOCATION
RTD-Box
Other
RTD 5: Location
RTD 5 STAGE 1 RTD 5 STAGE 1 RTD 5 STAGE 2 RTD 5 STAGE 2 RTD 6 TYPE
RTD 5: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 5: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 5: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 5: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 6: Type
9062A
RTD 6 LOCATION
RTD-Box
Other
RTD 6: Location
RTD 6 STAGE 1 RTD 6 STAGE 1 RTD 6 STAGE 2 RTD 6 STAGE 2 RTD 7 TYPE
RTD 6: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 6: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 6: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 6: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 7: Type
9072A
RTD 7 LOCATION
RTD-Box
Other
RTD 7: Location
RTD 7 STAGE 1 RTD 7 STAGE 1 RTD 7 STAGE 2 RTD 7 STAGE 2 RTD 8 TYPE
RTD 7: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 7: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 7: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 7: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 8: Type
468
Addr. 9082A
Function RTD-Box
Setting Options Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100 Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100 Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100 Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Not connected Pt 100 Ni 120 Ni 100
RTD 8 STAGE 1 RTD 8 STAGE 1 RTD 8 STAGE 2 RTD 8 STAGE 2 RTD 9 TYPE
RTD 8: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 8: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 8: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 8: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 9: Type
9092A
RTD 9 LOCATION
RTD-Box
Other
RTD 9: Location
RTD 9 STAGE 1 RTD 9 STAGE 1 RTD 9 STAGE 2 RTD 9 STAGE 2 RTD10 TYPE
RTD 9: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 9: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD 9: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD 9: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD10: Type
9102A
RTD10 LOCATION
RTD-Box
Other
RTD10: Location
RTD10 STAGE 1 RTD10 STAGE 1 RTD10 STAGE 2 RTD10 STAGE 2 RTD11 TYPE
RTD10: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD10: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD10: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD10: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD11: Type
9112A
RTD11 LOCATION
RTD-Box
Other
RTD11: Location
RTD11 STAGE 1 RTD11 STAGE 1 RTD11 STAGE 2 RTD11 STAGE 2 RTD12 TYPE
RTD11: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD11: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD11: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD11: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD12: Type
469
Addr. 9122A
Function RTD-Box
Setting Options Oil Ambient Winding Bearing Other -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; -50 .. 250 C; -58 .. 482 F; Port B Port B
RTD12 STAGE 1 RTD12 STAGE 1 RTD12 STAGE 2 RTD12 STAGE 2 Module Port Module Port
RTD12: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD12: Temperature Stage 1 Pickup RTD12: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RTD12: Temperature Stage 2 Pickup RS485 module port for the RTD box RS485 module port for the RTD box
470
A.9
Information List
Indications for IEC 60 870-5-103 are always reported ON / OFF if they are subject to general interrogation for IEC 60 870-5-103. If not, they are reported only as ON. New user-defined indications or such newly allocated to IEC 60 870-5-103 are set to ON / OFF and subjected to general interrogation if the information type is not a spontaneous event (.._Ev). Further information with regard to the indications is set out in the SIPROTEC 4 System Description, Order No. E50417-H1100-C151. In columns Event Log, Trip Log and Ground Fault Log the following applies: UPPER CASE NOTATION ON/OFF: lower case notation on/off: *: <blank>: definitely set, not allocatable
In the column Marked in Oscill. Record the following applies: UPPER CASE NOTATION M: lower case notation m: *: <blank>:
No. Description
definitely set, not allocatable preset, allocatable not preset, allocatable neither preset nor allocatable
Function
>Back Light on (>Light on) Reset LED (Reset LED) Stop data transmission (DataStop) Test mode (Test mode) Feeder GROUNDED (Feeder gnd) Breaker OPENED (Brk OPENED) Hardware Test Mode (HWTestMod) Clock Synchronization (SynchClock) Disturbance CFC (Distur.CFC)
Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General
SP IntSP IntSP IntSP IntSP IntSP IntSP IntSP _Ev OUT IntSP IntSP IntSP IntSP IntSP
On Off on On Off On Off * * On Off * On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off
* * * * * * * * * * * * * *
* * * * * * * *
Fault Recording Start (FltRecSta) Osc. Fault Rec. Setting Group A is active (P-GrpA Change Group act) Setting Group B is active (P-GrpB Change Group act) Setting Group C is active (PGrpC act) Setting Group D is active (PGrpD act) Change Group Change Group
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
Function Key
Binary Input
Type of Informatio n
Log Buffers
Configurable in Matrix
IEC 60870-5-103
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
471
No.
Description
Function
1 2 3 4
Controlmode REMOTE (ModeR- Cntrl Authority EMOTE) Control Authority (Cntrl Auth) Controlmode LOCAL (ModeLOCAL) 52 Breaker (52Breaker) 52 Breaker (52Breaker) Disconnect Switch (Disc.Swit.) Disconnect Switch (Disc.Swit.) Ground Switch (GndSwit.) Ground Switch (GndSwit.) >CB ready Spring is charged (>CB ready) >Door closed (>DoorClose) >Cabinet door open (>Door open) >CB waiting for Spring charged (>CB wait) >No Voltage (Fuse blown) (>No Volt.) Cntrl Authority Cntrl Authority Control Device Control Device Control Device Control Device Control Device Control Device Process Data Process Data Process Data Process Data Process Data
IntSP IntSP IntSP CF_D 12 DP CF_D 2 DP CF_D 2 DP SP SP SP SP SP SP SP SP SP SP SP IntSP _Ev IntSP _Ev IntSP IntSP IntSP SP SP SP_E v SP
On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off * * On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off ON ON On Off * On Off * * * *
* * *
BO BO BO BO CB BO CB BO CB BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO CB CB CB CB CB CB CB CB CB CB CB 101 101 160 240 240 240 240 240 240 1 2 38 181 182 183 184 185 186 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 101 101 240 240 240 240 240 240 85 86 160 160 161 161 164 164 1 1 20 1 20 1 20 1 Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
* * * * * * * * * * *
* * * * * * * * * * *
LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI
>Error Motor Voltage (>Err Mot V) Process Data >Error Control Voltage (>ErrCntr- Process Data lV) >SF6-Loss (>SF6-Loss) >Error Meter (>Err Meter) >Transformer Temperature (>Tx Temp.) >Transformer Danger (>Tx Danger) Reset Minimum and Maximum counter (ResMinMax) Reset meter (Meter res) Error Systeminterface (SysIntErr.) DCP identify (DCP ident) Threshold Value 1 (ThreshVal1) Process Data Process Data Process Data Process Data Min/Max meter Energy Protocol Protocol Thresh.-Switch
No Function configured (Not con- Device, General figured) Function Not Available (Non Exis- Device, General tent) >Synchronize Internal Real Time Device, General Clock (>Time Synch) >Trigger Waveform Capture (>Trig.Wave.Cap.) Osc. Fault Rec.
472
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
Function Key
Binary Input
Type of Informatio n
Log Buffers
Configurable in Matrix
IEC 60870-5-103
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
No.
Description
Function
5 7 8 009.0100 009.0101 009.0102 15 16 51 52 55 56 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 110 113 125 126 140 160 161 162 163 167 169 170
Device, General
SP SP SP IntSP IntSP IntSP SP SP OUT IntSP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT
* * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
* * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
LED BI LED BI LED BI LED LED LED LED BI LED BI LED LED
BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO
50 51 52
1 1 1
>Setting Group Select Bit 0 (>Set Change Group Group Bit0) >Setting Group Select Bit 1 (>Set Change Group Group Bit1) Failure EN100 Modul (Failure Modul) Failure EN100 Link Channel 1 (Ch1) (Fail Ch1) Failure EN100 Link Channel 2 (Ch2) (Fail Ch2) >Test mode (>Test mode) >Stop data transmission (>DataStop) Device is Operational and Protecting (Device OK) At Least 1 Protection Funct. is Active (ProtActive) Reset Device (Reset Device) EN100-Modul 1 EN100-Modul 1 EN100-Modul 1 Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General
53 54 81 18 4 5
1 1 1 1 1 1
Initial Start of Device (Initial Start) Device, General Resume (Resume) Clock Synchronization Error (Clock SyncError) Daylight Saving Time (DayLightSavTime) Setting calculation is running (Settings Calc.) Settings Check (Settings Check) Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General
BO BO BO BO BO BO BO
160
160
22
Level-2 change (Level-2 change) Device, General Local setting change (Local change) Event lost (Event Lost) Flag Lost (Flag Lost) Chatter ON (Chatter ON) Protection ON/OFF (via system port) (ProtON/OFF) Error with a summary alarm (Error Sum Alarm) Alarm Summary Event (Alarm Sum Event) Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General P.System Data 2 Device, General Device, General
OUT_ on Ev OUT OUT IntSP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT on On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off
LED m * * * * * * * * * * LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED
BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO
1 1 1
1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Failure: General Current Supervi- Measurem.Superv sion (Fail I Superv.) Failure: Current Summation (Fail- Measurem.Superv ure I) Failure: Current Balance (Fail I balance) Failure: Voltage Balance (Fail V balance) Measurem.Superv Measurem.Superv
VT Fuse Failure (alarm >10s) (VT Measurem.Superv FuseFail>10s) VT Fuse Failure (alarm instantaneous) (VT FuseFail) Measurem.Superv
General Interrogation Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No No Yes No Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
Function Key
Binary Input
Type of Informatio n
Log Buffers
Configurable in Matrix
IEC 60870-5-103
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
473
No.
Description
Function
171 175 176 177 178 181 191 193 194 197 203 208 232 233 234.2100 235.2110 235.2111 235.2112 235.2113 235.2114 235.2115 235.2116 235.2117 235.2118 235.2119 235.2120 235.2121 235.2122
Measurem.Superv
OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT
On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off
* * * * * * * * * * * *
* * * * * * * *
BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO
35 191 192
1 1 1
Failure: Phase Sequence Current Measurem.Superv (Fail Ph. Seq. I) Failure: Phase Sequence Voltage Measurem.Superv (Fail Ph. Seq. V) Failure: Battery empty (Fail Battery) Device, General
I/O-Board Error (I/O-Board error) Device, General Error: A/D converter (Error A/Dconv.) Error: Offset (Error Offset) Alarm: NO calibration data available (Alarm NO calibr) Error: Neutral CT different from MLFB (Error neutralCT) Measurement Supervision is switched OFF (MeasSup OFF) Waveform data deleted (Wave. deleted) Failure: RTD Int. Temperature Measurem. (Fail: RTD int.) Device, General Device, General Device, General Device, General Measurem.Superv Osc. Fault Rec. RTD-Box
LED LED
BO BO BO BO BO BO FC TN FC TN FC TN FC TN FC TN FC TN FC TN FC TN BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO
135 135
197 203
1 1
OUT_ on Ev OUT OUT OUT IntSP SP SP SP SP SP SP SP SP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off
* * *
LED LED LED LED LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED LED LED LED LED
LPCT phase Current Transf. mis- Device, General matching (CT ph mismatch) LPCT ground Current Transf. mismatching (CT gnd mismatch) Device, General
27, 59 blocked via operation (27, 27/59 O/U Volt. 59 blk) >BLOCK Function $00 (>BLOCK Flx $00) >Function $00 instantaneous TRIP (>$00 instant.) Flx
* On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off * * On Off On Off * * * * * * * * * * * * *
* * * * * * * * * * * * * *
>Function $00 Direct TRIP (>$00 Flx Dir.TRIP) >Function $00 BLOCK TRIP Time Delay (>$00 BLK.TDly) >Function $00 BLOCK TRIP (>$00 BLK.TRIP) >Function $00 BLOCK TRIP Phase A (>$00 BL.TripA) >Function $00 BLOCK TRIP Phase B (>$00 BL.TripB) >Function $00 BLOCK TRIP Phase C (>$00 BL.TripC) Function $00 is BLOCKED ($00 BLOCKED) Function $00 is switched OFF ($00 OFF) Function $00 is ACTIVE ($00 ACTIVE) Function $00 picked up ($00 picked up) Function $00 Pickup Phase A ($00 pickup A) Flx Flx Flx Flx Flx Flx Flx Flx Flx Flx
474
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
Function Key
Binary Input
Type of Informatio n
Log Buffers
Configurable in Matrix
IEC 60870-5-103
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
No.
Description
Function
235.2123 235.2124 235.2125 235.2126 235.2128 236.2127 253 255 256 257 258 264 267 272 301 302 303 320 321 322 323 335 356 395 396 397 398 399
Function $00 Pickup Phase B ($00 pickup B) Function $00 Pickup Phase C ($00 pickup C) Function $00 TRIP Delay Time Out ($00 Time Out) Function $00 TRIP ($00 TRIP)
OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT IntSP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT SP SP SP SP SP SP SP
On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off *
* * * * * *
* * * * * * * * * * * * * *
LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED
Function $00 has invalid settings Flx ($00 inval.set) BLOCK Flexible Function (BLK. Flex.Fct.) Failure VT circuit: broken wire (VT brk. wire) Device, General Measurem.Superv
Failure VT circuit (Fail VT circuit) Measurem.Superv Failure VT circuit: 1 pole broken wire (VT b.w. 1 pole) Failure VT circuit: 2 pole broken wire (VT b.w. 2 pole) Failure VT circuit: 3 pole broken wire (VT b.w. 3 pole) Failure: RTD-Box 1 (Fail: RTDBox 1) Failure: RTD-Box 2 (Fail: RTDBox 2) Set Point Operating Hours (SP. Op Hours>) Power System fault (Pow.Sys.Flt.) Fault Event (Fault Event) Measurem.Superv Measurem.Superv Measurem.Superv RTD-Box RTD-Box SetPoint(Stat) Device, General Device, General
sensitive Ground fault (sens Gnd Device, General flt) Warn: Limit of Memory Data exceeded (Warn Mem. Data) Device, General
On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off * on on on on on * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * LED LED LED LED LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI FC TN BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO 150 6 1 Yes
Warn: Limit of Memory Parameter Device, General exceeded (Warn Mem. Para.) Warn: Limit of Memory Operation Device, General exceeded (Warn Mem. Oper.) Warn: Limit of Memory New exceeded (Warn Mem. New) >GOOSE-Stop (>GOOSE-Stop) >Manual close signal (>Manual Close) >I MIN/MAX Buffer Reset (>I MinMax Reset) >I1 MIN/MAX Buffer Reset (>I1 MiMaReset) >V MIN/MAX Buffer Reset (>V MiMaReset) >Vphph MIN/MAX Buffer Reset (>VphphMiMaRes) Device, General Device, General P.System Data 2 Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
Function Key
Binary Input
Type of Informatio n
Log Buffers
Configurable in Matrix
IEC 60870-5-103
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
475
No.
Description
Function
400 401 402 403 404 405 406 407 408 409 412 501 502 510 511 533 534 535 545 546 561 916 917 1020 1021 1022 1023 1201 1202
>P MIN/MAX Buffer Reset (>P MiMa Reset) >S MIN/MAX Buffer Reset (>S MiMa Reset) >Q MIN/MAX Buffer Reset (>Q MiMa Reset) >Idmd MIN/MAX Buffer Reset (>Idmd MiMaReset) >Pdmd MIN/MAX Buffer Reset (>Pdmd MiMaReset) >Qdmd MIN/MAX Buffer Reset (>Qdmd MiMaReset) >Sdmd MIN/MAX Buffer Reset (>Sdmd MiMaReset) >Frq. MIN/MAX Buffer Reset (>Frq MiMa Reset) >Power Factor MIN/MAX Buffer Reset (>PF MiMaReset) >BLOCK Op Counter (>BLOCK Op Count)
Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Statistics
on on on on on on on on on On Off on
* * * * * * * * *
* * * * * * * * * *
LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED
>Theta MIN/MAX Buffer Reset (> Min/Max meter MiMa Reset) Relay PICKUP (Relay PICKUP) P.System Data 2
* ON
* m
Relay Drop Out (Relay Drop Out) Device, General General CLOSE of relay (Relay CLOSE) Device, General
* *
* * ON On Off On Off On Off m LED BO 150 150 150 150 161 177 178 179 2 4 4 4 Yes No No No
Relay GENERAL TRIP command P.System Data 2 (Relay TRIP) Primary fault current Ia (Ia =) Primary fault current Ib (Ib =) Primary fault current Ic (Ic =) P.System Data 2 P.System Data 2 P.System Data 2
Time from Pickup to drop out (PU Device, General Time) Time from Pickup to TRIP (TRIP Time) Manual close signal detected (Man.Clos.Detect) Increment of active energy (Wp=) Increment of reactive energy (Wq=) Counter of operating hours (Op.Hours=) Accumulation of interrupted current Ph A ( Ia =) Accumulation of interrupted current Ph B ( Ib =) Accumulation of interrupted current Ph C ( Ic =) >BLOCK 64 (>BLOCK 64) >BLOCK 50Ns-2 (>BLOCK 50Ns-2) Device, General P.System Data 2 Energy Energy Statistics Statistics Statistics Statistics Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault
On Off
LED
BO
On Off On Off
* *
* *
LED BI LED BI
BO BO
151 151
101 102
1 1
476
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
Function Key
Binary Input
Type of Informatio n
Log Buffers
Configurable in Matrix
IEC 60870-5-103
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
No.
Description
Function
1203 1204 1207 1211 1212 1215 1217 1221 1223 1224 1226 1227 1229 1230 1264 1265 1266 1267 1271 1272 1273 1274 1276 1277 1278 1403 1404 1431 1451
>BLOCK 50Ns-1 (>BLOCK 50Ns-1) >BLOCK 51Ns (>BLOCK 51Ns) >BLOCK 50Ns/67Ns (>BLK 50Ns/67Ns) 50Ns/67Ns is OFF (50Ns/67Ns OFF) 50Ns/67Ns is ACTIVE (50Ns/67Ns ACT) 64 displacement voltage pick up (64 Pickup)
Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault
SP SP SP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT VI VI VI VI OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT SP SP SP OUT
* * * * * * m * m * m * m *
LED BI LED BI LED BI LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED
BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO
151 151 151 151 151 151 151 151 151 151 151 151 151 151
103 104 107 111 112 115 117 121 123 124 126 127 129 130
1 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1
64 displacement voltage element Sens. Gnd Fault TRIP (64 TRIP) 50Ns-2 Pickup (50Ns-2 Pickup) 50Ns-2 TRIP (50Ns-2 TRIP) 50Ns-1 Pickup (50Ns-1 Pickup) 50Ns-1 TRIP (50Ns-1 TRIP) 51Ns picked up (51Ns Pickup) 51Ns TRIP (51Ns TRIP) Sensitive ground fault detection BLOCKED (Sens. Gnd block) Corr. Resistive Earth current (IEEa =) Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault
Corr. Reactive Earth current (IEEr Sens. Gnd Fault =) Earth current, absolute Value (IEE =) Displacement Voltage VGND, 3Vo (VGND, 3Vo) Sensitive Ground fault pick up (Sens.Gnd Pickup) Sensitive Ground fault picked up in Ph A (Sens. Gnd Ph A) Sensitive Ground fault picked up in Ph B (Sens. Gnd Ph B) Sensitive Ground fault picked up in Ph C (Sens. Gnd Ph C) Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault
* On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off
LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED BI LED BI LED BI LED
BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Sensitive Gnd fault in forward di- Sens. Gnd Fault rection (SensGnd Forward) Sensitive Gnd fault in reverse di- Sens. Gnd Fault rection (SensGnd Reverse) Sensitive Gnd fault direction undefined (SensGnd undef.) >BLOCK 50BF (>BLOCK 50BF) >50BF Activate 3I0> threshold (>50BFactiv.3I0>) >50BF initiated externally (>50BF ext SRC) 50BF is switched OFF (50BF OFF) Sens. Gnd Fault 50BF BkrFailure 50BF BkrFailure 50BF BkrFailure 50BF BkrFailure
166 166
104 151
1 1
General Interrogation Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
Function Key
Binary Input
Type of Informatio n
Log Buffers
Configurable in Matrix
IEC 60870-5-103
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
477
No.
Description
Function
1452 1453 1456 1457 1471 1480 1481 1503 1507 1511 1512 1513 1515 1516 1517 1521 1580 1581 1704 1714 1718 1719 1721 1722 1723 1724 1725 1726 1730 1731 1732 1751
50BF BkrFailure
OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT SP SP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT SP OUT SP SP SP SP SP SP SP SP SP SP SP SP SP OUT
On Off On Off * * * * * * On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off * On Off On Off * * * * * * * * * * * On Off On Off On Off
* * * * m * * * * * * * * * * m * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED BI LED BI LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED BI LED LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED
BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO
166 166 166 166 160 166 166 167 167 167 167 167 167 167 167 167
1 1 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2
50BF is ACTIVE (50BF ACTIVE) 50BF BkrFailure 50BF (internal) PICKUP (50BF int 50BF BkrFailure Pickup) 50BF (external) PICKUP (50BF ext Pickup) 50BF TRIP (50BF TRIP) 50BF (internal) TRIP (50BF int TRIP) 50BF (external) TRIP (50BF ext TRIP) 50BF BkrFailure 50BF BkrFailure 50BF BkrFailure 50BF BkrFailure
>BLOCK 49 Overload Protection 49 Th.Overload (>BLOCK 49 O/L) >Emergency start of motors (>EmergencyStart) 49 Overload Protection is OFF (49 O / L OFF) 49 Overload Protection is BLOCKED (49 O/L BLOCK) 49 Overload Protection is ACTIVE (49 O/L ACTIVE) 49 Overload Current Alarm (I alarm) (49 O/L I Alarm) 49 Overload Alarm! Near Thermal Trip (49 O/L Alarm) 49 Th.Overload 49 Th.Overload 49 Th.Overload 49 Th.Overload 49 Th.Overload 49 Th.Overload
49 Winding Overload (49 Winding 49 Th.Overload O/L) 49 Thermal Overload TRIP (49 Th O/L TRIP) >49 Reset of Thermal Overload Image (>RES 49 Image) 49 Th.Overload 49 Th.Overload
49 Thermal Overload Image reset 49 Th.Overload (49 Image res.) >BLOCK 50/51 (>BLK 50/51) >BLOCK 50N/51N (>BLK 50N/51N) >BLOCK 50-3 (>BLOCK 50-3) 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur.
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60
144 145 1 2 3 4 5 6
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
>BLOCK 50N-3 (>BLOCK 50N-3) 50/51 Overcur. >BLOCK 50-2 (>BLOCK 50-2) >BLOCK 50-1 (>BLOCK 50-1) >BLOCK 51 (>BLOCK 51) 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur.
>BLOCK 50N-2 (>BLOCK 50N-2) 50/51 Overcur. >BLOCK 50N-1 (>BLOCK 50N-1) 50/51 Overcur. >BLOCK 51N (>BLOCK 51N) >BLOCK Cold-Load-Pickup (>BLOCK CLP) >BLOCK Cold-Load-Pickup stop timer (>BLK CLP stpTim) >ACTIVATE Cold-Load-Pickup (>ACTIVATE CLP) 50/51 O/C switched OFF (50/51 PH OFF) 50/51 Overcur. ColdLoadPickup ColdLoadPickup ColdLoadPickup 50/51 Overcur.
60
243
60
21
478
General Interrogation Yes Yes Yes Yes No Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
Function Key
Binary Input
Type of Informatio n
Log Buffers
Configurable in Matrix
IEC 60870-5-103
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
No.
Description
Function
1752 1753 1756 1757 1758 1761 1762 1763 1764 1765 1767 1768 1769 1770 1787 1788 1791 1800 1804 1805 1810 1814 1815 1820 1824 1825 1831 1832 1833 1834 1835 1836 1837 1838
50/51 Overcur.
OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT
On Off * * On Off * On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off on on * * on On Off * on On Off * on On Off * on On Off * on On Off * on On Off *
* * * * * m m m m m * * * * * * m * * m * * m * * m * * m * * m * *
LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED
BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO
60 60 60 60 60 160 160 160 160 160 60 60 60 60 60 60 160 60 60 160 60 60 160 60 60 60 60 60 160 60 60 160 60 60
1 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
50/51 O/C is ACTIVE (50/51 PH 50/51 Overcur. ACT) 50N/51N is OFF (50N/51N OFF) 50/51 Overcur.
50N/51N is BLOCKED (50N/51N 50/51 Overcur. BLK) 50N/51N is ACTIVE (50N/51N ACT) 50(N)/51(N) O/C PICKUP (50(N)/51(N) PU) 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur.
50/51 Phase A picked up (50/51 50/51 Overcur. Ph A PU) 50/51 Phase B picked up (50/51 50/51 Overcur. Ph B PU) 50/51 Phase C picked up (50/51 50/51 Overcur. Ph C PU) 50N/51N picked up (50N/51NPickedup) 50-3 picked up (50-3 picked up) 50N-3 picked up (50N-3 picked up) 50-3 TRIP (50-3 TRIP) 50N-3 TRIP (50N-3 TRIP) 50-3 TimeOut (50-3 TimeOut) 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur.
50N-3 TimeOut (50N-3 TimeOut) 50/51 Overcur. 50(N)/51(N) TRIP (50(N)/51(N)TRIP) 50-2 picked up (50-2 picked up) 50-2 Time Out (50-2 TimeOut) 50-2 TRIP (50-2 TRIP) 50-1 picked up (50-1 picked up) 50-1 Time Out (50-1 TimeOut) 50-1 TRIP (50-1 TRIP) 51 picked up (51 picked up) 51 Time Out (51 Time Out) 51 TRIP (51 TRIP) 50N-2 picked up (50N-2 picked up) 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur.
50N-2 Time Out (50N-2 TimeOut) 50/51 Overcur. 50N-2 TRIP (50N-2 TRIP) 50N-1 picked up (50N-1 picked up) 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur.
50N-1 Time Out (50N-1 TimeOut) 50/51 Overcur. 50N-1 TRIP (50N-1 TRIP) 51N picked up (51N picked up) 51N Time Out (51N TimeOut) 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur.
General Interrogation Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No Yes Yes No Yes Yes No Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No Yes Yes No Yes Yes
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
Function Key
Binary Input
Type of Informatio n
Log Buffers
Configurable in Matrix
IEC 60870-5-103
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
479
No.
Description
Function
1839 1840 1841 1842 1843 1851 1852 1853 1854 1855 1856 1866 1867 1994 1995 1996 1997 2603 2605 2606 2614 2616 2617 2618 2623 2624 2635 2636 2646 2648 2656
51N TRIP (51N TRIP) Phase A inrush detection (PhA InrushDet) Phase B inrush detection (PhB InrushDet) Phase C inrush detection (PhC InrushDet) Cross blk: PhX blocked PhY (INRUSH X-BLK) 50-1 BLOCKED (50-1 BLOCKED) 50-2 BLOCKED (50-2 BLOCKED) 50N-1 BLOCKED (50N-1 BLOCKED) 50N-2 BLOCKED (50N-2 BLOCKED) 51 BLOCKED (51 BLOCKED)
50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur.
OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT SP SP SP SP SP SP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT
* * * * * On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off * * On Off On Off On Off On Off * On Off On Off * * * * * * on on * * On Off
on On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off * * * On Off * * on On Off On Off * * * * * * * * On Off * *
m * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED LED LED LED LED
BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60
66 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110
2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1
51N BLOCKED (51N BLOCKED) 50/51 Overcur. 51 Disk emulation Pickup (51 Disk Pickup) 51N Disk emulation picked up (51N Disk Pickup) Cold-Load-Pickup switched OFF (CLP OFF) Cold-Load-Pickup is BLOCKED (CLP BLOCKED) Cold-Load-Pickup is RUNNING (CLP running) Dynamic settings are ACTIVE (Dyn set. ACTIVE) 67N-3 TRIP (67N-3 TRIP) 67N-3 is BLOCKED (67N-3 BLOCKED) 67-3 is BLOCKED (67-3 BLOCKED) >BLOCK 67N/67N-TOC (>BLK 67N/67NTOC) 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. ColdLoadPickup ColdLoadPickup ColdLoadPickup ColdLoadPickup 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C
60 60 60 60
1 1 1 1
>BLOCK 67N-2 (>BLOCK 67N-2) 67 Direct. O/C >BLOCK 67-3 (>BLOCK 67-3) 67 Direct. O/C
63
74
>BLOCK 67N-3 (>BLOCK 67N-3) 67 Direct. O/C >BLOCK 67N-1 (>BLOCK 67N-1) 67 Direct. O/C >BLOCK 67N-TOC (>BLOCK 67N-TOC) 67 Direct. O/C
63 63 63 63 63 63 63
3 4 87 88 62 63 13
1 1 1 1 2 2 1
Ground forward (Ground forward) 67 Direct. O/C Ground reverse (Ground reverse) 67 Direct. O/C 67N-2 picked up (67N-2 picked up) 67N-2 Time Out (67N-2 Time Out) 67N/67N-TOC switched OFF (67N OFF) 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C
480
General Interrogation Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
Function Key
Binary Input
Type of Informatio n
Log Buffers
Configurable in Matrix
IEC 60870-5-103
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
No.
Description
Function
2657 2658 2659 2668 2677 2678 2679 2681 2682 2683 2684 2685 2686 2687 2691 2695 2696 2697 2698 2699 2700 4601 4602 4822 4823 4824 4825 4826 4827 4828
67N/67N-TOC is BLOCKED (67N BLOCKED) 67N/67N-TOC is ACTIVE (67N ACTIVE) 67N-1 is BLOCKED (67N-1 BLOCKED) 67N-2 is BLOCKED (67N-2 BLOCKED) 67N-TOC is BLOCKED (67NTOC BLOCKED) 67-3 TRIP (67-3 TRIP) 67N-2 TRIP (67N-2 TRIP) 67N-1 picked up (67N-1 picked up) 67N-1 Time Out (67N-1 Time Out) 67N-1 TRIP (67N-1 TRIP) 67N-TOC picked up (67NTOCPickedup) 67N-TOC Time Out (67N-TOC TimeOut)
67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C
OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT SP SP SP SP OUT OUT OUT OUT SP
On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * On Off On Off * On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off
On Off * On Off On Off On Off on on On Off * on On Off * on * On Off On Off on On Off On Off * * * * * * * On Off * * *
* * * * * * m * * m * * m * m * m * * * * * * * * * * * * *
LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED LED LED LED LED BI
BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO
63 63 63 63 63
14 15 93 94 96
1 1 1 1 1
63 63 63 63 63 63 63
64 41 42 43 44 45 46
2 2 2 2 2 2 2
67N-TOC TRIP (67N-TOC TRIP) 67 Direct. O/C 67N-TOC disk emulation is ACTIVE (67N-TOC Disk PU) 67/67N picked up (67/67N pickedup) 67N/67N-TOC picked up (67N picked up) 67/67N TRIP (67/67N TRIP) 67-3 picked up (67-3 picked up) 67N-3 picked up (67N-3 picked up) 67-3 Time Out (67-3 Time Out) 67N-3 Time Out (67N-3 Time Out) >52-a contact (OPEN, if bkr is open) (>52-a) >52-b contact (OPEN, if bkr is closed) (>52-b) >BLOCK 66 Motor Startup Counter (>BLOCK 66) 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C 67 Direct. O/C P.System Data 2 P.System Data 2 48/66/51M Motor
63 63 63
50 54 55
2 2 2
>66 Mot.St. Cnt: Emergency start 48/66/51M Motor (>66 emer.start) 66 Motor Startup Counter OFF (66 OFF) 66 Motor Startup Counter BLOCKED (66 BLOCKED) 66 Motor Startup Counter ACTIVE (66 ACTIVE) 66 Motor Startup Counter TRIP (66 TRIP) >66 Mot.St. Cnt:Reset therm.memory rotor (>66 RM th.repl.) 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor
51 52 53 54 55
1 1 1 1 1
General Interrogation Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
Function Key
Binary Input
Type of Informatio n
Log Buffers
Configurable in Matrix
IEC 60870-5-103
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
481
No.
Description
Function
4829 4834 4835 5143 5145 5147 5148 5151 5152 5153 5159 5165 5166 5170 5171 5203 5206 5207 5208 5209 5211 5212 5213 5214 5232 5233 5234 5235 5236
66 Mot.St. Cnt: therm.memory rotor reset (66 RM th.repl.) Rotor thermal overload TRIP (Rot.overl.TRIP) Rotor thermal overload alarm (Rot.overl.alarm) >BLOCK 46 (>BLOCK 46) >Reverse Phase Rotation (>Reverse Rot.) Phase rotation ABC (Rotation ABC) Phase rotation ACB (Rotation ACB) 46 switched OFF (46 OFF)
48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor 46 Negative Seq P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 P.System Data 1 46 Negative Seq
OUT OUT OUT SP SP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT SP SP SP SP SP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT
On Off on On Off * On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off * * * * * On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off * * * * *
* on * * * * * * On Off * On Off On Off On Off on * * * * * * * On Off * On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off on
* m * * * * * * * * * * * m * * * * * * * * * * * * * * m
LED LED LED LED BI LED BI LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED
BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 176 177 178 179 180 181 182 183 184 230 231 232 233 234 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 128 129 131 132 133 138 150 141 149 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 168 168 70 57 58 126 2 2 1 Yes Yes Yes
46 is BLOCKED (46 BLOCKED) 46 Negative Seq 46 is ACTIVE (46 ACTIVE) 46-2 picked up (46-2 picked up) 46-1 picked up (46-1 picked up) 46-TOC picked up (46-TOC pickedup) 46 TRIP (46 TRIP) 46 Disk emulation picked up (46 Dsk pickedup) >BLOCK 81O/U (>BLOCK 81O/U) >BLOCK 81-1 (>BLOCK 81-1) >BLOCK 81-2 (>BLOCK 81-2) >BLOCK 81-3 (>BLOCK 81-3) >BLOCK 81-4 (>BLOCK 81-4) 81 OFF (81 OFF) 81 BLOCKED (81 BLOCKED) 81 ACTIVE (81 ACTIVE) 81 Under Voltage Block (81 Under V Blk) 81-1 picked up (81-1 picked up) 81-2 picked up (81-2 picked up) 81-3 picked up (81-3 picked up) 81-4 picked up (81-4 picked up) 81-1 TRIP (81-1 TRIP) 46 Negative Seq 46 Negative Seq 46 Negative Seq 46 Negative Seq 46 Negative Seq 46 Negative Seq 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq.
482
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
Function Key
Binary Input
Type of Informatio n
Log Buffers
Configurable in Matrix
IEC 60870-5-103
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
No.
Description
Function
5237 5238 5239 6503 6505 6506 6508 6509 6510 6513 6530 6531 6532 6533 6534 6537 6538 6539 6540 6565 6566 6567 6568 6570 6571 6573 6801 6805 6811
81-2 TRIP (81-2 TRIP) 81-3 TRIP (81-3 TRIP) 81-4 TRIP (81-4 TRIP) >BLOCK 27 undervoltage protection (>BLOCK 27) >27-Switch current supervision ON (>27 I SUPRVSN)
81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 81 O/U Freq. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt.
OUT OUT OUT SP SP SP SP SP SP SP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT SP SP OUT
* * * * On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off * On Off On Off On Off * * * * * * On Off On Off On Off * * * * * * On Off
m m m * * * * * * * * * * * * * * m * * * * * m * * * * *
LED LED LED LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED BI LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED BI LED BI LED
BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO
70 70 70 74 74 74 74 74 74 74 74 74 74 74 74 74 74 74 74 74 74 74 74 74
2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 2 2
>BLOCK 27-1 Undervoltage pro- 27/59 O/U Volt. tection (>BLOCK 27-1) >BLOCK 27-2 Undervoltage pro- 27/59 O/U Volt. tection (>BLOCK 27-2) >Failure: Feeder VT (>FAIL:FEEDER VT) Measurem.Superv
>Failure: Busbar VT (>FAIL: BUS Measurem.Superv VT) >BLOCK 59 overvoltage protection (>BLOCK 59) 27 Undervoltage protection switched OFF (27 OFF) 27 Undervoltage protection is BLOCKED (27 BLOCKED) 27 Undervoltage protection is ACTIVE (27 ACTIVE) 27-1 Undervoltage picked up (27-1 picked up) 27-1 Undervoltage PICKUP w/curr. superv (27-1 PU CS) 27-2 Undervoltage picked up (27-2 picked up) 27-2 Undervoltage PICKUP w/curr. superv (27-2 PU CS) 27-1 Undervoltage TRIP (27-1 TRIP) 27-2 Undervoltage TRIP (27-2 TRIP) 59-Overvoltage protection switched OFF (59 OFF) 59-Overvoltage protection is BLOCKED (59 BLOCKED) 59-Overvoltage protection is ACTIVE (59 ACTIVE) 59-1 Overvoltage V> picked up (59-1 picked up) 59-1 Overvoltage V> TRIP (59-1 TRIP) 59-2 Overvoltage V>> picked up (59-2 picked up) 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt. 27/59 O/U Volt.
59-2 Overvoltage V>> TRIP (59-2 27/59 O/U Volt. TRIP) >BLOCK 48 Motor Startup Time Supervision (>BLOCK 48) >48/14 Mot.St.Time Sup. Rotor locked (>48 Rot. locked) 48 Motor Startup Time Supervision OFF (48 OFF) 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor
169
51
General Interrogation Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
Function Key
Binary Input
Type of Informatio n
Log Buffers
Configurable in Matrix
IEC 60870-5-103
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
483
No.
Description
Function
6812 6813 6821 6822 6823 6851 6852 6853 6861 6862 6863 6864 6865 6903 6921 6922 6923 6924 6925 6926 6927 6928 6929 6930 6931 6932 6951 6961 6962
48 Motor Startup Time Superv. BLOCKED (48 BLOCKED) 48 Motor Startup Time Supervision ACTIVE (48 ACTIVE) 48 Motor Startup Time Supervision TRIP (48 TRIP) 48/14 Mot.St.Time Sup. Rotor locked (48 Rotor locked) 48 Motor Startup Time Superv. picked up (48 pickup) >BLOCK 74TC (>BLOCK 74TC) >74TC Trip circuit superv.: trip relay (>74TC trip rel.) >74TC Trip circuit superv.: bkr relay (>74TC brk rel.)
48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor 74TC TripCirc. 74TC TripCirc. 74TC TripCirc.
OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT SP SP SP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT SP OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT VI VI SP OUT OUT
On Off On Off * * On Off * On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off * On Off On Off On Off * * * * * * *
* * m * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
LED LED LED LED LED LED BI LED BI LED BI LED LED LED LED LED LED BI LED LED LED LED LED
BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO
52 53 54 55 56
1 1 2 2 1
170 170 170 153 153 170 170 152 152 152 152
51 52 53 16 17 54 55 1 10 11 12
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
74TC Trip circuit supervision OFF 74TC TripCirc. (74TC OFF) 74TC Trip circuit supervision is BLOCKED (74TC BLOCKED) 74TC Trip circuit supervision is ACTIVE (74TC ACTIVE) 74TC blocked. Bin. input is not set (74TC ProgFail) 74TC Failure Trip Circuit (74TC Trip cir.) >block interm. E/F prot. (>IEF block) Interm. E/F prot. is switched off (IEF OFF) Interm. E/F prot. is blocked (IEF blocked) 74TC TripCirc. 74TC TripCirc. 74TC TripCirc. 74TC TripCirc. Intermit. EF Intermit. EF Intermit. EF
Interm. E/F prot. is active (IEF en- Intermit. EF abled) Interm. E/F detection stage Iie> (IIE Fault det) Interm. E/F stab detection (IIE stab.Flt) Interm.E/F det.stage Iie> f.Flt. ev.Prot (IIE Flt.det FE) Interm. E/F detected (Intermitt.EF) Counter of det. times elapsed (IEF Tsum exp.) Interm. E/F: reset time running (IEF Tres run.) Interm. E/F: trip (IEF Trip) Intermit. EF Intermit. EF Intermit. EF Intermit. EF Intermit. EF Intermit. EF Intermit. EF
152 LED LED LED LED BO BO BO BO 152 152 152 152 152 152 LED BI LED LED BI BO BO BO
13 14 15 16 17 18 19
2 2 2 2 2 4 4
Max RMS current value of fault = Intermit. EF (Iie/In=) No. of detections by stage Iie>= (Nos.IIE=) >Block directional interm. E/F prot. (>dIEF block) Dir. Interm. E/F prot. is switched off (dIEF OFF) Dir. Interm. E/F prot. is blocked (dIEF blocked) Intermit. EF Dir. Interm. EF Dir. Interm. EF Dir. Interm. EF
* * *
484
General Interrogation Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No Yes No Yes No No No
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
Function Key
Binary Input
Type of Informatio n
Log Buffers
Configurable in Matrix
IEC 60870-5-103
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
No.
Description
Function
6963 6972 6973 6974 6975 6976 6979 7551 7552 7553 7554 7556 7557 7558 7559 7560 7561 7562 7563 7564 7565 7566 7567 10020 10021 10022 10023 10024
Dir. Interm. E/F prot. is active (dIEF active) dIEF: pick up (dIEF pick up) dIEF: Trip (dIEF TRIP) dIEF: No. of detected forward pulses = (No.forward=) dIEF: No. of detected reverse pulses = (No.reverse=) dIEF: No. of detected undefined pulses = (No.undef.=) dIEF: Alarm (dIEF ALARM) 50-1 InRush picked up (50-1 InRushPU) 50N-1 InRush picked up (50N-1 InRushPU)
Dir. Interm. EF Dir. Interm. EF Dir. Interm. EF Dir. Interm. EF Dir. Interm. EF Dir. Interm. EF Dir. Interm. EF 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur.
OUT OUT OUT VI VI VI OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT SP OUT OUT OUT OUT SP OUT OUT OUT OUT
* On Off on On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off * On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off * On Off On Off On Off On Off
* * *
BO BO BO
* * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED BI LED LED LED LED LED BI LED LED LED
BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO 60 60 60 60 169 169 169 169 169 88 89 90 91 60 61 62 63 64 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 2 Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 80 81 82 83 92 93 94 84 85 86 87 2 2 2 2 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
51 InRush picked up (51 InRush- 50/51 Overcur. PU) 51N InRush picked up (51N InRushPU) InRush OFF (InRush OFF) 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur.
InRush BLOCKED (InRush BLK) 50/51 Overcur. InRush Ground detected (InRush 50/51 Overcur. Gnd Det) 67-1 InRush picked up (67-1 InRushPU) 67N-1 InRush picked up (67N-1 InRushPU) 67-TOC InRush picked up (67TOC InRushPU) 67N-TOC InRush picked up (67N-TOCInRushPU) >BLOCK InRush (>BLOCK InRush) Ground InRush picked up (Gnd InRush PU) Phase A InRush picked up (Ia InRush PU) Phase B InRush picked up (Ib InRush PU) Phase C InRush picked up (Ic InRush PU) >BLOCK Load Jam Protection (>BLOCK Load Jam) Load Jam Protection is BLOCKED (Load Jam BLOCK.) Load Jam Protection is OFF (Load Jam OFF) Load Jam Protection is ACTIVE (Load Jam ACTIVE) 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur. 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor 48/66/51M Motor
LED
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
Function Key
Binary Input
Type of Informatio n
Log Buffers
Configurable in Matrix
IEC 60870-5-103
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
485
No.
Description
Function
10025 10026 10027 10028 10029 10030 10031 10032 10033 10034 10035 10036 10037 10038 10039 10040 10041 10042 10043 10044 10045 10046 10047 10048 10080 10081 10082 10083 14101 14111 14112 14113 14121 14122
48/66/51M Motor
OUT OUT VI VI VI VI VI VI VI OUT OUT OUT VI VI VI VI VI VI VI VI VI VI VI VI OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off
On Off On Off
m m
LED LED
BO BO
169 169
65 66
2 2
Load Jam Protection TRIP (Load 48/66/51M Motor Jam TRIP) Startup Duration 1 (Dur.) Startup Current 1 (Cur.) Startup Voltage 1 (Volt.) Total Number of Motor Starts (Nr.of Mot.Start) Mot.Statistics Mot.Statistics Mot.Statistics Mot.Statistics
Total Motor Running Time (Motor Mot.Statistics Run.Time) Total Motor Stopped Time (Motor Mot.Statistics Stop.Time) Motor Percent Running Time (Perc.Run.Time) 50-3 BLOCKED (50-3 BLOCKED) 50N-3 BLOCKED (50N-3 BLOCKED) Mot.Statistics 50/51 Overcur. 50/51 Overcur.
On Off On Off
* *
BO BO BO
60 60
169 170
1 1
Malparameteriz. Volt.-divider Ca- P.System Data 1 pacities (Capac.Par.Fail.) Startup Duration 2 (Dur.) Startup Current 2 (Cur.) Startup Voltage 2 (Volt.) Startup Duration 3 (Dur.) Startup Current 3 (Cur.) Startup Voltage 3 (Volt.) Startup Duration 4 (Dur.) Startup Current 4 (Cur.) Startup Voltage 4 (Volt.) Startup Duration 5 (Dur.) Startup Current 5 (Cur.) Startup Voltage 5 (Volt.) Mot.Statistics Mot.Statistics Mot.Statistics Mot.Statistics Mot.Statistics Mot.Statistics Mot.Statistics Mot.Statistics Mot.Statistics Mot.Statistics Mot.Statistics Mot.Statistics
Error Extension I/O (Error Ext I/O) Device, General Error Ethernet (Error Ethernet) Device, General
* * * * * * * * * *
* * * * * * * * * *
LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED
BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO
Error Current Terminal (Error Ter- Device, General minal) Error Basic I/O (Error Basic I/O) Fail: RTD (broken wire/shorted) (Fail: RTD) Device, General RTD-Box
Fail: RTD 1 (broken wire/shorted) RTD-Box (Fail: RTD 1) RTD 1 Temperature stage 1 picked up (RTD 1 St.1 p.up) RTD 1 Temperature stage 2 picked up (RTD 1 St.2 p.up) RTD-Box RTD-Box
Fail: RTD 2 (broken wire/shorted) RTD-Box (Fail: RTD 2) RTD 2 Temperature stage 1 picked up (RTD 2 St.1 p.up) RTD-Box
486
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
Function Key
Binary Input
Type of Informatio n
Log Buffers
Configurable in Matrix
IEC 60870-5-103
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
No.
Description
Function
14123 14131 14132 14133 14141 14142 14143 14151 14152 14153 14161 14162 14163 14171 14172 14173 14181 14182 14183 14191 14192 14193 14201 14202 14203 14211 14212 14213
RTD-Box
OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT
On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off
* * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
* * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED LED
BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO BO
Fail: RTD 3 (broken wire/shorted) RTD-Box (Fail: RTD 3) RTD 3 Temperature stage 1 picked up (RTD 3 St.1 p.up) RTD 3 Temperature stage 2 picked up (RTD 3 St.2 p.up) RTD-Box RTD-Box
Fail: RTD 4 (broken wire/shorted) RTD-Box (Fail: RTD 4) RTD 4 Temperature stage 1 picked up (RTD 4 St.1 p.up) RTD 4 Temperature stage 2 picked up (RTD 4 St.2 p.up) RTD-Box RTD-Box
Fail: RTD 5 (broken wire/shorted) RTD-Box (Fail: RTD 5) RTD 5 Temperature stage 1 picked up (RTD 5 St.1 p.up) RTD 5 Temperature stage 2 picked up (RTD 5 St.2 p.up) RTD-Box RTD-Box
Fail: RTD 6 (broken wire/shorted) RTD-Box (Fail: RTD 6) RTD 6 Temperature stage 1 picked up (RTD 6 St.1 p.up) RTD 6 Temperature stage 2 picked up (RTD 6 St.2 p.up) RTD-Box RTD-Box
Fail: RTD 7 (broken wire/shorted) RTD-Box (Fail: RTD 7) RTD 7 Temperature stage 1 picked up (RTD 7 St.1 p.up) RTD 7 Temperature stage 2 picked up (RTD 7 St.2 p.up) RTD-Box RTD-Box
Fail: RTD 8 (broken wire/shorted) RTD-Box (Fail: RTD 8) RTD 8 Temperature stage 1 picked up (RTD 8 St.1 p.up) RTD 8 Temperature stage 2 picked up (RTD 8 St.2 p.up) RTD-Box RTD-Box
Fail: RTD 9 (broken wire/shorted) RTD-Box (Fail: RTD 9) RTD 9 Temperature stage 1 picked up (RTD 9 St.1 p.up) RTD 9 Temperature stage 2 picked up (RTD 9 St.2 p.up) Fail: RTD10 (broken wire/shorted) (Fail: RTD10) RTD10 Temperature stage 1 picked up (RTD10 St.1 p.up) RTD10 Temperature stage 2 picked up (RTD10 St.2 p.up) Fail: RTD11 (broken wire/shorted) (Fail: RTD11) RTD11 Temperature stage 1 picked up (RTD11 St.1 p.up) RTD11 Temperature stage 2 picked up (RTD11 St.2 p.up) RTD-Box RTD-Box RTD-Box RTD-Box RTD-Box RTD-Box RTD-Box RTD-Box
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
Function Key
Binary Input
Type of Informatio n
Log Buffers
Configurable in Matrix
IEC 60870-5-103
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
487
No.
Description
Function
14221 14222 14223 16001 16002 16003 16005 16006 16007 16008 16010
Fail: RTD12 (broken wire/shorted) (Fail: RTD12) RTD12 Temperature stage 1 picked up (RTD12 St.1 p.up) RTD12 Temperature stage 2 picked up (RTD12 St.2 p.up) Sum Current Exponentiation Ph A to Ir^x (I^x A=) Sum Current Exponentiation Ph B to Ir^x (I^x B=) Sum Current Exponentiation Ph C to Ir^x (I^x C=) Threshold Sum Curr. Exponent. exceeded (Threshold I^x>) Residual Endurance Phase A (Resid.Endu. A=) Residual Endurance Phase B (Resid.Endu. B=) Residual Endurance Phase C (Resid.Endu. C=) Dropped below Threshold CB Res.Endurance (Thresh.R.Endu.<) Number of mechanical Trips Phase A (mechan.TRIP A=) Number of mechanical Trips Phase B (mechan.TRIP B=) Number of mechanical Trips Phase C (mechan.TRIP C=) Sum Squared Current Integral Phase A (I^2t A=) Sum Squared Current Integral Phase B (I^2t B=) Sum Squared Current Integral Phase C (I^2t C=) Threshold Sum Squa. Curr. Int. exceeded (Thresh. I^2t>) >52 Breaker Wear Start Criteria (>52 Wear start)
RTD-Box RTD-Box RTD-Box Statistics Statistics Statistics SetPoint(Stat) Statistics Statistics Statistics SetPoint(Stat)
* * *
* * *
BO BO BO
On Off
LED
BO
On Off
LED
BO
16011 16012 16013 16014 16015 16016 16018 16019 16020 16027 16028
VI VI VI VI VI VI OUT SP OUT OUT OUT On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off On Off * * * * * * * * * * LED LED BI LED LED LED BO BO BO BO BO
52 Wear blocked by Time Setting P.System Data 2 Failure (52 WearSet.fail) 52 Breaker Wear Logic blk IrCB>=Isc-CB (52WL.blk I PErr) P.System Data 2
52 Breaker W.Log.blk P.System Data 2 SwCyc.Isc>=SwCyc.Ir (52WL.blk n PErr) Sens.gnd.flt. 51Ns BLOCKED Setting Error (51Ns BLK PaErr) Angle between 3Vo and INsens. ((3Vo,INs) =) Fault recording is running (Fault rec. run.) Q0 operationcounter= (Q0 OpCnt=) Sens. Gnd Fault Sens. Gnd Fault Osc. Fault Rec. Control Device
OUT VI OUT VI
* On Off
LED
BO
* *
LED
BO
488
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
Function Key
Binary Input
Type of Informatio n
Log Buffers
Configurable in Matrix
IEC 60870-5-103
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
No.
Description
Function
31001 31008
VI VI
* *
General Interrogation
Chatter Suppression
Information Number
Function Key
Binary Input
Type of Informatio n
Log Buffers
Configurable in Matrix
IEC 60870-5-103
Data Unit
Relay
Type
LED
489
A.10
Group Alarms
No. Description Error Sum Alarm 177 178 10080 10081 10082 10083 191 193 162 163 167 175 176 264 267 208 162 163 175 176 1517 5159 5165 5166 6821 10025 1761 2691 1224 1221 1215 1521 5170 6821 10026 1791 2696 1226 1223 1217 Function No. Description Fail Battery I/O-Board error Error Ext I/O Error Ethernet Error Terminal Error Basic I/O Error Offset Alarm NO calibr Failure I Fail I balance Fail V balance Fail Ph. Seq. I Fail Ph. Seq. V Fail: RTD-Box 1 Fail: RTD-Box 2 Fail: RTD int. Failure I Fail I balance Fail Ph. Seq. I Fail Ph. Seq. V 49 Winding O/L 46-2 picked up 46-1 picked up 46-TOC pickedup 48 TRIP Load Jam pickup 50(N)/51(N) PU 67/67N pickedup 50Ns-1 Pickup 50Ns-2 Pickup 64 Pickup 49 Th O/L TRIP 46 TRIP 48 TRIP Load Jam TRIP 50(N)/51(N)TRIP 67/67N TRIP 50Ns-1 TRIP 50Ns-2 TRIP 64 TRIP
140
160
511
Relay TRIP
490
A.11
Measured Values
No.
Description
Data Unit
Position
Type
601 602
Number of TRIPs= (#of TRIPs=) Operating hours greater than (OpHour>) Ia (Ia =) Ib (Ib =)
157 145 157 157 157 157 157 157 145 157 157 157 118 157 157 157 157 157 158 118 -
No Yes No No No No No No Yes No No No No No No No No No No No -
9 3 9 9 9 9 9 9 3 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 -
1 1 2 3 4 6 7 8 2 9 10 11 1 12 13 5 15 16 1 2 -
Ic (Ic =) In (In =) I1 (positive sequence) (I1 =) I2 (negative sequence) (I2 =) Va (Va =) Vb (Vb =) Vc (Vc =) Va-b (Va-b=)
625 626 627 629 630 641 642 644 645 661 680 681 682 701 702 805 807 809 830 831 832 833 834 835 836 837 838 839
Vb-c (Vb-c=) Vc-a (Vc-a=) VN (VN =) V1 (positive sequence) (V1 =) V2 (negative sequence) (V2 =) P (active power) (P =) Q (reactive power) (Q =) Frequency (Freq=) S (apparent power) (S =) Threshold of Restart Inhibit ( REST. =) Angle Va-Ia (Phi A =) Angle Vb-Ib (Phi B =) Angle Vc-Ic (Phi C =)
Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement
134 134 134 134 134 134 134 134 134 134 -
CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC
Resistive ground current in isol systems (INs Measurement Real) Reactive ground current in isol systems (INs Measurement Reac) Temperature of Rotor ( Rotor) Thermal Overload (/trip) Measurement Measurement
Time untill release of reclose-blocking (T re- Measurement close=) INs Senstive Ground Fault Current (INs =) 3Io (zero sequence) (3Io =) Vo (zero sequence) (Vo =) I1 (positive sequence) Demand (I1 dmd=) Active Power Demand (P dmd =) Reactive Power Demand (Q dmd =) Apparent Power Demand (S dmd =) I A Demand Minimum (IAdmdMin) I A Demand Maximum (IAdmdMax) I B Demand Minimum (IBdmdMin) Measurement Measurement Measurement Demand meter Demand meter Demand meter Demand meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter
CFC
491
No.
Description
Data Unit
Position
Type
840 841 842 843 844 845 846 847 848 849 850 851 852 853 854 855 856 857 858 859 860 861 862 863 864 865 867 868 869 870 871 872 873 874 875 876 877 878 879 880 881 882 883 884 885 888
I B Demand Maximum (IBdmdMax) I C Demand Minimum (ICdmdMin) I C Demand Maximum (ICdmdMax) I1 (positive sequence) Demand Minimum (I1dmdMin) I1 (positive sequence) Demand Maximum (I1dmdMax) Active Power Demand Minimum (PdMin=) Active Power Demand Maximum (PdMax=) Reactive Power Minimum (QdMin=) Reactive Power Maximum (QdMax=) Apparent Power Minimum (SdMin=) Apparent Power Maximum (SdMax=) Ia Min (Ia Min=) Ia Max (Ia Max=) Ib Min (Ib Min=) Ib Max (Ib Max=) Ic Min (Ic Min=) Ic Max (Ic Max=) I1 (positive sequence) Minimum (I1 Min=) I1 (positive sequence) Maximum (I1 Max=) Va-n Min (Va-nMin=) Va-n Max (Va-nMax=) Vb-n Min (Vb-nMin=) Vb-n Max (Vb-nMax=) Vc-n Min (Vc-nMin=) Vc-n Max (Vc-nMax=) Va-b Min (Va-bMin=) Va-b Max (Va-bMax=) Vb-c Min (Vb-cMin=) Vb-c Max (Vb-cMax=) Vc-a Min (Vc-aMin=) Vc-a Max (Vc-aMax=) V neutral Min (Vn Min =) V neutral Max (Vn Max =)
Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter
133
55
No
205
CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC
V1 (positive sequence) Voltage Minimum (V1 Min/Max meter Min =) V1 (positive sequence) Voltage Maximum (V1 Max =) Active Power Minimum (Pmin=) Active Power Maximum (Pmax=) Reactive Power Minimum (Qmin=) Reactive Power Maximum (Qmax=) Apparent Power Minimum (Smin=) Apparent Power Maximum (Smax=) Frequency Minimum (fmin=) Frequency Maximum (fmax=) Power Factor Maximum (PF Max=) Power Factor Minimum (PF Min=) Pulsed Energy Wp (active) (Wp(puls)) Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Energy
492
CFC
No.
Description
Data Unit
Position
Type
889 901 924 925 928 929 963 964 965 1058 1059 1068 1069 1070 1071 1072 1073 1074 1075 1076 1077 1078 1079 16004 16009 16017 16031 30701 30702 30703 30704 30705 30706 30707 30708 30709 30800 30801
Pulsed Energy Wq (reactive) (Wq(puls)) Power Factor (PF =) Wp Forward (WpForward) Wq Forward (WqForward) Wp Reverse (WpReverse) Wq Reverse (WqReverse) I A demand (Ia dmd=) I B demand (Ib dmd=) I C demand (Ic dmd=) Overload Meter Max (/TrpMax=) Overload Meter Min (/TrpMin=) Temperature of RTD 1 ( RTD 1 =) Temperature of RTD 2 ( RTD 2 =) Temperature of RTD 3 ( RTD 3 =) Temperature of RTD 4 ( RTD 4 =) Temperature of RTD 5 ( RTD 5 =) Temperature of RTD 6 ( RTD 6 =) Temperature of RTD 7 ( RTD 7 =) Temperature of RTD 8 ( RTD 8 =) Temperature of RTD 9 ( RTD 9 =) Temperature of RTD10 ( RTD10 =) Temperature of RTD11 ( RTD11 =) Temperature of RTD12 ( RTD12 =) Threshold Sum Current Exponentiation (I^x>)
Energy Measurement Energy Energy Energy Energy Demand meter Demand meter Demand meter Min/Max meter Min/Max meter Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement SetPoint(Stat)
133 134 133 133 133 133 134 134 134 134 134 134 134 134 134 134 134 134 -
56 157 51 52 53 54 146 146 146 146 146 146 146 146 146 146 146 146 -
No No No No No No No No No No No No No No No No No No -
14 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 -
CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC CFC
Lower Threshold of CB Residual Endurance SetPoint(Stat) (Resid.Endu. <) Threshold Sum Squared Current Integral (I^2t>) SetPoint(Stat)
Angle between 3Vo and INsens. ((3Vo,INs) Measurement =) Pa (active power, phase A) (Pa =) Pb (active power, phase B) (Pb =) Pc (active power, phase C) (Pc =) Qa (reactive power, phase A) (Qa =) Qb (reactive power, phase B) (Qb =) Qc (reactive power, phase C) (Qc =) Power Factor, phase A (PFa =) Power Factor, phase B (PFb =) Power Factor, phase C (PFc =) Voltage VX (VX =) Voltage phase-neutral (Vph-n =) Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement Measurement
CFC
493
494
Literature
/1/ /2/ /3/ /4/ /5/ SIPROTEC 4 System Description; E50417-H1176-C151-A1 SIPROTEC DIGSI, Start UP; E50417-G1176-C152-A2 DIGSI CFC, Manual; E50417-H1176-C098-A5 SIPROTEC SIGRA 4, Manual; E50417-H1176-C070-A1 Additional description for the protection of explosion-protected motors of protection type increased safety "e"; C53000B1174C170
495
Literature
496
Glossary
Battery The buffer battery ensures that specified data areas, flags, timers and counters are retained retentively. Bay controllers Bay controllers are devices with control and monitoring functions without protective functions. Bit pattern indication Bit pattern indication is a processing function by means of which items of digital process information applying across several inputs can be detected together in parallel and processed further. The bit pattern length can be specified as 1, 2, 3 or 4 bytes. BP_xx Bit pattern indication (Bitstring Of x Bit), x designates the length in bits (8, 16, 24 or 32 bits). C_xx Command without feedback CF_xx Command with feedback CFC Continuous Function Chart. CFC is a graphics editor with which a program can be created and configured by using ready-made blocks. CFC blocks Blocks are parts of the user program delimited by their function, their structure or their purpose. Chatter blocking A rapidly intermittent input (for example, due to a relay contact fault) is switched off after a configurable monitoring time and can thus not generate any further signal changes. The function prevents overloading of the system when a fault arises. Combination devices Combination devices are bay devices with protection functions and a control display.
497
Glossary
Combination matrix DIGSI V4.6 and higher allows up to 32 compatible SIPROTEC 4 devices to communicate with each other in an inter-relay communication network (IRC). The combination matrix defines which devices exchange which information. Communication branch A communications branch corresponds to the configuration of 1 to n users which communicate by means of a common bus. Communication reference CR The communication reference describes the type and version of a station in communication by PROFIBUS. Component view In addition to a topological view, SIMATIC Manager offers you a component view. The component view does not offer any overview of the hierarchy of a project. It does, however, provide an overview of all the SIPROTEC 4 devices within a project. COMTRADE Common Format for Transient Data Exchange, format for fault records. Container If an object can contain other objects, it is called a container. The object Folder is an example of such a container. Control display The image which is displayed on devices with a large (graphic) display after pressing the control key is called control display. It contains the switchgear that can be controlled in the feeder with status display. It is used to perform switching operations. Defining this diagram is part of the configuration. Data pane The right-hand area of the project window displays the contents of the area selected in the navigation window, for example indications, measured values, etc. of the information lists or the function selection for the device configuration. DCF77 The extremely precise official time is determined in Germany by the "Physikalisch-Technischen-Bundesanstalt PTB" in Braunschweig. The atomic clock unit of the PTB transmits this time via the long-wave time-signal transmitter in Mainflingen near Frankfurt/Main. The emitted time signal can be received within a radius of approx. 1,500 km from Frankfurt/Main. Device container In the Component View, all SIPROTEC 4 devices are assigned to an object of type Device container. This object is a special object of DIGSI Manager. However, since there is no component view in DIGSI Manager, this object only becomes visible in conjunction with STEP 7.
498
Glossary
Double command Double commands are process outputs which indicate 4 process states at 2 outputs: 2 defined (for example ON/OFF) and 2 undefined states (for example intermediate positions) Double-point indication Double-point indications are items of process information which indicate 4 process states at 2 inputs: 2 defined (for example ON/OFF) and 2 undefined states (for example intermediate positions). DP Double-point indication DP_I Double point indication, intermediate position 00 Drag-and-drop Copying, moving and linking function, used at graphics user interfaces. Objects are selected with the mouse, held and moved from one data area to another. Electromagnetic compatibility Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) is the ability of an electrical apparatus to function fault-free in a specified environment without influencing the environment unduly. EMC Electromagnetic compatibility ESD protection ESD protection is the total of all the means and measures used to protect electrostatic sensitive devices. ExBPxx External bit pattern indication via an ETHERNET connection, device-specific Bit pattern indication ExC External command without feedback via an ETHERNET connection, device-specific ExCF External command with feedback via an ETHERNET connection, device-specific ExDP External double point indication via an ETHERNET connection, device-specific Double-point indication ExDP_I External double-point indication via an ETHERNET connection, intermediate position 00, Double-point indication
499
Glossary
ExMV External metered value via an ETHERNET connection, device-specific ExSI External single-point indication via an ETHERNET connection, device-specific Single-point indication ExSI_F External single point indication via an ETHERNET connection, device-specific, Fleeting indication, Singlepoint indication Field devices Generic term for all devices assigned to the field level: Protection devices, combination devices, bay controllers. Floating Without electrical connection to the ground. FMS communication branch Within an FMS communication branch the users communicate on the basis of the PROFIBUS FMS protocol via a PROFIBUS FMS network. Folder This object type is used to create the hierarchical structure of a project. General interrogation (GI) During the system start-up the state of all the process inputs, of the status and of the fault image is sampled. This information is used to update the system-end process image. The current process state can also be sampled after a data loss by means of a GI. GOOSE message GOOSE messages (Generic Object Oriented Substation Event) in accordance with IEC 61850 are data packages that are transmitted cyclically and event-controlled via the Ethernet communication system. They serve for direct information exchange among the relays. This mechanism facilitates cross-communication between bay devices. GPS Global Positioning System. Satellites with atomic clocks on board orbit the earth twice a day in different parts in approx. 20,000 km. They transmit signals which also contain the GPS universal time. The GPS receiver determines its own position from the signals received. From its position it can derive the running time of a satellite and thus correct the transmitted GPS universal time. Ground The conductive ground whose electric potential can be set equal to zero in any point. In the area of ground electrodes the ground can have a potential deviating from zero. The term "Ground reference plane" is often used for this state.
500
Glossary
Grounding Grounding means that a conductive part is to connect via a grounding system to ground. Grounding Grounding is the total of all means and measured used for grounding. Hierarchy level Within a structure with higher-level and lower-level objects a hierarchy level is a container of equivalent objects. HV field description The HV project description file contains details of fields which exist in a ModPara project. The actual field information of each field is memorized in an HV field description file. Within the HV project description file, each field is allocated such an HV field description file by a reference to the file name. HV project description All data are exported once the configuration and parameterization of PCUs and sub-modules using ModPara has been completed. This data is split up into several files. One file contains details about the fundamental project structure. This also includes, for example, information detailing which fields exist in this project. This file is called a HV project description file. ID Internal double-point indication Double-point indication ID_S Internal double point indication intermediate position 00 Double-point indication IEC International Electrotechnical Commission IEC address Within an IEC bus a unique IEC address has to be assigned to each SIPROTEC 4 device. A total of 254 IEC addresses are available for each IEC bus. IEC communication branch Within an IEC communication branch the users communicate on the basis of the IEC60-870-5-103 protocol via an IEC bus. IEC61850 Worldwide communication standard for communication in substations. This standard allows devices from different manufacturers to interoperate on the station bus. Data transfer is accomplished through an Ethernet network.
501
Glossary
Initialization string An initialization string comprises a range of modem-specific commands. These are transmitted to the modem within the framework of modem initialization. The commands can, for example, force specific settings for the modem. Inter relay communication IRC combination IRC combination Inter Relay Communication, IRC, is used for directly exchanging process information between SIPROTEC 4 devices. You require an object of type IRC combination to configure an Inter Relay Communication. Each user of the combination and all the necessary communication parameters are defined in this object. The type and scope of the information exchanged among the users is also stored in this object. IRIG-B Time signal code of the Inter-Range Instrumentation Group IS Internal single-point indication Single-point indication IS_F Internal indication fleeting Fleeting indication, Single-point indication ISO 9001 The ISO 9000 ff range of standards defines measures used to ensure the quality of a product from the development to the manufacturing. LFO filter (Low Frequency Oscillation) Filter for low-frequency oscillation Link address The link address gives the address of a V3/V2 device. List view The right pane of the project window displays the names and icons of objects which represent the contents of a container selected in the tree view. Because they are displayed in the form of a list, this area is called the list view. LV Limit value LVU Limit value, user-defined
502
Glossary
Master Masters may send data to other users and request data from other users. DIGSI operates as a master. Metered value Metered values are a processing function with which the total number of discrete similar events (counting pulses) is determined for a period, usually as an integrated value. In power supply companies the electrical work is usually recorded as a metered value (energy purchase/supply, energy transportation). MLFB MLFB is the acronym of "MaschinenLesbare FabrikateBezeichnung" (machine-readable product designation). It is equivalent to the order number. The type and version of a SIPROTEC 4 device are coded in the order number. Modem connection This object type contains information on both partners of a modem connection, the local modem and the remote modem. Modem profile A modem profile consists of the name of the profile, a modem driver and may also comprise several initialization commands and a user address. You can create several modem profiles for one physical modem. To do so you need to link various initialization commands or user addresses to a modem driver and its properties and save them under different names. Modems Modem profiles for a modem connection are saved in this object type. MV Measured value MVMV Metered value which is formed from the measured value MVT Measured value with time MVU Measured value, user-defined Navigation pane The left pane of the project window displays the names and symbols of all containers of a project in the form of a folder tree. Object Each element of a project structure is called an object in DIGSI.
503
Glossary
Object properties Each object has properties. These might be general properties that are common to several objects. An object can also have specific properties. Off-line In offline mode a link with the SIPROTEC 4 device is not necessary. You work with data which are stored in files. OI_F Output indication fleeting Transient information On-line When working in online mode, there is a physical link to a SIPROTEC 4 device which can be implemented in various ways. This link can be implemented as a direct connection, as a modem connection or as a PROFIBUS FMS connection. OUT Output indication Parameter set The parameter set is the set of all parameters that can be set for a SIPROTEC 4 device. Phone book User addresses for a modem connection are saved in this object type. PMV Pulse metered value Process bus Devices featuring a process bus interface can communicate directly with the SICAM HV modules. The process bus interface is equipped with an Ethernet module. PROFIBUS PROcess FIeld BUS, the German process and field bus standard, as specified in the standard EN 50170, Volume 2, PROFIBUS. It defines the functional, electrical, and mechanical properties for a bit-serial field bus. PROFIBUS Address Within a PROFIBUS network a unique PROFIBUS address has to be assigned to each SIPROTEC 4 device. A total of 254 PROFIBUS addresses are available for each PROFIBUS network. Project Content-wise, a project is the image of a real power supply system. Graphically, a project is represented by a number of objects which are integrated in a hierarchical structure. Physically, a project consists of a series of folders and files containing project data.
504
Glossary
Protection devices All devices with a protective function and no control display. Reorganizing Frequent addition and deletion of objects creates memory areas that can no longer be used. By cleaning up projects, you can release these memory areas. However, a clean up also reassigns the VD addresses. As a consequence, all SIPROTEC 4 devices need to be reinitialized. RIO file Relay data Interchange format by Omicron. RSxxx interface Serial interfaces RS232, RS422/485 SCADA Interface Rear serial interface on the devices for connecting to a control system via IEC or PROFIBUS. Service port Rear serial interface on the devices for connecting DIGSI (for example, via modem). Setting parameters General term for all adjustments made to the device. Parameterization jobs are executed by means of DIGSI or, in some cases, directly on the device. SI Single point indication SI_F Single-point indication fleeting Transient information, Single-point indication SICAM PAS (Power Automation System) Substation control system: The range of possible configurations spans from integrated standalone systems (SICAM PAS and M&C with SICAM PAS CC on one computer) to separate hardware for SICAM PAS and SICAM PAS CC to distributed systems with multiple SICAM Station Units. The software is a modular system with basic and optional packages. SICAM PAS is a purely distributed system: the process interface is implemented by the use of bay units / remote terminal units. SICAM Station Unit The SICAM Station Unit with its special hardware (no fan, no rotating parts) and its Windows XP Embedded operating system is the basis for SICAM PAS.
505
Glossary
SICAM WinCC The SICAM WinCC operator control and monitoring system displays the condition of your network graphically, visualizes alarms and indications, archives the network data, allows to intervene manually in the process and manages the system rights of the individual employee. Single command Single commands are process outputs which indicate 2 process states (for example, ON/OFF) at one output. Single point indication Single indications are items of process information which indicate 2 process states (for example, ON/OFF) at one output. SIPROTEC The registered trademark SIPROTEC is used for devices implemented on system base V4. SIPROTEC 4 device This object type represents a real SIPROTEC 4 device with all the setting values and process data it contains. SIPROTEC 4 variant This object type represents a variant of an object of type SIPROTEC 4 device. The device data of this variant may well differ from the device data of the source object. However, all variants derived from the source object have the same VD address as the source object. For this reason, they always correspond to the same real SIPROTEC 4 device as the source object. Objects of type SIPROTEC 4 variant have a variety of uses, such as documenting different operating states when entering parameter settings of a SIPROTEC 4 device. Slave A slave may only exchange data with a master after being prompted to do so by the master. SIPROTEC 4 devices operate as slaves. Time stamp Time stamp is the assignment of the real time to a process event. Topological view DIGSI Manager always displays a project in the topological view. This shows the hierarchical structure of a project with all available objects. Transformer Tap Indication Transformer tap indication is a processing function on the DI by means of which the tap of the transformer tap changer can be detected together in parallel and processed further. Transient information A transient information is a brief transient single-point indication at which only the coming of the process signal is detected and processed immediately.
506
Glossary
Tree view The left pane of the project window displays the names and symbols of all containers of a project in the form of a folder tree. This area is called the tree view. TxTap Transformer Tap Indication User address A user address comprises the name of the station, the national code, the area code and the user-specific phone number. Users DIGSI V4.6 and higher allows up to 32 compatible SIPROTEC 4 devices to communicate with each other in an inter-relay communication network. The individual participating devices are called users. VD A VD (Virtual Device) includes all communication objects and their properties and states that are used by a communication user through services. A VD can be a physical device, a module of a device or a software module. VD address The VD address is assigned automatically by DIGSI Manager. It exists only once in the entire project and thus serves to identify unambiguously a real SIPROTEC 4 device. The VD address assigned by DIGSI Manager must be transferred to the SIPROTEC 4 device in order to allow communication with DIGSI Device Editor. VFD A VFD (Virtual Field Device) includes all communication objects and their properties and states that are used by a communication user through services. VI Value Indication
507
Glossary
508
Index
4
46-1, 46-2 120 Current Balance Monitoring 165 Current inputs 350 Current Symmetry Monitoring 167
A
Alternating voltage 351 Ambient temperature 155 Analog Inputs 350 ATEX100 136, 156 Auxiliary voltage 351
D
Definite-time overcurrent protection 360 Determination of Ground-faulted Phase 186, 192 Device-Specific CFC Blocks 404 Direct voltage 351 Direction Check with Load Current 340 Directional intermittent ground fault protection 213, 396 Directional Overcurrent Protection Blocking by FFM 93 Directional overcurrent protection ground 373 Directional, inverse-time overcurrent protection 92 Dynamic cold load pickup 375
B
Binary inputs 351 Binary outputs 351 Breaker Failure Protection 218 Breaker failure protection 397 Broken wire monitoring 173 Buffer battery 164
E
Electrical tests 355 EMC tests for immunity (type tests) 355 EMC tests for noise emission (type test) 356 Emergency Start 137 Energy counter 411 Equilibrium Time 135
C
Changing Setting Groups 54 Check: Circuit Breaker Failure Protection 335 Check: Current and Voltage Connection 337 Check: Direction 340 Check: Phase Rotation 338 Check: Polarity for Current Input IN 342 Check: Switching States of the Binary Inputs and Outputs 333 Check: System Connections 325 Check: Termination 324 Check: Tripping/Closing for the Configured Operating Devices 346 Checking: User-Defined Functions 337 Circuit breaker monitoring 411 Climatic Stress Tests 357 Clock 412 Commissioning aids 412 Communication interfaces 352 Constructive designs 358 Coolant temperature 155 Cross Blocking 73
F
Fault Display Setting note 35 Fault logging 410 Fault recording 410 Fiber-optic Cables 323 Final Preparation of the Device 348 Flexible protection functions 398 Frequency Protection 150 Frequency protection 388 Function blocks 403 Fuse failure monitor 169
509
Index
G
General Device Pickup 258 General diagrams 423 General tripping 259 Ground fault Measurement procedure cos 188 Ground Fault Check 341 Ground Fault Detection Current Element for cos-/ sin- 186 Current Element for U0/10- 193 Direction Determination for cos-/ sin- 187, 201 Logic for cos-/ sin- 189 Logic for U0/10- 194 Tripping Range for U0/10- 193 Voltage Element for cos-/ sin- 185 Voltage Element for U0/10- 192 Ground fault detection Trip time delay at V0/I0 203 Group switchover of the function parameters 412
Measuring voltage failure detection 169 Mechanical tests 356 Min./max. memory 409 Minimum Inhibit Time 135 Monitoring of the Circuit Breaker Auxiliary Contacts 220 Monitoring of the Current Flow 219 Motor restart inhibit 386 Motor starting time supervision 385
N
Negative sequence protection (definite-time characteristic) 378 Negative sequence protection (inverse-time characteristics) 379 Non-interlocked Switching 290
O
Offset Monitoring 167 Operating hours counter 411 Operational Measured Temperature Values 401, 401 Operational measured values 408 Ordering Data 418 Output relays binary outputs 352 Overfrequency 150 Overload protection 154
H
Hardware monitoring 164 Hours Meter "CB open" 263 Humidity 357
I
I/O 2 Extension Module 245 Inrush Restraint 72, 94 Inrush restraint 94, 374 Insulation test 355 Insulation Test of Temperature Detectors 355 Interlocked Switching 290 Intermittent Ground Fault Protection 207 Intermittent ground fault protection 395 Inverse Time Overcurrent Protection 66 Inverse-time overcurrent protection 362
P
Phase rotation reversal 256 Phase Sequence Monitoring 169 Pickup logic 258 Polarity Check for Current Input IN 342 Port A 352 Port B 353
R L
Limits for CFC blocks 405 Limits for user-defined functions 405 Load jam protection 387 Local measured value monitoring 410 Long-term mean values 409 Recordings for Tests 346 Regulations 355 Restart Threshold 135 Restart Time 135 Reverse Interlocking Busbar Protection 76 Rotor Overload Detection 135 RTD-Box 324
M
Malfunction responses of monitoring equipment 182 Measured value monitoring 164
510
Index
S
Selection of Default Display Start page 35 Sensitive Ground Fault Detection 185 Sensitive ground fault detection 391 Service conditions 358 Software Monitoring 167 Standard Interlocking 291 Supply voltage 351 Switchgear Control 286 Switching authority 294 Switching device control 413 Switching mode 295 Switching statistics 411
V
Vibration and shock stress during steady-state operation 356 Vibration and shock stress during transport 357 voltage controlled 69 Voltage inputs 350 Voltage Protection 27, 59 376 Voltage supply 351 Voltage Symmetry 168 Voltage-restraint 69
W
Watchdog 167
T
Temperature Detection 401 Temperature detectors 401 Temperature Detectors at the I/O 2 Extension Module 350 Temperature Detectors with Direct Connection 401 Temperatures 357 Terminal assignment 423 Terminating the Trip Signal 259 Termination 324 Test: system interface 328 Test: Voltage transformer miniature circuit breaker (VT mcb) 338 Thermal overload protection 389 Thermal replica 154 Thresholds for temperature indications 402 Time allocation 410 Time synchronization 412 Total Time 136 Triggering Oscillographic Recording 347 Trip circuit supervision 178, 411 Trip/Close Tests for the Configured Operating Devices 346 Tripping Logic 259 Tripping Test with Circuit Breaker 346 Two-phase overcurrent protection 76
U
Underfrequency 150 Undervoltage Consideration 69 User interface 352 User-defined functions 403
511
Index
512